diff options
| author | nfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org> | 2025-01-21 20:52:34 -0800 |
|---|---|---|
| committer | nfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org> | 2025-01-21 20:52:34 -0800 |
| commit | 7d08fad16aa7a38b1b68d1fac39b8be1bd852fc5 (patch) | |
| tree | ad0bf2126f98b91d8a7604a9e6bad45fef031ca3 | |
| parent | 7af7a2cb3196911453e476210479384f728849df (diff) | |
| -rw-r--r-- | .gitattributes | 4 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | LICENSE.txt | 11 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | README.md | 2 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-0.txt | 9497 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-0.zip | bin | 156606 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h.zip | bin | 1112725 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/68182-h.htm | 11862 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/images/cover.jpg | bin | 530644 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/images/coversmall.jpg | bin | 261837 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/images/i_084.jpg | bin | 75966 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/images/i_212.jpg | bin | 65357 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/images/i_268.jpg | bin | 57393 -> 0 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/68182-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg | bin | 68624 -> 0 bytes |
13 files changed, 17 insertions, 21359 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d7b82bc --- /dev/null +++ b/.gitattributes @@ -0,0 +1,4 @@ +*.txt text eol=lf +*.htm text eol=lf +*.html text eol=lf +*.md text eol=lf diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6312041 --- /dev/null +++ b/LICENSE.txt @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements, +metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be +in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES. + +Procedures for determining public domain status are described in +the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org. + +No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in +jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize +this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright +status under the laws that apply to them. diff --git a/README.md b/README.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..558eced --- /dev/null +++ b/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,2 @@ +Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for +eBook #68182 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/68182) diff --git a/old/68182-0.txt b/old/68182-0.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 4983f12..0000000 --- a/old/68182-0.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,9497 +0,0 @@ -The Project Gutenberg eBook of The quest of the Silver Swan, by W. -Bert Foster - -This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and -most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions -whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms -of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at -www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you -will have to check the laws of the country where you are located before -using this eBook. - -Title: The quest of the Silver Swan - A land and sea tale for boys - -Author: W. Bert Foster - -Release Date: May 26, 2022 [eBook #68182] - -Language: English - -Produced by: D A Alexander, David E. Brown, and the Online Distributed - Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net (This file was - produced from images generously made available by the - Library of Congress) - -*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE QUEST OF THE SILVER -SWAN *** - - -[Illustration: “WELL, SHIPMATE, OUT GUNNING?”] - - - - - THE QUEST OF THE - SILVER SWAN - - A Land and Sea Tale for Boys - - BY - W. BERT FOSTER - - Author of “In Alaskan Waters,” “With Washington at - Valley Forge,” “The Lost Galleon,” “The Treasure - of Southlake Farm,” etc. - - _ILLUSTRATED_ - - NEW YORK - CHATTERTON-PECK COMPANY - PUBLISHERS - - - - -GOOD BOOKS FOR BOYS - - - The Young Builders of Swiftdale. By Allen Chapman. Cloth. Price, 60 - cents. - - Andy the Acrobat. By Peter T. Harkness. Cloth. Illustrated. Price, 60 - cents. - - Canoe Boys and Camp Fires. By William Murray Graydon. Cloth. Price, - $1.00. - - From Office Boy to Reporter. By Howard R. Garis. Cloth. Illustrated. - Price, $1.00. - - With Axe and Flintlock. By George Waldo Browne. Cloth. Illustrated. - Price, $1.00. - - The Crimson Banner. By William D. Moffat. Cloth. Price, $1.00. - - The Quest of the Silver Swan. By W. Bert Foster. Cloth. Price, 75 - cents. - - - Copyright, by Frank A. Munsey Co., 1894 and 1895, as a serial. - - Copyright, 1907, by Chatterton-Peck Company. - - THE QUEST OF THE SILVER SWAN. - - - - -CONTENTS - - - CHAPTER PAGE - - I. THE RAFT AT SEA 9 - - II. INTRODUCING BRANDON TARR AND UNCLE ARAD 21 - - III. AN ACCOUNT OF THE WRECK OF THE SILVER SWAN 34 - - IV. BRANDON COMES TO A DECISION 40 - - V. UNCLE ARAD HAS RECOURSE TO LEGAL FORCE 45 - - VI. RELATING A MEETING BETWEEN UNCLE ARAD AND THE SAILOR 51 - - VII. INTRODUCING “SQUARE” HOLT AND HIS OPINIONS 59 - - VIII. SOMETHING ABOUT LEAVING THE FARM 66 - - IX. ANOTHER LETTER FROM NEW YORK 72 - - X. BRANDON’S ARRIVAL AT THE METROPOLIS 79 - - XI. THE FIRM OF ADONIRAM PEPPER & CO. 85 - - XII. IN WHICH BRANDON VENTURES INTO RATHER DISREPUTABLE - SOCIETY 90 - - XIII. THE OLD SAILOR WITH THE WOODEN LEG 98 - - XIV. THE OLD SAILOR’S EXCITEMENT 103 - - XV. CALEB RECEIVES A STARTLING COMMUNICATION 110 - - XVI. TELLING HOW BRANDON BEARDED THE LION IN HIS LAIR 116 - - XVII. HOW THE OMNIPRESENT WEEKS PROVES HIS RIGHT TO THE - TERM 123 - - XVIII. BRANDON LISTENS TO A SHORT FAMILY HISTORY 130 - - XIX. TELLING A GREAT DEAL ABOUT DERELICTS IN GENERAL 137 - - XX. THE CONTENTS OF SEVERAL INTERESTING DOCUMENTS 144 - - XXI. IN WHICH MR. PEPPER MAKES A PROPOSITION TO CALEB - AND DON 151 - - XXII. INTO BAD COMPANY 156 - - XXIII. MR. ALFRED WEEKS AT A CERTAIN CONFERENCE 163 - - XXIV. HOW A NEFARIOUS COMPACT WAS FORMED 171 - - XXV. UNCLE ARAD MAKES AN ANNOUNCEMENT 176 - - XXVI. CALEB WETHERBEE OBSTRUCTS THE COURSE OF THE LAW 183 - - XXVII. WHEREIN BRANDON TARR CONCEALS HIMSELF 188 - - XXVIII. THE DEPARTURE OF THE WHALEBACK, NUMBER THREE 197 - - XXIX. THE STOWAWAY ABOARD THE SUCCESS 208 - - XXX. SHOWING WHAT MISS MILLY DOES FOR BRANDON 217 - - XXXI. WHEREIN NUMBER THREE APPROACHES THE SUPPOSED - VICINITY OF THE SILVER SWAN 224 - - XXXII. RELATING HOW THE SILVER SWAN WAS HEARD FROM 229 - - XXXIII. IN WHICH COMRADES IN COURAGE LAUNCH THEMSELVES - UPON THE DEEP 234 - - XXXIV. THE INCIDENTS OF A NIGHT OF PERIL 240 - - XXXV. SHOWING HOW CALEB APPEARED ON THE SCENE JUST - TOO LATE 250 - - XXXVI. THE CASTAWAYS ON THE BRIG SUCCESS 257 - - XXXVII. LEFT IN DOUBT 264 - - XXXVIII. HOW THE ENEMY APPEARED 270 - - XXXIX. SHOWING HOW MR. WEEKS MADE HIS LAST MOVE 278 - - XL. IN WHICH THE ENEMY IS DEFEATED AND THE QUEST OF - THE SILVER SWAN IS ENDED 286 - - - - -THE QUEST OF THE SILVER SWAN - - - - -CHAPTER I - -THE RAFT AT SEA - - -THE sun, whose upper edge had just appeared above the horizon, cast its -first red beams aslant a deserted wilderness of heaving billows. - -Here and there a flying fish, spurning its usual element, cut the air -like a swift ray of light, falling back into the sea again after its -short flight with a splash that sent myriad drops flashing in the -sunlight. - -There were not a few triangular objects, dark in color, and looking -like tiny sails, darting along the surface of the sea, first in this -direction and then in that. There was a peculiar sinister motion -to these fleshy sails, an appearance to make the beholder shudder -involuntarily; for these objects were the dorsal fins of sharks, and -there is nothing more bloodthirsty and cruel than these “tigers of the -sea.” - -It was quite noticeable that these monsters had gathered about an -object which, in comparison with the vast expanse of sea and sky, was -but a speck. It labored heavily upon the surface of the sea, and -seemed to possess a great attraction for the sharks. - -It was really a heavily built raft, more than twenty feet in length, -and with a short, stumpy mast lashed upright amidships. Near each end -was a long sea chest, both placed across the raft, and there were also -a broken water butt and several empty cracker boxes lashed firmly (as -were the chests) to the strongly built platform. - -At one end of this ungainly craft, behind one of the chests, lay two -men; at the further side of the opposite chest reclined another. - -One might have thought the sea chests to be fortifications, for all -three men were heavily armed, and each was extremely careful not to -expose his person to the party behind the opposite chest. - -Between the two boxes lay the figure of a fourth man; but he was flat -upon his face with his arms spread out in a most unnatural attitude. He -was evidently dead. - -Of the two men who were at the forward end of the raft (or what was the -forward end for the time being, the ocean currents having carried the -craft in various directions during the several past days), of these -two, I say, one was a person of imposing, if not handsome, presence, -with curling brown hair streaked with gray, finely chiseled features, -and skin bronzed by wind and weather; but now the features were most -painfully emaciated, and a blood stained bandage was wrapped about his -brow. - -His companion was a hearty looking old sea dog, well past the half -century mark, but who had evidently stood the privations they had -undergone far better than the first named. - -He was burned even darker than the other, was of massive figure and -leonine head, and possessed a hand like a ham. One leg was bent up -beneath him, but the other was stretched out stiffly, and it took only -a casual glance to see that the old seaman had a wooden leg. - -Every few moments the latter individual raised his head carefully and -peered over the chest, thus keeping a sharp watch on the movements of -the single occupant of the space behind the other fortification. - -This person was a broad shouldered, deep chested man, seemingly quite -as powerful as the wooden legged sailor. Privation and hardship had -not improved his appearance, either, for his raven black beard and -hair were matted and unkempt, and his bronzed face had that peculiar, -pinched expression with which starvation marks its victims; and this -look did not make his naturally villainous features less brutal. - -In truth, all three of these unfortunates were starving to death; the -fourth man, who lay so still upon the rough boards between the two -chests, was the first victim of the hardships they had suffered for the -last ten days. - -These four men had been members of the ship’s company of the good brig -Silver Swan, bound to Boston from Cape Town and Rio Janeiro. After -leaving the latter port three weeks before, several severe storms had -arisen and the brig was beaten terrifically by the elements for days -and days. - -Finally, after having every stick wrenched from her and even the jury -mast the crew had rigged, stripped bare, the brig, now being totally -unmanageable, was blown upon a narrow and barren reef several leagues -to the south and west of Cuba. - -The crew, who had ere this most faithfully obeyed the captain and mate, -Caleb Wetherbee, now believing the vessel about to go to pieces, madly -rushed to the boats, and lowering them into the heavy sea, lost their -lives in their attempt to leave the brig. - -Captain Tarr and mate Wetherbee were able to save only two of the -unfortunates--Paulo Montez, a Brazilian, and Jim Leroyd, the latter the -least worthy of all the crew. - -These four had built the rude raft upon which they had now floated so -long, and not daring to remain with the brig during another storm that -seemed imminent, they set sail in the lumbering craft and left the well -built and still seaworthy brig hard and fast upon the reef. - -This storm, which had frightened them from the Swan, was only severe -enough to strip their rude mast of its sail and rigging and drive them -seemingly far out of the course of other vessels, for not a sail had -they sighted since setting out on the raft. - -Slowly their provisions had disappeared, while the now calmed sea -carried them hither and thither as it listed; and at last the captain -and mate had decided to put all hands upon still shorter allowance. - -At this, Leroyd, always an ugly and brutal fellow even aboard ship, -had rebelled, and had tried to stir up his companion, Paulo, to mutiny -against the two officers; but the Brazilian was already too far gone -to join in any such scheme (in fact, he died the next forenoon), and -Caleb Wetherbee had driven Leroyd to his present position behind the -further chest, at the point of his pistol. - -Captain Tarr, who had received a heavy blow on the head from a falling -block at the time of the brig’s wreck, was far less able to stand the -hardship than either of his living companions, and, now that ten full -days had expired since leaving the Silver Swan, he felt himself failing -fast. - -Alone, he would have been unable to cope with Leroyd; but Caleb -Wetherbee stood by him like a faithful dog and kept the villainous -sailor in check. As Leroyd had demanded his share of the water and -scanty store of provisions, the mate had, with careful exactness, given -him his third and then made hint retire behind his chest again; for he -could not trust the fellow an instant. - -“The scoundrel would put two inches o’ steel between both our ribs for -the sake o’ gettin’ the whole o’ this grub,” declared Caleb, keeping a -firm grip upon his pistol. - -“He’d only shorten my time a little, Cale,” gasped Captain Tarr, a -paroxysm of pain weakening him terribly for the moment. “I can’t stand -many such times as _that_,” he added, when the agony had passed. - -“Brace up, cap’n,” said the mate cheerfully. “You’ll pull through yet.” - -“Don’t deceive yourself, or try to deceive me, Caleb,” responded -Captain Tarr gloomily. “I know my end is nigh, though I’m not an old -man yet--younger than you, old trusty, by ten years. And my life’s -been a failure, too,” he continued, more to himself than to his -companion. - -“Tut! tut! don’t talk like that ’ere. Ye’ll have ter pull through for -the sake o’ that boy o’ yourn, you know.” - -“I shall never see him again,” declared the injured man, with -confidence. “And how can I die in peace when I know that I shall leave -my son penniless?” - -“Penniless!” exclaimed Wetherbee. “Didn’t you own the brig, an’ ain’t -you been makin’ v’y’ges in her for the past ten year?” - -“I _did_ own the Silver Swan, and I _have_ made paying voyages with -her,” replied the captain weakly; “but, shame on me to have to say it, -all my earnings have been swallowed up by a speculation which turned -out to be utterly worthless. A sailor, Caleb, should stick by the sea, -and keep his money in shipping; I went into a mine in Nevada and lost -every cent I had saved.” - -“But there was the Swan,” said the dumfounded mate; “there’ll be the -int’rest money on her--and a good bit it should be, too.” - -“Aye, _should_ be,” muttered Captain Tarr bitterly; “but the brig is on -that reef and there’s not a cent of insurance on her.” - -“What! no insurance?” gasped Wetherbee. - -“No. When I left port last time my policy had run out, and I hadn’t a -cent to pay for having it renewed. So, if the old brig’s bones whiten -on that reef, poor Brandon will not get a cent.” - -“_If_ they do,” exclaimed the mate in wonder. - -“Yes, _if_ they do,” responded Captain Tarr, rising on his elbow and -speaking lower, so that there could be no possibility of the man at the -other end of the raft hearing his words; “for it’s my firm conviction, -Caleb, that we’d done better to stick by the old Swan. This last storm -drove hard from the west’ard. Suppose she’d slipped off again into -deep water? She didn’t leak enough to keep her sweet, in spite of the -terrific pounding she got from waves and rocks, and she might float -for weeks--aye, for months--and you know she’d have plenty of company -drifting up and down the Atlantic coast.” - -“But that ain’t probable, cap’n, though I’ll grant ye that we might -have done better by stickin’ by her a while longer.” - -“Probable or not, Caleb, I _feel_ that it is true. You know, they say a -dying man can see some things plainer than other folks.” - -Caleb was silenced by this, for he could not honestly aver that he did -not believe his old commander to be near his end. - -“And we had a valuable cargo, too, you know--very valuable,” murmured -Captain Tarr. “I put every cent I received from the sale of the goods -we took to Cape Town into this cargo, and would have cleared a handsome -profit--enough to have kept both Brandon and me in good circumstances -for a year. And then, there is something else.” - -“Well, what is it?” Caleb asked, after taking a squint over the top of -their breastwork to make sure that Leroyd had not ventured out. - -“If I’d got home with the Silver Swan, Caleb, I should have been rich -for life, and _you_, old trusty, should have had the brig just as she -stood, for the cost of makin’ out the papers.” - -“What?” exclaimed Caleb. - -He looked at his commander for several moments, and then shook his head -slowly. He believed that the privation they had suffered had at length -affected even Captain Horace Tarr’s brain. - -“I’m not crazy, Caleb,” said the captain faintly. “I tell you I should -have been immensely wealthy. Brandon should have never wanted for -anything as long as he lived, nor should I; and I had already decided -to give the brig to you.” - -“What--what d’ye mean if ye _ain’t_ crazy?” cried Caleb, in -bewilderment. - -“Do you remember the man who came aboard the brig at Cape Town, just -before we sailed?” asked Captain Tarr, in a whisper, evidently saving -his strength as much as possible for his story. “He was a friend of my -brother Anson.” - -“Anson!” interjected Caleb. “Why, I supposed _he_ was dead.” - -“He is now,” replied the captain; “but instead of dying several years -ago, as we supposed, he had been living in the interior of Cape Colony, -and just before he actually did die he gave a package (papers, this -man supposed them to be) to an acquaintance, to be delivered to me. -I happened to touch at Cape Town before the friend of my brother had -tried to communicate with me by mail, and he brought the package aboard -the brig himself. - -“He did not know what he was carrying--he never would have dared do it -had he known--for with a letter from Anson was a package, done up in -oil silk, of--diamonds of the purest water!” - -“Diamonds!” repeated Caleb. - -“Yes, diamonds--thousands of dollars’ worth--enough to make one man, -at least, fabulously rich!” The captain slowly rolled his head from -side to side. “After all these years the luck of the Tarrs had changed, -Caleb. Fortune has ever played us false, and even now, just when wealth -was in our grasp, it was snatched from us again. - -“After wandering up and down the earth for forty years, Anson finally -‘struck it rich,’ and am I, who was to profit by his good fortune, and -the son whom I love more than I do anything else on earth, to lose this -treasure after all?” - -He fell back upon the raft, and the exertion set the wound in his head -to bleeding again. A dark stream appeared beneath the bandage and -trickled down his forehead, while he lay, gasping for breath, upon the -bit of sailcloth which served him for a bed. - -“What did you do with the diamonds?” the mate asked, when the dying man -had again become calm. - -“I--I have written a letter to Brandon, telling him all about it,” -gasped the captain. “That is what I wrote the second day we were on the -raft. I dared not take them with me from the brig, and they are hidden -in the cabin. I know now that we made a grave mistake in leaving the -Silver Swan at all, for she may hold together for months. - -“Take--take the papers from my pocket, Cale,” he added, feebly -unbuttoning his coat, “and keep them. If you are saved I charge you to -give them to Brandon with your own hands, and I can trust you to assist -him in every possible way to recover his fortune, should such a thing -be possible.” - -The mate bent over the unfortunate owner of the Silver Swan, and with -trembling hands removed several thick documents from his pocket and -thrust them into the breast of his flannel shirt. - -As he did so and turned again, he saw the scowling visage of Jim Leroyd -peering at them above his chest. Quick as a flash he seized his pistol -and aimed it at the sailor; but Leroyd dodged out of view at once. -Without doubt, however, he had seen the papers passed from the captain -to mate Wetherbee. - -“Take good care of them, Cale,” whispered Captain Tarr. “And let nobody -else see them. I believe that Leroyd suspected something back there at -Cape Town, for he came into the cabin on an errand just as that friend -of poor Anson gave the package into my hands, and I caught him snooping -about the companionway several times afterward. It was he I feared most -when we left the brig, and therefore dared not take the diamonds with -me.” - -“I’ll shoot him yet,” muttered the old seaman fiercely, with his -weather eye cocked over the top of the chest. “I hated the sight o’ -that fellow when he first boarded the brig at New York. His face is -enough to bring bad luck to any ship.” - -But the captain was not listening to him. He had floated away into a -restless slumber, from which he only awoke once to whisper, “Remember, -Cale!” and then passed into a dreamless sleep from which there could -be no awakening in this world. - -Caleb Wetherbee closed the captain’s eyes tenderly, wrapped him in the -bit of sailcloth which had served as his bed, and fastened his lifeless -body so that no unexpected roll of the raft would precipitate it into -the water. Then he took the scant share of food left of the captain’s -hoard, and religiously divided it into two equal portions. - -“Jim!” he said, when this was done, allowing himself but a moment to -gloat over the pitifully meager supply which he laid on the chest lid. - -“Aye, aye, sir!” responded the sailor gruffly, cautiously raising his -head from behind his fortification. - -“Captain Tarr is dead, Jim, and I have divided _his_ share o’ the grub. -Put down your weapons and come forward to the chest and take your part. -Remember, no slippery business or I’ll bore a hole in ye! Step out now.” - -Suddenly the sailor arose, his ungainly, dwarfish proportions being -more manifest now that he was on his feet, and approached his officer, -stepping over the body of Paulo without a glance at it. - -His fierce eyes lighted eagerly as he saw the little supply of food (he -had already consumed all his own), and he seized it at once. While he -did so he looked at the wooden legged sailor with a crafty smile. - -“Wot was it the old man give ye, Caleb?” he asked familiarly. - -The mate scowled fiercely at him, and did not reply. - -“Oh, ye needn’t act so onery,” went on Leroyd. “_I_ knowed there was -somethin’--money I bet--that was given to the old man at the Cape. -He’s acted like a new man ever since, and if there’s anything in it, -I’m goin’ ter hev my share, jest like this share o’ the grub, now I -tell ye!” - -“You take that food and git back to your place!” roared Caleb, pointing -the huge “bull dog,” which had a bore like a rifle, at the fellow’s -head. “An’ let me tell you that I shall be on the watch, I shall, an’ -it’ll be a long say afore you catch Caleb Wetherbee asleep. Ef I ain’t -saved, _you_ won’t be, let me tell you, for ef I feel myself a-goin’ to -Davy Jones, _you’ll go along with me_!” - -Leroyd sneaked back to his place again, and crouched behind the chest. -In that position he could not see the movements of Caleb, who, after a -few moments’ thought, deposited the packet of papers where he believed -no one would think of looking for them. - -“There!” he muttered grimly. “If I _do_ foller Cap’n Tarr, I reckon -these papers’ll never do that scoundrel any good, an’ he can throw this -old hulk to the sharks and welcome. If the cap’n’s boy don’t profit by -’em, _nobody_ shall.” - -Then he folded his arms, the pistol still in his grasp, and continued -his task of watching for the rescuing sail, which it seemed would never -come. - - - - -CHAPTER II - -INTRODUCING BRANDON TARR AND UNCLE ARAD - - -LEADING from the village of Rockland, Rhode Island, a wide, dusty -country road, deeply rutted here and there, winds up to the summit of a -long ridge, the highest land in that portion of the State, which past -generations have named Chopmist. - -It is a drizzly, chilly spring day, the showers pattering down in true -April style, the sun promising to show his face every few minutes, -and then, when you are expecting his warming rays, down falls another -shower and Sol hides his face in despair. - -Near the highest part of the ridge, on the easterly side of the road, -stood an old, gambrel roofed, weather beaten house, its end facing the -road and its front door at the side as though it, like its present -owner, had turned sourly away from the world, refusing even to look out -upon the highway which passed socially near it. - -The rain dripped steadily into the moss covered water butt at the -corner of the house, and a bedraggled chicken, who seemed not to -possess enough energy to get under better cover, sat humped up in a -most dismal manner under the lilac bush at the other corner of the -house. - -It was well nigh as dismal inside the house as out. A miserable little -fire of green wood sputtered and hissed in an even more miserable -stove, and the faded yellow cambric curtain at the little window, did -its best (with the aid of the dirt, which was considerable) to keep the -light from penetrating the panes. - -At one end of the kitchen was a square deal table littered with soiled -dishes left from the morning meal; the two or three chairs about the -room were in a state of great dilapidation; and even the old clock on -the mantel shelf ticked with a sort of rasping groan, as though every -stroke put its rheumatic old wheels and springs in agony. - -Before the stove, in a sadly abused, wooden bottomed armchair, and -with his back humped up a good deal like the chicken under the lilac -bush outside, sat an old man with weazened, wrinkled face, eyes like a -hawk’s, a beak-like nose, and a sparse settlement of gray hairs on his -crown and chin. - -He leaned forward in his seat, and both claw-like hands clutching the -arms of the chair, seemed to be all that kept him from falling upon the -stove. - -At the window, just where the light fell best upon the book in his -hand, sat a youth of sixteen years--a well made, robust boy, whose -brown hair curled about his broad forehead, and whose face was not -without marks of real beauty. - -Just now his brows were knit in a slight frown, and there was a flash -of anger in his clear eyes. - -“I dunno what’s comin’ of ev’rything,” the old man was saying, in a -querulous tone. “Here ’tis the first o’ April, an’ ’tain’t been weather -fit ter plow a furrer, or plant a seed, yit.” - -“Well, I don’t see as it’s _my_ fault, Uncle Arad,” responded the boy -by the window. “_I_ don’t make the weather.” - -“I dunno whether ye do or not,” the old man declared, after staring -across at him for an instant. “I begin ter believe yer a regular -Jonah--jest as yer Uncle Anson was, an’ yer pa, too.” - -The boy turned away and looked out of the window at this mention of his -parent, and a close observer might have seen his broad young shoulders -tremble with sudden emotion as he strove to check the sobs which all -but choked him. - -Whether the old man was a close enough observer to see this or not, he -nevertheless kept on in the same strain. - -“One thing there is erbout it,” he remarked; “Anson knew _he_ was born -ter ill luck, an’ he cleared out an’ never dragged nobody else down ter -poverty with him. But your pa had ter marry--an’ see what come of it!” - -“I don’t know as it affected _you_ any,” rejoined the boy, bitterly. - -“Yes, ’t’as, too! Ain’t I got you on my hands, a-eatin’ of your head -off, when there ain’t a sign of a chance o’ gittin’ any work aout o’ -ye?” - -“I reckon I’ve paid for my keep for more’n _one_ year,” the other -declared vehemently; “and up to the last time father went away he -always paid you for my board--he told me so himself.” - -“He did, did he?” exclaimed Uncle Arad, in anger. “Well, he----” - -“Don’t you say my father lied!” cried the boy, his eyes flashing and -his fists clenched threateningly. “If you do, you’ll wish you hadn’t.” - -“Well--I ain’t said so, hev I?” whined Uncle Arad, fairly routed by -this vehemence. “Ain’t you a pretty boy to threaten an old man like me, -Brandon Tarr?” - -Brandon relapsed into sullen silence, and the old man went on: - -“Mebbe Horace _thought_ he paid your board, but the little money he -ever give me never more’n ha’f covered the expense ye’ve been ter me, -Don.” - -His hearer sniffed contemptuously at this. He knew well enough that -he had done a man’s work about the Tarr place in summer, and all the -chores during winter before and after school hours, for the better part -of three years, and had amply repaid any outlay the old man had made. - -Old Arad Tarr was reckoned as a miser by his townsmen, and they were -very nearly correct. By inheritance the farm never belonged to him, -for he was the youngest son of old Abram Tarr, and had been started in -business by his father when he was a young man, while his brother Ezra -had the old homestead, as the eldest son should. - -But reverses came to Ezra, of which the younger brother, being -successful in money matters, took advantage, and when Ezra died at last -(worked to death, the neighbors said) the property came into Arad’s -hands. There was little enough left for the widow, who soon followed -her husband to the grave, and for the two boys, Anson and Horace. - -Anson was of a roving, restless disposition, and he soon became -disgusted with the grinding methods of old Arad, who sought to get -double work out of his two nephews. So he left the farm, and, allured -by visions of sudden wealth which led him all over the world, he -followed from one scheme to another, never returning to the old place -again, though his brother, Horace, heard from him occasionally. - -The younger lad was not long in following his brother’s footsteps (in -leaving home, at least), and went to sea, where he rose rapidly from -the ranks of the common sailor to the post of commander. - -He married a girl whom he had known in his boyhood, and Brandon, the -boy who was now left to the tender mercies of the great uncle, was -their only child. - -By patient frugality Captain Tarr had amassed sufficient money to -purchase a brig called the Silver Swan, and made several exceptionally -fortunate voyages to South and West African ports, and to Oceanica. - -But after his wife’s death (she was always a delicate woman) his only -wish seemed to be to gain a fortune that he might retire from the sea -and live with his son, in whom his whole heart was now bound. There was -a trace of the same visionary spirit in Horace Tarr’s nature that had -been the _motif_ of his brother Anson’s life, and hoping to gain great -wealth by a sudden turning of the wheel of fortune, he speculated with -his savings. - -Like many other men, he trusted too much in appearances and was wofully -deceived, and every penny of his earnings for a number of voyages in -the brig was swept away. - -His last voyage had been to Cape Town, and on the return passage the -good Silver Swan had struck on a rock somewhere off Cuba, and was a -total loss, for neither the vessel itself, nor the valuable cargo, was -insured for a penny’s worth. - -This had occurred nearly two months before, and the first news Brandon -and Uncle Arad had received of the disaster was through the newspaper -reports. Two surviving members of the crew were picked up by a New York -bound steamship, from a raft which had been afloat nearly two weeks, -and but one of the men was in a condition to give an intelligible -account of the wreck. - -From his story there could be but little doubt of the total destruction -of the Silver Swan and the loss of every creature on board, excepting -himself and the mate, Caleb Wetherbee, who was so exhausted that he had -been taken at once to the marine hospital. Captain Tarr had died on the -raft, from hunger and a wound in the head received during the wrecking -of his vessel. - -It was little wonder, then, with these painful facts so fresh in his -mind, that young Brandon Tarr found it so hard to stifle his emotion -while his great uncle had been speaking. In fact, when presently the -crabbed old man opened his lips to speak again, he arose hastily, threw -down his book, and seized his hat and coat. - -“I’m going out to see if I can pick off that flock of crows I saw -around this morning,” he said hastily. “If you _do_ get a chance to -plant anything this spring, they’ll pull it up as fast as you cover the -seed.” - -“We kin put up scarecrows,” said Arad, with a scowl, his dissertation -on the “shiftlessness” of Don’s father thus rudely broken off. “_I_ -can’t afford you powder an’ shot ter throw away at them birds.” - -“Nobody asked you to pay for it,” returned the boy gruffly, and -buttoning the old coat about him, and seizing his rifle from the hooks -above the door, he went out into the damp outside world, which, despite -its unpleasantness, was more bearable than the atmosphere of the farm -house kitchen. - -The farm which had come into Arad Tarr’s possession in what he termed a -“business way,” contained quite one hundred acres of cultivated fields, -rocky pastures, and forest land. - -It was a productive farm and turned its owner a pretty penny every -year, but judging from the appearance of the interior of the house and -the dilapidated condition of the barn and other outbuildings, one would -not have believed it. - -There was sufficient work on the farm every year to keep six hired -hands beside Brandon and the old man, himself, “on the jump” every -minute during the spring, summer, and fall. - -In the winter they two alone managed to do the chores, and old Arad -even discharged the woman who cooked for the men during the working -season. - -As soon as the season opened, however, and the old man was obliged -to hire help, the woman (who was a widow and lived during the winter -with a married sister in the neighborhood) was established again in -the Tarr house, and until the next winter they lived in a manner that -Brandon termed “like Christians,” for she was a good cook and a neat -housekeeper; but left to their own devices during the cold weather, he -and his great uncle made sorry work of it. - -“The frost is pretty much out of the ground now,” Brandon muttered as -he crossed the littered barnyard, “and this drizzle will mellow up the -earth in great shape. As soon as it stops, Uncle Arad will dig right in -and work to make up for lost time, I s’pose.” - -He climbed the rail fence and jumped down into the sodden field beyond, -the tattered old army coat (left by some hired hand and used by him in -wet weather) flapping dismally about his boots. - -“I wonder what’ll become of me now,” he continued, still addressing -himself, as he plodded across the field, sinking ankle deep in the wet -soil. “Now that father’s gone there’s nothing left for me to do but to -shift for myself and earn my own living. Poor father wanted me to get -an education first before I went into anything, but there’ll be no more -chance for that here. I can see plainly that Uncle Arad means to shut -down on school altogether now. - -“I’ll never get ahead any as long as I stay here and slave for him,” he -pursued. “He’ll be more exacting than ever, now that father is gone--he -didn’t dare treat me _too_ meanly before. He’ll make it up now, I -reckon, if I stay, and I just _won’t_!” - -He had been steadily approaching the woods and at this juncture there -was a rush of wings and a sudden “caw! caw!” - -Crows are generally considered to be endowed with a faculty for knowing -when a gun is brought within range, but this particular band must have -been asleep, for Brandon was quite within shooting distance as the -great birds labored heavily across the lots. - -The rifle, the lock of which he had kept dry beneath his armpit, was -at his shoulder in a twinkling, there was a sharp report, and one of -the birds fell heavily to the ground, while its frightened companions -wheeled with loud outcry and were quickly out of view behind the woods. - -Brandon walked on and picked up the fallen bird. - -“Shot his head pretty nearly off,” he muttered. “I believe I’ll go -West. Knowing how to shoot might come in handy there,” and he laughed -grimly. - -Then, with the bird in his hand, he continued his previous course, and -penetrated beneath the dripping branches of the trees. - -Pushing his way through the brush for a rod or two he reached a plainly -defined path which, cutting obliquely across the wood lot, connected -the road on which the Tarr house stood with the “pike” which led to the -city, fourteen miles away. - -Entering this path, he strolled leisurely on, his mind intent upon the -situation in which his father’s death had placed him. - -“I haven’t a dollar, or not much more than that sum,” he thought, “nor -a friend, either. I can’t expect anything but the toughest sort of a -pull, wherever I go or whatever I take up; but it can’t be worse than -’twould be here, working for Uncle Arad.” - -After traversing the path for some distance, Don reached a spot where -a rock cropped up beside the way, and he rested himself on this, still -studying on the problem which had been so fully occupying his mind for -several weeks past. - -As he sat there, idly pulling handfuls of glossy black feathers from -the dead crow, the noise of a footstep on the path in his rear caused -him to spring up and look in that direction. - -A man was coming down the path--a sinister faced, heavily bearded man, -who slouched along so awkwardly that Brandon at first thought him lame. -But the boy had seen a few sailors, besides his father, in his life, -and quickly perceived that the stranger’s gait was caused simply by a -long experience of treading the deck of a vessel at sea. - -He was a solidly built man, not below the medium height, yet his head -was set so low between his shoulders, and thrust forward in such a way -that it gave him a dwarfed appearance. His hands were rammed deeply -into his pockets, an old felt hat was drawn down over his eyes, and his -aspect was generally seedy and not altogether trustworthy. - -He started suddenly upon seeing the boy, and gazed at him intently as -he approached. - -“Well, shipmate, out gunning?” he demanded, in a tone which was -intended to be pleasant. - -“A little,” responded Brandon, kicking the body of the dead crow into -the bushes. “We’re always gunning for those fellows up this way.” - -“Crows, eh?” said the man, stopping beside the boy, who had rested -himself on the rock again. “They’re great chaps for pullin’ -corn--faster’n you farmers can plant it, eh?” - -Brandon nodded curtly, and wondered why the tramp (as he supposed him) -did not go along. - -“Look here, mate,” went on the man, after a moment, “I’m lookin’ for -somebody as lives about here, by the name of Tarr----” - -“Why, you’re on the Tarr place now,” replied Brandon, with sudden -interest. “That’s _my_ name, too.” - -“No, it isn’t now!” exclaimed the stranger, in surprise. - -A quick flash of eagerness came over his face as he spoke. - -“You’re not Brandon Tarr?” he added. - -“Yes, sir,” replied Don, in surprise. - -“Not Captain Horace Tarr’s son! God bless ye, my boy. Give us your -hand!” - -The man seized the hand held out to him half doubtfully, and shook it -warmly, at the same time seating himself beside the boy. - -“You knew my father?” asked Brandon, not very favorably impressed by -the man’s appearance, yet knowing no real reason why he should not be -friendly. - -“Knew him! Why, my boy, I was his best friend!” declared the sailor. -“Didn’t you ever hear him speak of Cale Wetherbee?” - -“Caleb Wetherbee!” cried Don, with some pleasure. - -He had never seen his father’s mate, but he had heard the captain speak -of him many times. This man did not quite come up to his expectation -of what the mate of the Silver Swan should have been, but he knew -that his father had trusted Caleb Wetherbee, and that appearances are -sometimes deceitful. - -“Indeed I _have_ heard him speak of you many times,” and the boy’s -voice trembled slightly as he offered his hand a second time far more -warmly. - -“Yes, sir,” repeated the sailor, blowing his nose with ostentation, -“I’m an old friend o’ your father’s. He--he died in my arms.” - -Brandon wiped his own eyes hastily. He had loved his father with all -the strength of his nature, and his heart was too sore yet to be rudely -touched. - -“Why, jest before he--he died, he give me them papers to send to ye, ye -know.” - -As he said this the man flashed a quick, keen look at Brandon, but it -was lost upon him. - -“What papers?” he asked with some interest. - -“What papers?” repeated the sailor, springing up. “D’ye mean ter say ye -never got a package o’ papers from me a--a month ergo, I reckon ’twas?” - -“I haven’t received anything through the mail since the news came of -the loss of the brig,” declared Don, rising also. - -“Then that mis’rable swab of an ’orspital fellow never sent ’em!” -declared the man, with apparent anger. “Ye see, lad, I was laid up -quite a spell in the ’orspital--our sufferings on that raft was jest -orful--an’ I couldn’t help myself. But w’en your father died he left -some papers with me ter be sent ter you, an’ I got the ’orspital nurse -to send ’em. An’ you must hev got ’em--eh?” - -“Not a thing,” replied Brandon convincingly. “Were they of any value?” - -“Valible? I should say they was!” cried the sailor. “Werry valible, -indeed. Why, boy, they’d er made our--I sh’d say _your_--fortune, an’ -no mistake!” - -Without doubt his father’s old friend was strangely moved by the -intelligence he had received, and Don could not but be interested in -the matter. - - - - -CHAPTER III - -AN ACCOUNT OF THE WRECK OF THE SILVER SWAN - - -“TO what did these papers bear reference?” Brandon asked. “Father met -with heavy misfortunes in his investments last year, and every penny, -excepting the Swan itself, was lost. How could these papers have -benefited me?” - -“Well, that I don’t rightly know,” replied the sailor slowly. - -He looked at the boy for several seconds with knitted brows, evidently -deep in thought. Brandon could not help thinking what a rough looking -specimen he was, but remembering his father’s good opinion of Caleb -Wetherbee, he banished the impression as ungenerous. - -“I b’lieve I’ll tell ye it jest as it happened,” said the man at -length. “Sit down here again, boy, an’ I’ll spin my yarn.” - -He drew forth a short, black pipe, and was soon puffing away upon it, -while comfortably seated beside Don upon the rock. - -“’Twere the werry night we sailed from the Cape,” he began, “that I -was--er--in the cabin of the Silver Swan, lookin’ at a new chart the -cap’n had got, when down comes a decently dressed chap--a landlubber, -ev’ry inch o’ him--an’ asks if this were Cap’n Horace Tarr. - -“‘It is,’ says the cap’n. - -“‘Cap’n Horace Tarr, of Rhode Island, U. S. A.?’ says he. - -“‘That’s me,’ says the cap’n ag’in. - -“‘Well, Cap’n Tarr,’ says the stranger chap, a-lookin’ kinder squint -eyed at me, ‘did you ever have a brother Anson?’ - -“Th’ cap’n noticed his lookin’ at me an’ says, afore he answered the -question: - -“‘Ye kin speak freely,’ says he, ‘this is my mate, Cale Wetherbee, an’ -there ain’t a squarer man, nor an honester, as walks the deck terday,’ -says he. ‘Yes, I had a brother Anson; but I persume he’s dead.’ - -“‘Yes, he is dead,’ said the stranger. ‘He died up country, at a place -they calls Kimberley, ’bout two months ago.’ - -“That was surprisin’ ter the cap’n, I reckon, an’ he tol’ the feller -that he’d supposed Anson Tarr dead years before, as he hadn’t heard -from him. - -“‘No, he died two months ago,’ says the man, ‘an’ I was with him. He -died o’ pneumony--was took werry sudden.’ - -“Nat’rally this news took the old man--I sh’d say yer father--all -aback, as it were, an’ he inquired inter his brother’s death fully. -Fin’ly the man drew out a big package--papers he said they was--wot -Anson Tarr had given him ter be sure ter give ter the cap’n when he -sh’d see him. Then the feller went. - -“O’ course, the cap’n didn’t tell me wot the docyments was, but I -reckoned by his actions, an’ some o’ the hints he let drop, that they -was valible, an’ I--I got it inter my head that ’twas erbout money--er -suthin’ o’ the kind--that your Uncle Anson knowed of. - -“Wal, the Silver Swan, she left the Cape, ’n’ all went well till arter -we touched at Rio an’ was homeward boun’. Then a gale struck us that -stripped the brig o’ ev’ry stick o’ timber an’ every rag o’ sail, an’ -druv her outer thet ’ere rock. There warn’t no hope for the ol’ brig -an’ she began to go ter pieces to once, so we tried ter take to the -boats. - -“But the boats was smashed an’ the only ones left o’ the hull ship’s -company was men Paulo Montez, and yer father, an’--an’ another feller. -We built the raft and left the ol’ brig, just as she--er--slid off er -th’ rock an’ sunk inter the sea. It--it mos’ broke yer father’s heart -ter see the ol’ brig go down an’ I felt m’self, jest as though I’d lost -er--er friend, er suthin!” - -The sailor paused in his narrative and drew hard upon his pipe for a -moment. - -“Wal, you know by the papers how we floated around on that ’ere raf’ -an’ how yer poor father was took. He give me these papers just afore he -died, an’ made me promise ter git ’em ter you, ef I was saved. He said -you’d understand ’em ter oncet, an’,” looking at Brandon keenly out of -the corners of his eyes, “I didn’t know but ye knew something about it -already.” - -Brandon slowly shook his head. - -“No,” he said; “I can’t for the life of me think what they could refer -to.” - -“No--no buried treasure, nor nothing of the kind?” suggested the man -hesitatingly. - -“I guess not!” exclaimed Don. “If I knew about such a thing, you can -bet I’d be after it right quickly, for I don’t know any one who needs -money just at the present moment more than I.” - -“Well, I believe I’ll go,” cried the sailor, rising hastily. “That -’orspital feller must hev forgotten ter mail them papers, an’ I’ll git -back ter New York ter oncet, an’ see ’bout it. I b’lieve they’ll be of -vally to ye, an’ if ye want _my_ help in any way, jest let me know. -I--I’ll give ye a place ter ’dress letters to, an’ I’ll call there an’ -git ’em.” - -He produced an old stump of a pencil from his pocket and a ragged -leather note case. From this he drew forth a dog eared business card -of some ship chandler’s firm, on the blank side of which he wrote in a -remarkably bad hand: - - CALEB WETHERBEE, - NEW ENGLAND HOTEL, - WATER STREET, - NEW YORK. - -Then he shook Don warmly by the hand, and promising to get the papers -from the “’orspital feller” at once, struck away toward the city again, -leaving the boy in a statement of great bewilderment. - -He didn’t know what the papers could refer to, yet like all boys who -possess a good digestion and average health, he had imagined enough to -fancy a hundred things that they _might_ contain. Perhaps there was -some great fortune which his Uncle Anson had known about, and had died -before he could reap the benefit of his knowledge. - -Yet, he felt an instinctive distrustfulness of this Caleb Wetherbee. He -was not at all the kind of man he had expected him to be, for although -Captain Tarr had never said much about the personal appearance of the -mate of the Silver Swan, still Don had pictured Caleb to his mind’s eye -as a far different looking being. - -As he stood there in the path, deep in thought, and with his eyes fixed -upon the spot where he had seen the sailor disappear, the fluttering -of a bit of paper attracted his attention. He stooped and secured it, -finding it to be a greasy bit of newspaper that had doubtless reposed -for some days in the note case of the sailor, and had fallen unnoticed -to the ground while he was penciling his address on the card now in -Don’s possession. - -One side of the scrap of paper was a portion of an advertisement, but -on the other side was a short item of news which Don perused with -growing interest. - - SAVANNAH, MARCH 3. The Brazilian steamship Montevideo, which arrived - here in the morning, reports having sighted, about forty miles west - of the island of Cuba, a derelict brig, without masts or rigging of - any kind, but with hull in good condition. It was daylight, and by - running close the Montevideo’s captain made the wreck out to be the - Silver Swan, of Boston, which was reported as having been driven - on to Reef Number 8, east of Cuba, more than a month ago. The two - surviving members of the crew of the Silver Swan were picked up from - a raft, after twelve days of terrible suffering, by the steamship - Alexandria, of the New York and Rio Line. The Montevideo’s officers - report the brig as being a most dangerous derelict, as in its present - condition it may keep afloat for months, having evidently withstood - the shock of grounding on the reef, and later being driven off by the - westerly gale of February 13th. - - Her position, when sighted by the Montevideo, has been reported to - the Hydrographic Office, and will appear on the next monthly chart. - - - - -CHAPTER IV - -BRANDON COMES TO A DECISION - - -THE first thought which flashed across Brandon Tarr’s mind as he read -the newspaper item quoted in the previous chapter was that the story -of the wreck of the Silver Swan, as told by the old sailor, had been -totally misleading. - -“Why, he lied--point blank--to me!” he exclaimed, “and with this very -clipping in his pocket, too.” - -He half started along the path as though to pursue the sailor, and then -thought better of it. - -“He declared that he saw the Swan go down with his own eyes; and here -she was afloat on the 13th of March--a month after the wreck. He must -have wanted to keep the knowledge of that fact from me. But what for? -Ah! those papers!” - -With this Brandon dropped back on the rock again and read the newspaper -clipping through once more. Then he went over the whole matter in his -mind. - -What possible object could Caleb Wetherbee have in coming to him and -telling him the yarn he had, if there was no foundation for it? There -must be some reason for the story, Brandon was sure. - -Evidently there had been papers either given into the hands of the -mate of the Silver Swan, or obtained by him by dishonest means. These -papers must relate to some property of value which had belonged to -Anson Tarr, Don’s uncle, and, his cupidity being aroused, the sailor -was trying to convert the knowledge contained in them to his own -benefit. - -There was probably some “hitch” in the documents--something the -rascally mate could not understand, but which he thought Brandon could -explain. Therefore, his trip to Chopmist from New York to “pump” the -captain’s son. - -“Without doubt,” said the boy, communing with himself, “the papers were -brought aboard the brig just as this rascally Wetherbee said, and they -were from Uncle Anson. Let’s see, he said he died at Kimberley--why, -that’s right at the diamond mines!” For like most boys with adventurous -spirits and well developed imagination, Brandon had devoured much that -had been written about the wonderful diamond diggings of South Africa. - -“Perhaps--who knows?” his thoughts ran on, “Uncle Anson ‘struck it -rich’ at the diamond mines before he died. There’s nothing impossible -in that--excepting the long run of ill luck which had cursed this -family.” - -He shook his head thoughtfully. - -“If Uncle Anson had owned a share in a paying diamond mine, this -rascally sailor would have known at once that the papers relating to -it could not benefit him, for the ownership would be on record there -in Kimberley. It must, therefore, be that the property--whatever -it may be--is in such shape that it can be removed from place to -place--perhaps was brought aboard the brig by the friend of Uncle -Anson who told father of his death.” - -For the moment the idea did not assist in the explanation of the course -of Caleb Wetherbee in retaining the papers. But Brandon had set himself -to the task of reasoning out the mystery, and when one thread failed -him he took up another. - -“One would think,” he muttered, “that if there had been any money -brought aboard the brig, father would have taken it on the raft with -him when they left; but still, would he? - -“According to the report the brig grounded on Reef Number 8, and -perhaps was not hurt below the water line. The next gale from the -west’ard blew her off again. She is now a derelict, _and if the money -was hidden on board it would be there now_!” - -At this sudden thought Brandon sprang up in excitement and paced up and -down the path. - -He had often heard of the wrecks of vessels abandoned in mid ocean -floating thousands of miles without a hand to guide their helms, a -menace and danger to all other craft. The Silver Swan might float for -months--aye, for years; such a thing was possible. - -“And if the money--if it _is_ money--is hidden aboard the brig, the one -who finds the derelict first will have it,” was the thought which came -to him. - -“But why should the mate come to _me_ about it?” Brandon asked himself. -“Why need he let _me_ know anything about the papers, or the treasure, -if he wished to recover it himself? Didn’t he know where on the brig -the money was hidden? Or didn’t the papers tell that?” - -He cudgled his brains for several minutes to think _where_ his father -would have been likely to hide anything of value on the brig. Was there -any place which only he and his father had known about? - -This idea suggested a train of reminiscences. He had been aboard the -Silver Swan several times while she lay in Boston, and had been all -over her. - -Once, possibly four years before (it seemed a long time to him now), he -had been alone with his father in the cabin, and Captain Tarr had shown -him an ingeniously hidden sliding panel in the bulkhead, behind which -was a little steel lined cavity, in which the captain kept his private -papers. - -Perhaps Caleb Wetherbee did not know about this cupboard, and it was -this information that he wished to get from him. The idea seemed -probable enough, for if he did not know where the treasure was hidden -on the brig, what good would the papers relating to it be to him? - -“There may be a fortune there, just within my grasp, and yet I not be -able to get at it,” muttered Don, pacing the rough path nervously. - -“Despite his former confidence in this Wetherbee, father must have -doubted him at the last and not dared to take the treasure (if treasure -it really is) when he left the brig. - -“Instead, he gave him these papers, hoping the fellow would be honest -enough to place them in my hands; but, still fearing to fully trust the -mate, he wrote his directions to me so blindly, that Wetherbee is all -at sea about what to do. - -“Wetherbee knows that the brig is afloat--this clipping proves -that--and he hoped to get the information he wanted from me and then -go in search of the Silver Swan. _Why can I not go in search of it -myself?_” - -The thought almost staggered him for an instant, yet to his boyish -mind the plan seemed feasible enough. He knew that derelicts are often -carried by the ocean currents for thousands of miles before they -sink, yet their movements are gradual, and by a close study of the -hydrographic charts he believed it would be possible to locate the -wrecked brig. - -“I’ve got no money, I know,” he thought, “at least, not much; but I’ve -health and strength and an ordinary amount of pluck, and it will be -strange if I can’t accomplish my purpose if the old brig only holds -together long enough.” - -He looked at the soiled card the sailor had given him. - -“‘New England Hotel, Water Street,’” he repeated. “Some sailors’ -boarding house, likely. I believe--yes, I will--go to New York myself -and see this scoundrelly Wetherbee again. He can’t do _much_ without -me, I fancy, and perhaps, after all, I can use him to my own benefit. I -ought to be as smart as an ignorant old sailor like him.” - -He stood still a moment, gazing steadily at the ground. - -“I’ll do it, I vow I will!” he exclaimed at last, raising his head -defiantly. “Uncle Arad’s got no hold upon me and I’ll go. I’ll start -tomorrow morning,” with which determination he picked up his rifle and -left the woods. - - - - -CHAPTER V - -UNCLE ARAD HAS RECOURSE TO LEGAL FORCE - - -IN the several oceans of our great globe there are many floating -wrecks, abandoned for various causes by their crews, which may float on -and on, without rudder or sail, for months, and even years. Especially -is this true of the North Atlantic Ocean, where, during the past five -years, nearly a thousand “derelicts,” as these floating wrecks are -called, were reported. - -The Hydrographic Office at Washington prints a monthly chart on which -all the derelicts reported by incoming vessels are plainly marked, even -their position in the water being designated by a little picture of the -wreck. - -By this method of “keeping run” of the wrecks, it has been found that -some float thousands of miles before they finally reach their ultimate -port--Davy Jones’ locker. - -The average life of these water logged hulks is, however, but thirty -days; otherwise the danger from collision with them would be enormous -and the loss of life great. Many of those vessels which have left -port within the past few years and never again been heard from, were -doubtless victims of collisions with some of these derelicts. - -Several more or less severe accidents have been caused by them, and -so numerous have they become that, within the past few months, several -vessels belonging to our navy have gone “derelict cruising”--blowing up -and sinking the most dangerous wrecks afloat in the North Atlantic. - -At the time of the Silver Swan’s reported loss, however, it was -everybody’s business to destroy the vessels, and therefore nobody’s. -At any time, however, the hull of the brig, reported by the steamship -Montevideo as floating off Cuba, might be run into and sunk by some -other vessel, such collisions being not at all uncommon. - -Brandon Tarr realized that there was but a small chance of the Silver -Swan being recovered, owing to these circumstances; yet he would not -have been a Tarr had he not been willing to take the chance and do all -he could to secure what he was quite convinced was a valuable treasure. - -Derelicts had been recovered and towed into port for their salvage -alone, and the Silver Swan was, he knew, richly laden. It might also -be possible to repair the hull of the brig, for she was a well built -craft, and if she had withstood the shock of being ground on the reef -so well, she might even yet be made to serve for several years. - -These thoughts flitted through the mind of the boy as he slowly crossed -the wet fields toward the farm house. - -“I’ll go tomorrow morning--Uncle Arad or no Uncle Arad,” he decided. -“It won’t do to leave the old fellow alone, so I’ll step down after -dinner and speak to Mrs. Hemingway about coming up here. He will have -to have her any way within a few days, so it won’t much matter.” - -He didn’t really know how to broach the subject to the old man, for he -felt assured that his great uncle would raise manifold objections to -his departure. He had lived at the farm four years now and Uncle Arad -had come to depend on him in many ways. - -They had eaten dinner--a most miserable meal--and Don was washing the -dishes before he spoke. - -“Uncle Arad,” he said, trying to talk in a most matter of fact way, -“now that father is--is gone and I have nothing to look forward to, I -believe I’ll strike out for myself. I’m past sixteen and big enough and -old enough to look out for myself. I think I shall get along faster by -being out in the world and brushing against folks, and I reckon I’ll go -to New York.” - -Uncle Arad fairly wilted into his seat, and stared at Don in utter -surprise. - -“Go to New York?” he gasped. - -“That’s what I said.” - -“Go to New York--jest when yer gittin’ of some account ter me?” - -“Oh, I’ve been of some account to you for some time, and any way father -always paid my board before last fall, you know,” said Don cheerfully. - -Uncle Arad snorted angrily, and his eyes began to flash fire. - -“Paid your board!” he exclaimed. “I dunno what put _that_ inter your -head.” - -“Father put it there, that’s who,” declared Don hotly. - -“_I_ never give him no receipts for board money,” cried the old man. -“You can’t show a one!” - -“I don’t suppose you did,” returned Don, with scorn. “You never give -receipts for anything if you can help it. If you’d given receipts to -your own brother as you ought, you wouldn’t be in possession of this -farm now.” - -“I wouldn’t, hey?” cried the old man, goaded to desperation by this -remark, which he knew only too well to be true. “You little upstart -you! Ye’ll go ter New York, whether ’r no, will ye?” - -He arose in his wrath and shook his bony fist in Don’s face. The youth -looked down upon him scornfully, for the man would have been no match -for him at all. - -“Now don’t have a fit,” he said calmly. “I’m going to step ’round to -Mrs. Hemingway’s after dinner, and get her to come up here and look -after you. You’ll need her any way, in a few days.” - -“It won’t matter! it won’t matter!” shrieked Uncle Arad, exasperated -by the boy’s coolness. “It won’t matter, I s’pose, when I hev ter pay -three dollars--_three dollars_, mind ye--fur a hull week’s extry work!” - -He fairly stamped about the room in his fury. - -“It don’t matter, eh, when I’ll have ter hire a man ter take your -place? Be you crazy, Brandon Tarr?” - -“Guess not,” responded Don, wiping the last dish and hanging up the -towel to dry. “You must think _me_ crazy, however. Do you s’pose I’d -stayed here this season without wages?” - -“Wages!” again shrieked the old man, to whom the thought of paying -out a penny was positive pain, “Wages! an’ you a beggar--yes, sir, a -beggar!--’pendent upon my bounty, as it were.” - -Don smiled at this. - -“I’m a pretty sturdy beggar, as they used to call ’em in the old days,” -he said. - -“Wal, any way, I’m your guardeen, an’ I’ll see if you’re goin’ jest -when you like.” - -Don laughed outright now. - -“My guardian!” he responded. “I’d like to know _why_ I should have any -guardian. I’ve no property, goodness knows. And as you said about the -board receipts, _where are your papers giving you any legal control -over me?_” - -The old man was utterly taken aback at this and sat down again, -glowering at his nephew angrily, while the latter put on his hat and -coat and departed on his errand to Mrs. Hemingway’s. - -But Arad Tarr was not the man to see either money or its equivalent -slipping his grasp without strenuous efforts to retain it. His nephew -represented to him just so much hard cash saved, for if Brandon went -away Uncle Arad realized that the hiring of an extra hand would be an -absolute necessity. - -Therefore, the boy had not been gone long before the old man decided on -a line of action. He struggled into his own coat, locked up the house, -and harnessed a horse to a dilapidated light wagon. He was too careful -of his good vehicles to take anything but this out on such a nasty day. - -“That boy is a-gettin’ too upstartish!” he declared, climbing into the -wagon and chirruping to the horse. “He’s jest like Anson an’ Horace. -There was no livin’ with _them_, an’ now _he’s_ got this fool notion -inter his head erbout goin’ away! - -“But I’ll git _that_ aout o’ him,” he added, with emphasis. “If I -hain’t got no legal right ter his services, I _will_ have, now I tell -ye! Arter all I’ve done fur him an’ fur his shif’less, no ’count pa, -I ain’t goin’ ter let go o’ him till he comes of age--mos’ five years -yet.” - -He shook his head slowly at that thought. Five years of Brandon’s -services on the farm would be worth all of twenty-five hundred dollars! - -He clucked to the horse and drove on the faster at that. Suppose the -boy should take it into his head to go before he obtained the papers -which he was sure he could have made out? The idea was quite agonizing. - -“I reckon Squire Holt kin fix it up for me in short order,” he -muttered, as he urged his horse into a faster trot. “I’ll show that boy -’t he ain’t his own master, by no means!” - - - - -CHAPTER VI - -RELATING A MEETING BETWEEN UNCLE ARAD AND THE SAILOR - - -THE old man drove on through the mud and slush of the country road, the -wheels of the rickety vehicle first rattling over outcropping rocks and -boulders, and then splashing half way to their hubs in the yellow mire. - -A mile beyond his own farm he turned into a broader highway which -trended to the right--the city “pike.” Woods bordered the way on either -side and although the rain had ceased, the drops fell in showers from -the trees. It was a nasty day and the horse splashed itself to the -belly with the mire. - -Not many rods beyond the turn old Arad overtook a man walking in the -same direction that he was driving, and as the farmer rattled up, the -man stepped to one side and hailed him. - -He was a bronzed and bearded fellow, dressed in garments about as seedy -as the miser’s own clothing, and although he lacked all of twenty years -of Arad’s age, his back, as he stood there beside the cart path, seemed -almost as bent. - -“Hullo, shipmate!” was the man’s greeting, raising his hand for the -farmer to stop. “Goin’ toward the city?” - -“Wal, I be a piece,” replied Arad grudgingly. - -It was something of an effort for him to speak civilly to a casual -stranger. I presume he was afraid of wearing out the small stock of -civility he possessed. - -“Ye’re goin’ in ballast, I see,” said the stranger. “Can’t ye stow me -away there?” - -“Hey?” responded the farmer, who did not understand the other’s figure -of speech. - -“I say ye’re goin’ in ballast,” repeated the man; “yer wagon’s empty, -ye know. Give me a ride, will ye?” - -“Wal, I dunno,” said Arad slowly, with a sudden avaricious twinkle in -his eye. “I know the team’s empty, but th’ mare ain’t s’ limber ’s she -might be, an’ it’s hard trav’lin’.” - -“Got an eye on the main chance, ain’t ye, ye old land shark?” muttered -the man. Then he said aloud: “How fur ye goin’ on this road?” - -“’Bout three mile furder.” - -“What’ll ye take me that fur, for?” - -“Wall, I dunno,” began Arad. - -“Come, I’ll give ye a quarter,” said the stranger, fishing a handful of -silver from the depths of his pocket. - -The old man’s eyes flashed. - -“Jump aboard,” he said briefly, and the black bearded man sprang to the -seat with great agility. - -“Ye’re some limber,” said the old farmer, in admiration, pocketing the -quarter and starting up his horse again. - -“_You’d_ be if ye’d shinned up as many riggin’s as I hev.” - -“Ye’re a sailor, then?” - -“I be. No landlubber erbout me, is ther’? I reckon ye don’t see many -sailors in these parts?” - -“Ya-as we do,” snarled Arad impolitely; “more’n’ we wanter sometimes. -I got a nevvy who was a sailor--a cap’n. Lost at sea erbout two months -ergo. Lef’ me er great, hulkin’ boy ter take keer of.” - -“Great Peter!” exclaimed the sailor, with some astonishment. “Ye don’t -mean Cap’n Horace Tarr?” - -“Yes, I do mean Cap’n Horace Tarr,” growled Arad. “He was my nevvy, an’ -it’s his no ’count, wuthless boy I’ve got on my han’s. My name’s Arad -Tarr--’n’ th’ only Tarr ’t ever knew ’nough ter make money an’ keep it.” - -The sailor looked at the weazened old figure curiously. - -“He didn’t favor you none,” he said. - -“Who didn’t? Horace Tarr? I reckon he didn’t!” exclaimed Arad. “He -favored a ca’f more’n he did anything else, ’cordin’ ter _my_ notion. -Did ye know him?” added the old man curiously. - -“In course I did. I sailed with him--er--lots. Why, I was with him this -’ere las’ v’y’ge o’ his.” - -“Ye don’t mean it!” - -“I guess I do.” - -“Wal, wal!” exclaimed Uncle Arad, roused out of himself for a moment. -“So you was on that raf’ fur so long, eh? Must er been quite an -experience. An’ Horace is really dead, is he?” - -“Dead’s a door nail,” the sailor declared. “Can’t be no mistake erbout -_that_. We had ter pitch him overboard--er--another feller and me; -’cause ’twas so all fired hot, ye know. Him and Paulo Montez both went -ter the sharks.” - -The old man shuddered. - -“An’ he died without leavin’ a cent, eh? Poor’s poverty! I allus -knew how ’twould be. ’N’ I s’pose Anson--fur he mus’ be dead by this -time--died poor, too.” - -The sailor looked at the old man sharply out of the corners of his -eyes, and after a minute spoke again. - -“Yes,” he said slowly, in confirmation of Uncle Arad’s remark. “I was -with the cap’n at the last.” - -“What ye doin’ ’way up here?” inquired the farmer, with sudden interest. - -“Well, I come up ter see Cap’n Tarr’s boy.” - -“Hey?” ejaculated the farmer. “Come ter see Brandon?” - -“That’s it,” said the sailor, nodding. - -“But ye didn’t see him?” - -“Yes, I did; over yonder in the woods.” - -“Why, he didn’t say nothin’ erbout it ter me,” gasped the old man. - -“Mebbe ye ain’t seen him since,” suggested the sailor. - -“When was yer er-talkin’ with him?” - -“Long erbout two hours back, ’r so.” - -“’Fore dinner?” - -“I reckon so. I seen him over in the woods yonder, an’ talked with him -quite a spell. I started ’long back towards the city a’gin, but I found -out I’d lost--er--somethin’, an’ went back ter hev er look fur it.” - -“What was it ye lost?” asked Uncle Arad, with perhaps a momentary -thought that, if it was of value and had been lost on his farm, he -might be able to find it himself. - -“Nothin’ but a piece of paper.” - -“Find it?” - -“Not me. Must ha’ blowed away. Howsomever, that ain’t ter the p’int. -It’s funny yer nevvy never tol’ erbout meetin’ me.” - -Old Arad was silent for a minute. - -“I wish ye hadn’t come ’round here, fillin’ up his head with fool -notions,” he grumbled. “Seein’ you must be what set him up ter leavin’ -so sudden.” - -“Goin’ to leave ye, is he?” asked the sailor quickly. - -“He _thinks_ he is,” returned the farmer, with a snarl. “Th’ little -upstart! But I’ll l’arn him who’s who, now I tell ye? Goin’ ter New -York, is he? Wal, I reckon not.” - -“To New York? What’s he goin’ there fur? I sh’d think ye’d want him -right here on th’ farm,” said the sailor, with a cunning smile. - -“So I do--an’ right here is where he’s goin’ ter stay,” declared Uncle -Arad wrathfully. “I’m er-goin’ down ter Square Holt’s ter see erbout it -now. I’m either goin’ ter hev him bound ter me till he’s twenty-one, ’r -git p’inted him gardeen. _Then_, I reckon he won’t talk no more erbout -runnin’ off ter New York.” - -“Yes, I reckon this place is the best fur a boy like him,” acquiesced -the sailor. “An’ then, ye orter be his guardeen. S’posin’ he had -prop’ty fallin’ to him now--you’d orter hev th’ handlin’ of it till -he’s of age.” - -“Prop’ty! I guess ther’ won’t be none ter fall to him,” sniffed Uncle -Arad. “_I_ ain’t a dyin’ man, by no means, an’ his pa didn’t leave a -cent. Didn’t even hev that brig o’ his’n insured.” - -“I dunno erbout that,” said the sailor shrewdly. - -“What don’t ye know erbout?” demanded Arad suspiciously. “The Silver -Swan wasn’t insured, were she?” - -“I reckon not.” - -“Then what d’ye mean?” - -Arad’s piercing eyes were fixed searchingly on his companion’s face, -but the sailor was not easily disturbed. - -“Well, now, I’ll put a case to ye--jest a s’posin’ case, now mind ye,” -he said calmly, as Arad, now thoroughly interested in the matter, let -the old horse walk along the muddy highway. “S’posin’ now this ’ere -Cap’n Tarr had knowed erbout a buried treasure, ’r some sich thing, an’ -he’d writ erbout it, an’ give the papers ter another man--his mate, fur -instance--ter be given ter his son. - -“Now, nat’rally, if ther’ was any money in it fur this Brandon, _you’d_ -orter know erbout it, hadn’t ye? You bein’ th’ boy’s guardeen, you’d -orter handle that money; un’ if _I_ could help you ter the gettin’ o’ -that money, _I’d_ orter hev a part of it, eh?” - -Old Arad stared at him with wide open eyes, and the hand which held the -reins trembled visibly. - -“Now, s’posin’ the mate sends them papers to Brandon through the mail, -’r writes a letter erbout ’em--_you’d_ orter know it, hadn’t ye? You’d -orter see that letter, or them papers, an’ you’d jest drop me a line, -an’ _I_ c’d help ye get ’em, ’cause I know all erbout sich things, -bein’ a sea farin’ man fur thirty year.” - -Uncle Arad moistened his trembling lips before he could speak. - -“But this is only s’posin’,” he said quaveringly. - -“But, _s’pose ’twas so!_ S’pose I seen them papers passed, an’ s’pose -I heered Cap’n Tarr say with his own lips ther’ was ’nough suthin ’r -other (I couldn’t ketch th’ word--gold, mebbe) there ter make a man -fabulously rich?” - -“Fabulously rich!” repeated Arad. - -“That’s it; fabulously rich, is wot he said. An’ if it’s so, _you_ -orter to get the letters from the post office, an’ open every one of -’em, hadn’t ye?” - -Uncle Arad nodded quickly. - -“O course ye had; and if the letter or papers sh’d come from Caleb -Wetherbee--thet’s the mate’s name; he’s in the ’orspital yet--you’d let -me know, an’ then we’d see wot we sh’d see, eh?” - -The sailor poked the old man familiarly in the ribs and slapped his own -knee. - -“That’s wot we’d do, shipmate,” he said. “Wot say ye? Ye’ll need me, -fur I reckon wherever th’ money’s hid, ye’ll need a sailor ter go ’long -with ye--er ter git it fur ye.” - -“I--I couldn’t go; my health ain’t good ’nough,” declared the farmer. -“Then--then--mebbe there ain’t nothin’ in it.” - -“Well, mebbe there ain’t,” said the sailor calmly, preparing to -dismount as the old man pulled up before a house; “an’ then ag’in -mebbe there is. Leastways, I adwise ye ter jest keep yer eyes open -fur letters f’om New York. An’ when one comes from Caleb Wetherbee, -p’r’aps ye’ll want ter talk with me furder.” - -“Where--where kin I find ye?” Arad asked, in a shaking voice. - -“Jest write ter Jim Leroyd, New England Hotel, Water Street, New -York--that’ll fetch me,” declared the sailor briskly. “Now remember, -old feller,” he added meaningly, “ye won’t be able ter do nothin’ with -them papers ’thout me. If ye try it ye’ll be up a stump ter oncet. Now, -take keer o’ yerself!” - -He turned away and rolled along the road toward the distant city, while -Uncle Arad climbed down from the wagon. - -“Fabulously rich!” he muttered to himself, as he fastened the horse to -the hitching post with trembling hands. - - - - -CHAPTER VII - -INTRODUCING “SQUARE” HOLT AND HIS OPINIONS - - -“SQUARE” HOLT, who was a justice of the peace as well as the judge -of the probate court of the town, was a very tall and very angular -individual with a massive development of nose (old Arad Tarr’s was -as nothing beside it) and a wide mouth continually drawn into a -grim line, as though such a thing as a smile had never crossed his -imagination--if, indeed, he had an imagination. - -He had no children of his own (which was an exceedingly fortunate -thing for the unborn generations) and had apparently forgotten his own -boyhood. Boys, in his estimation, were made to work--the harder the -better. In this he was of the same opinion as Uncle Arad Tarr. - -Old Arad was at once admitted to the front parlor of the house at -which he had stopped, which was used by the judge as his office when -he was not at the town hall. Here, seated in one of the prim hair -cloth chairs, with which his soiled and badly fitting garments hardly -harmonized, the old man told his story. - -“That boy, square, comes o’ the shif’lessest kind o’ stock, ye know, -ef his gran’father _was_ my own brother,” he said, in conclusion. “You -’member Ezra?” - -“Oh yes, I remember Ezra,” said the judge, grimly. - -“Wal, then, ye know what a shif’less loose j’inted critter he was in -business matters, an’ Anson an’ Horace was as like him as two peas aout -o’ the same pod. An’ now this ’ere Brandon hez got th’ same traits o’ -no ’count shif’lessness.” - -“Very likely, very likely,” said the other, with sternness. “I’ve seen -the youth, I think, out gunning quite frequently--a most objectionable -practice.” - -“Ye’re right, square,” old Arad exclaimed, with eagerness. “Jest er -firin’ erway good powder an’ shot ’t cost money. Thet boy hez airnt -money erhelpin’ of the neighbors lots o’ times, ter waste on powder an’ -shot. He’s a dretful bad boy.” - -“From what you say, neighbor,” said the judge, with confidence, “I -should say that the proper place for the young rascal was the State -reform school----” - -“Oh, no, no, square,” exclaimed Arad, in sudden terror at the thought -of losing Don’s services in this way. “’Tain’t as bad as that. I kin -manage him, once give me legal ’thority. - -“Ye see, his pa left him ’ithout a cent, an’ I thought it didn’t make -a bit er diff’rance ’bout his havin’ a guardeen--’twould er been some -expense, ye know, ter hev th’ papers made aout; but since he’s got this -’ere wild goose notion o’ leavin’ me, I begin ter see that I sh’d hev -some holt on him fur--hem!--fur his own good, as it were.” - -“Quite right,” declared the judge confidently. “And so the boy--this -Brandon--proposes to go away at once, does he?” - -“So he has th’ audacity ter tell me,” responded old Arad. “He declared -he was goin’ termorrer mornin’. Ye know, square, I’m too broke up ’ith -the rheumatiz ter tackle him as he’d orter be tackled. A good hidin’ -would be th’ best thing fur him, in _my_ ’pinion.” - -“And in my opinion, too,” quoth the judge. “Now, of course this matter -will have to be done when the court meets next week, Mr. Tarr; but I’ll -come up and see the youth tonight, and I think that between us we can -make him see that this is the place for him to stay, and that there -is to be no running away from it,” and the judge shut his thin lips -together very grimly. - -“That’s it, square; thank ’ee,” said the old man, shambling out of the -house. “Dretful weather we been havin’, ain’t it?” - -Then he climbed into his wagon and drove back toward home, chuckling as -he went. - -“I reckon I’ve put a spoke in _his_ wheel,” he muttered, referring to -his nephew. - -As he pursued his homeward way, however, thoughts of the sailor with -whom he had so recently conversed, and of that conversation itself, -filled his mind. - -“I don’t persume thet ther’s anythin’ in it,” he muttered, thoughtfully -stroking the wisp of beard on his pointed chin. “Horace Tarr never had -no luck no-how, an’ I don’t see how he’d come ter know anythin’ erbout -this ’ere treasure. P’r’aps that sailor was jest a yarnin’ ter me.” - -Still, the old man could not drive the thought out of his mind. - -“Fabulously rich!” he repeated. “That’s what he heard Horace say. This -’ere mate of the Silver Swan was a chum er Horace’s, like ’nough, an’ I -s’pose if ther’ _is_ anythin’ in it, he’ll jes’ try ter git it himself. -An’ then--er--Brandon’ll never see a cent of it. - -“It really is my duty ter look aout fur th’ boy’s int’rest,” continued -the old hypocrite. “’F I’m goin’ ter be his guardeen, I’d orter know -what’s goin’ on; an’ this _may_ mean money fur--fur Brandon.” - -He wiped his wrinkled brow with a soiled handkerchief, the reins lying -idly on his knee the while. Somehow, despite the chilliness of the day, -the perspiration stood in great drops upon his forehead. - -“S’posin’,” he thought, “ther’ should be a letter at Sam Himes’ fur him -now, f’om that Wetherbee feller? ’Twouldn’t no way do fur a boy ter git -letters that his guardeen didn’t know nothin’ erbout, an’ ther’ ain’t -no doubt thet, if Brandon got it, he wouldn’t show it ter me. I--I -b’lieve I’ll drive ’round thet way an’ see.” - -He touched up the mare again and, upon reaching the forks of the road, -turned to the north once more and drove along the ridge until he -reached a little gambrel roofed cottage on the westerly side of the -highway. - -This was the post office where Sam Himes held forth, and to which the -lumbering old stage brought one mail each day. - -Here he dismounted from the wagon again, and went into the house, being -greeted at the door by the customary “Haow air ye?” of the postmaster. - -“I was jes’ thinkin’ er sendin’ daown ter your haouse, Arad,” declared -the postmaster, who was no respecter of persons, and called everybody -by his first name, being familiar with them from the nature of his -calling. “Here’s a letter fur yeou an’ one fur th’ boy--Don.” - -He thrust two missives into the old man’s hand, and Arad stumbled out -to his wagon again, his fingers shaking with excitement. Glancing -at the two envelopes he recognized one at once, and clutched it -avariciously. It was from a brokerage firm in New York, and contained -his monthly dividend for certain investments which he had made. - -The other letter, however, he did not look at until he had turned his -horse about and started her jogging along toward home again. Then he -drew forth the envelope and studied it carefully. - -It was addressed in a big, scrawling hand to: “Master Brandon Tarr, -Chopmist, Rhode Island,” yet, despite the plainness of the address, old -Arad, after a hasty and half fearful glance around, broke the seal and -drew forth the inclosed page. - -He looked first at the signature, and finding it to be “Caleb -Wetherbee,” he began to peruse the epistle, looking up from time to -time to glance along the road, that nobody might catch him in the act -of reading the letter intended only for his nephew’s eye. - -Uncle Arad’s sight was not so keen for written words as it once had -been, but he managed to stumble through the document, which read as -follows: - - NEW YORK MARINE HOSPITAL, - April the 2d, 1892. - - MASTER BRANDON TARR, - - SIR:--As I am laid up in dry dock, as you might say, and can’t get up - to see you right off as I promised your poor father, I am taking the - first chance these swabs of doctors have given me, to write this. - - Me and another man was all that was saved off the raft, as you - probably know now, for your father was hurt so bad that there wasn’t - any chance for him. He died ten days after we left the brig. - - I want you should pack up your togs, leave that farm where no son of - Captain Horace Tarr ought to dig all his life, and come down here to - New York to see me. I shall be out of this hospital before long, and - then we’ve got some work to do, like I promised your father before he - died. - - Captain Tarr put some papers in my hands which is of great value, - providing they can be used at once. It seems your uncle Anson died - several months ago in Kimberley, South Africa, and while he was at - Cape Town loading up the brig, a fellow come aboard and told your - father about it, and brung these papers. - - Among the papers (though the fellow didn’t know it, so I understood - from the few words poor Captain Tarr let drop) was a package of - diamonds which he hid aboard the old brig, and was afraid to take - with him on the raft for fear of the sailors that was with us. These - papers I’ve got he said would tell where the diamonds was hid. I - ain’t opened them yet, so I don’t know. - - Now you may think this here is no use because the Silver Swan is - wrecked; but I don’t believe she has gone to pieces yet; nor your - father didn’t think she would right off. We would have done better - by sticking to her, any way, I reckon. She was driv upright onto the - reef, and I’ll bet she’s sticking there yet. - - If you come down here to once, and I can get onto my old timber leg - again, we’ll charter a boat and go down there and see about it. If - it is as your father said--and I believe it--there’s enough of them - diamonds to make you another Vanderbilt or Jay Gould. - - Just you leave the land shark of an uncle that you’re staying with, - and trust yourself to - Your true friend, - CALEB WETHERBEE, - Mate of the Silver Swan. - - - - - -CHAPTER VIII - -SOMETHING ABOUT LEAVING THE FARM - - -CERTAINLY Uncle Arad Tarr had never been so filled with astonishment in -his life as he was upon reading the letter of the mate of the Silver -Swan to the captain’s son. - -Diamonds enough to make Brandon a second Vanderbilt! The thought almost -made Arad’s old heart stand still. - -“Who’d er-thought it--who’d ever er-thought it?” he muttered weakly, -folding the letter once more, and thrusting it into the pocket of his -patched coat. - -Then he picked up the reins and drove on, shaking his head slowly. - -“Diamonds enough ter make him rich!” he murmured, with an avaricious -contortion of his face. “Jest ter think o’ Anson Tarr ever gittin’ -more’n his bread and butter. It don’t seem ter me he c’d ha’ got ’em -honest.” - -He was very ready now, considering the guilty thoughts there were in -his own heart, to declare the fortune gained by his nephew Anson to be -dishonestly obtained. - -“It jest stands ter reason,” he went on, “that this ’ere Caleb -Wetherbee isn’t er--er trustworthy person to hev charge o’ Brandon--or -them di’monds either. I mus’ hev them papers made out jes’ as soon as -th’ square kin do it, an’ then I kin find that ’ere wreck--er hev it -found--m’self.” - -His mind at once reverted to Jim Leroyd, the sailor with whom he had -entered into a compact to “divide the spoils,” and he shook his head -again doubtfully. - -“He ain’t jes’ th’ man I’d er chosen ter do th’ work fur me,” muttered -the old sinner; “but then, he’s the old sailor I know, an’ it’s got ter -take a sailor, I s’pose, ter go ter them furrin parts. - -“He knows suthin’ erbout it already, too, an’ it wouldn’t do ter let -him git mad an’ go an’ tell this ’ere Wetherbee; then mebbe I couldn’t -git th’ papers from him. But th’ fust thing is ter hev thet ’p’intment -as guardeen fixed up.” - -Brandon was in the yard when he arrived, and good naturedly put up the -horse for him. - -“I’ve seen Mrs. Hemingway, uncle,” he said cheerfully, “and she’ll -be up here tomorrow morning. I shall take the stage to town in the -morning, and go to New York on the evening train, I guess.” - -“Ye will, eh?” returned Uncle Arad, showing his teeth. - -“Yes. Now you mustn’t get uppish, uncle. You didn’t suppose I would -stay here very long any way, did you?” - -“I s’pect ye’ll stay here a spell,” replied the old man, with a cunning -leer. “I ain’t fed an’ su’ported ye in lux’ry fur nigh four year fur -nothin’. Ye’ll stay here as my ward fur yer minor’ty, now I tell ye.” - -But Brandon was laughing over the thought of Uncle Arad’s “luxury,” -and did not hear the last of his speech. - -He did the most of the chores about the house and barn, as was usual, -and helped prepare the extremely frugal meal which Uncle Arad’s larder -afforded. - -“By George!” he thought, as he set about this latter task, “if I was in -the forecastle of some old ‘hooker’ I shouldn’t have worse fare than -this. I declare I’ll go off tomorrow before breakfast. This will be my -last meal at Uncle Arad’s table for one spell at least.” - -But he said nothing further about going away, knowing that it would -only anger the old man. Before the dishes were cleared away after -the meal, there was the sound of wheels at the gate, and in a moment -somebody knocked sharply. - -Old Arad himself arose and hobbled to the door, admitting “Square” -Holt into the miserable den of a kitchen. If it had been the President -himself, the old man would not have opened the “best room.” - -“Go aout an’ take the square’s boss ’roun’ ter the shed,” harshly -commanded Uncle Arad, and Brandon did as he was bidden, vaguely -suspecting that something was brewing. - -When he came into the kitchen again after doing the errand, the parrot -beaked judge was ready for him. - -“Young man,” began the judge severely, “your uncle, Mr. Tarr, who has -done so much for you for the past four years, tells me that you have -made a sorry return for all his kindness and bounty.” - -“In what?” demanded Brandon rather sharply, for he considered this -interference on the justice’s part as wholly uncalled for. - -“Is _that_ the way you speak to your elders, young man?” cried the -judge, aghast. “Have you no respect for gray hairs?” - -“I do not see why I should respect _you_, Mr. Holt,” replied Don, -with some temper. “You’ve never given me cause to and I consider that -your questions and remarks are entirely unwarranted. I propose to go -away from my uncle’s house (to whom, by the way, my father paid three -dollars per week board for me up to last fall, and for whom I have done -the work of a regularly hired hand during most of the time I have been -here) I propose to go away, I say, and nothing _you_ or uncle can say -will stop me!” - -“Hoighty toighty, young man!” cried the judge; “do you realize to whom -you are speaking?” - -“Yes, I do,” responded Brandon hotly. “To one who is known, far and -wide, as the meanest man in Scituate!” - -The judge’s ample nasal organ flushed to the color of a well grown -beet; but before he could reply old Arad put in _his_ oar: - -“What d’ye mean, ye little upstart?” (Fancy his calling Brandon -_little_, who already stood a good three inches taller than himself!) -“What d’ye mean, sayin’ that I was ever paid fur yer keep? Ye’ve been -nuthin’ but an expense an’ trouble ter me ever since ye come here.” - -“That’s an untruth, and you know it,” declared Don, who had quite lost -his temper by this time, and did not behave himself in just the manner -I should have preferred my hero to behave; but Brandon Tarr was a very -human boy, and, I have found, heroes are much like other folks and not -by any means perfect. - -“Young man, mark my words!” sputtered “Square” Holt, “you will yet come -to some bad end.” - -“I’ll git all this aout o’ ye, afore I’m done with ye, Brandon Tarr,” -declared Uncle Arad, “if I hev ter hire somebody ter lick ye.” - -“You wouldn’t do that--you’re too stingy to hire anybody to ‘lick’ me,” -responded Don tartly. “Now I don’t propose to listen to any more of -this foolishness. I’m going away, and I’m going away tomorrow morning. -I’ve eaten my last meal at this house, Uncle Arad!” - -“Is that the way to speak to your guardian?” said the judge, with -horror in his tone. “Mr. Tarr, you are too lenient with this young -scoundrel. He should be sent to the State reform school as I suggested.” - -“But then I wouldn’t get no work aout o’ him,” the farmer hastened to -say. “I--I’ve got ter git the money back I’ve spent on him, ye know.” - -Brandon laughed scornfully. - -“I should like to know by what right you call him my guardian, Mr. -Holt?” he asked. - -“Wal, I’m goin’ ter be yer guardeen--right off,” Arad hastened to -inform him, before the “square” could reply. “The square’s goin’ ter -make the papers aout ter oncet.” - -“They’ll be funny looking documents, I reckon,” said Don, in disgust. -“I understand that Mr. Holt has done several pretty crooked things -since he’s been in office, but this is going a little too far.” - -“Young man!” cried the judge, trying to wither the audacious youth with -a glance. - -But Don didn’t “wither” at all. - -“If you know anything at all about law,” he said to the judge, with -sarcasm, “you know that a guardian can’t be appointed in an hour. -Legal notice must be given and reason shown _why_ a guardian should be -appointed. I’ve no property, and Uncle Arad only wants to control me so -as to have my work. And, besides all that, I am old enough to choose my -own guardian, and you can bet your last cent that I shouldn’t choose -Arad Tarr.” - -“It ain’t so! ’tain’t no sich thing, is it, square?” cried old Arad, -in alarm. “Ain’t I th’ proper person to be ’p’inted over my own nevvy? -Ther’ ain’t nobody else got anythin’ ter do with it.” - -“He can tell you what he likes,” responded Brandon quickly; “but I’ve -given you the facts. Now I’ve heard enough of this, and I’m going to -bed.” Then he added, turning to Holt: “When you go out to fleece a lamb -next time, Mr. Holt, be pretty sure that the lamb is just as innocent -as you think it.” - -He turned away without another word then and left the kitchen, mounting -to his bedroom in the second story of the old house, leaving the -baffled conspirators in a state of wrathful bewilderment. - - - - -CHAPTER IX - -ANOTHER LETTER FROM NEW YORK - - -“MR. TARR,” declared the judge, when Brandon had, for the moment, so -successfully routed them and retired, “you are doing a very wrong thing -in shielding that young reprobate from the reform school. That’s where -he belongs. Send him there, sir, send him there!” - -“I never thought he’d ha’ shown disrespect fur the law,” gasped Uncle -Arad weakly. - -“Disrespect!” cried the judge, “I never was so insulted in all my life. -That boy will be hung yet, you mark my words!” - -“I never thought it of Brandon,” said the farmer, shaking his head. - -He seemed quite overcome to think that his nephew had dared defy the -law, or its representative. To Uncle Arad the law was a very sacred -thing; he always aimed to keep within its pale in his transactions. - -“You’ll never be able to do anything with that boy here,” declared -“Square” Holt. “A strait jacket is the only thing for him.” - -“But if he goes there what’ll be the use o’ my bein’ his guardeen?” -queried Arad. - -Then he hesitated an instant as a new phase of the situation came to -him. - -“If Brandon was under lock an’ key--jes’ where I c’d put my han’ on him -when I wanted him--I c’d go right erbout this ’ere treasure business, -an’ git it fur--fur _him_,” he thought, yet shivering in his soul at -the thought of the wrong he was planning to do his nephew. - -“I--I dunno but ye’re right, square,” he said quaveringly. “I--I don’ -wanter see th’ boy go right ter perdition, ’fore my very eyes, as ye -might say, an’ if ye think the reformin’ influences o’ the institution -is what he needs----” - -“The best thing in the world for him,” declared the judge, drawing on -his driving gloves. “The _only_ thing, I might say, that will keep him -out of jail--where he belongs, the young villain!” - -“But--but haow kin it be fixed up?” asked Arad, in some doubt. - -“You leave that to me,” said the judge pompously. “I’ll show that young -reprobate that he has defied the wrong man when he defies _me_. I’ll -give him all the law he wants--more, perhaps, than he bargained for.” - -“But s’pose he tries to run away in th’ mornin’, as he threatened?” - -“All you’ve got to do, Mr. Tarr,” said the judge, shaking one long -finger at the farmer, “is to keep a close watch on that young man. -Don’t give him a chance to run away. Lock him into his room tonight -and keep him there till we can--er, hem!--straighten this out. I think -it will be a very easy matter to place the case before the court in -such manner that the necessity for immediate action will be at once -admitted. - -“Why,” declared the judge, warming up to his subject, “I wonder, sir, -how you--an old man” (Uncle Arad winced at that), “and in feeble -health--have been able to remain here alone with that young scoundrel -all this winter. I wonder that he has not laid violent hands on you.” - -“Wal, he _has_ been some abusive, square, but I wouldn’t say nothin’ -erbout that,” said Uncle Arad hesitatingly. - -“Don’t compound villainy by shielding it,” responded the judge, with -righteous indignation. “This matter has already gone too far. When our -quiet town is to be aroused and made a scene of riot, such as has been -enacted--er--_here_ tonight, sir, it is time something was done. Such -young hoodlums as this Brandon Tarr should be shut up where they will -do no harm to either their friends or neighbors. - -“If I had _my_ way,” added the judge viciously, “I’d shut up every boy -in town in the reform school!” - -Then he marched out to his carriage, and Uncle Arad, after locking the -door, sat down to think the matter over. - -If he was successful in his nefarious plan of shutting Brandon up in -the reformatory institution of the State, the getting of the diamonds, -which Captain Tarr had hidden aboard the Silver Swan, would be all -plain sailing. - -Of course he would have to lose Brandon’s work on the farm; but he -had seen, by the boy’s open defiance of “Square” Holt, that he cared -nothing for the law or its minion--and Uncle Arad dared not allow his -nephew out of his sight for fear he would run away. - -To _his_ mind there was very little doubt that the attempt to shut -Brandon up would be successful. Judge Holt was a most powerful man -(politically) in the town, and he would leave no stone unturned to -punish the youth who had so fearlessly defied him. - -Judge Holt, although disliked by many of his townsmen who realized that -some of his methods and actions were illegal, still swayed the town on -election days, and carried things with a high hand the remainder of the -year. Old Arad chuckled to think how easily Brandon’s case would be -settled by the doughty “square.” - -Then, remembering the suggestion the judge had made just before his -departure, he rose hastily from his chair and quietly ascended to the -floor above. Here Brandon and himself slept in two small bedrooms on -opposite sides of the hall. - -The doors were directly opposite each other, and, although such things -as locks were unknown in the house on any except the outside doors, the -old man quickly lit upon a scheme that he thought remarkably clever. - -He obtained a piece of stout clothes line and fastened it back and -forth from handle to handle of the two bedroom doors, which, opening -into their respective rooms, were now arranged so that the occupants of -neither apartment could open the portals. - -Then, chuckling softly over his sharp trick, the old farmer crept -down the stairs once more to the kitchen, feeling moderately sure of -finding Brandon in his room in the morning. - -But one narrow window, looking out upon the barnyard, was in his -nephew’s apartment, and as the sash had long since been nailed in, and -the shutters closed on the outside, Uncle Arad felt secure on this -score. - -“I’ll starve him inter submission, ef I can’t do it no other way,” he -muttered angrily. - -Seating himself once more in his old armchair, he drew forth the two -letters obtained that day at the post office, adjusted his steel bowed -spectacles which, in a moment of extravagance, he had purchased of -a traveling peddler, and opened the epistle from his brokers which, -heretofore, he had not read. - -He slit the envelope carefully with the blade of his jack knife. More -than one man had torn or otherwise mutilated a check by opening an -envelope too carelessly. - -But instead of the printed form and generous draft which was the -usual monthly inclosure of the firm, all the envelope contained was -a typewritten letter, which the old farmer read with something like -horror: - - Office of - BENSELL, BENSELL & MARSDEN, - 513 Wall St., New York, - April 2, 1892. - - MR. ARAB TARR, - CHOPMIST, RHODE ISLAND. - - Dear Sir: - - We beg to announce that owing to several accidents, causing a large - loss of rolling stock of the road, the B. P. & Q. has dropped - several points on the market and has passed its monthly dividend. - - We would suggest that you hold on to your stock, however, as this is - a matter which will quickly adjust itself. - - Yours sincerely, - BENSELL, BENSELL & MARSDEN. - -The letter fluttered to the floor from Uncle Arad’s nerveless -fingers. To lose money was like losing his very life, and this was no -inconsiderable sum that had gone. He had invested a large amount in B. -P. & Q. stock, and up to the present time it had paid large interest. - -“Them brokers air thieves! I know they be,” cried the old man, breaking -forth into vituperations against the innocent firm of Bensell, Bensell -& Marsden. “Ye can’t trust ’em--not an inch! I don’t b’lieve none o’ -their lyin’ stories erbout the railroad’s passin’ its div’dend. I--I’ll -go ter New York m’self, I declare I will!” - -He got up and paced the floor wrathfully. - -“Jes’ as soon as I git this matter o’ Brandon’s settled, an’ git th’ -farm work started with Jim Hemin’way fur foreman, I’ll go. I ain’t -er-goin’ ter be cheated bare faced like this ’ere.” - -Then he thought a moment, and pulling Caleb Wetherbee’s letter from its -envelope again, read it once more carefully. - -“I--I might look inter this w’ile I was there too,” he muttered slowly. -“I reckon I kin fin’ thet feller I saw terday--Leroyd, his name was, -an’ his address was New England Hotel, Water Street. I shan’t furgit -thet right off.” - -He shook his head slowly, thrust both letters into his pocket, and then -shambled off to bed in the room off the kitchen as, having locked his -nephew in, he had also locked himself _out_ of his usual bed chamber. - - - - -CHAPTER X - -BRANDON’S ARRIVAL AT THE METROPOLIS - - -LONG habit had made Uncle Arad Tarr an extremely early riser, and it -had been his custom to arouse Brandon as early as half past three or -four during the summer months, and never later than five-thirty in -winter. On the morning after he had fastened the door of his nephew’s -room, however, the old man did not seek to disturb the boy, but rising -himself before five he went about the customary duties of the house and -barn. - -In this work he missed Brandon sadly; but having made up his mind that -the boy was bound to leave him any way, old Arad was determined that he -should go to the reform school, and therefore he would have to learn to -do without his valuable services. - -To his unsophisticated mind, it seemed a very simple matter indeed for -a powerful local politician like “Square” Holt to send his nephew to -the State reformatory institution, “and no questions asked.” - -But under our present system of humane laws, and with our enlightened -legal executives, an undeserved incarceration in prison or reform -school is seldom known--outside of story books. Judge Holt was a large -man in his own community (and in his own estimation) but he had never -been beyond that community far enough to learn how very small a man he -really was. - -After the arduous labor of feeding the stock and poultry, drawing water -and bringing in wood, old Arad hardly felt equal to either the task of -preparing breakfast, or eating the same; but he did at last sit down to -what he termed “a cold snack” about seven o’clock. - -“That ’ere boy sleeps like a pig,” he muttered, with a groan, twisting -about in his chair to get an easy position for his rheumatic limbs. “I -wonder he hain’t begun er-kickin’ on th’ door, er suthin’, yit.” - -At that moment there was a noise behind him, and turning about he -beheld the subject of his thoughts standing in the doorway leading to -the floor above. - -Uncle Arad gave a shout expressing surprise and anger, and sprang to -his feet. Brandon had been surveying him coolly, with a smile on his -face, and now he laughed outright. - -“Good morning, uncle,” he said. - -He was fully dressed in his best suit, hat, overcoat and all, and -carried a traveling bag in his hand. - -“How--how did ye git aout?” sputtered Uncle Arad, in wonder. - -“How did I get out?” - -“Yes--haow did ye git aouto’ yer room?” cried the old man. - -“I wasn’t in, therefore I didn’t have to get out,” responded Brandon -calmly. - -“Ye warn’t in?” repeated his bewildered relative. - -“That’s what I said. I wasn’t in. When you crawled up stairs last -night and took all that trouble with the clothes line, I wasn’t in my -room at all. I expected some such delicate attention as that on your -part, uncle, so I took the trouble to remove my things to the spare -room at the other end of the hall, and slept there.” - -The farmer fairly gnashed his teeth in rage. - -“Where be yeou goin’?” he demanded, planting himself between his nephew -and the door. - -“Why, uncle, I thought you knew that,” said Brandon, raising his -eyebrows in apparent surprise. “I told you last night that I was going -to New York. I haven’t changed my mind since then, though I’ve modified -my plans somewhat. It’s such a pleasant morning, I believe I’ll walk -down to Rockland, take the stage from there to Hope, and go to town on -the train.” - -“Yeou will, hey? Wal, I guess not!” - -Old Arad backed up against the door as though to guard that way of -escape. His lean form was trembling with excitement, and he was really -in a pitiable state for so old a man. - -“Think not, eh?” said Brandon coolly. - -He came into the kitchen and deposited his traveling bag on a chair, -and then stepped across the room and took his rifle down from the two -hooks upon which it rested. - -Old Arad uttered a shout of alarm and darted away from the door to the -opposite side of the table. - -“Goodness me! would you shoot me?” he gasped, fairly white to his lips. - -“Don’t be a fool, uncle,” responded Brandon with asperity, opening -the hall door again and bringing in a gun case which had been standing -in the corner of the other apartment. “The rifle isn’t loaded, and, -besides, what do you suppose I’d want to shoot you for?” - -“Oh, you young villain, you!” groaned old Arad, paying for his agile -movements of the moment before by several rheumatic twinges. - -“Thanks! Well, uncle, I guess I’ll be off. I don’t suppose you’ll shake -hands with a fellow?” and Brandon stopped, with his hand on the door -latch. - -“I’ll have ye a’rested afore ye git ter Rockland!” the old man shouted, -shaking his clenched fist at him. - -“You’d better not try it,” the boy declared, with flashing eyes. - -Arad followed him outside, sputtering. - -“Ye’ll live ter rue this day, ye young villain!” he cried. “I’ll show -ye no mercy.” - -“All right; it’s all the same to me,” Brandon returned, and whistling -cheerfully, he went out of the gate and started down the road with his -burden of traveling bag and gun case. - -It was a beautiful morning, despite the rain of the day before. -True, there were puddles of muddy water standing in the road and -patches of dirty snow in the fence corners and under the hedges. But -these drawbacks did not serve to cloud either the clear azure sky or -Brandon’s bright hopes. - -Looking back at the old farm house once, before turning the bend in the -road, he had a glimpse of old Arad driving furiously out of the yard. - -“He is going to see his familiar spirit, Holt,” muttered Don, with a -smile, “and lots of good may it do him. I’ll be in town before they -catch me, and Judge Ebenezer Holt isn’t anywhere near as big a man in -town as he is here. I’ll risk all the harm they can do me now.” - -He arrived at Rockland in time for the stage to Hope, and at the latter -village took the train for Providence. Neither his uncle nor Holt had -appeared, and he made up his mind that he was well rid of them. - -Once aboard the cars he settled himself back in his seat, and drew -forth the scrap of newspaper which had dropped from the old sailor’s -note case the day before. He read it through again carefully. - -“I’ve got nearly fifty dollars (wouldn’t uncle be crazy if he knew it?) -and although that isn’t a fortune, still it ought to keep me for some -time,” he thought. “But, the question is, after I pump all I can out of -that Wetherbee, what had I better do?” - -He mused a moment in silence, and then took up the connected train of -his reflections again. - -“Fifty dollars ought to last me quite a spell--and take me quite a way, -too. Of course, I can’t hire a boat in New York to go in search of the -Silver Swan with it; but I can watch the Hydrographic Office reports, -and find out in what general direction the brig’s headed. Then I’ll get -as near to her as possible and see--what I shall see! - -“I’d give a cent” (probably he would have given a good deal more) “if -this Wetherbee was a different sort of a man. It’s a mystery to me how -father ever trusted the fellow. I always supposed that father had a -keen insight into human nature; but a man will be deceived at times, I -suppose. - -“But I won’t let this treasure idea keep me from going to work, and -working hard, too. If I don’t get the money, why I don’t want to be -roaming about the world like Uncle Anson, with nothing to do in life -but hunt for wealth. I believe I’ll get a place on some vessel any way, -for there’s a good deal of the sailor in me as there was in father. We -get it from grandfather’s folks--the Brandons--I suppose.” - -He arrived at Providence before noon, and spent the time until evening -in looking about the business portion, of the city, and especially -about the wharves. Then late in the afternoon he took the cars for New -York, arriving in the metropolis at such an hour that to go to a hotel -near the station seemed necessary. - -Although a country boy by bringing up, Brandon was not easily disturbed -by the magnitude of life in the great city. In fact, he rather enjoyed -it, and after retiring to his room at the hotel, he went to sleep -without one apprehensive thought of what the morrow might bring forth. - -[Illustration: “GOODNESS ME! WOULD YOU SHOOT ME?”] - - - - -CHAPTER XI - -THE FIRM OF ADONIRAM PEPPER & CO. - - -LEAVING his bag and gun case at the hotel. Brandon Tarr started out by -nine o’clock on the following morning, his first aim being to find and -interview the sailor who had already visited Chopmist for the purpose -of seeing him. - -“Caleb Wetherbee, New England Hotel. Water Street,” was the address, -and after considerable inquiry he found the street in question. - -It was, however, the Battery end of it and no one seemed to know -anything about the New England Hotel. Still, Don was not dismayed and -pursued his way, keeping his eyes open and himself alert among the many -new sights and sounds of the metropolis. - -The locality grew worse as he pursued his way, but he was not to be -frightened off by gangs of street gamins, or crowds of half drunken -men. Still, in these days, Water Street isn’t as bad as it was once--at -least, not by daylight. - -As he wandered along he could see down the cross streets to the wharves -and water beyond, where all sorts and conditions of seagoing craft were -gathered from all parts of the world. He sniffed the sea breeze, too, -which, to him, killed all the odor of the filth about him. - -“That’s what I want to be--a sailor,” he muttered. - -Just then something caught his eye and he stopped motionless on the -sidewalk. - -On the opposite side of the street (the river side) as though crowded -off Front Street by its more pretentious neighbors, was the office of a -shipping firm. It was in a low brick building, dingy and dirty as were -the structures about it, and a much battered sign over the door read: - - ADONIRAM PEPPER & CO., - SHIPPING MERCHANTS. - -The name was what attracted Brandon’s attention first. He had heard his -father speak of it and of the man who was “Adoniram Pepper & Co.,” and -from his description he had a desire to see this eccentric personage. - -Perhaps, also, Mr. Pepper would know the locality of the New England -Hotel, and therefore Brandon crossed the street and entered the dingy -little front office. - -On a high stool by a high desk just beside the window, sat a man with -a wonderful development of leg, a terrific shock of the reddest hair -imaginable, and a shrewd, lean face, lit up by sharp, foxy eyes. -His face was smoothly shaven and the yellow skin was covered with -innumerable wrinkles like cracks in the cheeks of a wax doll; but -whether this individual was twenty-five, or fifty-five, Brandon was -unable to guess. - -The man (a clerk, presumably) looked up with a snarl at Brandon’s -appearance. - -“Well, what do _you_ want?” he demanded. - -“Is the firm in?” asked Don, almost laughing in the other’s face, for -the red haired clerk had a huge daub of ink on the bridge of his nose -and another on his shirt front. - -“_I’m_ the firm just now,” declared the man, glowering at him as though -he was a South Sea Islander with cannibalistic tendencies. - -“Oh, you are, eh?” returned Brandon. “Well, I want to see Mr. Pepper.” - -“You do, eh?” The clerk eyed him with still greater disfavor. “You do, -eh? Well you can’t see Mr. Pepper.” - -“Why not?” - -“Well, for one reason he isn’t here--he ain’t down yet--he’s gone -away--he’s _dead_!” - -He slammed down his pen and jumped off the high stool. - -“Git out o’ here you little rapscallion!” he roared, evidently -expecting Brandon to be frightened by his vehemence. “We don’t allow no -loafing ’round this office. Git, I say, or----” - -At that instant the street door behind the amused Brandon was opened, -and with one glance at the newcomer the clerk’s jaws shut together like -a trap, he turned about and bounded to his seat on the stool with great -ability, and seizing his pen went to work on his books with monstrous -energy. - -Brandon turned about also, surprised at these proceedings, and found -a short, pudgy looking little man standing in the doorway of the -office, gazing at the clerk with a broad smile on his red face; but -upon looking closer the boy discovered that, although the mouth was -smiling, the gentleman’s eyes were very stern indeed behind the gold -rimmed eye glasses. - -“What is the meaning of this unseemly conduct, Weeks?” he asked in a -tone of displeasure. - -“I--I was just showin’ this--this young friend of mine how--how a -feller up to the Bow’ry acted t’other night,” murmured the clerk, a -sort of ghastly red color mounting into his withered face beneath the -parchment-like skin. - -“The Bowery?” repeated the gentleman, severely, and Brandon decided -that this was no other than Mr. Adoniram Pepper himself. - -“Yes, sir; Bowery Theater, you know,” responded the clerk glibly, -with an imploring side glance at Brandon. “’Twas in the play, ‘The -Buccaneer’s Bride,’ you know.” - -“No, I _don’t_ know,” replied Mr. Pepper, in disgust. “So this is your -friend, is it?” and he turned his gaze upon Brandon genially. - -“Our friendship is of rather short duration,” said Don, smiling. - -“So I presume,” returned Mr. Pepper. “Did you wish to see me?” - -“Just a moment, sir.” - -“I’ll give you two moments if you like.” Then he turned again to -the clerk and shook one fat finger at him. “One of these days I’ll -discharge you, Weeks,” he said sternly. - -“I expect so,” groaned the clerk. “And then what’ll I do?” - -Mr. Pepper looked at him a moment silently. - -“Then you’ll go and lie somewhere else, I suppose. You _will_ lie, -Alfred Weeks, and I suppose I might as well keep you here and let you -lie to me, as to turn you loose upon your fellow men. Well, well! Now, -young man;” he turned with a sigh from the clerk and again looked at -Brandon. - -“I suppose you are Mr. Pepper?” began Brandon. - -“I--sup--pose--I--am,” replied the gentleman, with great care, -scrutinizing the face of the captain’s son with marked interest. - -“Let’s see, what is your name?” he said: “or, no, you needn’t tell me. -I know it already. Your name is Tarr, and you are Captain Horace Tarr’s -son!” - -“Yes, sir, I am,” Brandon replied in surprise. - -“I knew it, I knew it!” declared Mr. Pepper, shaking both the boy’s -hands so violently that the eye glasses, which had a hard enough time -generally in staying on the little man’s nose, tumbled off, and were -only caught and saved from destruction by great agility on Mr. Pepper’s -part. - -“My dear boy! I’d have known you if I’d met you in Timbuctoo!” he -declared. “Come into my office and tell me all about yourself. I’ve -been thinking about you ever since--er--your poor father’s death. I’ve -got something to tell you, too.” - -He led Brandon toward the inner door, marked “Private,” and opening it, -disclosed a comfortably furnished room with a fire in the grate, and a -general air of cheerfulness about it. - -“Come right in,” he repeated, and then shut the door behind his visitor. - -But no sooner was the door closed than the acrobatic clerk was off his -stool, and had his ear fitted to the keyhole with a celerity which -denoted much practice in the art of eavesdropping. - - - - -CHAPTER XII - -IN WHICH BRANDON VENTURES INTO RATHER DISREPUTABLE SOCIETY - - -“MY dear boy, sit down!” exclaimed Mr. Pepper, motioning Brandon to a -chair. “Sit down and let me look at you.” - -He himself took a chair at a desk by the window and studied the boy -intently for several moments. Meanwhile Brandon was making a mental -examination of the shipping merchant as well. - -Adoniram Pepper was a little, rotund man with a good deal of color -in his face and very little hair on his head. His mouth was always -smiling, but at times, as Brandon had already seen, the gray eves could -be very stern indeed behind the gold rimmed glasses, which latter had -such hard work remaining upon Mr. Pepper’s squat nose. - -“Yes, sir, you are the perfect picture of your father,” declared the -shipping merchant at last. “I thought when I read of his death that we -should never see his like again; but you have the promise of all his -outward characteristics, at least. I hope you’ve his inner ones, too.” - -“I hope so,” replied Brandon, pleased indeed at such praise of his -father. - -“He was a good man,” continued Mr. Pepper ruminatively. “By the way, -what’s your name?” - -“Brandon, sir.” - -“Oh yes, I remember now. Your father talked to me of you. He wanted you -to follow the sea, too, and I suppose that is what you’ve come down -here to New York for, eh?” - -“Yes, I hope to go to sea,” responded Brandon slowly. - -Had he not remembered his experience with Caleb Wetherbee, without -doubt Brandon would have opened his heart to the eccentric merchant and -told him all; but bearing in mind the (to him) evident treachery of the -mate of the Silver Swan, he was not ready to take into his confidence -every friend of his father who happened to turn up. - -“I thought so, I thought so!” exclaimed Mr. Pepper, rubbing his fat -hands softly together. “The sea, by all means, my boy. That’s where -I’ve obtained my living--and something beside--for many years, though -in a little different way from your father. Captain Tarr commanded one -of my vessels before he purchased the Silver Swan.” - -“Yes, so he has told me,” responded Brandon. - -“It was a sad thing--his loss at sea,” said Mr. Pepper. - -He still smiled, but there was moisture on his eye glasses, and he -removed and wiped them gently on a silk handkerchief. - -“And he left you hardly a penny’s worth?” he continued interrogatively. - -“I have only about fifty dollars,” Brandon replied briefly. - -“Only fifty dollars,” repeated the shipping merchant softly. “Not -much--more than I had, though, when I went out to seek my fortune; but -I had friends--powerful friends--and so have you, Brandon.” - -“Not many of them, I fancy,” Don returned, smiling. - -“Not many, perhaps: but _some_,” the other declared with confidence, -“and one of them is Adoniram Pepper.” - -“Thank you, Mr. Pepper,” said Don. “I hope I shall be worthy of your -kindness.” - -“No doubt of that--no doubt of that,” rejoined the merchant, beaming -upon him benignantly. “But to _talk_ isn’t enough for Adoniram Pepper; -I want to _do_ something for you, my boy.” - -“I--I don’t know just what you can do for me, sir,” said Brandon -doubtfully. - -“Don’t know? Why, you want to go to sea, don’t you?” - -“Yes, sir; I think I do.” - -“Then I _can_ help you,” declared the merchant. “I’ve several -vessels--three are in port at the present time--and it will be strange -indeed if I can’t find a berth on one of them for you.” - -“But I’m no sailor yet; I’ve got to learn,” objected Don. - -“So I suppose; but I’ll risk your learning fast enough. Now, where -would you like to go, and what position shall I give you?” and Mr. -Pepper settled himself deeper into his chair, and looked as though he -was prepared to offer Don any position he craved, from cook’s assistant -to captain. - -Brandon felt just a little bewildered by all this, and probably showed -his bewilderment on his face. - -“I’ll tell you what I have now,” went on Mr. Pepper. “There’s the brig -Calypso, loading for Port Said--she sails tomorrow; and the clipper -ship Frances Pepper (my sister’s name, you know) unloading from Rio, -and bound back there and to Argentine ports in a fortnight; and then -there’s the whaleback, Number Three.” - -“The whaleback?” queried Brandon in perplexity. - -“Yes, sir, whaleback; a whaleback steamer, you know. Didn’t you ever -see one?” - -Brandon shook his head. - -“Well, you’ll have a chance to,” declared Mr. Pepper. “These whalebacks -are something new. Lots o’ folks don’t believe in ’em; but I do. I -bought the third one the company ever built, and it lies at one of my -wharves now, being fitted up.” - -“But where will _that_ go?” Brandon inquired with interest. - -Mr. Pepper rubbed his bald pate reflectively. - -“Well,” he said, “that I don’t know yet. I haven’t decided. I’ve got a -scheme, but whether ’twill work or not, I can’t say. I must find a man -to command her first. I don’t suppose _you’d_ feel like doing that, -would you?” and the ship owner laughed jollily. - -“I’m afraid not; perhaps, though, there’d be some other place on her I -could fill with satisfaction to you.” - -“Perhaps so. If I put her in the passenger trade, how would you like -to be purser--assistant purser, of course, till you learn the duties?” - -“I think I should like it,” replied Brandon, with some hesitation, -however; “provided, of course, that I could take it at all.” - -“Eh? Not take it? Why not?” demanded Mr. Pepper. - -“Well, first I want to see my father’s old mate--one of the men saved -from the raft, you know--about--well, about a matter concerning the -wreck. Perhaps, then, if you can give me a berth, I’ll be able to -accept it.” - -“Going over to the hospital to see him, eh? I know Caleb Wetherbee.” - -“No, he’s out of the hospital now. He gave me his address--New England -Hotel, on this very street--and hunting for the place is what brought -me here.” - -“Bless my soul!” cried the ship owner; “Caleb out of hospital? Why, I -didn’t expect he’d be ’round for some time yet. The papers said he was -pretty nearly done for when he got to New York. It went harder with him -than it did with the other sailor--a good deal harder.” - -Brandon looked at him curiously. If Caleb Wetherbee was a particular -friend of Mr. Pepper, the captain’s son began to feel some doubt as to -the latter’s sincerity. - -“Perhaps you can tell me where the New England Hotel is?” he asked. - -“Yes, it’s right along here on this side of the street; several blocks -away, perhaps. But,” he added, “you don’t tell me that Caleb is -_there_? Why, he must be ’way down on his luck. I must see about this.” - -Mr. Pepper wrinkled his brow nervously and Brandon rose. - -“Where are you going?” - -“Up to see this man--this mate of the Silver Swan.” - -“Oh yes. Well, you tell him I’m coming up to see him myself, today. -It’s a mystery to me why he should go to _that_ place. I don’t -understand it. How was he looking when you saw him--for I take it you -_have_ seen him?” - -“How do you mean--sick or well?” - -“Yes.” - -“Oh, he appeared in pretty fair health, I should say,” replied Brandon, -beginning to think that there was something queer about it all. - -“Well, I’ll see him myself,” declared the merchant, rising and giving -the boy his hand. “I tell you what we’ll do, Brandon. If you don’t get -back here by noon, I’ll step up and get you, and we’ll go to lunch -together; then afterward we’ll take a look at the whaleback, if you -like.” - -Brandon thanked him and opened the door into the outer office, almost -falling over Mr. Alfred Weeks, who had his head suspiciously near the -keyhole. - -“Lo--looking for my ruler that I dropped,” declared the red haired -clerk, as his employer’s eyes rested sternly upon him. - -But as he passed out, Brandon noticed that the ruler was on the high -desk holding open the leaves of a much tattered paper novel. - -“Funny sort of fellow for a respectable ship owner to employ,” Brandon -decided, as he made his way along the crowded thoroughfare. “In fact, I -guess I’ll withhold my opinion of all three of these people till I know -’em better--Wetherbee, Pepper, and his clerk.” - -By closely scanning the signs on the buildings as he passed, the -captain’s son finally discovered the place he sought. He came within an -ace of not doing so, however, for the words “New England Hotel” were -simply painted on a small strip of tin on one side of the doorway, the -rest of the sign space being devoted to the words: John Brady, Wines, -Liquors, and Cigars. - -Brandon hesitated a moment before entering the place. It was plainly -a saloon of the worst type, the “hotel” part evidently being but a -“blind” by means of which the bar could be kept open all night. - -Two or three disreputable men--sailors or longshoremen by -appearance--were hanging about the door, but Brandon Tarr had a good -deal of confidence in his ability to take care of himself, and finally -ascended the steps. - -A sickening odor of stale tobacco smoke and bad liquor assailed his -nostrils as he stepped within the room, and he was almost tempted to -back out and give up his intention of seeing Wetherbee. But the man -behind the bar--a villainous looking fellow with a closely cropped head -and red face--had seen him and came briskly forward. - -“Well, young felley, what kin I do fur ye?” he asked, in what was -intended as a pleasant tone. - -Deciding that he was in for it, the captain’s son walked forward to the -bar and replied: - -“Nothing to drink, thank you. I’m looking for a man who’s stopping -here--Caleb Wetherbee.” - -The bartender eyed him curiously and repeated: - -“Caleb Wetherbee, eh? Well, I’ll see ’f he’s here.” - -He stepped back to a door leading into an inner room and, opening it a -crack, called to somebody inside. There was a whispered conversation -between the men, and the bull necked individual came back to the bar. - -“All right, m’ duck; he’s in dere,” he said, with a grin, and a motion -of his thumb toward the inner door. “Yer don’t have ter send in no -kyard.” - -Taking this as a permission to enter, Brandon walked across the long -saloon, littered with tables and chairs, and its door covered with -sawdust, and opened the door. - -The apartment beyond was as badly furnished as the outer room, there -being only a square deal table and several wooden bottomed chairs. In -one of these chairs before the table, with his head bowed upon his -arms, was the sailor whom Brandon had seen two days before in the woods -on his uncle’s farm back in Chopmist, the only occupant of the place. - - - - -CHAPTER XIII - -THE OLD SAILOR WITH THE WOODEN LEG - - -IT was only in the country--in the woods and sheltered fence -corners--that the patches of snow still remained on this sixth day of -April. In New York the sun shone warmly upon the sidewalks, washed -clean by the shower of the night before, and the tiny patches of grass -in the parks and squares were quite green again. - -About the middle of the forenoon a man stumped along a street leading -to what remains of the Battery park--a man dressed in a half uniform of -navy blue, and with a face (where the beard did not hide the cuticle) -as brown as a berry. - -At first glance one would have pronounced this person to be a sailor, -and have been correct in the surmise, too. - -The man’s frame was of huge mold, with massive development of chest and -limbs, and a head like a lion’s. But his bronzed cheeks were somewhat -hollow, and his step halting, this latter not altogether owing to -the fact that his right leg had been amputated at the knee and the -deficiency supplied by an old fashioned wooden leg. - -Still, despite his evident infirmity, the old seaman looked cheerfully -out upon the world on this bright April morning, and pegged along the -sidewalk and into the park with smiling good nature. - -Not a beggar had accosted him during his walk down town without having -a nickel tossed to him, and it was with vast contentment that the -wooden legged sailor at length seated himself upon a bench, from which -vantage point he could overlook the bay and its multitudinous shipping. - -“Ah!” he exclaimed, sniffing the air which blew in from the sea, like a -hungry dog. “This is _life_, this is! Thank heaven I’ve got away from -them swabs of doctors at last. Another week at that ere hospital would -ha’ been the death o’ me. Still, I reckon they meant well ’nough.” - -He sat there for some time in cheerful silence, and drank in the -exhilarating air, his pea cloth jacket thrown open to the breeze, -baring the broad expanse of flannel shirt beneath. - -“A few days o’ this’ll put me right on my feet,” he said, with delight, -“better’n all the tonics the old sawbones ever invented. Lord! if I’d -had this breeze a-blowin’ inter my winder up there to the hospital, I’d -been out a fortnight ago. - -“The old man ain’t dead yet. It was a pretty hard tug, I admit; but -here I be!” - -He slapped his leg with such vigor that a flock of sparrows flew up -with sudden affright from the path; but this energetic gesture was -taken in another sense by the group of urchins which had gathered -near by to talk and fight (much after the manner of their feathered -prototypes, by the way) over the morning’s sale of papers. - -At the old man’s motion half a dozen of these sharp eyed little rascals -broke away from the group, and ran shrieking toward him, wildly waving -their few remaining wares in his face. - -“’Ere you are, sir! _Tribune_, _Sun_, _World_!” - -“_Tribune_,” said the old sailor, laughing heartily as though he saw -something extremely ludicrous in their mistake. - -“My last ’un, sir. Thankee!” - -The successful Arab pocketed his money and went back to his friends, -while the sailor slowly unfolded the sheet and took up the thread of -his reflections again. - -“Once I get my sea legs on,” he thought, fumbling in his pocket for -a pair of huge, steel bowed spectacles, which he carefully wiped and -placed astride his nose “once I get my sea legs on, I’ll take a trip up -ter Rhode Island and see the cap’n’s boy, unless he turns up in answer -to my letter. - -“Poor lad! he’s doubtless heart broken by Cap’n Horace’s death, and -won’t feel much like goin’ into this ’ere treasure huntin’ business; -but for his own good I’ll have ter rouse him up. It would be what the -cap’n would wish, I know.” - -He let the paper lie idly on his knee a moment, and a mist rose in his -eyes. - -“Never mind if the old brig _has_ gone to pieces before we get there,” -he muttered. “I’ve got a little shot in the locker yet, an’ the boy -shan’t come ter want. I’ll do my duty by him as though he was my own -son, that I will!” - -He picked up the paper again, and turned naturally to the shipping -news, which he ran over carelessly, smiling the while. Finally his eye -was attracted by something near the bottom of the column. - -“Eh, what’s this?” he exclaimed. “What’s this about the Silver Swan?” - -With great excitement he read the following news item, following each -line of the text with his stumpy forefinger: - - Captain Millington, of the English steamer Manitoba, which arrived - here yesterday from Brazil, reports that he passed a very dangerous - wreck in latitude 22:03, longitude 70:32. It was the hull of a brig, - apparently in good condition, but with her masts snapped off close to - the decks, and all her rigging carried away. The name on her stern - was Silver Swan, Boston. - - This is the same derelict reported by the steamer Montevideo at - Savannah several weeks ago. According to Captain Millington, the - wreck of the brig is a great menace to all vessels plying between - this and South American ports, as its course seems to be right across - the great highway followed by most of the steamship lines. - - It will be remembered that the Silver Swan was wrecked over two - months ago on Reef Eight, southwest of Cuba, grounding, according to - the report of the survivors of her crew, upright on the rock. The - captain of the Montevideo sighted her not far from the reef, from - which she was doubtless loosened by the westerly gale of February - 13th; but since that time she has floated some distance to the north - and east, and if she follows the same tactics as many of her sister - derelicts, she may zigzag across the course of the South American - steamers for months. - - The cruisers Kearsarge and Vesuvius are both lying in port at - present, and it will be respectfully suggested to the Navy Department - that one or both of those vessels be sent to destroy this and several - others of the most dangerous derelicts now floating off our coast. - -“Shiver my timbers, sir!” - -With this forcible and exceedingly salty ejaculation, the old sailor -with the wooden leg dropped the newspaper to the walk, and his -spectacles along with it, and springing up, trampled upon them both. - -But in his great excitement he noticed neither the torn paper nor the -ruined glasses. He stumped up and down the walk for several moments -before he became calm enough to think coherently. - -In fact, the blue-coated policeman on the corner had begun to eye him -suspiciously. - -“The Silver Swan afloat--a derelict!” he muttered. “This ’ere is a -sitiwation I didn’t look for. An’ then, them blasted cruisers are -liable to go down there and blow her into kingdom come any minute. The -Silver Swan on Reef Eight was bad enough, but the Silver Swan afloat, -at the mercy of the gales as well as other vessels, is worse! - -“Now, what in creation’ll I do about it? I haven’t heard from the boy -yet, and there’s little enough time as it is. Why, she might sink ’most -any time with all them di’monds the cap’n told about aboard her! - -“I’ll take a steamer to get down there ahead of them confounded -iron pots” (by this disrespectful term did he designate Uncle Sam’s -cruisers), “but who under the canopy’s got a steamer to charter? - -“By the great horn spoon, I have it!” he exclaimed, after a moment’s -thought. “Adoniram Pepper is just the fellow.” - -With this declaration he jammed his hat on his head, and stumped off as -rapidly as one good leg and one wooden one could carry him, toward the -shipping merchant’s office on Water Street. - - - - -CHAPTER XIV - -THE OLD SAILOR’S EXCITEMENT - - -AS the old sailor hurried along the street toward the ship owner’s -office he became calmer, and, being a person who had all his life been -taking greater or less chances in his business of seagoing, he began to -look at the situation more composedly. - -The Silver Swan was without doubt in far greater danger of destruction -now than she had been while hard and fast on the reef, but no amount -of worrying would better the matter, and therefore one might accept -the fact coolly. Then, besides, she had floated unmolested for over -six weeks already, and there was a big chance for her doing so for six -weeks or more to come. - -“Blast these navy vessels any way, I say!” the old man muttered, -stumping along now at a moderate gait. “They probably won’t be able to -find her. And if nothing collides with her, I reckon she’ll keep afloat -for one while, for I can swear myself that the old brig warn’t injured -none below the water line--she went on that reef jest as easy! - -“She’s got the same chance o’ staying above board--the Silver Swan -has--as any other craft that’s become a derelict. Look at the schooner -W. L. White, abandoned by her crew during the great storm of ’88. She -floated about the North Atlantic for the better part of a year, before -she went ashore at last on the Hebrides. - -“An’ then there was the Weyer G. Sargent, mahogany laden, floated -fifty-five hundred mile, or more, ’cording to the pilot chart, -a-swingin’ ’round the Atlantic from New Foundland to the Azores for -two years. An’ there may be many another good ship that’s got a bigger -record ’n that at this very day, down in the Sargasso sea. Oh, it might -be worse.” - -Nevertheless, despite this cheerful view, the old sailor’s forehead was -knotted into a scowl as he opened the door of the ship owner’s dingy -office and entered. The red haired clerk was alone at the desk and the -door of the private office was shut. - -“Well, you jail bird, are you here yet?” demanded the visitor -impolitely, eying the clerk with exceeding disfavor. - -“Oh, is that you, Mr. Featherbee----” - -“Wetherbee, you scoundrel!” roared the sailor, in a voice like a bull. - -“Oh, yes! I should say Wetherbee--er--that’s what I meant,” the clerk -hastened to say. - -It was remarkable to notice the difference between the greeting -accorded to Caleb Wetherbee and that given young Brandon Tarr shortly -before. - -“So you haven’t managed to get at Pepperpod’s till and clear out, yet, -eh?” demanded Caleb jocularly. - -Mr. Weeks scowled and grinned at the same time, a feat that very few -men can perform; but he made no verbal reply to the question. - -“Where is he?” queried the sailor, nodding toward the inner office. “In -his den?” - -“He’s busy--engaged,” Mr. Weeks hastened to say. - -“I believe you’re lying to me, Weeks,” returned the sailor, after eying -the fellow a moment. “You’d rather lie than eat. Where’s Pepperpod?” - -“He--he really _is_ engaged, sir,” declared Weeks, who stood in mortal -fear of the brawny sailor. “That is, he told me to say so to anybody -that called----” - -“I don’t doubt it--that’s what’s taught you to lie,” cried Caleb, in -disgust. “Well, I’m going to see him if he’s engaged fifty times. Cut -along now and tell him I’m here.” - -Mr. Weeks slowly descended from his stool, evidently unwilling to -comply with the request. - -“Get a move on you,” the sailor commanded. “If you don’t I’ll roast you -over a slow fire. I’m just out of the hospital and I’ve got an appetite -like an ostrich--or I’d never think of eating _you_.” - -Mr. Weeks unwillingly went to the inner door and rapped on the panel. -Then he turned the knob and went in, remaining a few moments, and on -making his appearance again, held the portal open for Caleb. - -The sailor entered without a word and the clerk closed the door behind -him; then, as on the former occasion, he applied his ear to the keyhole -with a diligence worthy of a better cause. - -Mr. Pepper was sitting before his desk, which was piled high with -papers and letters. The day’s mail had just been sent up from the -wareroom office by Mr. Marks, the ship owner’s trusted manager, or -“steward,” as Adoniram was in the habit of calling him. - -Beginning business life more than fifty years before in this very -office, Mr. Pepper could not bring himself, as his trade increased, -to leave his old quarters, and having found his manager to be a most -trustworthy man, he had shifted the burden of the more arduous duties -upon his younger shoulders, and himself reposed contentedly amid the -dust, the gloom, and the cobwebs of the Water Street office. - -Thus it was that few people ever saw “Adoniram Pepper & Co.” to know -him; but to his old friends, those of his boyhood and young manhood, -Adoniram was always the same. - -Naturally his acquaintance was mostly among seafaring people, and it -was no uncommon sight to see old hulks of sea captains and ship owners, -long past their usefulness, steering a course for the Water Street -office on pleasant days, where they were sure to receive a pleasant -word from the little old gentleman, if he was in, and not uncommonly -a bit of silver to spend for luxuries which “sailors’ homes” do not -supply. - -The old gentleman sprang up at once at Caleb’s appearance, the -unfortunate eye glasses jumping off the chubby little nose as though -they were endowed with life. Mr. Pepper gave both his hands to the huge -sailor, who indeed looked gigantic beside the little man, and begged -him to sit down. - -“Well, Pepperpod, how are ye?” cried the sailor, in a hearty roar that -shook the light pieces of furniture in the room, just as his bulk shook -the chair he had seated himself in. - -“First rate, old Timbertoes!” declared the old gentleman, laughing -merrily. “So you’re out of the hospital, at last?” - -“I be, Adoniram, I be!” cried Caleb with satisfaction. “Never was so -glad o’ anythin’ in my life. Them sawbones would have killed me if -they’d kep’ me there much longer.” - -“Well, well, Caleb, you was a mighty sick man--a mighty sick man.” - -“I reckon I was,” responded the sailor reflectively. - -“The doctor wouldn’t let me come in to see you,” said the merchant, -smiling jovially; “so I had to content myself with sending up things.” - -“Yes, you did,” said Caleb, turning on him sternly. “I _did_ think, -Adoniram, that you wouldn’t waste your money on such truck as -that--a-sendin’ me white grapes, an’ jellies, an’ bunches o’ posies.” - -He snorted in veriest scorn. - -“Well, er--er--you see, Caleb, I told Frances about you and she took -over the things herself,” said Adoniram hesitatingly. - -“Hem!” - -The old sea dog flushed up like a girl and mopped his suddenly heated -face with a great bandanna, finally saying gruffly: - -“You tell your sister, Miss Frances, that I am mightily obleeged for -’em, Adoniram. They--er--jest went to the right spot, you tell her; -jest what I needed to tone me up!” - -“You’d better come up and tell her yourself, Caleb,” said the merchant, -with a sly smile. - -“Well--er--mebbe I will. Thankee, Adoniram.” - -He was silent a moment, and then, suddenly bethinking himself of the -errand which had brought him there, he turned upon the little merchant -with a slap of his knee which sounded throughout the office like a gun -shot. - -“But this ’ere ain’t what brought me here--not by a long chalk. Ye know -the Silver Swan, Adoniram? Cap’n Horace Tarr’s brig ’t I was with when -she grounded on Reef Eight, two months and more ago?” - -Mr. Pepper nodded. - -“Well, sir, she’s afloat.” - -“Afloat!” - -“That’s what I said; afloat! A-f-l-o-t-e,” responded the sailor, -spelling the word very carefully, if a trifle erratically. - -“How--how can that be?” - -“Well, ye see she went aground jest like she was goin’ inter stocks for -repairs, and if we’d stuck by her, it’s my opinion Cap’n Tarr’d ha’ -been alive now.” He stopped and blew his nose hastily. “Well, what is, -can’t be bettered, so we’ll say no more o’ that. - -“But what I’m gettin’ at is this: she went aground all standin’, an’ -the storm wot come up right arterwards, blew her off ag’in. She’s been -floating, according to this morning’s paper, ever since.” - -“Well, well!” exclaimed Adoniram. “It’s too bad her hull can’t be -secured for the boy. If it’s still sound----” - -“Sound as a dollar!” - -“Where is it floating?” - -“’Cordin’ to the report of a cap’n wot sighted her, she’s somewheres -about latitude 22, longitude 70.” - -“A pretty valuable derelict, eh, Caleb?” said the merchant, -reflectively. - -“Valible? Well, I should say!” The old sailor looked at his friend -curiously a moment, and then leaned forward and rested his huge hand on -Adoniram’s knee. “Besides a valible cargo wot we took on at the Cape -and Rio, _there’s enough diamonds hid aboard that brig to make the boy -a second Vanderbilt_!” - -“Mercy me!” exclaimed the merchant, and this time the eye glasses -leaped off their insecure resting place and fell with a crash to the -floor, the splintered crystal flying in all directions. - -“Now you’ve done it, Adoniram!” ejaculated Caleb in disgust. “What -under the canopy a man like you--with no nose to speak of--wants to try -to wear such tackle as them for, is beyond me.” - -“Well--er--Frances thinks they look better on me than other kinds of -glasses,” remarked the merchant meekly. - -“Well--hem!--I s’pose they _do_ look some better on ye,” declared Caleb -loyally, and then a slight noise from the other side of the door caused -him to jump up and spring hastily to it. - -When he flung the door open, however, the red haired clerk was astride -his high stool with a look of perfect innocence on his face; but Caleb -was not reassured. He shook his huge fist at the fellow, and then shut -the door again, turning the key in the lock and hanging his hat upon -the door knob for further precaution. - - - - -CHAPTER XV - -CALEB RECEIVES A STARTLING COMMUNICATION - - -“SOME of these days,” said Caleb, with decision, when he had taken -these precautions, “I shall wring that scoundrel’s neck, Adoniram. I -wonder at your keeping him here.” - -“Well, you see, nobody else would have him,” responded the merchant, as -though that fact was reason enough for _his_ keeping the objectionable -Mr. Weeks. - -“Ya-as--one o’ your blasted philanthropic notions,” declared Caleb, -with a snort denoting disgust. “Well, he’ll rob and murder you some day -and then you’ll wish you’d heard to me. If ‘jail bird’ ain’t written on -_his_ face, then I never saw it on no man’s.” - -“But, Caleb, what do you mean by the astounding remark you just made -about the Silver Swan?” asked the merchant, drawing the sailor’s mind -away from the subject of Mr. Alfred Weeks and his frailties. - -“I’ll tell you about it,” said Caleb, in a lower tone, seating himself -by the desk again. “What I said is straight, Pepper. There is hidden -inside that hulk of the Silver Swan, a lot o’ di’monds--how many, I -don’t know--but enough, according to Cap’n Horace’s own words to make a -man fabulously rich. They belong to his boy, Brandon, and _we_ must get -’em for him. - -“I never knew a word about the stones till we was on the raft. Cap’n -Horace was pretty fur gone--any one with half an eye could see -_that_--and when we’d been out several days an’ hadn’t sighted no ship, -he wrote a long letter to Brandon an’ give it to me with a package of -other papers. - -“I’ve got them papers right here at this identical minute; but I ain’t -opened ’em, ’cause it ain’t my place to do so. They tells all about the -di’monds an’ how they come into Cap’n Horace’s han’s. - -“It seems that just afore we left the Cape a man come aboard the Silver -Swan and brought a package of wot _he_ thought was papers, to Cap’n -Horace, from his brother Anson.” - -“Why, Anson was dead long ago, I thought,” interrupted Mr. Pepper. - -“So did everybody else think so; but he wasn’t. He was dead, though, -when this feller seed Cap’n Horace, for he’d give the package into the -man’s hands when he was dying, for _him_ to send to Cap’n Tarr. But we -put into the Cape afore the man got ’round to sendin’ ’em to the States. - -“_He_ never knew what a valible thing he was a carryin’ ’round; but -when the cap’n come to open the package he found a lot o’ di’monds done -up in a separate wrapper. These he hid somewhere about the brig--he -tells about it in this letter to Brandon, I b’lieve. - -“I wanted to know why he didn’t take ’em on the raft when we left the -brig, but it seems he misdoubted himself about a rascally sailor we had -with us--one Jim Leroyd. - -“This ’ere Leroyd had been snoopin’ around the cabin when the cap’n was -given the diamonds, and he thought the feller suspected something. So, -not knowing how it might go with any of us, he left the gems on the -brig, preferring to risk losin’ ’em altogether, rather than to cause -strife an’ p’r’aps bloodshed on that raft. - -“An’ I reckon ’twas lucky he did so, fur we had trouble enough with -that swab Leroyd.” - -“Why, wasn’t he the man who was saved with you?” asked the merchant. - -“That’s who.” - -“Tell me, Caleb,” said Mr. Pepper earnestly, “why was it he stood the -experience so much better than you? Why, he was discharged from the -hospital in a week, so I understand, while you show traces of the -suffering you underwent even now.” - -Caleb closed his lips grimly and looked at the little man in silence -for several moments. Then he leaned further forward and clutched his -arm with one great brown hand. - -“He had food that I didn’t have,” he whispered hoarsely. - -“What!” cried Adoniram, shrinking back, his eyes abulge. - -Caleb nodded slowly. - -“There were four of us on that raft. Paulo Montez--he went first. We -divided the food and water, an’ that villain Leroyd ate his all up. -Then we had ter drive him behind his chest at the other end of the -raft, an’ keep him there at the point of our pistols. - -“Then the cap’n went, an’--an’--_I had to throw him to the sharks to -keep him out o’ the clutches o’ that cannibal Leroyd!_” - -“Great heavens!” exclaimed the ship owner, shrinking back into his -chair, his face the picture of horrified amazement. - -“Yes, sir,” whispered Caleb; “he dragged poor Paulo’s body back o’ that -chest--an’--well, ’taint no use talkin’! I ain’t said a word about it -before to any living creature. It’s only my word ag’in his, at best. -But I swear, Adoniram, I’d kill the hound with as little compunction as -I would a rat. - -“He’s been sneaking ’round the hospital, inquiring about me, too,” -continued the sailor. “He’s got his eye on these papers, for he see -Cap’n Horace give ’em to me. I reckon he don’t know what they’re about, -but he suspects there’s money in it. He was ’round to the hospital only -last night, so the doctor told me. - -“And now, Adoniram, wot I want o’ you is to help me find this derelict -before some o’ Uncle Sam’s blasted iron pots go out after her. We must -get the boy down from that uncle’s place in Rhode Island----” - -“Why, didn’t you see him this morning?” asked Mr. Pepper, in surprise. - -“See who?” - -“Why, the boy--Captain Tarr’s son, Brandon?” - -“What?” roared the sailor. “Then he’s here in New York, is he?” - -“Why--of--course,” responded the merchant, in bewilderment. “I thought -you’d seen him again. He started out to call on you not two hours ago. -He said you’d given him your address--at the New England Hotel, just -below here. - -“And what I want to say, Caleb is that I don’t consider it a great -proof of friendship on _your_ part, for you to go to such a place as -that, even if you were low in finances. I’d only be too glad to have -you come to my house and stay the rest of your natural life--and so -would Frances.” - -“Me!--at the New England Hotel!--why the man’s crazy!” declared Caleb. - -“Ain’t you stopping there?” gasped the merchant. - -“Am I? Well. I guess not! I ain’t but just got out o’ the hospital this -blessed morning.” - -“Why, he said he’d seen you once, and you’d told him to call at the New -England Hotel.” - -“Who?” roared Caleb. - -“Brandon Tarr.” - -“Why, man alive, I never saw the lad in all my life!” - -“Then,” declared Adoniram with energy, “there’s foul play about it. -When I came down this morning I found the captain’s son waiting to see -me. He’d just come down from Rhode Island, I believe, and he’d got your -address--said he’d already seen you once, mind you--and was going up to -this place to see you again. - -“I thought ’twas funny you should put up at such a house, Caleb; but I -didn’t know but perhaps you were ‘on your uppers’” (Caleb snorted at -this), “and had gone there for cheapness. I told Brandon I’d come up -after him this noon and take him to lunch.” - -But Caleb was on his feet now, and pacing the floor like a caged lion. - -“I see it all--I see it all!” he declared. “It’s some o’ that swab -Leroyd’s work. Why, man alive, do you know what the New England Hotel -is? It’s one o’ the wickedest places in New York. I know the den well, -and the feller as runs it, too. Why, the boy’s in danger every moment -he stays there!” - -He seized his hat and jammed it on his head again. - -“Ef anything’s happened to that boy, I’ll break every bone in that -scoundrel’s body!” he exclaimed, seizing the door and throwing it wide -open without the formality of unlocking it. - -The splintered wood and broken lock flew in all directions as he dashed -through the doorway and flung himself into the street, while Mr. Pepper -remained weakly in his chair, too utterly bewildered to move, and the -festive Mr. Weeks dodged behind the high desk with alacrity, as the -sailor went through the outer office like a whirlwind. - - - - -CHAPTER XVI - -TELLING HOW BRANDON BEARDED THE LION IN HIS LAIR - - -AS Brandon Tarr entered the apartment behind the bar room of the New -England Hotel, the man at the table raised his head and surveyed him -surlily. Evidently he had been drinking, and the liquor had changed -his mood greatly from that of the affable sailor who had accosted the -captain’s son in the Chopmist woods. - -“Well, how came _you_ here?” inquired the sailor, in no very friendly -tone, gazing at Brandon, with bloodshot eyes. - -“I came down on the train.” - -“Ain’t you lost?” - -“Guess not,” responded the boy. - -The man shifted his position uneasily, keeping his eyes fixed upon his -visitor. - -“Can’t say as I expected to see you--just yet, any way.” - -“No?” returned Brandon coolly. - -“Say! wot the blazes do you want, any way?” demanded the sailor -fiercely, after an instant’s silence. “It won’t pay you to be sassy -here, my lad, now I can assure ye.” - -“Think so? Seems to me you’re not as glad to see me as I reckoned you -would be. It didn’t exactly pay you to come ’way up to Rhode Island to -pump me, did it?” - -The fellow hissed out an oath between his teeth and clinched his fist -angrily. - -“You’re too fresh, you are!” he declared. - -“Maybe.” - -“So I went up there to pump you, eh?” - -“I reckon.” - -“And what did _you_ come down here for?” - -“To pump you,” responded the captain’s son, laughing. - -The sailor stared at him in utter amazement for a moment. - -“Of all the swabs----” he began, but Brandon interrupted him. - -“See here, Wetherbee, I’ve come here for a purpose. My father intrusted -you with some papers for me (though why he ever did so _I_ don’t see--I -mistrusted your ugly face the first time I ever saw it), and now you -are trying to play me false.” - -“You know too much!” roared the sailor, rising and thumping the table -with his clenched fist. - -“Yes, I _do_ know too much for your good--or for the success of your -plot,” Brandon replied, with cool sarcasm. “See this?” - -He took the bit of newspaper from his pocket and tossed it upon the -table before the man. - -“What is it?” demanded the sailor, clutching at the clipping. - -“The newspaper item stating that the Silver Swan is a derelict, instead -of being sunken, as you declared to me. Had I not found it in the -woods after you left, I might have still believed your lying yarn, -Wetherbee.” - -The sailor crumpled the bit of paper in his fist and shook the clenched -member in the boy’s face. - -“Young man,” he said with emphasis, “ye think ye’re smart; but do ye -know that ye’re likely ter git inter trouble ’fore ye get out o’ this -place? I don’t ’low no boy ter sass me.” - -“I’m sorry for that,” said Brandon, thinking the fellow’s threat but -mere bombastic eloquence; “for I reckon you’ll have to stand it.” - -His very fearlessness caused the man to hesitate ere he used -violence, for it _might_ be that the boy had friends within call. The -sailor therefore bit his thick lip in fury, and poured a shower of -vituperations upon his visitor’s head. - -“Let me tell you something else, also,” continued Brandon. “I propose -to have those papers that father gave you.” - -“Oh, you do?” half screamed the man, stamping up and down the room in -ungovernable rage. - -“Yes, sir; and no amount of swearing will scare me. Those papers are -mine and if you won’t give them up peaceably, the law will make you.” - -Suddenly the man stopped storming and became more tranquil. - -“So you’re goin’ ter law erbout it, be ye?” - -“No, I don’t think I’ll have to; I think you’ll see plain enough that -it will be best for you to give them up. By your own confession you -don’t know where the treasure is hid; _but I do_. Somehow I’m going -to find the wreck of the brig and get--whatever it was father hid. But -first, I want those papers that I may know _what_ the--the treasure -consists of.” - -“Oh, ye do? Well, how be ye goin’ ter prove that I’ve got the -docyments?” - -“Very easily indeed,” Brandon responded frankly. “I’m going to look up -the sailor who was with you on the raft. If father gave you the papers -_he_ doubtless knows it, and I don’t believe that there are _two_ men -as dishonest as you, Wetherbee.” - -“So you know where the old man has hid the stuff, hey? An’ yer goin’ -ter see th’--th’ other sailor an’ git his evidence, be ye?” - -The man’s ugly face turned a deep reddish hue and he reached out -his hands and clutched the empty chair as though he were strangling -somebody. The gesture was so terribly realistic and the man’s face so -diabolical, that Brandon involuntarily shrank back. - -“You little fool!” hissed the other slowly. “You’ve put yourself right -inter my han’s an’ let me tell ye I’m a bad man ter monkey with. I’ve -let ye hev it all your own way so fur, but now ’twill be _my_ turn, an’ -don’t you forgit it! Ye know where thet treasure is hidden aboard the -brig, hey? Then, by the great jib boom, ye’ll tell me or _ye’ll never -git out o’ here alive_!” - -As he uttered the threat he sprang upon the boy so suddenly that -Brandon was totally unprepared for the assault. His victim was no match -for his great strength, and was borne to the floor at once. - -The villain’s hand upon his throat deprived the boy of all power of -utterance, and he felt himself being slowly choked into insensibility. - -Suddenly the door between the apartment and the bar room was flung wide -open as though a small hurricane had descended upon the establishment -of the New England Hotel. Don’s villainous assailant--big and burly -though he was--was seized in a grip of iron, pulled from his victim, -and thrown bodily to the other side of the room. - -“You scoundrel!” roared Caleb (for it was he) in a voice that made the -chandelier tremble. “Would you kill the lad?” - -But Brandon, now that the pressure was removed from his throat, was -on his feet in a moment, staring curiously at the big, wooden legged -sailor. - -“Just saved you from adding murder to your other sins, did I?” -continued the mate of the Silver Swan. “Did he hurt you, lad?” - -“Guess I’m all right,” responded Brandon, feeling of his throat as his -assailant arose to his feet, scowling ferociously at the newcomer. - -“I’ll live to see you hung yet, Jim Leroyd!” Caleb declared, shaking -his huge fist at the sailor. - -“Great Scott!” exclaimed Brandon; “is _that_ his name? Why, he told me -he was Caleb Wetherbee!” - -“He did, eh? Blast his impudence! Let me tell you, lad, if Cale -Wetherbee looked like that scoundrel, he’d go drown himself for very -shame. _I’m_ Caleb Wetherbee, myself, and _you_, I reckon, are Brandon -Tarr.” - -Brandon was fairly stupefied by this announcement. - -“But what about the--the papers father put into his hands for me?” he -asked, breathlessly. - -“Your father give _him_ papers, lad? Well, I reckon not! He’s lied to -ye.” - -“Then he hasn’t them?” - -“Not he. I’ve got ’em myself, safe and sound.” - -“You have them?” repeated Brandon. - -“That I have,” replied the mate confidently, “and what’s more, I’ve got -’em right here!” - -At this juncture the door behind them opened and the red faced -barkeeper came into the room. - -“Look er-here, wot’s de meanin’ of all dis, hey?” he demanded, eying -Caleb with disfavor. - -“Oh, it’s you, is it?” said the wooden legged sailor, in disgust. “I -know _you_, Jack Brady. Get out here, you walking beer keg! I’m having -a private seance with this gentleman,” intimating the cowed Leroyd. - -A quick look of intelligence passed between Leroyd and the bartender. - -“Ye’re tryin’ ter kick up a shindy in dis place, dat’s wot ye’re at!” -declared the latter, rolling up his sleeves, belligerently. - -“Yes, and I’ll kick up a bigger row before I’m through,” Caleb replied -threateningly. “Now you run out and play, sonny, while I talk to my -friend, Mr. Leroyd, here.” - -This so angered the pugilistic looking man that he made a dash at the -big sailor; but the consequences were exceedingly unpleasant. - -Caleb’s hammer-like fist swung round with the force of a pile driver, -and an ox would have fallen before that blow. As Mr. Brady himself -would have put it, he was “knocked out in one round.” - -But the treacherous Leroyd, taking advantage of his friend’s attack on -the mate, sprang upon Caleb from the other side. This flank movement -was totally unexpected, and, weakened by his long confinement in the -hospital, the mate of the Silver Swan could not hold his own with his -former shipmate. - -Both went to the floor with a crash, and as they fell Leroyd tore open -his antagonist’s coat and seized a flat leather case from the mate’s -inside pocket. Dealing one heavy blow on the other’s upturned face, the -scoundrel sprang up and disappeared like a shot through the door at the -opposite end of the apartment. - -“Stop him!” roared Caleb, and Brandon, who had stood utterly bewildered -and helpless throughout the scene, sprang forward to the door. - -“The papers! He’s stolen the papers!” he gasped, seizing the knob and -trying to pull open the door. - -But the key had been turned in the lock and the stout door baffled all -his attempts upon it. - - - - -CHAPTER XVII - -HOW THE OMNIPRESENT WEEKS PROVES HIS RIGHT TO THE TERM - - -HAMPERED as he was by his wooden leg, it was several moments before -the old sailor could get upon his feet, and the festive Mr. Brady, -maddened and almost blinded by the blow he had received in the first of -the fracas, would have pitched into him had not Brandon threatened the -fellow with one of the heavy chairs with which the room was furnished. - -“I’ll make dis the sorriest day er your life, ye bloomin’ big brute!” -declared Mr. Brady, holding one hand to his bruised face, and shaking -the other fist at the sailor. “I’ll have ye jugged--that’s wot I’ll -do----” - -And just then he stopped, for in the doorway leading to the bar room -stood Adoniram Pepper, flushed and breathless, and behind him the burly -forms of two blue-coated policemen. - -“Thank goodness, the boy is safe!” gasped the little merchant. “Are -_you_ hurt, Caleb?” - -“Some shaken up, but that’s all, shipmate,” declared the mate of the -Silver Swan. “I got here just in time to keep that brute Leroyd from -choking the lad to death.” - -“Mercy! and where is he now?” - -“Skipped, I reckon,” responded Caleb briefly, brushing the sawdust off -his clothing. - -“But he’s stolen the papers,” said Brandon. - -“Not the papers your father gave Caleb?” cried the little man. “He must -be captured at once!” - -“Yes, he robbed me,” said Caleb slowly; “but whether he got anything o’ -much value or not is another question. Let’s get out o’ here, ’Doniram, -and take account o’ cargo.” - -Just here the policemen crowded into the room. - -“Has your man got away, sir?” one of them asked Mr. Pepper. - -“I’m afraid he has, officer--unless you want this fellow arrested, -Caleb?” indicating the saloon keeper. - -At this Brady began to storm and rave disgracefully. - -“Come, quit that, Brady!” commanded officer Mullen. “You’re deep in -this, I’ve no doubt. You want to walk a chalk line now, or I’ll have -your license taken away. D’ye understand?” - -Mr. Brady subsided at this threat, and the party filed out. - -“It’s all right now, officer,” said Adoniram, slipping something into -Mr. Mullen’s hand. “We won’t trouble you further. If anything more -comes of it, I’ll step around and see the captain myself.” - -The two policemen nodded and Mr. Pepper led his friends back to his -office. - -On the way Brandon explained his previous connection with the villain -Leroyd, and recounted what had occurred at the New England Hotel before -Caleb’s timely appearance. - -“Well, I reckon you were just what Leroyd told you--a little too -fresh,” was the comment of the mate of the Silver Swan. “’Twas only by -luck that ye warn’t garroted by that scoundrel. There’s been more than -one man gone into that dive that never come out arterwards, now I tell -ye.” - -“You are wrong, Caleb,” declared Mr. Pepper confidently “It was not -luck--’twas Providence.” - -“Mebbe you’re right, old man,” returned the mate. “Now, lad, come in -here and tell us all about yourself before we do anything further. We -want to get a thorough understanding o’ the case.” - -They had arrived at the shipping merchant’s office, but it was locked -and Mr. Pepper had to use his own private pass key. - -“Weeks has gone out,” the old gentleman explained, ushering them in. -“It’s his dinner hour.” - -“I’m glad the swab’s out of the way,” growled the sailor. “I don’t see -what you keep that prying, sneaking rascal about here for any way. -He’ll do you some damage some time, ’Doniram.” - -“I--I should dislike to discharge him,” said the old gentleman gently. -“He--he is an unfortunate fellow----” - -“Unfortunate!” snorted the mate in disgust. - -“Yes, unfortunate, Caleb. Even his face is against him. Who would want -such a looking fellow around an office? And office work is all he knows -how to do. Marks wouldn’t keep him down to the other office, so I _had_ -to take him up here.” - -“Had to!” - -Caleb stared at his old friend in pitying surprise. - -“’Doniram,” he said, “you--make--me--weary!” - -Then he shook his head sadly and dropped heavily into a chair he had -formerly occupied near the merchant’s desk. - -“Come,” he said, turning to Brandon, holding out his hand -affectionately, “come and sit down here beside me, my lad. We want to -know each other better--you and I--and I’ve got a good deal to say to -ye. - -“Your father’s last words to me was ‘Remember, Cale!’ an’ they referred -to the fac’ that he’d left me in charge o’ you--an’ of your property. -An’ I’m rememberin’, though that hospital business delayed me a good -bit.” - -“But, Caleb,” said the merchant nervously, “what will you do about -those--those diamonds,” and he looked at Brandon smilingly, “now that -that scamp has stolen the captain’s papers?” - -“Diamonds?” echoed Brandon. - -“Aye, diamonds--lashin’s of ’em!” the sailor declared earnestly. “If -yer father was ter be believed--an’ _you_ know whether or not to -believe him as well as _I_--there’s di’monds hid aboard that brig, -enough to make you a rich man, my lad.” - -“But the papers?” repeated Mr. Pepper. - -“Blast the papers!” exclaimed the sailor, slapping his thigh -impatiently. “They don’t amount to a row of pins.” - -“But they’ll tell that Leroyd all about the treasure and just where to -find it,” said Brandon. - -“And you won’t know _where_ to look for it aboard the Silver Swan,” Mr. -Pepper chimed in. - -“I won’t hey?” responded Caleb with a snort of disgust. “Sure of that, -be ye?” - -“I think I know where father would place the gems for safe keeping,” -said Brandon, slowly. - -“Yes, an’ I reckon _I_ know, too,” the mate declared. “There’s a -sliding panel in the cabin--eh, lad?” - -Brandon nodded acquiescence. - -“Yes, that’s it,” went on the sailor; “it come to me just now when I -was a-thinkin’ of the matter. We useter keep our private papers in that -’ere hole in the bulkhead. It’s the third panel on the port side front -the companionway.” - -“Sh!” exclaimed the merchant, “suppose somebody should overhear you.” - -“Oh, that sneak Weeks isn’t here,” replied Caleb carelessly. “You don’t -have anybody else working for you here who would snoop like him, do -you, ’Doniram?” - -The merchant shook his head with a mild smile. - -“Well, then,” said the mate of the Silver Swan, “we can get down to -business. We understand each other, eh, lad? Ye’ll put yourself under -our care, an’ ’Doniram an’ I’ll see you through this thing.” - -“I’m only too glad to have your help,” cried Don warmly. “Alone I can -do nothing; but with you to help me, Mr. Wetherbee----” - -“Drop that!” thundered Caleb. “Don’t you ‘mister’ me, blast yer -impudence! I’m Cale Wetherbee to _you_, as I was to yer father.” - -Then he added more mildly: - -“You can count on me, Don. And you can count on Pepperpod, here, every -time, eh?” and he nodded to the ship owner. - -“That you can, Don,” rejoined Mr. Pepper. “And already I have a vessel -I can place at your disposal. It is the whaleback steamer I spoke of -this morning. You shall have her and go in quest of the Silver Swan.” - -“A whaleback, hey?” repeated Caleb quickly, with a doubtful shake of -his head. “I don’t know much about them new fangled things.” - -“Well, you shall before long,” Mr. Pepper declared. “With her you can -beat any of these cruisers to the brig, and get the diamonds before -they blow her sky high. - -“Now, let us go out to lunch; it is long past my regular hour,” he -continued. “I will close the office for the day and you must both go -home with me. Wait, I’ll telephone to Marks.” - -“Let me git my clo’es brushed before we go up town, ’Doniram,” -exclaimed Caleb, in sudden haste. “I’ve got sawdust all over me.” - -“All right,” the merchant responded, giving the call for the wareroom -office (it was a private line); “you’ll find a whisk broom in that -wardrobe there. Don can brush you.” - -The sailor arose and walked over to the wardrobe. - -“Dem the thing! how it sticks,” he remarked impatiently, tugging at the -handle. - -Then he exerted his great strength and the door flew open with -surprising suddenness, and with it, to the startled amazement of the -entire party, came the red haired clerk, Alfred Weeks, clinging vainly -to the inner knob. - -The momentum of his exit fairly threw him across the small room, where -he dropped into a chair which happened to stand handy, gazing, the -picture of fright, at the infuriated sailor. - - - - -CHAPTER XVIII - -BRANDON LISTENS TO A SHORT FAMILY HISTORY - - -“WEEKS! Weeks! I wouldn’t have thought it of you,” exclaimed Adoniram -Pepper sorrowfully, turning away from the ’phone to gaze sternly at the -rascally clerk. - -“Wouldn’t have thought it of him?” roared Caleb. “’Doniram, you’re -a fool! It’s just exactly what you might have expected of him. Oh, -you--you swab, you!” he added, shaking his fist at the trembling -culprit. “I wish I had you aboard ship. If I wouldn’t haze you!” - -Then he sprang at the fellow, and seizing him ere he could escape, -tossed him face downward over his knee, and, while he held him with one -hand, delivered a most energetic spanking with the other huge palm, to -his squirming prisoner’s manifest discomfort. - -“Oh! oh! oh!” roared Weeks, almost black in the face. “Oh, he’s -a-murderin’ me I Let me go! Oh! oh!” - -“Stop your bawling, Alfred,” Mr. Pepper commanded, as the breathless -sailor released the scamp and placed him upright with no gentle force. - -Brandon, who had been well nigh convulsed with laughter at the mode of -punishment the clerk had received, had not thought it possible for the -jolly Adoniram to ever appear so stern as he did now. - -“Weeks,” continued the merchant, the customary smile totally eradicated -from his features, “Weeks, I have done my best for you for ten years. -I’ve helped you the best I know how. I have shielded you from those who -would have given you over to justice more than once, for your petty -crimes. Now, sir, I am through with you! - -“This offense is unpardonable. You may go down to the other office and -draw your salary to the end of the month, and never let me see you -again until you have become a respectable member of society, and shown -by your actions, not by words, that you are such. Go at once, sir!” - -Weeks hesitated an instant as though he contemplated making an appeal -to his old employer for mercy; but the look on Mr. Pepper’s face -forbade that. The old merchant was an embodiment of justice now; mercy -for the rascally clerk had flown. - -Picking up his hat, he limped silently to the door, but ere he -disappeared he turned and looked at Brandon, who, in spite of himself, -was unable to keep his face straight. He glared at the laughing youth -an instant, and then the real nature of the fellow flashed out from -beneath the veneer of apparently harmless impudence and cunning. - -His dark, old looking face flushed deeply red, his narrow eyes flashed -with sudden rage, and he shook his clenched fist at Brandon Tarr with -insane fury. - -“I’ll even things up with _you_, you young whelp!” he hissed, and in -another moment limped out of the place. - -“A nice fellow you’ve harbored, there, ’Doniram, just as I told you,” -Caleb declared. “He’ll knife you some dark night, if you’re not -careful.” - -But Adoniram only shook his head sadly and returned to the telephone. -After talking to his manager several minutes, he picked up his hat and -gloves and led the way out of the office, locking it behind him. - -“Adoniram Pepper & Co. will take a holiday today,” he said, his old -jovial smile returning. “First let us go to lunch.” - -They were all too hungry by this time to go far before attending to the -wants of the inner man; but notwithstanding that they were so far down -town, Adoniram was able to introduce them to a very comfortable looking -little chop house. He also, despite their protestations, settled the -checks himself, and then telephoned to Brandon’s hotel and to the -Marine Hospital for the luggage of both his guests to be sent to his up -town residence. - -“We’ll go up leisurely and give the baggage a chance to get there -before us,” said the merchant, as they left the restaurant; “then -Frances will know that company is coming.” - -So they saw a bit of New York for Brandon’s benefit, arriving at the -large, though plain looking house in which the merchant resided, just -before six o’clock. - -Brandon noticed, as they neared their destination, that the old sailor -seemed ill at ease, and that the conversation was being mostly carried -on by Mr. Pepper and himself. He did not understand this until they -were in the house, and the old merchant had gone to summon his sister -to meet his guests. - -Caleb seemed terribly nervous. He sat on the edge of the substantial, -upholstered chair and twisted his hat between his huge hands, his face -and neck of flaming hue, while his eyes were downcast, and he started -at every sound. - -Finally, as the merchant did not return at once, Caleb drew forth his -bandanna and blew his nose furiously. - -“This ’ere is terrible, isn’t it, lad?” he muttered hoarsely, to -Brandon, who had been eying him in great surprise. - -“What is, Caleb?” - -“This ’ere meeting ladies, ye know,” responded the mate of the Silver -Swan in a mild roar, laboring under the delusion that he was speaking -very low indeed. - -“There isn’t but one, Caleb,” replied Don encouragingly. - -“I--I know it,” said Caleb, with a groan; “but she’s--she’s th’ -spankin’est craft ever yer see! Sails allus new and fresh, riggin’ all -taut--I tell ye, lad, it allus rattles me for fear I ain’t all trim.” - -“You look first rate, Caleb,” Brandon assured him, stifling a desire to -laugh as the old seaman evidently considered the occasion so serious. -“I wouldn’t worry.” - -“That’s easy enough for _you_ to say,” returned Caleb, with another -shake of his head. “You wouldn’t be Cap’n Horace’s son if ye didn’t -find it all plain sailin’ in a city droorin’ room, same’s on th’ -ship’s deck; but with me it’s different. Oh, Lordy! she’s hove in -sight.” - -There was a rustle of silken skirts, and Brandon looked up to see Miss -Frances Pepper entering the room. - -She was short and plump like her brother, though of considerable less -weight, and she smiled like him. But otherwise Miss Pepper was rather -prim and exact in her appearance, manner, and dress. As the sailor had -said “her rigging was all taut,” and she looked as though she had just -stepped out of a bandbox. - -“My old friend. Mr. Whitherbee!” she exclaimed, holding out her hand to -Caleb with unfeigned warmth. - -“Wetherbee--Caleb Wetherbee, ma’am,” responded Caleb, in a monotone -growl, seizing the tips of the lady’s fingers as though they were as -fragile as glass, and he feared to crush them in his calloused palm. - -“Oh, yes--Mr. Wetherbee,” she replied brightly, gazing frankly into the -old seaman’s face, which naturally added materially to poor Caleb’s -confusion. “I was very sorry to hear about your illness, and am glad -you have at length been released from the hospital ward.” - -Then she turned to Brandon who had also risen. She went up to him, and -seizing both his hands imprinted a motherly kiss upon his forehead. - -The youth saw that her soft brown eyes, which could not possibly look -stern as could her brother’s gray ones, were filled with tears. - -“God bless you, my boy!” she said, in a low tone. “I knew your father, -Captain Tarr, and a very nice man he was. You are like him. - -“And now, brother,” added Miss Frances briskly, “if you will take Mr. -Wetherbee to his room to prepare for dinner, I will show Brandon to -_his_ apartment. Dinner will be ready in twenty minutes.” - -Mr. Pepper, who had entered behind his sister, bore Caleb off as she -had commanded, to a room on the lower floor, while Brandon was led up -stairs by Miss Frances. The house was nicely though plainly furnished, -evidences of comfort rather than of great wealth being apparent. - -Everywhere, on mantel and table, and in the niches of the hall, were -innumerable curiosities in the line of shells and coral brought from -all parts of the world. - -Miss Frances ushered Brandon into a very prettily furnished chamber on -the second floor--almost too daintily furnished for a boy’s room, in -fact. Innumerable bits of fancy work and the like, without doubt the -work of feminine fingers, adorned the place: yet all was fashioned in a -style of at least twenty years back. - -Above the bed, in a heavily gilded frame, was a large portrait of a -young woman--not exactly a beautiful woman, but one with a very sweet -and lovable face--which smiled down upon the visitor and attracted his -attention at once. - -Miss Frances noticed his glance, and lingered a moment at the door. - -“It was our little sister Milly,” she said softly. “This was her room -years ago. She was more than twenty years younger than Adoniram and I.” - -“Then she died?” queried Don softly, still gazing up at the smiling -face. - -“No, she married against father’s wishes. Father was a very stern, -proud man; not at all like Adoniram, who, I am afraid, is not stern -enough for his good,” and she smiled a little; but there was moisture -in her eyes as she gazed up at the portrait. - -“She was a lovely girl--at least _we_ thought so--and she was father’s -favorite, too. But she married a poor sea captain by the name of Frank, -in direct opposition to father’s command, and so he cast her off. - -“He forbade Adoniram or me having anything to do with her, or to help -her in any way, and she herself put it out of our power to do so, by -going to the other side of the world with her husband. Several years -later we heard of her death, and were told that there was a child; but -although Adoniram has done all he could he has never been able to find -this Captain Frank.” - -The old lady wiped her eyes before continuing. - -“After father died we had this room fixed just as she used to have it, -and had that picture hung there. - -“Now, Brandon, I won’t bother you longer. There is your satchel, which -the expressman brought an hour ago. If you want anything, please ring.” - -Then she departed, and left the captain’s son to make ready for dinner. - - - - -CHAPTER XIX - -TELLING A GREAT DEAL ABOUT DERELICTS IN GENERAL - - -ALTHOUGH there seemed to be everything for comfort about the Pepper -mansion, the habits of the household were most simple. Miss Frances was -evidently a woman of very domestic tastes, and had a vital interest -in all her household arrangements. Yet there appeared to be plenty of -servants about. - -When dinner was over, the merchant had a short conference with his -manager, Mr. Marks, who always came to report on matters at the close -of the day; after which he took his two guests into the library, and -the all absorbing topic of the search for the Silver Swan was broached -by Caleb, who had now regained some of his wonted confidence. - -“This ’ere delay is a bad thing,” the old sailor declared, when Miss -Frances had left them to talk the matter over. “If I hadn’t been -laid up all these weeks in the hospital, I sh’d ha’ follered up the -brig long before, and had the di’monds. Now we’ve got two--yes, -three--circumstances against us. - -“First and foremost is the fact that the Swan has already been afloat -’most two months, an’ that’s longer than the majority of derelicts -last. Then these confounded cruisers may get after her any minute, -which will be remarkably bad for our plans. And thirdly, as the -parsons say, there’s that rascal Leroyd. He’s not the man I think him -if he doesn’t make a break for the wreck at once.” - -“And he’s got the papers, too,” interjected Mr. Pepper. - -Caleb smiled at this, but said nothing in reply, continuing his remarks: - -“Now, I’ve seen a good many derelicts in my time--a good many--but if -the Silver Swan is in the shape I think her, she’s liable (setting -aside accident) to float for months. And she’s got lots of company, -too.” - -“I should think these derelicts would be dreadfully dangerous,” -suggested Brandon, with all the curiosity of a boy about anything -pertaining to sea and sea going. - -“They are,” declared Caleb; “more dangerous, it’s likely, than anybody -dreams of. Many a good ship--steamers and sailing vessels both--has -doubtless gone to Davy Jones’ Locker because of them. Take one o’ these -’ere European steamships making time across the ocean; she strikes a -derelict--a coal laden one, mebbe; they’re the most dangerous--and we -never hear of her again. - -“I’ll never forget something that happened when I was mate of the -American bark Neptune, several years ago. The Neptune were a mighty -speedy craft, an’ Cap’n Tollman was a terror for crowding on all sail. - -“We was scuddin’ along one dark night before a stiff easterly gale, -an’ I had the deck. It was just before eight bells--half past three -o’clock, mebbe--when all to onct the man on lookout gave a yell that -fairly riz my hair on end. - -“‘A wreck! dead ahead!’ he yelled. ‘Down with your helm! hard down!’ - -“I jumped to the wheel myself an’ helped the helmsman swing ’er over. -Right up before us loomed the dim, black form of a vessel--her stern -under water, an’ her bowsprit straight up. I tell ye, for about two -minutes I was dead sure ’twas all day with the old Neptune, and us -along with her. - -“However she did it I dunno, but she answered her helm quicker ’n she -did afore or since. She jest shaved the wreck, some of the cordage -fastened to the upright bowsprit catching in our spars an’ being torn -away, an’ we slipped by without any damage. But I don’t want to have a -closer shave than _that_.” - -“That was a close call, Cale,” said Mr. Pepper reflectively. “I’ve a -man in my employ--Richards his name is; he sails this trip as captain -of the Calypso--who came originally from New Brunswick. A regular -‘blue-nose’ he is, and a good sailor. - -“Well, he was one of the crew of the ‘Joggins raft’ as it was called, -that left the Bay of Fundy for New York several years ago.” - -“And a mighty foolish thing that was, too,” interrupted Caleb, shaking -his head. “It’s a merciful Providence that that thing didn’t occasion -half a dozen wrecks; but it didn’t, as far as anybody knows.” - -“Richards tells a pretty thrilling story of his experience,” the -merchant continued, seeing that Brandon was interested in the tale. -“Lumber and coal laden derelicts are considered the most dangerous, -eh, Caleb? And this Joggins raft was probably the most perilous object -that was ever set afloat. - -“The raft was composed of 27,000 great tree trunks, bound together -with chains, and it weighed something like eleven thousand tons. The -hawsers by which it was towed, parted in a hurricane, and the raft went -to pieces south of Nantasket. For a good many months the logs were -reported as scattered over a great portion of the North Atlantic. As -Caleb says, however, they did no damage, but the hydrographic charts -during the time were plentifully decorated with them.” - -“What are these hydrographic charts?” asked Brandon, with interest. -“That clipping Leroyd lost and which I found, mentioned the matter of -the Swan’s being reported to the Hydrographic Office at Washington. -What did it mean?” - -“Well,” responded Mr. Pepper, while Caleb, at the little merchant’s -request, filled and smoked his evening pipe, “when these abandoned -wrecks are sighted by incoming steamers, they are reported at once to -the Hydrographic Office at the capitol, the latitude and longitude, -name of the vessel if known, and her position in the water, being given. - -“As fast as messages of this kind are received at the office they are -posted on a big blackboard on which is inscribed an outline map of the -North Atlantic. The position of each derelict is indicated by a pin -stuck into the board, and thrust at the same time through a square -scrap of paper. - -“On this bit of paper is inscribed in red ink the name of the deserted -craft, if it is known, together with a minute picture showing the -attitude of the vessel, whether bottom up, sunken at the stern, or -what not. - -“These little pictures are reproduced on the next pilot chart (which is -a monthly publication), and changes are made in the chart as frequently -as the derelicts are reported.” - -“Seems to me, ’Doniram,” remarked Caleb, puffing away with vast content -at the pipe--“seems to me you know a good deal about this derelict -business.” - -The little man seemed strangely confused at this, and his jolly face -blushed a deep red as he shifted his position restlessly. - -“Well,” he said slowly. “I _have_ been looking it up lately. I--I had -an idea--a scheme, you know--that caused me to study the matter some. -Seems odd, too, doesn’t it, with the matter of the Silver Swan coming -right on top of it?” - -But here Brandon, whose thoughts had been wandering a little, -interrupted any further questioning on the sailor’s part. - -“I’m dreadfully sorry that that rascally Leroyd got away with the -letter father wrote me,” he said reflectively. - -Caleb looked at him with a smile, and removed his pipe from between his -lips. - -“Did I say he _had_ got away with it?” he said. - -“Eh?” interjected Adoniram, quickly. - -“What do you mean?” queried Brandon. - -“See here,” said Caleb, enjoying their surprise, “You’ve been running -this pretty much by yourselves. _I_ haven’t said that the swab got away -with the papers, have I?” - -“For pity’s sake, what _did_ he steal then?” demanded Brandon, -springing to his feet. - -“Well,” returned the mate of the Silver Swan, “by my reckoning he got -an old pocketbook with some worthless bills of lading in it and about -ten dollars in money--an’ much good may it do him.” - -“Why--why--” sputtered Mr. Pepper, staring at the smiling sailor in -amazement. - -“Now, don’t be in a hurry,” urged Caleb. “I _didn’t_ say the papers -were stolen, so don’t ye accuse me o’ that. Ye both jumped at that -conclusion and I let you think so, for as I’d made a fool of myself -once by lettin’ folks know I had ’em, I reckoned I wouldn’t do it again. - -“But now,” he added, “if ye think this is the time and place to see -them papers, I can perduce ’em ter oncet.” - -“Where are they? Let’s see ’em,” urged Brandon, in excitement. - -“All right, my lad. If you says the word, why here goes.” - -The old sailor laid his pipe down, and coolly began to unstrap his -wooden leg. The implement was an old fashioned affair, consisting of -a smoothly turned stick at the lower end hardly larger than a broom -handle, but swelling as it rose, to the semblance of a leg. - -In a moment he had it off and to the surprise of his two friends this -swelled portion of the imitation limb was hollow. From this cavity he -drew forth first a bulky wallet and then a package of papers wrapped in -oiled paper. - -“There ye be,” he declared, with satisfaction. “If _I’d_ known about -them di’monds afore we left the brig, I sh’d have had the cap’n let me -hide ’em in this ’ere timber leg. Then we’d have been saved a mighty -sight o’ bother.” - - - - -CHAPTER XX - -THE CONTENTS OF SEVERAL INTERESTING DOCUMENTS - - -“WELL, of all things!” ejaculated Mr. Pepper, as the old sailor -produced the papers from their queer repository, while Brandon burst -out laughing. - -“There’s some reasons for being grateful for even a wooden leg,” -remarked Caleb grimly. “I hid those papers there when I was aboard the -raft, and if I’d passed in my checks I reckon papers an’ all would have -gone to the sharks, for Leroyd would never have thought to look there -for ’em.” - -Then he strapped the artificial limb in place again, and gravely handed -the package to Brandon. The boy had lost all desire to laugh now, for -he was in possession of the last written words of his father, and for a -moment his hands trembled and his eyes filled with tears. - -“Open it, my lad,” said the sailor. “I haven’t touched the wrapper -since Cap’n Horace gave it to me.” - -Brandon untied the string which bound the package, and removed the -oiled paper. There were several folded documents within and one was -marked: - - “To my son, Brandon, - Horace Tarr.” - -Don quickly opened the paper, recognizing the chirography of the dead -captain at once, although much of the writing was blurred and illy -formed, showing how great a tax the effort had been for the injured and -dying man. It read as follows: - - ON BOARD THE RAFT, - TUESDAY NOON. - - MY BELOVED SON: - - We have now been on this raft two days, and I feel that my end is - drawing near, although my companions will doubtless escape. But I - have received a terrible blow on the head, and my sufferings at times - are frightful; therefore I know I am not long for this world. - - Oh, that I might see you again, my son! That I might be spared to - reach you, and to put into your hand the power to make you the - wealthy man I should have been had I lived. But no; it could not be. - Fortune has at last come to the Tarrs, but I shall not share it; your - uncle Anson was not benefited by it, and death will overtake me soon, - too. But you, my son, I pray may regain the fortune which I have - hidden aboard the brig. - - We committed a grave error in leaving the wreck; I know that now. - The hull of the Silver Swan was uninjured, and she may outlast many - gales. I shall put these papers into Caleb Wetherbee’s hands ere I - am called, and he, I know, will help you to regain the fortune which - first belonged to Anson. Be guided by him, and trust him fully. - - The letter from your uncle will explain all about the diamonds, and - how he came in possession of them. I dared not take the gems with - me from the brig, for Leroyd knew about them, or suspected their - presence, and he would have killed us all for them, I fear. - - But they are hidden in the steel lined closet--the one I showed you - in the cabin. Caleb knows where it is. Go to the reef at once and - get the jewels, before some one else gets there. There are diamonds - enough to make you fabulously rich, if Anson appraised them rightly. - - I am so weak that I cannot write longer. - - These will probably be my last words on earth to you, my son. Live - uprightly; fear God; and hold sacred your mother’s memory. God bless - you, my boy! Farewell! - Your loving father, - HORACE TARR. - -Tears fairly blinded Don’s eyes as he finished reading the missive. He -passed it to Mr. Pepper, who, in turn, passed it to Caleb. - -“He was a good man,” declared Adoniram softly, while the old sailor -blew his nose loudly, and wiped the suspicious moisture from his eyes. - -“That he were!” responded the latter. “Cap’n Horace were all that he -tells you to be, Don.” - -“Please God, I’ll be worthy of his memory,” said Brandon quietly. “If -we are fortunate enough to obtain any of this treasure he speaks of. I -hope I shall use it wisely, and as he would wish.” - -“Don’t you fear--we’ll get it, lad,” Caleb assured him earnestly. “I -feel it in my bones we will.” - -“What else was there in the package?” asked the merchant curiously. - -“There were two other papers,” Brandon replied. “One is my father’s -will.” - -He picked that up from his lap and opened it. - -“Why,” he exclaimed, “you are named as executor, Mr. Pepper.” - -He passed the legal document to Adoniram who adjusted the eye glasses -(of which a new pair had been purchased), and examined it with manifest -surprise. - -“This is a legal will, as sure as I am alive!” he exclaimed. “It was -drawn up at Rio by an American lawyer--a Mr. Bromley. Properly signed -and witnessed.” - -“Well, you’ll look out for it, won’t you?” said Caleb, who was eager to -hear the other paper--the letter from Anson Tarr to his brother--read. - -“Of course. But let me tell you its contents,” replied the merchant. -“It is short and to the point, Caleb. _You_ are given the Silver Swan, -in fee simple, and everything else goes to Brandon, here.” - -He read the paragraph which secured all the property of which Captain -Tarr had been possessed, excepting the brig, to Brandon, including -“certain uncut diamonds, roughly estimated at two hundred thousand -dollars.” - -“Two hundred thousand!” repeated Brandon, in bewilderment. - -“Quite a pile, my boy,” said Caleb. “That is, if we get ’em.” - -“And you and I, Caleb,” concluded Mr. Pepper, “are joint guardians of -Don.” - -“All right, all right,” cried the impatient sailor. “But let’s hear the -other letter, my lad. Read it out.” - -Thus urged, Brandon unfolded the third paper, and read its contents -aloud: - - “KIMBERLEY, SOUTH AFRICA, - “November the 27th, 1891. - - “BROTHER HORACE: - - “Probably you have long since believed me dead, and I have given - you good reason for that belief, for, if I am not mistaken, it was - eight years ago, after my miserable failure at the Australian gold - diggings, that I last wrote to you. - - “I intended then that you should never hear from me again. I was a - failure--a complete failure, I believed--and I determined to tempt - fortune no further. With this intention I went to an island in the - Pacific, and buried myself there, with only natives and one other - white man for company, for six years. - - “Then the old roving spirit awoke in me again, and I longed to try my - luck once more where other men were gaining wealth. The news of the - rich finds here in the diamond fields reached even our lonely isle, - and finally I could not resist the temptation longer, and came here, - leaving my companion to dwell alone among the natives. I have been - here now the better part of a year and, at last, have been successful! - - “Two months ago I struck a pocket in the hills, and out of a trench - less than two rods in length, I have dug what I believe to be at - least forty thousand pounds’ worth of diamonds of exceptional purity. - But the diggings have now petered out. - - “I kept the find a secret, and got all there was myself, excepting a - small number which my black digger ran away with, and now I am afraid - I shall not live to enjoy my riches. - - “Perhaps it is as well. You know that riches have ever taken wings - with us, and I should probably lose all in some other venture. I - hope that you, Horace, will do better with them than I, for to you, - brother, and to your boy, if he has lived, I bequeath the gems. - - “I have been very ill now several days and the physician tells me - that I am in a very bad way. Exposure to all sorts of weather in - every kind of climate, is telling on me. Therefore I do write this - to you, my brother, and take precaution to have the letter and the - package of uncut stones sent to you. - - “Nobody here knows of my find. It is safest to trust nobody in such - a place as this. I propose to give the letter and the gems, all in a - sealed packet, to a friend, who is the most trustworthy man I know, - and have him give them to you. He will believe the package to contain - nothing but papers, and therefore you will stand a good chance of - getting the diamonds safely. - - “Good by for this world, Horace. May the luck of the Tarrs be changed - with this find of mine. - - “Your brother, - “ANSON TARR.” - -“Well,” exclaimed Caleb, with a sigh, as Brandon folded the document, -“we’ve got the rights of it at last. Two hundred thousand dollars wuth -o’ di’monds--for that’s what forty thousand pounds mean, I take it, eh, -’Doniram?” - -“About that,” said the merchant. “You will be a very rich man, Don.” - -“Let’s not count our chickens too soon,” said the youth, trying to -stifle his excitement. “It seems too bewilderingly good to be true.” - -“That’s a good idea about not countin’ our chickens,” said Caleb. “But -we’ll have a whack at ’em just as soon as possible, my lad.” - -“And you’ll let me furnish the vessel,” the merchant added. - -“Let’s see,” said the old sailor. “You was saying something about -havin’ one all ready. ’Doniram, wasn’t you?” - -“One that can be ready in a week’s time, any way; and the craft you -want, too--a whaleback.” - -“I dunno,” said Caleb slowly. “I don’t fancy them new fangled things. -What under the sun did you ever get a whaleback steamer for?” - -Mr. Pepper looked at his old friend curiously, and his little eyes -twinkled. - -“Well,” he said reflectively, “oddly enough, I purchased Number Three -from the American Barge Company for the very purpose for which you wish -to use it.” - -“What?” shouted Caleb. - -“Not to go in search of the Silver Swan?” cried Brandon, in wonder. - -“No, not exactly that; but to go in quest of derelicts in general.” - -“Another of your crazy ideas, ’Doniram!” Caleb declared finally. - -“Perhaps; but I notice that most of my ‘crazy ideas’ turn out pretty -successfully, old Timbertoes,” said the little merchant jovially. “If -you’ll give me a chance, though, I’ll explain how I came to think of -_this_ ‘crazy idea.’” - - - - -CHAPTER XXI - -IN WHICH MR. PEPPER MAKES A PROPOSITION TO CALEB AND DON - - -“YOU see,” the ship owner began, as soon as he was assured of the -attention of his audience, “I have had my eye on these whaleback -steamers from the start. Three years ago, you know, nobody but Captain -Alexander MacDougall, the inventor, knew anything about them. - -“We are altogether too conservative here in the East,” continued -Adoniram warmly. “It takes the Westerners to get hold of new things, -and practically test them. These whalebacks are a Western idea and were -first used and tested on the Great Lakes. - -“You don’t seem to realize, Caleb, that the boat was never built which -could sail as easily as those whalebacks. In the heaviest gales they -only roll slightly, as a log would at sea. The waves can beat against -the curved steel sides of the craft as much as they like, or wash clean -over her; but the boat is not affected by them in the least.” - -“It’s the most wonderful thing I ever heard of,” Brandon declared. - -“They _are_ wonderful boats, as you will declare, yourself, when you -see Number Three, tomorrow,” Adoniram returned. “My whaleback is 265 -feet long, 38 feet beam, and 24 feet deep. She is warranted to carry -3,000 tons of grain on a sixteen and one half foot draft. You see, for -her size, she carries an enormous cargo, for between the collision -bulkhead forward, and the bulkhead in front of the engine room aft, the -whole inside of the craft is open for lading. - -“But my scheme--the reason I bought this vessel, in fact--is this,” -went on Mr. Pepper. - -He hesitated a moment, and looked just a little doubtfully at Caleb. - -“I presume this _is_ what you will call a ‘crazy idea,’ Caleb,” he -said. “Several months ago my attention was drawn to the fact that great -numbers of these derelicts now afloat in the Atlantic, north of the -equator, are richly laden merchant vessels on whose cargoes and hulls a -large salvage might be demanded by any vessel towing them into port. - -“Now and then, you know, it happens that somebody _does_ recover -a derelict with a valuable cargo. In these times, when the crews -of American ships, and even many of the officers, are ignorant and -untrustworthy fellows, lacking altogether the honor arm perseverance -which were characteristics of sailors forty years ago (I don’t say that -_all_ are so, but many) under these circumstances, I say, many a vessel -which might be worked safely into port, is abandoned in mid ocean by -the frightened crew. - -“With a vessel like Number Three one could recover and tow into port -many of these hulks, and net a large salvage from the owners. Vessels -which would not be worth saving themselves, might still contain -articles which it would pay to transfer to the hold of the whaleback, -before they were sunk; for it was my intention to have Number Three -destroy all the wrecks which are not worth saving. - -“I have even sounded the Washington officials in the matter of aiding -me in the work of destroying these derelicts; but I find that the -Hydrographic Office is trying to get an appropriation from Congress to -build a vessel of about 800 tons burden, especially for the work of -blowing up these wrecks. Until that matter is decided, of course I can -get no bonus on what I do. - -“Nevertheless,” Mr. Pepper continued, “I believe that there is money -enough in it to amply reward me for my outlay. Why, look at that New -England whaler which found the British ship Resolute fast in the ice of -Melville Bay in the summer of ’55. - -“She was one of three vessels sent out by the British government to -find Sir John Franklin. She was ‘nipped’ by the ice in the winter -of ’51 and was abandoned. The whaler brought her to New London, and -Congress bought her for $200,000 salvage and sent her to England. Of -course, I shouldn’t expect to get many such prizes as that,” and the -little man laughed, “but I do expect to make a handsome profit on the -venture.” - -“Take, for instance, the case of the Silver Swan. I’ll make you a -proposition, Brandon, and you see if it isn’t a fair one. Caleb shall -judge himself. I’ll send the whaleback out after the brig at my own -expense. If we are successful and find the derelict and tow her to -port, I will take the cargo (I know it to be a valuable one) for my -pains--of course, not including the diamonds, which are your own -personal property, my boy. The brig herself is Caleb’s, any way, -according to the terms of your father’s will. Now what do you say?” - -“I say it’s a good offer!” exclaimed Caleb, slapping his thigh -heartily. “You’re a man and a gentleman, Adoniram. And far from -thinking this scheme of yours crazy, I think well of it--mighty well.” - -“That’s because it ‘hits you where you live,’ as the saying is,” -returned Mr. Pepper, smiling slily. - -“Oh, I don’t know anything about whalebacks,” began Caleb. - -“But you will,” the merchant declared, interrupting him. “I haven’t got -through with my proposition yet.” - -“Fire ahead, old man,” said Caleb puffing steadily on his pipe. - -“Well, then, first I want you for the captain of the steamer, Caleb.” - -“Yes, so I supposed,” remarked the mate of the Silver Swan -imperturbably. “What else?” - -“I want Brandon for second mate.” - -“Me?” exclaimed Don. “Why, I never was aboard a steamship in my life.” - -“Oh, that doesn’t make any difference, Don,” returned Caleb -sarcastically. “It would be just like him (if he wanted to) to send the -vessel out with every blessed one of the crew landlubbers. It don’t -make a particle o’ difference.” - -“Now, Caleb,” said the merchant deprecatingly. - -“No, Adoniram, we can’t do it. The boy knows nothing at all about a -steamship, and I know but little more.” - -“You’ve been mate on a steamer, Caleb.” - -“On a dredger, you mean,” returned the old sailor, in disgust. - -“There’s no reason why you can’t do it--both of you,” the ship owner -declared. “If I’m satisfied, _you_ ought to be. I’ve already engaged -Lawrence Coffin for mate.” - -“Coffin!” ejaculated Caleb, his face lighting up, as he forgot to -pull on his pipe in his interest. “Got _him_, eh? Well, that puts a -different complexion on the matter. I could sail the Great Eastern with -Lawrence Coffin for mate.” - -“I thought so,” said Mr. Pepper, laughing gleefully. “Then I’ve got -a man by the name of Bolin for third. He’s a good man, and knows his -business, too.” - -“That would make Don’s duties pretty light,” said Caleb reflectively. - -“Of course. I shall put in rather a larger crew than a whaleback -usually carries--fourteen at least,” Mr. Pepper added; “to handle the -cargoes I shall expect the steamer to recover.” - -“Well, well,” said Caleb, rising; “let’s sleep on it. It’s never best -to decide on anything too quickly.” - -“If you’ll take up with my offer,” concluded the merchant, rising, too, -“the craft can be made ready, and you can get away this day week.” - -“Let’s think it over,” repeated the old sailor, bound not to be hurried -into the business; but Don went to bed so excited by the prospect that -it was hours before he was able to sleep. - -“Did a fellow _ever_ have a better chance for fun and adventure?” was -his last thought as he finally sank into a fitful slumber. - - - - -CHAPTER XXII - -INTO BAD COMPANY - - -IF I were to follow up my own inclinations I should much prefer to stay -in the company of Brandon Tarr and of his two good friends, the honest, -hearty old seaman, Caleb Wetherbee, and the jovial, philanthropic ship -owner, Adoniram Pepper. And I feel sure that the reader, too, would -much prefer to remain with them. - -But, for the sake of better understanding that which is to follow, I -shall be obliged for a short time to request the company of the reader -in entirely different scenes, and among rather disreputable characters. - -Mr. Alfred Weeks, who had been in receipt of so many favors in times -past from the firm of Adoniram Pepper & Co., is the first person who -will receive our attention. - -Weeks was “an effect of a cause.” He was of the slums, his ancestry -came from the slums; he was simply, by accident of education -(compulsory education, by the way) once removed from the usual “gutter -snipe” of the city streets. - -Who his parents were, he could not, for the life of him, have told. -I do not mean to suggest for an instant that Weeks was not to be -pitied; but that he was deserving of pity I deny. He had been saved -from the debasing influences of the reform school in his youth by -a philanthropic gentleman (who might have been the twin of Adoniram -Pepper), and sent to a Western State where he was clothed, fed, and -educated by a kind hearted farmer, whom he repaid by theft and by -finally running away. - -Then he went from one thing to another, and from place to place, -and you may be sure that neither his morals nor his habits improved -during the progression. Finally at twenty-five, he drifted back to the -metropolis, and quickly found his old level again--the slums. Here he -likewise discovered many of the acquaintances of his youth, for he had -been a boy of twelve when he had been sent West. - -Among these old friends he was known as “Sneaky” (a very appropriate -appellation, as we have seen), “Alfred Weeks” being the name given him -by his Western benefactor. The fellow was a most accomplished hypocrite -and it was by the exercise of this attribute that he had obtained -the situation as Adoniram Pepper’s clerk, and kept it for ten years, -despite many of his evil deeds coming to the knowledge of the shipping -merchant. - -Not one of the three persons who had been in the office that afternoon -when his presence in the wardrobe was discovered, realized how -thoroughly bad at heart Weeks was, or how dangerous an enemy they had -made. Even Caleb Wetherbee did not fully recognize it. - -But they _had_ made an enemy, and within twenty-four hours that enemy -was at work to undermine and thwart their plans. - -Weeks had overheard enough of the story of the Silver Swan and her -valuable cargo to make it an easy matter for him to decide on a line -of action which might lead to his own benefit, as well as to the -compassing of his much desired revenge. - -He solaced his wounded feelings the evening after his dismissal -from the ship owner’s office by a trip to his favorite resort--the -Bowery Theater--where he again drank in the highly colored sentences -and romantic tableaux of that great drama “The Buccaneer’s Bride.” -Unfortunately, however, he was forced to remain standing during the -play for obvious reasons; the seats of the theater were not cushioned. - -The next forenoon he adorned himself in the height of Bowery style, and -strolled down past the scene of his former labors and on toward that -rendezvous known as the New England Hotel. He had his plans already -mapped out, and the first thing to do was to join forces with Jim -Leroyd, whom he knew very well by reputation, at least, as did a great -many others among the denizens of lower New York. - -But as he strolled along Water Street he discovered something which -slightly changed his plans. Perhaps, to be exact, I should say that he -discovered _somebody_. - -On the opposite side of the thoroughfare was a weazen faced old man, -with bowed shoulders, and not altogether steady feet. He was dressed in -rusty black clothes of a pattern far remote from the present day. - -Evidently he was quite confused by his surroundings and by the crowd -which jostled him on the walk. - -“What a chance for a ‘bunco man,’” exclaimed the festive Alfred, under -his breath. “That’s country, sure enough. I wonder how it ever got -here all alone,” and the philanthropic ex-clerk crossed the street at -once and fell into the old man’s wake. - -Despite his countrified manner, however, there was an air of shrewd, -suspicious intelligence about the man of the rusty habiliments. -Fortunately for the success of his further plans, Weeks did not seek to -accost him at once. - -Had he done so he would have aroused the countryman’s suspicions. The -latter had come warned and forearmed against strangers who sought his -acquaintance. - -As they went along, the old man ahead and Weeks in the rear, the latter -discovered that the countryman was seeking for something. He went along -slowly, with his eyes fixed on the signs on either side, studying each -new one as it came in view with apparent interest. - -Finally he stopped on the corner of a cross street and looked about him -at the rushing, hurried life in perplexity. Now was Mr. Week’s chance. - -He strolled slowly along toward the old fellow, the only person without -an apparent object, in that whole multitude. - -As the ex-clerk expected, the countryman accosted him. - -“Say, mister,” he said, in his harsh, cracked voice, which rose plainly -above the noise of the street, “kin you tell me the whereabouts of the -New England Hotel?” - -“Whew!” thought Mr. Weeks. “Pretty shady locality for a respectable -farmer. Wonder what the old fellow wants _there_?” - -Then aloud he said: - -“I’m going along there myself, sir; it is several blocks yet.” - -“Wal, ’t seems ter me,” snarled the other, taking his place by the side -of Weeks, “thet this ’ere street hain’t got no end, nor no numbers ter -speak of. I looked in one o’ them things over at the hotel--a d’rectory -I b’lieve the clerk called it--but I don’t see as it helped me any.” - -“It’s pretty hard for a stranger to find his way about New York, that’s -a fact.” - -The old fellow flashed a sudden look at his companion, which was not -lost on the sly Weeks. The farmer had “read up” on “bunco men” and -their ways, and expected that the polite stranger would suggest showing -him about the city a little. - -But Weeks didn’t; he wasn’t that kind. - -Finding that the fellow seemed totally uninterested as to whether he -found his way about the metropolis or not, the countryman gained a -little confidence in his new acquaintance. - -“New York streets hain’t much like Providence streets,” he said. “Ye -_kin_ find yer way ’round them; but I defy any one ter know whether -they’re goin’ straight here, or not.” - -Mr. Weeks smiled and nodded, but let the other do most of the talking. -He went on the principle that if you give a fool rope enough he’ll -hang himself; and although the old fellow thought himself exceedingly -shrewd, and took pains to dodge the real object of his visit to New -York, in seeking to be pleasant to his new acquaintance he “gave the -whole thing dead away,” as the astute Alfred mentally expressed it. - -“Ye see,” said the old man. “I’m down here a-lookin for my nevvy, -Brandon, who’s run away from me. Nothing else would ha’ got me down -here right in the beginnin’ of the spring work.” - -Weeks started slightly, but otherwise showed no signs of special -interest; but as the old fellow ran on about the terrible state he -expected his affairs would be in because of his absence, Mr. Alfred -Weeks did some pretty tall thinking. - -“Brandon is no common name,” so the ex-clerk communed with himself. “I -bet there hasn’t been _two_ Brandons come to New York within the past -few days--both from Rhode Island, too. - -“This is the old uncle I heard the young chap mention. He’s down here -after the boy, eh? But I’m betting there’s something else behind it. -Now, let’s see; what does he want at the New England Hotel? - -“Leroyd, so young Tarr said, had been up to Rhode Island to see him.” -Weeks thought, continuing his train of reasoning. “Passed himself off -to _him_, at least, as old Wetherbee. Oh, Jim’s a keen one, he is! -Now Leroyd’s at the hotel--at least, he _has_ been. What is this old -scarecrow going there for? - -“There’s a great big rat in the toe of this stocking,” Mr. Weeks -assured himself. “This uncle is an old scamp, that’s _my_ opinion.” -(Mr. Weeks knew a scamp when he saw one--excepting when he looked in -the glass.) “I’d wager a good deal that he and Jim understand each -other pretty well. - -“Probably Jim has let the old fellow into the fact that there’s -treasure aboard that brig, hoping to get him to back him in an attempt -to find it. By the cast in the old man’s eye, I reckon he’s always on -the lookout for the almighty dollar. Now, he and Jim are going to try -and hitch horses together, I bet. And am I in this? I betcher! with -both feet!” - -With this elegant expression, Mr. Weeks drew up before the uninviting -resort known as the New England Hotel. - - - - -CHAPTER XXIII - -MR. ALFRED WEEKS AT A CERTAIN CONFERENCE - - -“HERE we are, mister,” said the ex-clerk; “see, there’s the sign--New -England Hotel. Did you expect to find your runaway nephew here?” - -“No-o,” replied old Arad Tarr, eying the place with a good deal of -disfavor. - -“See here,” said Weeks slowly, “I’ve been trying to remember -whereabouts I’ve heard that name ‘Brandon’ before. It’s not a common -name, you know.” - -“No, ’taint common. D’ye thing ye’ve seen Brandon since he’s been here -in New York? He’s only been here two days, I reckon,” said old Arad -eagerly. - -“Perhaps.” - -“Where was he?” queried the old man. “I’m his lawful guardeen, an’ I’m -a-goin’ ter hev him back, now I tell ye!” - -“Let’s see; his name is Brandon Tarr, isn’t it?” - -“That’s it; that’s it,” Arad declared. - -“And he came from Chopmist, Rhode Island?” - -“Sartin. You must have seen him, mister.” - -“I guess I have,” said Weeks reflectively. “He was the son of a Captain -Horace Tarr, lost at sea on the Silver Swan not long ago, eh?” - -“The very feller!” cried Arad, with manifest delight. - -“Then I guess I can help you find him,” declared Weeks cheerfully. -“Let’s go inside and I’ll tell you how I happened to run across him. -It’s not a very nice looking place, this isn’t; but they know me here -and it won’t be safe for them to treat any of my friends crooked.” - -The old man, who had forgotten all about bunco men and their ilk in -his anxiety to recover his nephew, followed him into the bar room. The -place was but poorly patronized at this hour of the day, and with a -nod to Brady, who, his face adorned with a most beautiful black eye, -was behind the bar, Weeks led the way to an empty table in the further -corner. - -“What’ll you an’ your friend hev ter drink?” inquired Mr. Brady, with -an atrocious grin. - -“Oh, a bottle of sarsaparilla,” responded Weeks carelessly, and when -the bull necked barkeeper had brought it, the ex-clerk paid for the -refreshment himself. - -Old Arad had looked rather scared at the appearance of the bottle. His -mind at once reverted to the stories he had read in the local paper -at home (which paper he had borrowed from a neighbor, by the way) of -countrymen being decoyed into dens in New York and treated to drugged -liquor. - -But as Weeks allowed the bottle to stand on the table between them -untouched throughout their conference, the old man felt easier in his -mind. - -“Ye say ye’ve seen Brandon?” inquired Arad, when Jack Brady had -returned to his position behind the bar, and there was nobody within -earshot. - -“Yes. I’ll tell you how it was. You see, Mr. Tarr--that’s your name, -isn’t it?--I have a position in a shipping merchant’s office as clerk. -The office is--er--closed today, so I am out. This office is that of -Adoniram Pepper & Co. Ever hear of them?” - -Old Arad shook his head negatively. - -“Pepper was a great friend of this Brandon’s father, so I understand.” - -“Mebbe,” snarled the farmer. “Cap’n Tarr’s friends warn’t _my_ friends.” - -“No? Well, your nephew steered straight for Pepper’s office, and I -believe that he’s staying at the old man’s house now--he and a man by -the name of Caleb Wetherbee.” - -“Caleb Wetherbee? Gracious Peter!” ejaculated the old man. “Hez he -found _him_ so soon.” - -Mr. Weeks nodded briefly. - -“This Wetherbee was mate of the Silver Swan.” - -“That’s the man,” muttered Arad hopelessly. - -“I take it you didn’t want your nephew and this Wetherbee to meet?” -suggested Weeks shrewdly. - -“No--o----well, I dunno. I--I’m erfraid ’twon’t be so easy to git -Brandon back ter the farm ef he’s found this mate.” - -“Perhaps we can fix it up,” said Weeks cheerfully. - -“D’ye think so?” - -“Let’s see; are you his legal guardian?” - -“Yes, I be,” declared Arad savagely; “on’y the papers ain’t made aout.” - -“I don’t really see, then, how you can bring it about until you are -appointed,” said Mr. Weeks slowly. - -“I jest kin!” asserted Arad, with confidence. “I gotter warrant here -for him.” - -“Whew!” The astute Weeks looked at the old sinner admiringly. “Well, -well! you _are_ a smart one. What’s the charge?” - -“Robbing me,” responded the old man. “The day he run away he took ’most -fifty dollars outer a--a beury droor. Dretful bad boy is that Brandon.” - -“Yes, I should think so. Well, with that warrant I should think you had -him pretty straight.” - -“D’ye think I kin find him all right?” asked Arad anxiously. - -“If you can’t, I can,” responded Weeks. “I know where to put my hand on -him.” - -At that moment a door at the rear of the room (within a few feet of the -table at which they were seated, in fact) opened, and a man entered. -Weeks recognized him at once as Jim Leroyd; he had seen him before, -although he could claim no speaking acquaintance with him. - -Old Arad also saw and recognized the newcomer, and as the sailor passed -along the room, he caught sight of the old farmer. - -“Why, dash my top lights!” he exclaimed, in surprise. “Ef here ain’t -Mr. Tarr!” - -He stepped back to the table and grasped the old man’s hand most -cordially, at the same time casting a suspicious glance at Weeks. He -knew the ex-clerk by reputation, as Weeks knew _him_. - -“Don’t ye be up ter any funny biz with this gentleman, Sneaky,” he -said, with a scowl. “He’s my friend.” - -“Don’t you fret,” responded Weeks. “He and I were talking about his -nephew, Brandon Tarr, who was up to see you yesterday----” - -Mr. Leroyd uttered a volley of choice profanity at this, and Arad was -greatly surprised. - -“Came ter see yeou?” he gasped. “Er--erbout that matter we was -a-talkin’ of, Mr. Leroyd? Ye know I--I’m his legal guardeen----” - -“Don’t ye be scared, Mr. Tarr,” said Weeks, who understood the -circumstances pretty well, “I can vouch for Jim, here, not playing you -false.” - -“What do you know about it, anyway?” growled Jim uglily. - -“Now, sit down and keep cool, Leroyd,” urged Weeks. “I know _all_ about -it. I know about your little scheme to gobble the--the _treasure_ -aboard the Silver Swan----” - -“Sh!” exclaimed Leroyd fiercely. “You know too much, young feller.” - -“No, I know just enough, and I’ll prove it to you.” - -“I s’pose ye think ye kin force yer way inter this, but ye’re mistaken. -This is the private affair o’ Mr. Tarr an’ me, an’ I warn ye ter keep -yer nose out.” - -He arose as he spoke, his fierce eyes fixed threateningly upon Weeks’ -impassive face. - -“You come with me, Mr. Tarr, where we can talk the matter over -privately. We don’t want nothin’ o’ that swab.” - -The red headed ex-clerk fairly laughed aloud at this. - -“See here, Leroyd,” he said, still coolly: “you made a break for those -papers yesterday, I believe. What did you get?” - -“Hey?” roared the sailor. - -“I said that you made a break for those papers of Cale Wetherbee’s -yesterday,” repeated Weeks, slowly and distinctly. “Now, what did you -get?” - -“Not a blamed thing,” responded the sailor frankly, after an instant’s -hesitation. - -“That’s what I thought. I thought Cale Wetherbee took it altogether too -coolly if you _had_ made a haul worth anything. Now, I could tell you -something, if I thought ’twould be worth my while.” - -“What is it?” - -“Do you know what the treasure hidden aboard the brig consists of?” - -“No,” replied Leroyd shortly, while old Arad gazed from one to the -other in bewilderment. - -“Well, I do,” declared Weeks. - -“Ye do?” - -“Sure. I heard that Wetherbee and the boy and old man Pepper talking it -over.” - -“Who’s Pepper?” growled Leroyd. - -“He’s the feller who is going to back ’em in this hunt for the brig. -He’s going to furnish the vessel and all.” - -“Curses on the luck!” growled the sailor again. - -Here old Arad interposed. The old man’s hands were trembling violently, -and his face was pale with excitement. - -“We--we must stop ’em--they ain’t got no right ter do it,” he -sputtered. “Horace Tarr was my nevvy, an’ I’m the guardeen o’ that -boy. There hain’t nobody else got no right to go arter them di’monds.” - -“Diamonds!” exclaimed Leroyd. “Is _that_ the treasure?” - -“Ye--es,” replied Arad hesitatingly, looking at Weeks. “I--I found a -letter from this Wetherbee, the mate of the Silver Swan, an’ it says -so. Horace’s brother Anson got ’em in South Afriky.” - -“Good for you, old feller,” said Leroyd admiringly. “Ye did take my -advice, didn’t ye?” - -Old Arad rubbed his hands together as though washing them with -imaginary soap, and grinned. - -“Yes, diamonds is the treasure,” Weeks rejoined calmly. “Now, you’ll -start right off to find the brig with Mr. Tarr here to back you with -money, eh, Leroyd?” - -“Never ye mind _what_ I’ll do,” returned Jim, uglily. “I tell ye this -hain’t none o’ your funeral, so you keep out of it, Sneaky.” - -“Are you sure?” asked Weeks, with a tantalizing smile. - -“Yes, I’m sure!” roared the enraged sailor. - -“Well, don’t holler so loud,” the red haired one admonished him. “But I -think you’re mistaken.” - -Leroyd glared at him like an angry bull dog but said nothing. - -“Now I s’pose,” continued Weeks, cocking his eye at the smoke begrimmed -ceiling of the bar room, “that you expect to get a vessel an’ go in -pursuit of the Silver Swan; and that when you’ve got her you’ll tow her -in port, an’ you’ll have the salvage--that’ll be a pretty good sum.” - -“And the di’monds,” interjected Arad, with an avaricious chuckle. - -“Oh, will you?” said Weeks with cool sarcasm. “That remains to be seen. -You’ll have the brig fast enough: but how’ll you get the stones?” - -“Why, ef we git the brig won’t the diamonds be aboard her?” queried -Arad. - -“Yes, they will; but _where will they be_, aboard her? Can you tell me -that?” - -Arad’s jaw fell and he stared blankly at the shrewd Weeks. Even Leroyd -was visibly moved by this statement. - -“You don’t know where the diamonds are hidden,” continued Weeks, -pursuing his advantage. “You might tear that whole brig to pieces an’ -not find ’em, _but I know just where they are and I can put my hand -right on ’em_!” - -“You kin?” gasped old Arad. - -“Is that straight, Sneaky?” demanded Leroyd, with interest. - -Weeks nodded calmly. - -“I believe you’re lying,” the sailor declared. - -“Well you can think so if you want to,” said the ex-clerk, rising, “and -I’ll go now and find somebody to go in with me on this scheme, and I’ll -run my chances of getting to the brig first. You can have the old hulk -and welcome after I’ve been aboard her five minutes, Leroyd. - -“But, if you’ll let me in on the ground floor of this,” he continued, -“and give me one third of all there is in it, why all right. If you -don’t, probably you’ll get nothing, while me and the other fellow’ll -get it _all_,” and Mr. Weeks smiled benignantly upon his audience. - - - - -CHAPTER XXIV - -HOW A NEFARIOUS COMPACT WAS FORMED - - -“BUT yeou can’t do that!” cried old Arad Tarr, the first to break -the silence after Mr. Weeks had delivered what might be termed his -“ultimatum.” “There hasn’t anybody got airy right ter go arter them -di’monds, but them I send.” - -“That is where you make an error, Mr. Tarr,” responded Weeks -cheerfully. “This is what is called ‘treasure trove;’ the fellow who -gets there first has the best right to it.” - -“It ben’t so, is it?” whined the old man, appealing to Leroyd. - -“Yes, I s’pose it is,” admitted the sailor, with a growl. “He’s got us -foul, old man.” - -“Now, don’t talk that way, Leroyd,” exclaimed Weeks briskly. “We three -must strike hands and share evenly in this thing. You need me, any way, -though I can get along without either of you; for you know it wouldn’t -take me long to find a man to back me with a couple of hundred dollars -against the chance of winning thousands.” - -“Well, you’re right,” said the sailor, seeing that it would be for his -advantage to make terms with “Sneaky Al,” as the red haired Weeks was -familiarly called. - -“Two hundred dollars is an awful lot of money ter risk,” muttered old -Arad, knowing that he was the one who would be expected to furnish the -“sinews of war.” - -“’Tain’t much compared with mebbe three hundred thousand dollars. I -heered Cap’n Tarr say, myself, that there was enough o’ them di’monds, -ter make a man fabulously rich,” responded Leroyd quickly. “That’d be a -clean hundred thousand for each of us.” - -“But ef I furnish the money I’d oughter hev more o’ th’ returns,” -declared the farmer, who was quite as sharp as either of his companions. - -“Come, we won’t quarrel over that,” the sailor declared, rising again. -“But we want to talk this matter over where it’s more quiet like. I’ve -got a room here. Let’s go up to it, where we shan’t be disturbed.” - -“Now you’re talking sense,” Weeks declared, rising gingerly from the -chair in which he had again seated himself. - -At that instant Mr. Brady, who had been kept busy at the bar by -transient customers for the past half hour, called Leroyd over to him. - -“Now, look a-here, Jim,” he said, in a hoarse aside, “wot be you -an’ Sneaky Al up to? Dere ain’t goin’ ter be no game played on dat -countryman here, see? Ye got me inter ’nough trouble yest’day. Ef I -hadn’t a pull in dis ward, dey’d er--nabbed me, sure.” - -“Don’t you fret, Jack,” responded Leroyd reassuringly. “We ain’t inter -any bunco business. The old man knows what he’s about, ef he _does_ -look like a hay-seed. Ef he don’t do _us_, it’ll be lucky.” - -“Well, what’s de game?” Brady demanded. - -“Never you mind, old man. We’re just going up stairs for a private -confab, an’ ef things turn out right, I kin promise a cool hundred for -keeping your mouth shut. Savey?” - -Brady nodded. - -“I’m mum,” he said, with satisfaction. “On’y I don’t want dem cops down -on me ag’in, so mind yer eye.” - -Armed with a bottle and glasses, Leroyd led the way into a small room -a good deal nearer the roof of the building, in which the New England -Hotel was located. His two companions, however, left the sailor to -dispose of the refreshments alone; the old farmer because he had never -used liquor in any shape at home, and Weeks because he proposed to keep -his brain perfectly clear that he might be sure to retain the “whip -hand” of the other conspirators. - -It is not my purpose to report verbatim the plans of the three -villains. Let it suffice to say that after much discussion, and by -virtue of coaxings, threatenings, promises, and what not, the sailor -and Weeks (who saw at once that it would be for their mutual advantage -to play into each other’s hands) obtained old Arad Tarr’s consent to -furnish them with the sum of over two hundred dollars (and more if it -was found to be actually needed) with which to charter the vessel. - -You may be sure that the two rascals never worked harder (with their -tongues) for two hundred dollars in their lives, for the amount looked -as large to old Arad as ten thousand would to almost any other man. - -The plot of the conspirators likewise included the discovery of -Brandon’s whereabouts and his arrest on the charge of robbery, as set -forth in the warrant with which Arad supplied himself before he left -Rhode Island. This part of the scheme Weeks proposed to attend to. - -Then, with a great deal of flourish and legal formula, the astute Mr. -Weeks drew up a most wonderful document (he was well versed in legal -phrases), which bound each of the three, Arad Tarr, James Leroyd, and -Alfred Weeks, to a co-partnership, the object of which was to seek and -obtain the floating hulk of the Silver Swan, and the treasure thereon, -the profit of the venture to be divided equally between them, excepting -the sum of one thousand dollars which was to go to Arad Tarr under -_any_ circumstances. And, of course, the document wasn’t worth the -paper on which it was written. - -But the old man didn’t know this. He was a great worshiper of the -law, and he trusted in the legality of the paper to hold his partners -to their promises. He lost sight, however, of the fact that the two -men were going together on the quest for the Silver Swan, and that -he--well, _he_ was to stay at home, and _wait_. Waiting isn’t very hard -work, to be sure; but it is terribly wearing. - -These several things having been accomplished, and it being long past -noon, the conspirators went their different ways--old Arad to interview -the brokerage firm of Bensell, Bensell & Marsden, which, he was sure, -was cheating him out of his dividends: Weeks to hunt up a scaly friend -of his to serve the warrant upon unsuspicious Brandon; and Leroyd to -look about for a vessel which could be converted to their purpose in -the shortest possible time. - -And now, let us return to Brandon and his two good friends, Caleb -Wetherbee and Adoniram Pepper, and find out how much progress _they_ -have made in the quest of the Silver Swan. - - - - -CHAPTER XXV - -UNCLE ARAD MAKES AN ANNOUNCEMENT - - -IF Caleb Wetherbee passed as sleepless a night as did his young friend, -Brandon, he showed no signs of it when he appeared the next morning. -They were a very jolly party indeed at the breakfast table, for the old -sailor had recovered, to some extent at least, his equanimity when in -the presence of Miss Frances. - -“Now, Caleb, have you decided to accept my offer of last evening?” -Adoniram inquired, as they arose after the meal. - -“Let’s see the steamer,” returned the sailor, noncommittally; so the -merchant and his two guests went down to the docks at once. - -To a person who has never seen a whaleback steamer, the first view of -one is certainly a most surprising sight. He is at once reminded of -Jules Verne’s great story of the Nautilus, the wonderful steel ship -which could sail equally well below and upon the surface of the ocean. - -Number Three was more than two hundred feet in length, and was shaped -like a huge cigar, the blunt end, oddly enough, being the bow. This -blunt “nose” is what suggested the term “pig,” as applied to the -whalebacks when first they appeared on the Great Lakes. - -At the forward end of the steamer a turret arose from the curved deck, -furnished with one of the American Ship Windlass Co.’s steam windlasses -(with the capstan above), and with hand steering gear, the shaft and -hub of the wheel being of brass to avoid affecting the compass. - -The cabin aft, which was fifteen feet above the deck, and therefore -presented a most astonishing appearance, was supported by two turrets, -and several strong ventilating pipes, the latter connecting with the -engine room, fire hold, and cargo hold. - -A low rail ran from bow to stern of the steamer, on either side, -inclosing the turrets within its shelter, thus making it possible for -the crew to go from the aft to the forward turrets. - -The deck, however, was so curved that the feat would not be easy to -perform in rough weather, if the whaleback _did_ roll as do other -vessels. - -“Ye call that a steamer, do ye?” demanded Caleb, in disgust, when he -first caught sight of Number Three; but after he had gone aboard, and -seen and understood the advantages the whaleback possessed over the -other seagoing craft, he no longer scoffed. - -Adoniram first led them to the officers’ quarters. These were finished -in oak, and furnished almost as sumptuously as the cabin of a fancy -yacht. The suite contained a dining room of comfortable size, and a -chart room and offices on the port side of the cabin. - -Below deck were the quarters of the crew, forward and aft, and they -were as comfortable as those on a palatial ocean steamship. - -“It’s a wonderful boat,” Brandon declared, as they examined the engine. - -“It is that,” the ship owner assented. “I paid a pretty penny for her, -but she’s worth it--every cent. She’ll outride any gale that ever blew, -as long as you keep her in deep water. ’Twould be hard to sink her. - -“In the matter of ballast,” he continued, “there are arrangements for -carrying eight hundred ton of water--water is used altogether for -ballast in these whalebacks. Then the engines are of the newest build, -too, you see. - -“The steam is generated from these two steel boilers, each eleven and -a half feet in diameter by the same in length, possessing a working -pressure of one hundred and twenty-five pounds. If the engine goes back -on you, you will have to get out the oars and row ashore, for there is -no chance for raising a sail,” and the jolly ship owner laughed good -naturedly. - -“Well, I’ve been to sea on a good many craft--most anything that would -float, in fact, from a torpedo boat to a Chinese junk--but this takes -the bun,” Caleb declared as they stepped upon the dock again. - -“Then I take it you’ll try your hand at this?” Adoniram asked slily. - -“Oh, yes, I s’ppose so, Pepperpod--and the boy, too. By the way, does -Lawrence Coffin know anything about this craft?” - -“He went to West Superior (where she was built) and came down in her,” -declared the merchant. - -“It’s all right, then. He’ll know what to do if we get to sea and the -blamed thing should roll over.” - -But despite the fact that he scoffed at the vessel, Caleb set to work -with his customary energy to make ready for the voyage. - -The ship owner gave him _carte blanche_ to provision the whaleback and -secure the crew. The engineers and firemen were already engaged and the -work of making ready for sea went on rapidly. - -Caleb being a worker himself, expected a good deal of everybody about -him and Brandon found himself with plenty to do during the next two -days. He ran errands, and bought provisions under the old sailor’s -directions, and saw to the storing away of the articles purchased. - -On the morning of the third day, however, came an interruption, and one -which promised to be most serious. - -In these times of hurried preparation Caleb and his young second -mate made the Water Street office of Adoniram Pepper & Co. their -headquarters. They were in and out of the place a score of times a day -to the satisfaction of Adoniram, but, if the truth were told, to the -great annoyance of the solemn faced young man whom Mr. Marks had sent -up from the other office to take the place of the departed Weeks. - -About ten o’clock on this forenoon Brandon ran in to see if he could -find Caleb, as that individual was not at the dock where lay the -whaleback, and where the boy had expected to meet him. - -“Where do you suppose he has gone?” Don asked of Mr. Pepper, who, good -soul, seemed to have no other business on hand but the getting ready of -the steamer. - -“I don’t know, I’m sure. You’d better sit down, my boy, and wait for -him,” advised Adoniram kindly. “He’s sure to turn up here, first or -last.” - -So Brandon sat down, striving to stifle his impatience. He had not -waited ten minutes, however, when the door of the outer office was -opened, and somebody entered. - -“Here he is now,” exclaimed the youth, thinking he heard Caleb’s voice. - -He threw open the door between the two offices, gave one glance into -the apartment beyond, and staggered to the nearest chair in utter -amazement. - -“Great Peter! it’s Uncle Arad!” he gasped, in answer to Adoniram’s -questioning exclamation, and the next instant Uncle Arad himself -appeared at the open portal of the private office. - -“Thar ye air, ye young reskil!” exclaimed the old man, shaking his bony -forefinger at the youth. - -Behind him was another man--a clean shaven, foxy looking fellow, who, -when old Arad had pointed the boy out, stepped quickly into the room. - -“Well, well!” exclaimed Brandon, recovering in part from his surprise. -“Who’d have thought of seeing _you_ here, Uncle Arad!” - -“Not yeou, I warrant!” cackled the old man shrilly. “I s’pose ye -thought ye c’d git off scott free with yer ill gotten gains, didn’t ye?” - -“What?” - -Brandon’s face flamed up redly, and he sprang to his feet in rage. - -“What do you mean?” he demanded. - -“Don’t ye let him escape, officer!” the farmer exclaimed, shrinking -back. “He’s quick’s a cat.” - -But here Adoniram took a hand in the proceedings. - -“I should like to know, sir, what you mean by this?” he said, his gray -eyes flashing behind the tip tilted eye glasses. “Brandon is under _my_ -care, sir, and I will not allow such remarks to be addressed to him.” - -No one would have believed that it was the jolly Adoniram, to see his -face now. The habitual smile had disappeared entirely. - -“I dunno who yeou be,” Arad replied defiantly; “but I kin tell ye who I -be, purty quick. I’m Arad Tarr; this young reskil here is my nevvy; an’ -I’m his nateral an’ lawful guardeen.” - -“Ah!” said Mr. Pepper, with quiet sarcasm. “So you are his guardian, -are you? How long since?” - -“How long since?” repeated the old man, in a rage. “I’ll show ye! I’ve -_allus_ been his guardeen--leastways, since his pa died.” - -“Which occurred a little over two months ago,” said Adoniram briefly. -“Now, Mr. Tarr, for I suppose that is your name, where are your papers -making you this lad’s guardian? Who appointed you?” - -“I’m his nateral guardeen now,” old Arad declared slowly; “but I’m -goin’ to be ’p’inted by the court.” - -“What court?” - -“The Court o’ Probate, o’ Scituate, R. I.,” responded the farmer -pompously. - -“Well, I think not,” said Adoniram, who was probably never more angry -in his life than at that moment. “You have made a slight mistake, Mr. -Tarr.” - -“Hey?” returned the farmer, growing red in the face, and looking -daggers at the little merchant. - -“I say you have made a slight mistake. You will _not_ be appointed -guardian of Brandon, by any court in the land. Did it ever occur to you -that Captain Horace Tarr might have made a will?” - -“A will?” gasped the old man. - -“Yes, sir, a will.” - -“But he didn’t hev nothin’ ter will, ’ceptin----” - -“Well, excepting what?” Mr. Pepper demanded, as the other hesitated. - -“Nothin’.” - -“Well, he _did_ have something to will, and he appointed me joint -guardian, with another gentleman, and _you_, Mr. Tarr, are _not_ the -party named to assist me. We have already made application in the New -York courts to have the appointment allowed and the will has been -presented for probate.” - -“I--I don’t believe it!” shouted Arad. - -“You’re not obliged to. But that doesn’t affect the facts of the case, -just the same.” - -For a moment the farmer was quite nonplussed: but then he looked at the -man he had brought with him again, and his faith revived. - -“Ye can’t escape me this way, ye young varmint!” he exclaimed, turning -upon Brandon as though he were some way at fault for the wrecking of -his plans. “Mebbe I hain’t your guardeen, but I’ve power ’nough right -here ter lug ye back ter Scituate an’ put yer through fur stealin’ that -money.” - -“What money?” demanded Brandon, white with rage. “To what do you refer?” - -“That fifty dollars ye stole f’om me--that’s what I mean,” old Arad -declared. “Th’ money ye stoled f’om my beury droor. I gotter warrant -right here fur ye, ’n’ this officer ter serve it!” - - - - -CHAPTER XXVI - -CALEB WETHERBEE OBSTRUCTS THE COURSE OF THE LAW - - -BRANDON was fairly paralyzed by Uncle Arad’s announcement. He had -realized that the old man was sorely disappointed at his inability to -keep him on the farm. He had not, however, believed he would follow him -clear to New York, and hatch up such a scheme as this to get him again -in his power. - -“You old scoundrel!” he exclaimed, too enraged for the moment to -remember that he was speaking to a man whose age, if not his character, -should command his respect. - -“Hush, Don,” commanded Adoniram Pepper admonishingly. “It will not -better matters to vituperate. Mr. Tarr,” he added, turning to the -farmer, “do you realize what a serious charge you have made against -your nephew?” - -“I reckon I do,” Arad declared with vigor. “I got it all down here on -er warrant--Squire Holt made it aout hisself. I’m er-goin’ ter hev that -boy arrested for burglarizing me. Now you go erhead, Mr. Officer, an’ -arrest him.” - -“Wait a moment,” and Adoniram stepped quickly in front of Don before -the foxy looking man could lay his hand upon the boy’s shoulder. - -“Let me see that warrant?” he said. - -The officer passed the paper over with a flourish, and Adoniram -examined it closely. - -“Why,” he exclaimed, shortly, “this is returnable to the Rhode Island -courts.” - -“Of course it is,” snarled old Arad. - -“But do you propose taking the boy back to Rhode Island?” - -“Yes, I do.” - -“But can’t this be settled here, officer?” asked Adoniram nervously, -knowing that any such delay as this would ruin their plans for an early -start after the Silver Swan. - -“No, sir; the robbery was committed in Rhode Island--it must be tried -there,” replied the officer, with a crafty smile. - -Adoniram handed the warrant back in utter bewilderment; but at that -juncture the door opened again, and Caleb Wetherbee himself stumped in. - -“Hey! what’s this?” the old seaman demanded, seeing instantly that -something was up. - -Old Arad tried to shrink out of sight behind the officer’s back as he -viewed Caleb’s fear inspiring proportions. - -“This is my _dear_ Uncle Arad, Caleb,” Brandon hastened to say, “and he -has come all the way from Rhode Island to arrest me and take me back.” - -“For what?” cried Caleb, aghast. - -“For robbing him; so he says. Isn’t he kind?” - -Brandon was fairly furious, but he trusted in the old seaman to get him -out of his relative’s clutches. - -“Robbing him!” - -Caleb’s face grew red with rage. - -“What d’ye mean, ye old scamp?” - -“He _hez_ robbed me,” Arad shrieked. - -“See here,” Caleb said coolly, “this looks to me like petty -persecution, don’t it to you, ’Doniram? I reckon the courts would see -it that way, too.” - -“The courts’ll send that reskil ter the State reform school--that’s -what they’ll do,” Arad declared. - -“So it’s locking him up you’re after, eh?” returned Caleb. “Now, -Brandon, don’t you worry about this. We kin have it fixed up in no -time.” - -“But the boy’s got to be taken to Rhode Island,” exclaimed Adoniram. -“It will be a matter of weeks.” - -“Weeks?” roared Caleb. “Why, the steamer sails Tuesday. He can’t go.” - -“I guess, mister, that you won’t have much to do with it,” remarked the -man with the warrant officiously. “This warrant is returnable to the -Rhode Island courts, and to Rhode Island he must go. If the boy had -wanted to go on a voyage he shouldn’t have stolen the money.” - -Caleb actually roared at this and shook his huge fist in the fellow’s -face. Adoniram hastened to keep the peace. - -“How do we know you are an officer?” he demanded sternly. “This is a -most atrocious action on Mr. Tarr’s part, and for all we know you may -be party to it.” - -The officer smiled slily, and throwing back his coat showed his badge. - -“I’m a dep’ty sheriff an’ don’t you fear,” he said. “The boy must come -along.” - -But as he reached out to clutch Don, the big sailor seized the youth -and whirled him in behind him, placing himself between the officer and -his prisoner. - -“Don’t be too fast,” he said. - -“Do you dare resist arrest?” the officer demanded angrily. - -“Nobody’s resisted you, yet.” - -His huge bulk, however, barred all approach to Don, who was now between -all the others and the outer door. - -“If you arrest this boy you’ll seriously inconvenience our plans, an’ -we’ll make you sweat for it, now I tell ye.” - -“I don’t care; I’m er--goin’ ter hev him took up!” shrieked old Arad, -to whom all this delay was agonizing. - -“You shut that trap of yours!” roared Caleb, turning upon the old man -in a fury. “Don’t ye dare open it ag’in w’ile ye’re here, or there’ll -be an assault case in court, too.” - -Old Arad dodged back out of range of the sailor’s brawny fist with -great celerity. - -“Do----don’t ye let him tetch me, officer,” he implored, jerking his -bandanna from the pocket of his shiny old black coat, and wiping his -face nervously. - -With the handkerchief came forth a letter which fell at Mr. Pepper’s -feet; but for the moment nobody but the merchant himself saw it. - -Brandon, who was directly behind the seaman, leaned forward and -whispered something in Caleb’s ear. The old seaman’s face lit up in an -instant, and he changed his position so that his burly form completely -blocked the doorway leading into the outer office. - -“So you won’t settle this thing out o’ court, eh?” he demanded. - -The officer shook his head. - -“It’s gone too far,” he said. - -“It has, hey?” Caleb exclaimed in wrath. “Well, so’ve _you_ gone too -far.” Then he exclaimed, turning to Don: “Leg it, lad! We’ll outwit the -landlubber yet.” - -“Hi! stop him! stop him!” shrieked Uncle Arad, for at the instant Caleb -had spoken, Don had darted back to the street door and thrown it open. - -“Good by, Uncle Arad!” the captain’s son cried mockingly. “I’ll see you -when I’ve returned from the West Indies.” - -He was out in a moment, and the door slammed behind him. - -The deputy sheriff sprang forward to follow, but Caleb managed to get -his wooden leg in the way, and the officer measured his length on the -office floor, while Uncle Arad, fairly wild with rage, danced up and -down, and shrieked for the police. - - - - -CHAPTER XXVII - -WHEREIN BRANDON TARR CONCEALS HIMSELF - - -THE doughty deputy sheriff was on his feet in an instant, and with a -wrathy glance at Caleb, dashed out of the office after the fleeing -Brandon. If he did not make the arrest he would fail to get his money, -and he did not propose to lose that. - -But Uncle Arad could not get to the door without passing Caleb and he -hardly dared do that. Just then the big seaman looked in no mood to be -tampered with. The farmer, however, _did_ sputter out something about -having the law on everybody in general. - -“Bring on all the law you want to, you old scarecrow,” responded Caleb, -vigorously mopping his face. “I reckon we kin take care of it. What ye -got there, Adoniram?” - -Mr. Pepper had picked up the letter which had fallen from old Arad’s -pocket, and was looking at the superscription in a puzzled manner. - -Arad caught sight of the epistle as quickly as did Caleb. - -“That’s mine! give it here!” he cried, making a snatch at the paper. - -But Adoniram held it out of his reach. - -“I don’t see how you make that out, Mr. Tarr,” he said quietly. “This -letter is not addressed to you. It is in _your_ handwriting, Caleb, -and is addressed to ‘Master Brandon Tarr, Chopmist, Rhode Island.’” - -“Oh, you swab!” exclaimed the old tar, with a withering glance of -contempt at old Arad, as he seized the letter. “This ’ere’s what I -wrote the boy w’en I was in the hospital--w’ich same he never got. Now, -how came _you_ by it? You old land shark!” - -Arad was undeniably frightened. Although he might explain the fact of -his opening Don’s letter as eminently proper, to himself, he well knew -that he could not make these friends of his nephew see it in the same -light. - -“I--I--it came arter Brandon went away,” he gasped in excuse. - -“It did, hey?” exclaimed Caleb suspiciously. - -Mr. Pepper took the envelope again and examined the postmark critically. - -“Hum--um,” he said slowly, “postmarked in New York on the third; -received on the afternoon of the fourth at the Chopmist post office. -I’m afraid, my dear sir, that that yarn won’t wash.” - -Uncle Arad was speechless, and looked from one to the other of the -stern faced men in doubt. - -“He--he was my nevvy; didn’t I hev a right ter see what he had written -ter him?” - -“You can bet ye didn’t,” Caleb declared with confidence, and with a -slight wink at Adoniram. “Let me tell ye, Mr. Tarr, that openin’ other -folks’ correspondence is actionable, as the lawyers say. I reckon that -you’ve laid yourself li’ble to gettin’ arrested yourself, old man.” - -“Ye--ye can’t do it,” sputtered Arad. - -“If that monkey of a sheriff finds Brandon (w’ich same I reckon he -won’t), we’ll see if we can’t give _you_ a taste of the same medicine.” - -The old man was undeniably frightened and edged towards the door. - -“I guess I better go,” he remarked hesitatingly. “I dunno as that -officer’ll be able ter ketch thet reskil.” - -“No, I don’t b’lieve he will myself,” Caleb declared. “And if you want -to keep your own skin whole, you’d best see that he doesn’t touch the -lad.” - -Old Arad slunk out without another word, and the two friends allowed -him to depart in contemptuous silence. - -When he had disappeared Adoniram turned to the sailor at once. - -“Where has Don gone, Caleb?” he asked anxiously. - -“You’ve got me. He told me he was goin’ to skip, and for us to go ahead -with the preparations for getting off next week, just the same. He’d -lay low till the old scamp had given it up, and then slip aboard the -steamer. Oh, the boy’s all right.” - -“He is, if that sheriff doesn’t find him,” said the merchant doubtfully. - -“I’ll risk that,” responded Caleb, who had vast confidence in Brandon’s -ability to take care of himself. - -But Adoniram shook his head. - -“New York is a bad place for a boy to be alone in. Where will he go?” - -“Down to the pier, I reckon, and hide aboard the steamer. I’ll agree to -put him away there so that no measly faced sheriff like _that_ fellow -can find him.” - -“It’s a bad business,” declared Mr. Pepper, shaking his head slowly. -“If he hadn’t run off there might have been some way of fixing it up so -that he wouldn’t have had to go back to Rhode Island, and thus delay -the sailing of the steamer. We might have scared the uncle out of -prosecuting him. He was badly frightened as it was.” - -Caleb gazed at his friend for several moments with a quizzical smile -upon his face. - -“Do you know, Adoniram,” he said at length, “I b’lieve you’re too -innocent for this wicked world.” - -“How do you mean?” asked the merchant, flushing a little, yet smiling. - -“Well, you don’t seem to see anything fishy in all this.” - -“Fishy?” - -“Yes, fishy,” returned Caleb, sitting down and speaking confidentially. -“Several things make me believe that you (and me, too) haven’t been -half awake in this business.” - -“I certainly do not understand you,” declared Adoniram. - -“Well, give me a chance to explain, will you?” said the sailor -impatiently. “You seem to think that this old land shark of an uncle of -the boy’s is just trying to get him back on the farm, and has hatched -up this robbery business for that purpose? I don’t suppose you think -Don stole any money from him, do you?” he added. - -“Not for an instant!” the merchant replied emphatically. - -“That’s what I thought. Well, as I say, you suppose he wants Brandon -back on the farm--wants his work, in fact?” - -“Ye--es.” - -“Well, did it ever strike you, ’Doniram,” Caleb pursued, with a smile -of superiority on his face--“did it ever strike you that if he was -successful in proving Brandon guilty, the boy would be locked up and -then _nobody_ would get his valuable services--nobody except the State?” - -“Why, that’s so.” - -“Of course it’s so.” - -“Then, what is his object in persecuting the poor lad? Is he doing it -just out of spite?” - -“Now, see here; does that look reasonable? Do you think for a moment -that an old codger like him--stingy as they make ’em--d’ye think he’d -go ter the expense o’ comin ’way down here to New York out of revenge -simply? Well, I guess not!” - -“Then, what is he up to?” demanded Adoniram, in bewilderment. - -“Well, of that _I’m_ not sure, of course; but,” said Caleb, with -vehemence, “I’m willing to risk my hull advance that he’s onter this -di’mond business. - -“Why, Pepper, how could he help being? Didn’t he get that letter of -mine, an’ didn’t I give the hull thing away in it, like the blamed -idiot I was? Man alive, a sharper like that feller would sell his -immortal soul for a silver dollar. What _wouldn’t_ he for a big stake -like this?” - -“But--” began Adoniram. - -“Hold on a minute and let me finish,” urged Caleb. “That scoundrel -Leroyd was up to Chopmist, mind ye. Who knows but what he an’ old Arad -Tarr have hitched hosses and gone inter this together? I haven’t told -either you or Brandon, for I didn’t want to worry you, but I learned -yesterday that Jim is tryin’ ter charter a craft of some kind--you an’ -I know what for. - -“He’s got no money; what rascal of a sailor ever has? He must have -backing, then. And who is more likely to be the backer than the old -sharper who’s just gone out of here! I tell ye, ’Doniram, _they’re -after them di’monds_, and it behooves us ter git up an’ dust if we want -ter beat ’em.” - -The ship owner shook his head unconvinced. - -“You may be right, of course, Caleb; I don’t say it is an -impossibility. But it strikes me that your conclusions are rather far -fetched. They are not reasonable.” - -“Well, we’ll see,” responded the old seaman, pursing up his lips. “I -shall miss Brandon’s help--a handier lad I never see--but he will have -to lay low till after the whaleback sails.” - -He went back to the work of getting the steamer ready for departure, -expecting every hour that Brandon would appear. But the captain’s son -did not show up that day, nor the next. - -Monday came and Number Three was all ready for sailing. Her crew of -twenty men, beside the officers, were aboard. - -The first and third mates were likewise present, the former, Mr. -Coffin, being a tall, shrewd looking, pleasant faced man, who eternally -chewed on the end of a cigar (except when eating or sleeping) although -he was never seen to light one; and Mr. Bolin, the third, a keen, -alert little man who looked hardly older than Brandon himself. - -But Brandon did not come. The new captain of the whaleback, and the -owner himself, were greatly worried by the boy’s continued absence. - -They had already set on foot inquiry for the youth’s whereabouts, but -nothing had come of it. - -They did discover that Uncle Arad had gone back to Rhode Island, and -gone back alone. The “scaly” ward politician who held the onerous -position of deputy sheriff, and who had sought to arrest the boy, had -not been successful, Brandon’s friends knew, for the man haunted the -pier at which the whaleback lay, day and night. - -“If he don’t come tonight, Adoniram,” Caleb declared, “we shall sail -in the morning, just the same--and that by the first streak of light, -too. _You_ will be here, and I can trust you to look out for the lad. -_I_ must be away after those di’monds. Don’ll turn up all right, I know -right well; and we mustn’t let them swabs get ahead of us, and reach -the brig first.” - -He had taken the precaution ere this to have his own and Brandon’s -effects brought down to the boat. He was ready, in fact, to cast off -and steam away from the dock at a moment’s notice. - -As the evening approached Caleb ordered the fires built under the -boilers, and everything to be made ready for instant departure. -Adoniram Pepper came down after dinner and remained in the whaleback’s -cabin, hoping to see Brandon once again before the steamer sailed. - -Caleb was too anxious to keep still at all, but tramped back and -forth, occasionally making trips to the wheelman’s turret in which he -had stationed Mr. Coffin and one of the sailors, so as to have no delay -in starting, no matter what should happen. - -“By Jove, this beats blockade running at Savannah in the sixties,” -muttered the first mate, after one of his commander’s anxious trips to -the forward turret to see that all was right. “This youngster they’re -taking all this trouble for must be a most remarkable boy.” - -“There’s two fellows watching the steamer from the wharf,” Caleb -declared, entering the cabin again. - -Just then there was a sound outside, and a heavy knock sounded at the -cabin door. Caleb pulled it open in an instant. - -Without stood three burly police officers. - -“Well, well!” exclaimed Mr. Pepper, in wonder. - -“What do _you_ want?” Caleb demanded, inclined to be a little combative. - -“Beg pardon, sir,” said the spokesman of the two, nodding respectfully -to Mr. Pepper, “but we’ve been sent to search the steamer for a boy -against whom this man holds a warrant,” and the officer motioned to a -third individual who stood without. It was the deputy sheriff. - -“Very well,” said Mr. Pepper quietly. - -“Search and be hanged,” growled Caleb, glowering at the man with the -warrant. “If you can find him you’ll have better luck than we.” - -He refused to assist them in any way, however, and Mr. Bolin politely -showed the party over the whole steamer. But of course, they found not -a sign of Brandon. - -After nearly an hour’s search the officers gave it up and departed, -Caleb hurling after them several sarcastic remarks about their -supposed intellectual accomplishments--or rather, their lack of such -accomplishments. - -The deputy sheriff, whose name was Snaggs, by the way, would not give -it up, however, but still remained on the wharf. - -Mr. Coffin, who had begun to take a lively interest in the proceedings, -was pacing the inclined deck of the whaleback on the side furtherest -from the pier, a few minutes past midnight (everybody on board was -still awake at even this late hour) when his ear caught the sound of a -gentle splash in the black waters just below him. - -He stopped instantly and leaned over the rail. - -“Hist!” whispered a voice out of the darkness. “Toss me a rope. I want -to come aboard.” - -Mr. Coffin was not a man to show his emotions, and therefore, without a -word, he dropped the end of a bit of cable into the water, just where -he could see the faint outlines of the owner of the voice. - -Hidden by the wheelhouse from the view of anybody who might be on the -wharf, he assisted the person aboard, and in a minute the mysterious -visitor stood upon the iron plates at Mr. Coffin’s side. - - - - -CHAPTER XXVIII - -THE DEPARTURE OF THE WHALEBACK, NUMBER THREE - - -NO emergency was ever too great for Lawrence Coffin. The appearance of -the stranger whom he had lifted over the rail to the steamer’s deck may -have surprised him; but he gave no visible sign. - -The instant the fellow was on his feet, Mr. Coffin slid open the door -of the wheelhouse and pushed the newcomer in. - -“Jackson,” he said sharply, to the man inside, “go for Captain -Wetherbee.” - -Then he turned to the dripping figure that stood just within the door -of the turret. - -The stranger was a youth of fifteen or sixteen, with a sharp, -intelligent face, and his saturated clothing was little more than rags. - -“Hullo!” said the mate, “_you’re_ not Brandon Tarr, I take it.” - -“You kin bet on that, mister,” responded the youth grinning. “An’ you, -I reckon, ain’t Cale Wetherbee. He’s got a wooden leg.” - -“I’ve sent for Mr. Wetherbee,” replied Mr. Coffin. “What do you want?” - -“I’ll tell th’ boss, wot I was told ter see,” declared the fellow -shrewdly. - -The youth was evidently of that great class of individuals known as -“street gamins” who, in New York City, are numbered by the thousand. - -He was thin and muscular, quick in his movements, and his eyes were -shifty and uneasy, not from any lack of frankness or honesty, perhaps, -but because his mode of life forced him to be ever on the watch for -what might “happen next.” - -Mr. Coffin had hardly made this mental inventory of the fellow, when -Caleb, accompanied by Mr. Pepper, came forward. The strange youth -evidently recognized the captain of the whaleback at once as the -individual he wished to see. - -“You’re Captain Wetherbee,” he said quickly fumbling in the inside of -his coarse flannel shirt (the shirt and trousers were all he had on) “I -got somethin’ fur you from Brandon Tarr.” - -“Where is he?” cried Mr. Pepper, in great excitement. - -“He’s gone to sea, boss,” responded the boy calmly. - -“Hey!” roared Caleb, and then the messenger brought forth that which he -was fumbling for--a little waterproof matchbox. - -“Gone to sea?” repeated Adoniram, in bewilderment. - -“Dat’s it,” said the boy. “He went day ’fore yest’day mornin’ in de -Success.” - -But Caleb had opened the matchbox and drawn forth the folded paper it -contained. - -“It’s a letter--the young rascal! Why didn’t he come himself?” - -“Didn’t I tell ye he’d gone ter sea?” demanded the youth in disgust. - -“Listen to this,” exclaimed Caleb, paying not the least attention to -the messenger’s words, and he read the closely written page aloud: - - “DEAR CALEB--Swivel is going to make a break with this letter for me, - although the Success sails, we understand, in an hour or two. He can - tell you how I came aboard here, so I won’t stop to do that. - - “What I want to say is, that Leroyd is aboard and that the brig will - touch at Savannah for Mr. Pepper’s old clerk, Mr. Weeks, who is in - the plot to find the Silver Swan, too. I shall leave her at Savannah - if it is a possibility. - - “If you get into Savannah while she is there, however, and I don’t - appear, try to find some way of getting me out. I’m afraid of - Leroyd--or, that is, I should be if he knew I was here. - - “I’ve got enough to eat and drink to last me a long time and am - comfortable. I can make another raid on the pantry, too, if I run - short. - - “Look out for Swivel; he’s a good fellow. He can tell you all that I - would like to, if space and time did not forbid. - - “Yours sincerely, - “BRANDON TARR. - - “P. S. We’ll beat these scamps and get the Silver Swan yet.” - -“Well, well!” commented Mr. Pepper, in amazement. “What will that boy -do next?” - -“The young rascal!” Caleb exclaimed in vexation. “What does he mean by -cutting up such didoes as this? Aboard the very vessel the scoundrels -have chartered, hey?” - -“But how did he get there?” cried Adoniram wonderingly. - -“This young man ought to be able to tell that,” suggested Mr. Coffin, -referring to the dripping youth. - -Caleb looked from the open letter to the boy. - -“So you’re Swivel, eh?” he demanded. - -The lad grinned and nodded. - -“Well, suppose you explain this mystery.” - -But here Adoniram interposed. - -“Let us take him to the cabin, and give him something dry to put on. -He’ll catch his death of cold here.” - -“’Nough said. Come on,” said Caleb leading the way. - -Fifteen minutes later the youth who rejoiced in the name of Swivel was -inside of warm and dry garments, several sizes too large for him, and -was telling his story to a most appreciative audience. - -I will not give it in detail, and in Swivel’s bad grammar; a less -rambling account will suffice. - -When Brandon Tarr had made his rapid retreat from the office of -Adoniram Pepper and Co. he had run across the street, dodged around the -first corner, and then walked hastily up town. He determined to keep -away from the office for the remainder of the day, hoping to tire out -both Uncle Arad and the deputy sheriff. - -Finally he took a car and rode over to Brooklyn, and it was there that -he fell in with Swivel, who was a veritable street gamin--a “wharf-rat” -even--though a good hearted and not an altogether bad principled one. - -It being a time in the day when there were no papers to sell, Swivel -(wherever the boy got the name he didn’t know, and it would have been -hard to trace its origin) was blacking boots, and while he shined -Brandon’s the two boys scraped up an acquaintance. - -Fearing that Uncle Arad or the officer, or perhaps both, would be on -the watch about the shipping merchant’s office, or the steamer dock, -Brandon decided that Swivel would be a good one to have along with him -to send ahead as “scout,” and for a small sum the gamin agreed. - -Brandon was a country boy, and was unfamiliar with city ways or -city conveniences. It never crossed his mind to use the telephone -communicating with his friends, and Swivel knew very little about -telephones, any way. - -So they waited until toward evening and then came back to New York. - -Water Street and its vicinity, and the docks, were as familiar to -Swivel as were the lanes and woods of Chopmist to Brandon. By devious -ways the gamin led the captain’s son to the ship owner’s office, but it -was quite dark by that time and the place was closed. - -So they went to the pier at which the whaleback lay, and here Swivel -showed that he was of great use to Brandon, for had it not been for -him, his employer would have run straight into a trap. The deputy -sheriff, Snaggs, was watching the steamer, and no less a person than -Mr. Alfred Weeks himself, was talking with him. - -By careful maneuvering the two boys got into a position from which they -could hear some of the conversation of the two rascals; but the way to -the steamer was right under Snaggs’ eye, and Brandon dared not attempt -it. - -By intently listening, the captain’s son heard several important items -of news, and, greatly to his astonishment, discovered that Uncle Arad, -Leroyd, and Mr. Weeks himself were playing right into each other’s -hands, and that their object was to keep Brandon from getting back to -his friends, and thus delay the sailing of the whaleback so that the -craft on which the plotters expected to sail might get away first. - -Snaggs was to keep a sharp lookout from the shoreward side of the -whaleback and there was already a man in a boat patroling the riverside -that Brandon might not return from that direction, and a third person -was “shadowing” Adoniram Pepper’s residence. The ship owner’s office -would be watched during the day. - -As soon as Brandon made his appearance he was to be seized at once on -the strength of the Rhode Island warrant and sent back to Chopmist. -This, the conspirators hoped, would keep Caleb Wetherbee from sailing -for several weeks, and by that time Leroyd and the ex-clerk expected -to overhaul the Silver Swan--that is, this is what Weeks and Leroyd -themselves were planning to do; but the former took care to say nothing -about the Silver Swan to the deputy sheriff. - -Finding that there was no chance to get aboard the whaleback just then, -and having heard Weeks say that he was going to meet Leroyd and that -they two were to go that night and see the vessel and her commander, -Brandon decided to follow them, and find out the name of the craft and -where she lay, believing that the information would be of value to -himself and to his friends. - -Piloted by Swivel, Brandon followed “Sneaky Al” to the New England -Hotel and while the ex-clerk went inside for Leroyd the two boys waited -without, and then took up the trail again when the two conspirators -appeared. - -The sailor and Weeks went over to Brooklyn and after two hours’ dodging -and running and hiding, they tracked the rascals to the brig Success, -lying at a Brooklyn wharf. - -Brandon decided that it would never do to be so near and not hear the -plans the villains made with the captain of the Success, so he rashly -crept aboard and listened to the conversation at the cabin skylight. -And this was when he got into trouble. - -He heard the two plotters agree with the captain of the vessel (who was -not in the scheme at all) to pay two hundred dollars for six week’s use -of the brig, providing the Success put to sea at once. - -She already had a very fair cargo for Savannah, and the agreement was -that she should put in at that port for the time necessary for the -cargo to be landed. - -Thus, of course, the captain, who was the owner as well, was going to -make a very good thing out of it, indeed. He asked no questions as to -what use the brig was to be put to; and he agreed to allow Leroyd to -accompany him to Savannah, where Weeks would meet them. - -Brandon made a shrewd guess that the ex-clerk was to remain in New York -until he was certain of _his_ capture and incarceration; then he would -reach Savannah by steamer. - -It was quite evident that the two rascals had managed to “boil” more -money out of old Arad Tarr than they had first expected, and could -afford to be more lavish with their funds. - -But, as I said, the boys, by venturing aboard the Success, got into -trouble. Somebody came aft while they were listening to the conference -below, and to escape discovery, they dodged down the after hatch. - -The crew of the Success were already aboard, and the two men who -constituted the “anchor watch” remained near the open hatchway (the -other hatches were battened down), and the two boys were unable to -leave the hold. - -Morning came, and found them still there. The cargo was nearly all in, -and the crew went to work to finish the lading by daylight. Brandon and -Swivel retreated into the bows of the vessel, and managed to remain -hidden all day. - -They did not dare leave the hold, although they suffered extremely from -lack of food and water, for Leroyd had come aboard to superintend the -work, and would have seen them. - -At evening the hatches were battened down, and the unintentional -stowaways were left in darkness. But Swivel, who a shrewd and sharp -eyed lad, had noticed a small door in the cabin bulkhead by which the -cook doubtless entered the hold for provisions from time to time. - -With their pocket knives they forced the fastenings of this door and -Swivel made a raid into the pantry, which was left unguarded, and -returned laden with provisions enough to last them a week if need be. -He secured a big “beaker” of water, too. - -Brandon also discovered the ship’s provisions stored near the bows, and -was sure that he could stand a siege. - -Leroyd, they ascertained, hardly ever left the cabin or deck of the -Success, and Brandon dared not venture out. At last, after talking the -whole matter over, Swivel agreed to take the risk of giving himself up -as a stowaway, and thus get put ashore before the brig started. - -Then he was to make his way to the whaleback and explain Brandon’s -situation to Caleb. - -The captain’s son wrote his letter and placed it in the matchbox, which -Swivel in turn had hidden in the breast of his shirt. Then the gamin -pounded on the hatch until the crew heard him and let him out. - -Naturally the captain of the Success was angry enough, for the brig -was already to sail, and they were getting the lines cast off, so he -summoned a night watchman from the dock, who took the unlucky Swivel in -charge and handed him over to a policeman. - -This was a phase of the situation which neither of the boys had -considered. But there was no way out of it, and the gamin spent the day -in the police station, for it was Sunday. - -He was brought before the magistrate the next morning, but of course -there was nobody to appear against him, so he was discharged with a -reprimand. The police captain, however, kept him busy about the station -until late in the afternoon, before he would let him go. - -“He kep’ me jugglin’ wid er mop er wipin’ up de floor,” as the gamin -expressed it to his hearers. - -As soon as he was free he had hurried to the New York side; but upon -reaching the vicinity of the whaleback he discovered that the “patrol -line” was drawn even closer than before. - -Snaggs and two of his friends were on duty, for as the time approached -for the sailing, they decided that if Brandon came back he would do so -very soon. - -Swivel had seen the raid the policemen made under the deputy’s -instigation, and after the bluecoats were safely out of the way, he had -slipped into the water and made for the steamer. - -“An’ here I is,” he said, in conclusion. “Dey didn’t ketch me, nor dat -Brandon Tarr, nuther. We’s too fly for ’em.” - -“Of all the scrapes I ever heard of, this is the worst,” Adoniram -exclaimed in comment. - -But Caleb, now that his fears for Don’s safety were somewhat allayed, -seemed rather to enjoy the situation. - -“Oh, that boy’s smart,” he declared, with a chuckle. “I’ll risk him -even if he is in that vessel’s hold. Leroyd won’t get the best of -_him_. Probably, too, the captain of the Success is not a bad sort of a -fellow, an’ he won’t see the boy maltreated. - -“I feel better, ’Doniram, and with your permission we’ll get under way -at once.” - -“But what shall we do with this lad?” asked the little merchant, -nodding and smiling at Swivel. “He’s deserving of much praise for his -honesty and faithfulness.” - -“Oh, take me along, will yer?” exclaimed the gamin, with eagerness. -“I’ll work _hard_ ef ye will! I jest wanter see dis thing out, I do! I -like dat Brandon Tarr, an’ I wanter see him git the di’monts wot he -said was on dat wreck yer arter. Say, lemme go, will yer?” - -Caleb looked at the ship owner in perplexity. - -“Oh, take him, Caleb,” said Adoniram quickly. “It may be the making of -the lad to get him off the city streets. He deserves it.” - -“So be it then,” said Caleb, rising. “Now, Mr. Coffin and Mr. Bolin--to -work! You’ll have to go ashore at once, Adoniram. I shall have Number -Three out of her berth in half an hour.” - -Steam was got up, the crew flew about their several duties under -the energetic commands of the officers, and within a short time the -whaleback, to the manifest disappointment of Mr. Snaggs, who watched -proceedings from the shadow of the wharf, cast off her lines and -steamed down the bay into the darkness of the night. - -Thus did she begin the voyage whose object was the finding of the wreck -of the Silver Swan. - - - - -CHAPTER XXIX - -THE STOWAWAY ABOARD THE SUCCESS - - -AS we know, Brandon Tarr had no intention of remaining long away from -his friends when he slipped out of Adoniram Pepper’s office to escape -arrest on the fraudulent charge of robbery, concocted by Uncle Arad. - -The events which followed, however, made it necessary for him to remain -away, and, finally, to go to sea as a stowaway in the hold of the -Success, the vessel chartered by the conspirators to make search for -the Silver Swan. - -After the friendly street gamin, Swivel, left him in the hold, in -the early hours of Sunday morning, Brandon of course had no means of -knowing what had become of him--whether he had accomplished his purpose -of getting away from the brig before she sailed, or whether, because -she was short handed, the captain of the Success had retained him. - -After Swivel was let up on deck, and the hatch closed, however, Brandon -heard nothing further, except the heavy tramping of the sailors, -the creaking of the ropes, and the hoarse roars of command from the -officers. - -The work of getting the Success away from the dock went rapidly on. - -Quite fortunately for the stowaway, the hold of the Success was little -more than two thirds filled with Savannah goods. In the bows, beside a -great many bags and boxes and barrels of provisions for the use of the -crew, there were likewise spare sails, cordage, etc. - -It would be a very easy matter indeed for him to hide among the stuff -if any one came into the hold. - -The scent of bilge water was not at all strong, for the Success was a -comparatively new vessel and had evidently been recently pumped out. - -Brandon judged her to be about the size of the Silver Swan, much the -same sort of craft in fact, and, like his father’s vessel, the Success -was a “tramp.” - -It was night--or at least a gloomy twilight--at all times in the hold; -but Brandon thought that it was surely daylight by the time the brig -was under way. - -She was taken down the river by a fussy little steam tug and then, -meeting the swells of the Atlantic, and a brisk gale springing up, she -shook out her sails and dropped the tug astern. - -Brandon was fearful that he might be sick, for he had never really been -to sea and the brig pitched not a little in the waves of the ocean. - -To reduce the possibility of this misfortune to a minimum, he ate but -sparingly the first day or two out, and by that time all “squeamish” -feelings passed away. - -It was dreadfully dull in the dark hold, however. Of food and water he -had a sufficiency, although the latter was warm and brackish; but there -was absolutely nothing for him to do to pass away the time. There was -not even the spice of danger about his situation, for nobody came into -the hold. - -He dared not explore much at first, for he was afraid that he might be -heard from the cabin or forecastle. - -During a slight blow which came up the fourth day, however, while the -spars and cordage were creaking so that all other sounds were drowned, -he felt perfectly safe in moving about. If he could not hear what went -on outside, nobody outside would be likely to hear him. - -On this day, however, he received several tumbles, for the ship -occasionally pitched so suddenly that he was carried completely off his -feet. Nothing worse happened to him, though, than the barking of his -elbows and knees. - -Gaining confidence in his ability to get around without being -discovered, he changed his position more frequently after this. The -weather remained fair for some time following this small blow, and -Brandon hung about the cabin bulkhead, striving to hear more of -Leroyd’s plans, if possible. - -It was plain that the captain of the brig knew nothing of the real -plans of the conspirators. They had told him what they pleased, and he -was to ask no questions. - -It was not long, however, before the stowaway discovered something -which was quite a surprise to him. There was a woman on board the brig; -he heard the rustle of her garments, and occasionally the tones of a -female voice. - -At first he thought her to be the captain’s wife, but because of the -youthfulness of her tones and some words which the captain addressed to -her, he changed this opinion, and decided that she was his daughter. - -Brandon was quite interested in her, for a girl on a sailing vessel -was certainly a novelty. He was sure she must be a “jolly one,” as he -expressed it, to sail with her father on a merchantman. Not many girls -would have the pluck to do that. - -As the days passed by, and the Success fled on before the favoring -gales, drawing nearer and nearer to Savannah, Brandon became -correspondingly worried over the obstructions to a safe escape from the -brig, which were presented to his mind. - -Once the brig reached port and the hatches were opened, it would be -“all day” with him. Nothing but a miracle would save him from falling -into the hands of Jim Leroyd, and he didn’t like to think of that. - -He had good reason to believe that the rascally sailor would not -hesitate to injure him in any way possible. - -Naturally his mind reverted to the trap in the cabin bulkhead by which -Swivel had gained access to the cook’s galley, as a possible means of -escape before the hatches were removed. If the brig reached Savannah -late in the day, doubtless the hatches would remain battened down till -the next morning. In that case the trap might be his salvation. - -Several times during the voyage the steward, sometimes with a seaman -with him, entered the hold by this door, for something among the -stores. At such times Brandon “laid low” and his presence was not -discovered. - -What little food he had purloined from the stores was not noticed -either. - -Therefore, as the brig drew nearer to her destination Brandon set about -studying the topography of the cabin--its entrances and exits--and how -he could best pass through it and reach the deck without attracting the -attention of anybody on board. - -All this scouting had to be done at night, of course, and many were his -narrow escapes while engaged in this most perilous undertaking. - -“Nothing ventured, nothing gained,” was the motto of the Tarrs, father -and son. In Captain Tarr’s case, and in that of his brother Anson, it -had been, as a usual thing, a good deal of _venture_ and little _gain_. - -The same motive, however, was predominant in Brandon’s nature, and he -took many risks in thus scouting about the brig’s cabin that almost any -other boy would not have taken. - -One night he had cautiously set the narrow door leading into the -steward’s pantry ajar, and sat just under it in the darkness of the -hold, trying to discover if all but the officers, excepting the one in -command of the watch, had turned in. - -There was a light in the outer cabin, but he could not see into the -room from where he sat, and he dared not enter the pantry until he -was sure that the cabin was unoccupied. Occasionally a sound of low -conversation would reach his ears from the deck, but otherwise all was -still. - -[Illustration: “I’M A STOWAWAY. I’VE BEEN IN THE HOLD SINCE WE LEFT NEW -YORK.”] - -“I believe I’ll risk it,” he declared, after remaining in a -listening attitude for nearly half an hour. “I need water badly--my -throat is well nigh parched--and if I could learn whether the lamp was -usually left turned up like that, whether the cabin was empty or _not_, -I might know better how to act when I do try to escape.” - -Finally he crawled through the opening and crept softly to the cabin -door. The apartment was empty--or it appeared to be--although there -was a chair drawn up to the table, and some books lay there as though -having been in recent use. - -“Guess I’d better not stay,” thought the stowaway nervously. “But I -must have a drink.” - -He turned back into the cook’s galley, and took a deep draught from a -bucket he found there. Just as he was about to leave the place he was -electrified by hearing a voice say, - -“What are _you_ doing here?” - -Brandon wheeled about like a flash. There framed by the cabin doorway -was a young girl--the girl whose voice he had heard more than once -since his incarceration in the hold of the Success--the captain’s -daughter! - -“Who are you? What do you want!” she repeated, eying him fearlessly, -though with a puzzled expression of countenance. “I never remember -having seen _you_ before.” - -Brandon was suddenly conscious that his long captivity in the vessel’s -hold had not improved his personal appearance, and with his feeling of -fright at being discovered, there was also considerable vexation at -being seen in such a plight by a lady. - -The girl was bright looking and intelligent, with a face which -attracted the boy greatly; in fact, he was almost tempted to believe -that he had seen her somewhere, so familiar did she appear. - -Dressed in a simple blue flannel yachting suit, trimmed with white -braid, which set off her plump figure to great advantage, she was a -pleasing picture. - -“Why don’t you answer me?” she demanded in vexation, as Brandon -continued silent. - -“Sh! don’t give me away,” begged the boy, taking a step nearer. “I’m a -stowaway, I’ve been in the hold ever since we left New York.” - -“Another stowaway!” she exclaimed, but in a lower tone. “Why father -found one just before we left port.” - -“I know it,” returned Brandon. “He was with me. What did they do with -him?” - -“Father gave him into the hands of the police,” replied the girl -gravely. “He’s very hard on stowaways. Why did you get into the hold?” - -“Because I _had_ to; yes, I did--actually had to,” declared Brandon, in -a whisper. “I can’t tell you the whole story now; but I will some time. -I haven’t done anything wrong--excepting taking a few provisions from -the ship’s stores. Those I will pay you for now,” and he took his purse -from the pocket of his stained and ragged coat. - -“No, no!” cried the girl, drawing back, “I do not want your money.” - -“Then I shall leave it, as I first intended, on the cabin table when we -get to Savannah.” - -“But the men will find you when we get in, even if I _don’t_ tell -father.” - -“I hope not,” Brandon replied, so earnestly that the captain’s daughter -looked at him curiously. - -“Is there anybody aboard whom you fear?” she asked shrewdly. - -“Yes, there is. It is that evil looking man--the one who has chartered -the brig--Jim Leroyd.” - -“He!” she exclaimed, in surprise. Then after a little silence she added: - -“He _is_ an evil looking man; I’ve told father so more than once, -but he says that a man is not always as bad as he looks. Father has -seen so many people and so much of the world, that I seldom question -his judgment; but I have been impressed from the first that there -was something wrong about him--and about that Mr. Weeks, who is in -partnership with him, and whom we expect to meet at Savannah. - -“It is a strange thing--this searching for a derelict brig--any way. I -tell father that there is something wrong back of it.” - -“There _is_,” Brandon declared. “I don’t dare tell you about it now. -You won’t let anybody know I’m here, will you?” - -“No--o, I’ll promise that. It wasn’t right to stow yourself away aboard -the brig, but you look honest--although you _are_ awfully dirty and -ragged,” said this most plain spoken young lady. - -“I know it; I look terribly,” whispered Don, creeping through the door -into the hold again. Then he turned about and asked, “What is your -name, please?” - -“Milly Frank.” - -“Thank you; and mine is Brandon Tarr. Some time I can explain all this -to you, and you will see that I did the only thing I could in stowing -myself away here.” - -“But how do you expect to get out?” - -“I hope we’ll get to port in the night. If we do, then I’ll try to slip -out through the cabin.” - -“Somebody will catch you.” - -“I hope not.” - -“We-ell, I _hope_, not, too,” said Miss Milly frankly. “I don’t suppose -it is just right, but I’ll try to help you. If I see a chance for you -to get away I’ll come to this door and knock--see, like this.” - -She knocked twice in succession, but lightly, so that nobody might hear -her but the stowaway. - -“Thank you--thank you!” murmured the boy, and then he shut the trap -quickly, for a heavy step sounded from the cabin without. - -Somebody had come down from the deck--probably the officer of the -watch. - - - - -CHAPTER XXX - -SHOWING WHAT MISS MILLY DOES FOR BRANDON - - -BRANDON crept away from the trap in the bulkhead, fearing that at -any moment the person who had entered the outer cabin during his -conversation with the captain’s daughter, might strive to capture him. -He was afraid that the person had heard his movements in descending -into the cargo hold again; but if the newcomer _did_ hear anything, -Milly evidently convinced him that there was nothing unusual going on, -for Brandon was not disturbed. - -Then ensued for the stowaway a period of anxious waiting. The very fact -that some hope of successful escape had been held out to him, made the -waiting all the harder to bear. - -Each hour was bringing the Success nearer to Savannah, and Brandon -remained near the bulkhead all the time, so as to miss no communication -from his fair assistant. - -Miss Milly seemed to really enjoy her secret knowledge of the -stowaway’s presence, and before the Success reached port she several -times called him to the bulkhead, ostensibly for the purpose of finding -out if he was all right, and was not going hungry. She supplied him -with water, too, these last two or three days, and he no longer had to -leave the hold on midnight foraging expeditions. - -“We shall be in this evening--perhaps before dark--so father told me -last night,” she whispered to him one morning, and Brandon’s heart -leaped for joy at the information. - -Slowly, indeed, did that day pass. - -The Success was beating up toward Savannah against a light head wind, -which gave promise of becoming an off shore gale before it was through -with. Fortunately, the brig escaped it, taking a tug about the middle -of the afternoon, and pulling into her dock about dark. - -“Thank Heaven!” was Brandon’s mental ejaculation, when this information -was whispered through the crack in the bulkhead door to him, and he was -indeed devoutly grateful. - -His life in the hold from the time of departure from New York, had been -a continual fever of impatience and doubt, and now that the real danger -of attempting to escape was at hand, he was rejoiced. In a short time -he would know whether he was to be free, or in Jim Leroyd’s power. - -Milly had informed him that Captain Frank was exceedingly hard on all -stowaways (as sea captains usually are, in fact), and he had no doubt -but that he would be placed in a very uncomfortable, if not dangerous, -position if the doughty captain should discover him. - -Leroyd, of course, would step forward at once and declare that he -(Brandon) was wanted in New York for robbery, and that fact could be -proved by telegraphing, should the Savannah officers desire to do so. -Then, if the whaleback steamer was not in, he should be absolutely -friendless, and at the mercy of the vindictive sailor. - -He lay close up against the door of the bulkhead all through the early -evening. Some of the crew, he judged by what he heard, were allowed -to go ashore for a few hours, and a part of the officers went with -them--which officers, however, he could not tell. - -There was both a first and second mate on the Success. - -Brandon had no means of telling the time, but it must have been well -along towards ten o’clock--perhaps later--when he heard the two gentle -raps for which he had been so anxiously listening. - -“Are you there, Brandon?” whispered the captain’s daughter, and as -Don pulled the door slightly ajar, she seized his hand, and aided him -through the opening. - -“Is the coast clear?” he asked anxiously. - -“Sh! Yes, father and Mr. Marsh have gone up town with some of the men, -and Mr. Barry has finally gone to bed.” (Mr. Barry was the second -officer.) “I was afraid that he’d never stop talking to me. I had to -fairly _freeze_ him out,” and the merry girl laughed softly. - -“But Leroyd?” pursued Brandon. - -“He’s gone, too.” - -“To bed?” - -“No; up the street. I hope you can get off the brig before any of them -get back. Now hurry.” - -“You’re a good girl, Miss Milly. I hope I shall be able to repay you -some time.” - -“Hush! go along now,” she said, smiling, but pushing him toward the -companionway. “What’s that for?” for Brandon had thrust a little wad of -bank notes into her hand. - -“It is to pay for the stores I broke into below. Take it, and put it -where your father will see it. Good by.” - -He started up the ladder, but came back again to ask, - -“Is there a steamer in the bay? Did you get in time enough to see?” - -“Lots of them.” - -“No, I should have said a whaleback steamer?” - -“What are those--oh, I know what you mean. A great long, steel boat, -with cabins way up above the hull, and no deck to speak of.” - -“That’s it,” said Brandon eagerly. - -“Yes, there _is_ one here. I saw it and meant to ask father what it -was. I thought it was a dredger of some kind,” and Milly laughed again -gleefully. “Is that a steamer?” - -“Yes. My friends are aboard her.” - -“Then you will find them,” she returned delightedly. “That funny boat -lies not far from our dock. Now go, or somebody will catch you.” - -Brandon crept noiselessly up the steps at this command, and peered out -across the deck. A sailor sat on the rail some rods away, but his back -was towards him; nobody else was in sight. - -“Now’s my chance,” muttered Don, and springing quickly up the -remaining steps, he darted as noiselessly as a shadow across the deck, -and leaped upon the pier. An instant later he was on the street, and -slinking along in the shadow of the buildings, hurried away from the -vicinity. - -He did not know in which direction the “funny boat” Milly had seen, -lay, but went blindly along, his only care for the moment being to -escape from the neighborhood of the Success and from his enemy, Jim -Leroyd. - -The street he followed kept close to the wharves--skirted the -waterfront in fact--and he passed many sailors; but he kept in the -shadow as much as possible and nobody remarked about his apparel or the -grime on his face and hands. - -Suddenly, as he approached a great pier, where several large vessels -were lying, he caught sight of a familiar figure coming down the street -toward him. There was no mistaking that rolling, peculiar gait, nor -the sound of the sharp “tap, tap” of the steel shod leg on the wooden -pavement. - -It was Caleb Wetherbee! - -“Oh, Cale!” Brandon almost shouted, and running forward fairly threw -himself into the sailor’s arms. - -“By the jumping Jehosophat!” cried the startled Caleb, and then, -recognizing the boy, despite his rags and dirt, he uttered a loud -“hurrah!” which left no doubt in Brandon’s mind as to the sailor’s -satisfaction at seeing him once more. - -But in a moment, he pushed the boy away from him and holding him by -both shoulders, peered down upon him curiously. - -“Well, well!” he exclaimed. “Where in the name o’ Davy Jones have you -been? Ye look as though you’d been stowed away in the hold o’ a coal -barge for a month.” - -“Well, I _have_ been stowed away in a brig’s hold--she got in only this -evening. I’ve just got away from her. Did you get my note by Swivel?” - -“I did, my lad.” - -“And Swivel himself?” - -“He’s aboard the steamer.” - -“I’m glad of that,” declared Brandon. “I hoped you’d be kind to him. He -did me a lot of favors, and I shan’t be able to repay him for some time -to come. Now, have you heard anything further from the Silver Swan?” - -“I have, my lad, this very afternoon. She was sighted two weeks ago by -a steamship from Rio to New York. Adoniram telegraphed me. But there’s -something else that ain’t so pleasin’.” - -“What’s that, Caleb?” - -“The Kearsarge has been ordered to destroy several of these derelicts, -the Silver Swan included, on her way down the coast to Havana. She -sails tomorrow, I hear.” - -“Then we haven’t any time to lose,” Brandon exclaimed. “Let’s go aboard -at once, Cale. The first thing I want is a wash--I’m as dirty as a -pig--and then I’ll tell you the whole story.” - -“We’ll do so right now,” declared the big captain. “Come on. My boat’s -down here. Number Three lays off some way.” - -He hurried Brandon down to the dock, and they were quickly seated in -the steamer’s small boat, and the men pulled out to the long, low, odd -looking craft, which, since her arrival in the bay three days before, -had attracted an enormous amount of attention. - -“She sails like a swan, Don,” declared Caleb, who, from openly scoffing -at the whaleback, had begun fairly to worship her. “I never see -anything beat it. She can outsail any cruiser in the navy, I believe, -an’ if we don’t reach the Silver Swan in her first, it’s because -somethin’ busts!” with which forcible declaration he helped the boy -over the low rail to the iron deck of the steamer. - - - - -CHAPTER XXXI - -WHEREIN NUMBER THREE APPROACHES THE SUPPOSED VICINITY OF THE SILVER SWAN - - -“WE’LL be off at once,” Caleb Wetherbee declared, as soon as he had -stepped upon the deck of the whaleback. “Go up to the cabin, Don, and -tell the steward to fix you out with a bath and some clean clothes. You -know which stateroom yours is.” - -Gladly did Brandon avail himself of this opportunity, and while Caleb -was personally seeing to the matter of getting under way, he indulged -in the luxury of a bath and a full change of clothing. - -Before he was presentable again, Number Three had steam up (the fires -had only been banked), and was moving slowly away from Savannah. - -“Quick connections on this trip, eh, lad?” Caleb said, rubbing his -hands gleefully, as he entered the cabin and found Brandon “clothed and -in his right mind” again, as the youth himself expressed it. “Three -hours ago you were in the hold of the brig, wasn’t you? Now, let’s hear -your yarn.” - -Brandon complied with his request, giving fullest details of his -incarceration in the hold of the Success. - -“That ’ere is a mighty plucky girl,” was Caleb’s admiring comment when -the tale was finished. “What d’ye say her name was?” - -“Milly Frank; the cap’n is her father, and he owns the brig himself.” - -“Frank--Frank,” repeated Caleb slowly. “That has a familiar sound.” - -“It has to me, too,” said Brandon slowly. “I’ve been trying to think, -ever since I met the girl, where I had heard her name and seen her -face, too, for both seem familiar.” - -“I have it!” suddenly exclaimed Caleb, smiting his thigh. - -“Well?” - -“Frank was the name of the chap as Adoniram’s sister married--the -little one, ye know.” - -“You’re right. And her name was Milly, too,” Brandon rejoined eagerly. -“Bet you this was a daughter of hers. I thought her face looked -familiar, and now I think of it, it was because she looked so much like -the face of Milly Pepper--her picture hung in the room they gave me at -Mr. Pepper’s.” - -“’Twould tickle ’Doniram ’most to death to know he had a niece,” Caleb -said. - -“And Miss Frances, too. As soon as we find the Silver Swan we must look -up the Success.... And that reminds me, Caleb. You say you’ve heard of -the wreck again?” - -The captain of the whaleback drew a telegram from his pocket and passed -it over to his young second officer. - -“That’s from ’Doniram. As I said, I got it this afternoon.” - -This was the message: - - Rio steamship Creole Prince arrived this a. m., reports Silver Swan - as being sighted March 23rd, latitude 27:18, longitude 68:30. - -“Still moving northeast, isn’t she?” Brandon said, handing back the -yellow slip. - -“In course.” - -“And what was that you told me about the Kearsarge?” - -“Here’s the evening paper,” responded Caleb, handing over a folded -sheet. “There’s the item,” and he pointed with his stumpy forefinger to -a marked passage which read as follows: - - The Department has ordered the Kearsarge to leave the Chesapeake - tomorrow on her trip to the West Indies. Her commander has received - special orders to destroy several of the most dangerous derelicts - which are at present infesting the coast below Hatteras, and - especially off the Bermudas. The hull of the Hattie Marvin, floating - bottom upwards north of Bermuda, and that of the Silver Swan, south - of the same islands, both of which have been frequently reported of - late and are exceedingly dangerous, will have the early attention of - the midshipmen, who consider the excitement of blowing up derelicts a - boon indeed. - -“We have a good start of her,” Brandon declared with satisfaction. “It -will be because we’re not smart if we can’t find the Silver Swan first.” - -“Right, lad. An’ we _will_ find her, too,” said Caleb hopefully. - -“And about Swivel,” went on Don, changing the subject; “where is he?” - -“He’s below with the men. Smart lad, he is, an’ I reckon we’ll make -quite a man of him yet.” - -“I must do something for him--if I get those diamonds,” Brandon added. -“Now, Captain Wetherbee, with your permission I’ll turn in and get some -sleep, for I haven’t slept decently for a week, I was so worried.” - -At sunrise the whaleback had left the mouth of the Savannah river, and -the shores were low down on the horizon behind them. At sunset, when -Brandon finally arose from a long slumber, the steamer was alone on a -vast extent of heaving, restless sea. The land had entirely disappeared. - -Brandon took up his duties of second officer with enthusiasm. He had -everything to learn--or about everything--but the work was right along -the line of his strongest taste. He loved it, and therefore went about -it earnestly, and learned rapidly. - -Messrs. Coffin and Bolin assisted him in every way possible, for they -were greatly attracted to the boy. Of course, Caleb was ever his -faithful mentor and teacher, and Brandon soon fell into the ways and -duties of the ship, and accredited himself very well, indeed. - -The swift steamer kept on her southeasterly course for several days -without incident of importance. No derelicts were sighted, and but few -vessels. - -Brandon was told, however, that coming down from New York the whaleback -had sighted two wrecks, but the captain dared not delay to investigate -them until the principal object of the voyage was accomplished. Caleb -determined to let all other derelicts but the Silver Swan severely -alone. - -The whaleback passed the Bermudas low down on the sea line, and being -well supplied with fuel kept on toward that portion of the ocean where -the hull of the Silver Swan was supposed to be making her objectless -voyage. - -A sharp lookout was kept day and night, but it was not until after the -Bermudas had faded from sight that anything other than passing sailing -vessels and steamers were sighted. At night the whaleback ran very -slowly, indeed, so that naught might escape her, but during the day she -traveled at a high rate of speed. - -Just before sunrise one morning Brandon was aroused by a commotion on -deck. He leaped from his berth at once, and having been to sea long -enough now to know how to dress quickly, was outside in less than a -minute. Then he made out what the lookout on the top of the forward -turret was shouting: - -“Wreck--dead ahead, sir!” - - - - -CHAPTER XXXII - -RELATING HOW THE SILVER SWAN WAS HEARD FROM - - -AS the sun rose and lit up the sea more fully Brandon could plainly -view the wreck which the steamer was now rapidly approaching. - -It was not, he believed at first glance, the Silver Swan. It was the -hull of a vessel, sunk a good deal at the stern; but one mast was -standing, and a great tangle of cordage and torn sails was still -attached to it. - -“That’s never the Silver Swan, lad,” Caleb declared. “She was swept as -clean as a whistle. This was a square rigged vessel, however.” - -The steamer ran in very close to the wreck, and Brandon made out the -words, “Porpoise, New Haven,” under the bows. - -The derelict gave every appearance of being what Mr. Coffin called “an -old stager,” and labored in the seas most heavily. - -“That’s a mighty dangerous wreck,” Caleb declared reflectively, as -the whaleback steamed slowly by. “It wouldn’t take long to sink her, -although ’twould cost something. What d’ye say, Mr. Coffin--will you go -aboard her, and if she isn’t worth towing in, drop enough dynamite into -her hold to blow her up? You know how to run that battery Mr. Pepper -had put aboard.” - -“Aye, aye, sir,” the first officer replied, and bustled away to order a -boat launched at once. - -By special request Brandon was allowed to accompany the expedition. The -old hulk was found to be in ballast, and Mr. Coffin therefore placed a -quantity of the powerful explosive in her hold, attached the wire, and -they pulled back toward the steamer. - -When the small boat was out of danger the officer touched the button -and an instant later the still morning air was shattered by a terrific -roar. - -The wreck seemed almost to rise from the sea, a great volume of fire -and smoke issued from her amidships, and she broke in two, the water -rushing in and filling the interior with a sound like the echo of the -explosion. - -Slowly the derelict settled, her stern going first, until the very -tip of the tottering mast disappeared below the surface. Only a few -splintered deck timbers, which would soon follow the ship to the -bottom, remained to show where the hulk had disappeared. - -“Good job, that,” Caleb declared, when the boat had returned to the -steamer, “though it cost us three hours’ time. That hulk had been -floating for nearly a year, according to the pilot charts.” - -The second day after the blowing up of the derelict Porpoise, a -steamship was sighted by the whaleback. It was the City of Havana, of -the James E. Ward line, and, by running in close, Caleb was able to -hold converse with the ship’s captain. - -To the satisfaction of the captain of Number Three, the City of -Havana’s commander could, and did, give him some information about the -derelict brig of which they were in search. - -The steamship had sighted the Silver Swan in latitude 28, longitude -69:13, and reported the vessel in a remarkable state of preservation. -The spring storms had not appeared to damage her much. - -This news was hailed joyfully by Caleb and Brandon, and the course of -the whaleback was changed a little more to the east. - -The weather, however, which had been all that they could wish thus -far since leaving Savannah, began to get nasty. The sea became short -and choppy, though without apparently affecting the sailing of the -whaleback, and the sky looked bad. - -Finally, after a day or two of this, a dead calm occurred, and Caleb -shook his head sagely. - -“We’re goin’ to ketch it,” he declared, “an’ we’ll have a chance to -find out how the steamer rides in a gale, whether we want to or not.” - -And he was right. While the whaleback steamed slowly ahead, a heavy -swell came on, although there was not a breath of air stirring. The sea -heaved and rolled, seemingly in throes of agony. - -At first the cause was entirely submarine. At length, however, there -was a groaning, moaning sound, which gradually increased in volume, -until, with a sudden roar, the hurricane swooped down upon them. The -waves were tossed toward the wind driven, leaden clouds with awful -fury, breaking like surf over the whaleback; but the steamer withstood -the fearful shocks as easily as she had the choppy waves which -preceded the gale. - -She kept but little headway, however, and as the black night shut -down about the craft, Brandon realized fully the terrible risks and -hazardous chances taken by “those who go down to the sea in ships.” - -For two days the gale continued, but with less fury than signaled its -first appearance. Number Three might have put back into Bermuda, but -she acted so well that Caleb decided to stay outside and thus lose no -possible opportunity of sighting the Silver Swan. - -Brandon had never contemplated what a storm at sea meant before and he -was thankful indeed that he was not upon a sailing vessel. - -During the first of the gale they had sighted several vessels, with -close reefed sails, scudding before the wind, but all were riding the -sea well. - -Late in the afternoon of the second day, however, the lookout, who was -lashed to the top of the wheelhouse, reported a wreck ahead. - -At first Caleb and Brandon, who were both armed with glasses, could not -make it out clearly enough to decide what it was. - -Finally the old seaman declared with conviction. - -“It’s the hull of a vessel an’ her masts have been carried away sure.” - -“Do you think it is the brig, Caleb?” the young second mate asked -eagerly. - -“Ye got me there. It _may_ be, and then ag’in it may not. We’ll run -down an’ see.” - -The storm was by no means abating and Caleb dared not run very close to -the wreck. - -As they approached it, however, the former mate of the Silver Swan -became convinced that it was not the wreck they sought. He was familiar -with every line of Captain Horace Tarr’s vessel and this, he declared, -was not it. - -Suddenly Swivel’s sharp eyes caught sight of something which the others -had not seen. - -“There’s something tied to that stump of a mast, sir,” he exclaimed, -pointing toward the forward part of the wreck. “It’s a flag o’ some -kind.” - -“It’s a signal!” Mr. Coffin declared. “There’s some poor soul on the -wreck. See--there he is.” - -At the instant he spoke they all descried a moving figure on the -derelict--some one, who, clinging with one hand to the cordage which -still hung to the mast, with the other waved a signal frantically at -the approaching steamer. - -“Great Heavens!” exclaimed Mr. Coffin, strongly moved by the scene. -“What shall we do? No mortal man can help him in this gale.” - -“We must do something,” Caleb replied. - -“A boat couldn’t live in this sea, sir,” said the first officer -despairingly. - -“We must try to throw him a line.” - -But upon trial it was found that it would be exceedingly hazardous to -run down near enough to the wreck for that. The hull was rolling so -frightfully that it might turn completely over at any moment and carry -the steamer to the bottom with it should they run in too near. - - - - -CHAPTER XXXIII - -IN WHICH COMRADES IN COURAGE LAUNCH THEMSELVES UPON THE DEEP - - -BRANDON’S glass had been turned upon the figure on the wreck for the -few moments during which the others had been discussing the possibility -of saving the poor creature. Now he exclaimed hurriedly. - -“That’s not a man--it’s a woman! Don’t you see her skirts blowing in -the gale? She is alone on the wreck.” - -Caleb seized his own glass again, and Mr. Bolin dived into the cabin -for his. - -“You’re right, lad,” the captain declared. “Either all the men have -been swept overboard, or the white livered rascals have taken to the -boats and abandoned her.” - -But Brandon was making other discoveries. As the steamer cut through -the huge waves, approaching nearer and nearer to the wreck, something -about the outlines of the female figure seemed familiar to him. - -He knew the face which was turned pleadingly toward the steamer--the -powerful glass revealed every feature clearly. - -It was Milly Frank! - -At the instant of Brandon’s discovery, the steamer gave a sudden roll, -and he was thrown partially from his balance and his glass wavered an -instant from the girl’s face. - -In that instant the stern of the fated vessel came within range of his -vision and he plainly saw the word “Success” painted in tarnished gold -lettering upon it. - -“Caleb! Caleb!” he cried, forgetting for the moment to apply the proper -term of respect to the captain which, according to the quarter deck -etiquette, he should have done, “that’s the Success, and the _girl_ is -the captain’s daughter!” - -“Oh, it can’t be, lad!” cried the old man, unwilling to believe such a -fact possible. - -“It is the Success--I see her name,” Mr. Bolin declared. - -“Poor little girl! poor little girl!” exclaimed the honest old sailor -brokenly. “We can’t stand here and see her perish.” - -“I shan’t,” Brandon affirmed, passing his own glass to Mr. Coffin. - -“What can you do, lad?” queried Caleb. “The gale’s not abating a mite.” - -“All that we can do I see, sir, is to stand by till the sea goes down, -and then, God willing, take her off,” said Mr. Coffin. - -“Why, that old hulk may sink at any moment!” cried Brandon. “I won’t -stay idle and see that girl drown after all she has done for me.” - -“An’ it’s Adoniram’s niece--no doubt of it,” murmured Caleb. - -“That is another reason why we should try to save her. I haven’t -forgotten all that Mr. Pepper has done for me,” declared Brandon -decidedly. - -“But, lad, lad, what can we do?” gasped the captain. “It’s not a living -possibility to send a boat to that brig, and I dare not risk the lives -of all these men in my care by running in near enough for a cable to be -thrown.” - -“And the girl probably couldn’t fasten it, if we did,” added Mr. Bolin. - -“Then we must do something else. Run by her, Caleb, and I’ll carry a -rope to the brig.” - -“You’re crazy!” cried Mr. Coffin. - -“Maybe I am,” Brandon returned, his face white and set; “but I shall do -it.” - -Swivel, who was clinging to a guard rope within hearing, struck in with -him. - -“Lemme do it, Brandon--I mean Mr. Tarr. I kin swim like a fish.” - -“Nobody shall go but myself,” the boy declared, with emphasis. “I won’t -suggest a perilous undertaking and not be the one to carry it out.” - -“Cap’n Tarr right over again,” Caleb muttered. - -Then he turned suddenly upon his young second officer. - -“Kick off your shoes, lad, and try it. If it’s the Lord’s will that you -accomplish it, well and good; if you can’t, we’ll haul you back. Quick, -now! I’ll order Mike to go ahead full speed.” - -Before the words were scarcely out of the captain’s mouth, Brandon had -kicked off his light shoes. - -Swivel, who could not be taught strict quarter deck manners, followed -the young officer’s example. - -“What are you about, you young limb o’ Satan?” demanded Mr. Coffin, -catching hint at this. - -“Ef he goes, I’m goin’ an’ you ain’t goin’ ter stop me, Mr. Coffin,” -announced the gamin. “I’m in dis!” - -“Behave yourself,” Brandon commanded, quickly knotting a light, strong -cable about his waist, while Mr. Bolin fastened a life preserver -beneath his arms. “One is enough.” - -“Den I’m de one!” the boy declared vehemently, and dodging Mr. Coffin’s -outstretched arm, he seized a second coil of rope, one end of which was -fastened to a ring in the deck, and ran to the stern of the steamer. - -“Come back here!” roared the first mate angrily. “I’ll rope’s end you, -you little scamp!” - -“You’ll have ter do it when I get back from dat wreck!” returned the -boy, with an impish grin, and the steamer having now forged ahead of -the laboring brig, and Brandon being all ready, the fearless Swivel -also dropped over the rail, and clinging with one hand a moment, let go -simultaneously with his friend and patron. - -Brandon tried to send him back, but it was too late then. The first -wave seized them in its embrace and they were carried far out from the -steamer’s stern. - -The cork belt kept the young second mate above the waves, but even with -this assistance, he found himself much less able to cope with the heavy -seas than was his companion. - -Swivel dived through the rollers like a gull, keeping faithfully by -his friend’s side; and had it not been for the street gamin, Brandon -afterward declared that he should never have reached the wreck alive. - -He had no idea how furious the waves were until he was among them, -battling for his life, and trying to reach the distant brig. - -It was a terrific struggle, lasting perhaps not five minutes, but a few -more seconds would have completely exhausted him. - -A great wave suddenly swept them directly under the brig’s bows. Swivel -seized Brandon’s hand with one of his own and with the other grabbed a -rope trailing over the rail of the wreck. - -Fortunately the other end of the rope was securely fastened, and with -an almost superhuman effort Swivel raised Brandon until the second mate -of the whaleback could grasp the rail. - -In another moment Brandon was aboard the brig, and had pulled Swivel -over the rail after him. - -“Wot--did--I--tell--ye?” gasped the gamin, whose spirit no amount -of danger could quench. “Two heads _is_ better’n one, ef one _is_ a -cabbage head. Where’s de girl?” - -But Milly was already creeping forward to their position on her hands -and knees. - -“How can you take me back?” she asked at once, her voice sounding as -firmly above the gale as though danger was the farthest of anything -from her thoughts. - -Then she recognized Brandon. - -“You?” she exclaimed, in surprise. “I never thought of you being on -that steamer.” - -“I didn’t forget what you did for me,” Brandon said in reply. “I’d have -risked a good deal more than this for you.” - -“You couldn’t risk any more,” she declared firmly; “for you’ve risked -your life.” - -Meanwhile Swivel was signaling to those on the steamer to attach a -heavier cable to the one tied about his waist. This was done in a short -time, and then all three of the endangered ones laid hold and pulled -the cable in, hand over hand. - -It was hard work. The heavy rope was wet and unmanageable, and the -strain on their young muscles was terrible. - -Milly worked as unceasingly as did the two boys, but the cable came -across the tossing waves but slowly. - -“Where are the crew--where is your father?” asked Brandon. - -The girl’s face worked pitifully at this question. - -“Father is dead,” she sobbed, “and the crew took to the boats while I -was below. That was early this morning.” - -“And you’ve been here alone ever since!” said Brandon pityingly. - -At that instant there was a slight exclamation from Swivel, and the -small cable by which they were endeavoring to gain the larger one, came -in over the rail with fearful suddenness. - -All three were sent sprawling on the deck. - -“What is it?” gasped Milly. - -“The rope’s parted,” cried Brandon in horror. - -“Never mind; don’t you give up, missy,” Swivel exclaimed. “We’ve got -anoder rope yet. Where’s de end o’ dat rope you had tied ’round you, -Brandon?” he demanded. - -Brandon only groaned. - -“Where is it?” shrieked the other lad, fairly shaking him in his -impatience. - -“I cast it loose,” was the disheartening reply. “It is gone!” - - - - -CHAPTER XXXIV - -THE INCIDENTS OF A NIGHT OF PERIL - - -NIGHT was shutting down over the face of the storm tossed ocean--night -of the blackest and wildest description. Already the outlines of the -steamer ahead were scarcely visible from the bows of the water logged -brig. - -By a series of misfortunes (Brandon Tarr bitterly accused himself of -causing the crowning mischance of them all) the three unfortunates on -the Success were entirely cut off from escape. - -“Oh,” cried Milly, in bitterness of spirit second only to Brandon’s -own, “you have lost your lives for me--both of you. I am not worthy of -it!” - -“Don’t ye lose heart, missy,” Swivel declared, with a courage he was -far from feeling. “Th’ ship hain’t sunk.” - -“No one but God Himself knows how long it will keep afloat, though,” -Brandon returned despairingly. - -“And the gale is increasing again, too,” added Milly softly. - -“This is the last end of it, that’s wot I think,” declared Swivel -cheerfully. “It’ll blow itself out now purty soon.” - -Brandon could not look at the situation thus hopefully, but he -determined to say nothing further to make the girl despair. - -Swivel’s tone shamed him into thinking of her rather than of himself. - -The men on board the steamer, had ere this discovered what had -happened, but they could do nothing to assist the three on the brig. - -It was absolutely necessary to keep some headway--considerable, in -fact--on the whaleback, to prevent her from swinging around into the -trough of the waves. Every moment they were getting farther and farther -away from the doomed derelict. - -Caleb roared something to them through the trumpet, but the distance -and the howling of the gale prevented them from making out what he -said. The wind and spray beat upon them alternately as they crouched -together in the high bows, and every other sound but that of the -elements was drowned. - -“Come back in the shelter of the mast,” Brandon shouted at last. “We -can do nothing further here. Our position is so exposed that we may be -washed off before we know it.” - -Each of the boys grasped an arm of the captain’s daughter and with no -little trouble they managed to reach the great tangle of rigging and -shreds of canvas which hung about the one remaining mast. - -The topmast had long since been carried away, but the main spar still -defied the storm, writhing and twisting like a thing of life in the -fierce grasp of the gale. - -Here, crouching under its lee, the shipwrecked boys and girl clung to -the stiffened ropes with hands little less stiffened by the cold and -water. - -As an extra precaution they bound themselves together, and then -fastened the same rope to the mast, knowing that a wave might board the -lumbering brig at any moment and sweep everything on it that was not -fastened, into the sea. - -Occasionally, as the wreck climbed heavily to the summit of an enormous -roller, they could catch a glimpse of the steamer’s lights; but as the -hours dragged slowly on, these became less and less distinct. - -Without doubt the whaleback was drawing slowly away from the wreck, and -the worst of it was, those on the steamer probably did not suspect it. - -The castaways had no means of showing their whereabouts by lights, and -the steamer was too far away, and had been since the darkness shut -down, for those aboard her to see the outlines of the brig. Therefore -Caleb Wetherbee and his officers had no means of knowing that the -steamer was traveling nearly two miles to the brig’s one. - -Suddenly there was a flash of light from the steamer’s deck, and a -rocket went hurtling upwards into the leaden sky, to fall in showers -of sparks into the sea. It was a message of hope to the unfortunates -on the brig--it was meant as such, at least--but they had no way of -replying to it. - -“Aren’t there any rockets aboard?” asked Brandon of the captain’s -daughter. - -“There may be, but I do not know where,” the girl replied; “and the -cabin is half filled with water, too.” - -“Never mind if it is; I believe I’ll try to find them. There must be -something of the kind aboard.” - -“Ye’d better stay here,” Swivel warned him anxiously. “I don’t like ter -see ye git out o’ sight.” - -“Don’t you think I can take care of myself?” Brandon demanded. - -“Not alone,” was the prompt reply. “I reckon ’at none of us can’t take -very good keer of ourselves in this gale. We’d best not git too fur -apart.” - -“Well, I’m going to try to get into the cabin,” Brandon added. “Nothing -ventured, nothing gained.” - -He unfastened the rope from about his waist, and in spite of the -objections of his two companions, crept aft toward the cabin -companionway. - -The feat was not of the easiest, as he quickly found; but once having -determined to do it, he would not give up. - -The door of the cabin was jammed fast, but after some little -maneuvering he was able to force an entrance and descended into the -apartment, which was knee deep with water washed in from the heavy seas -which had broken over the brig during the day. - -There was no means of lighting a lantern, however, and after rummaging -about in the darkness for half an hour, he had to return to the deck -without having accomplished anything. - -As he stepped outside again, he found the brig pitching worse than -ever. The gale was full of “flaws” now--a sure sign that it was blowing -itself out--but occasionally it would rise to greater fury than it had -shown in all the two previous days. - -Just as he reached the deck one of these sudden squalls occurred, and -a huge green roller swept in over the stern of the brig, and advanced -with lightning speed along the deck, sweeping wreckage and all else -before it. - -Brandon had just closed the door, and by clinging to the handle, was -able to keep himself from being washed overboard; but he was almost -drowned during the few moments while the wave filled the companionway. - -As it passed, there was a sudden crack forward, and even above the -shriek of the gale, he heard Swivel’s cry of alarm. - -With a rush and roar like the fall of a mighty forest tree, the mast, -splitting at the deck, toppled over across the rail. - -Brandon uttered a despairing shout, for it seemed impossible for the -wreck ever to right herself, the weight of the fallen spar dragged her -over so far. - -But providentially the mast had split clear off at the deck, and after -staggering a moment from the blow, the brig shook off her incumbrance, -and came to an even keel again. - -But following the falling of the mast came a shriek from Milly Frank -which pierced his very soul. - -“Brandon! Brandon! Help!” - -With that cry ringing in his ears, the boy dashed forward along the -slippery deck and reached the spot where he had left his companions. - -“Quick! this way!” called the girl’s clear voice, and darting to the -rail he was just able to grasp the captain’s daughter and drag her back -from the cruel sea. - -“Now him!” commanded the girl, and pulling in the line which was still -attached to her waist, Brandon drew the form of Swivel out of the waves. - -“Oh, he is dead!” cried Milly in agony. “He saved me, Brandon. When the -mast fell he cut the rope and took me in his arms and ran, but one of -the ropes tripped him up and we were washed to the rail by that great -wave.” - -“I hope he isn’t dead--oh, I hope not!” Brandon returned, kneeling down -beside the motionless boy, and chafing his forehead tenderly. - -Milly took one of the poor street gamin’s hands in her own and chafed -it likewise. - -Probably never before during his miserable, eventful existence had -Swivel known such gentleness. His life had been hard indeed, and it -looked as though its lamp had gone out now in the performance of a -noble and courageous deed. - -There on the storm swept deck Milly and Brandon knelt for nearly an -hour before the unconscious boy showed the least sign of life. - -Then the eyelids fluttered a little and he drew in his breath with a -slight sigh. - -“He’s coming to!” Brandon exclaimed. - -But although poor Swivel opened his eyes once or twice, it was a long -time before he seemed to realize where he was or what had happened. - -At last he whispered brokenly. - -“Don’t--don’t--fret yerself--missy--I’m--I’m goin’ ter be all right.” - -“Are you in pain, Swivel?” queried Brandon, having almost to shout to -make himself heard. - -Milly was crying softly. The strain of the last twenty hours was -beginning to tell on even her bravery and fortitude. - -“Dret--dretful!” gasped the injured boy weakly. - -Brandon had to place his ear almost to his lips to distinguish his -words. - -“Right--here,” and he laid his hand feebly on his chest. - -“That’s where he struck across the rail,” declared Milly, when Brandon -had repeated these words to her. “Oh, the poor fellow has been hurt -internally. _Do_ you think the morning will ever come, Brandon?” - -“I’m afraid it will come very soon for him, poor boy,” replied Don -meaningly, and there were tears in his own eyes. - -Swivel had closed his eyes and a strange, grayish pallor was spreading -over his drawn features. - -His hearing seemed wonderfully acute, however. He heard the word -“morning” at least, and his eyes flew open again and he struggled to -raise himself on his elbow. - -“_Is_ it morning now?” he asked feebly. - -“No, no,” replied Brandon soothingly. “Not yet, Swivel. Don’t exert -yourself. Lie down again.” - -The injured youth strove to speak once more, but suddenly fell back -upon the rude pillow Don had made of his coat, and a stream of blood -flowed from his lips. - -Milly uttered a startled gasp, but Brandon hastily wiped the poor -fellow’s lips, and after a moment the hemorrhage ceased. - -But they looked at each other meaningly. They had lost all hope now of -the shock not proving fatal. - -While they had watched Swivel, the gale, as though at last satisfied -with its cruel work, had gradually lessened. The wind ceased almost -wholly within the next hour, although the waves did not entirely go -down. - -Swivel lay motionless during all this time, occasionally opening his -eyes to gaze up into the faces of his two friends, whom he could see -quite clearly, but otherwise showing no sign of life. - -Finally he attempted to speak again. - -“It’s--it’s hard--on me--ain’t it?” he gasped, in Brandon’s ear. -“I--I--don’ wanter die.” - -His friend did not know what to say in reply to this, but Milly seized -his hand and tried to comfort him. - -“Don’t be afraid. Swivel,” she said, trying to make her own faith serve -for the dying fellow too. “It will be better over there.” - -“Mebbee--mebbee they won’t let me come.” - -“Yes, you may, if you ask, Swivel. Don’t you love God?” - -“I hain’t--hain’t never--heered--much erbout Him,” returned the lad. “I -heered the chap at the mission--school talk erbout--erbout Him some. -I--I never paid much ’tention.” - -His voice was stronger now, but in a moment the blood gushed from his -lips again. - -“Don’t talk--oh, don’t talk, Swivel?” cried Brandon beseechingly. - -“’Twon’t matter--not much,” the boy returned, after a few minutes. - -He felt blindly for Brandon’s hand and seized it tightly. Milly, still -kneeling on the opposite side, held the other. - -“Can’t ye say a prayer, like--like that feller in the mission did--er -one o’ them hymns?” he muttered. - -The boy and girl crouching above him looked into each other’s faces a -moment in silence. - -Brandon Tarr might have faced a thousand dangers without shrinking, but -he could not do this. It remained for Milly to comply with the poor -boy’s request. - -After the terrific howling of the gale, the night seemed strangely -still now. The hurrying, leaden clouds were fast breaking up, and here -and there a ray of moonlight pierced their folds and lit up the froth -flecked summits of the tossing billows. - -One narrow band of light fell across her pale face as she raised it -toward the frowning heavens and began to sing: - - “Jesus, Saviour, pilot me, - Over life’s tempestuous sea; - Unknown waves before me roll, - Hiding rock and treach’rous shoal: - Chart and compass come from the Thee: - Jesus, Saviour, pilot me. - - “When at last I near the shore, - And the fearful breakers roar - Twixt me and the peaceful rest, - Then, while leaning on Thy breast, - May I hear Thee say to me, - ‘Fear not, I will pilot thee’!” - -Faintly at first, but mounting higher and clearer, rose the sweet -girlish voice, and not only the poor street gamin, but Brandon himself -listened entranced. - -When the beautiful hymn was finished, Brandon felt that it was a prayer -not only for him whose spirit might at any moment depart, but for Milly -and himself, who should remain behind at the mercy of the storm tossed -sea. - - - - -CHAPTER XXXV - -SHOWING HOW CALEB APPEARED ON THE SCENE JUST TOO LATE - - -THE anxiety of Caleb Wetherbee for Brandon’s safety was really pitiful -to behold. When the cable parted which attached the wrecked brig to -the steamer, the captain at once realized that his ward and his two -companions were in a very serious predicament. - -There was absolutely nothing that those aboard the whaleback could do -in that howling gale to assist in the rescue of the castaways. - -Occasionally Caleb had a rocket fired to show the unfortunate trio -that he was remaining near them; but, as we know, that was very sorry -comfort to Brandon and his two companions. It simply served to convince -them how rapidly Number Three was leaving them astern. - -On one point Caleb’s calculations were very much amiss. He was running -the whaleback as slowly as practicable, keeping just enough headway on -to keep her from broaching to; but he failed to realize that even at -that speed he was sailing two miles or more to the brig’s one. - -Of course, when once the night had shut down it was impossible for -anybody aboard the steamer to see the outlines of the wreck, and -therefore this fact escaped their attention. The water logged Success -moved at a snail’s pace, and all night long the steamer drew away from -her, so that, after the storm had cleared away and the sun rose, not a -sign of the brig appeared. - -“Has she sunk?” queried Caleb in distress, as, in company with his two -remaining officers, he swept the horizon with his glass. - -“Rather, we have left her behind,” declared Mr. Coffin, making a shrewd -guess as to the real facts in the case. “The brig must have sailed -slower than we supposed.” - -“Then we must turn about at once and run back,” Caleb declared, and the -necessary orders were given. - -The day following the cessation of the gale was most beautiful, but -Caleb cared nothing for that. He neither ate nor slept, but remained on -deck nearly all the time, scanning the wide stretch of sea visible from -the top of the after cabin. - -The day passed and night came on, however, without a sign of the wreck -appearing. - -During this time the steamer had been running in a direction generally -south; while the gale was on she had run northeast. The whole day being -spent in fruitless search in this direction, however, Caleb commanded -the steamer to be put about again at evening. - -All that second night she ran slowly to the eastward, thus allowing -for the supposed drift of the Success, but they saw no signs of the -derelict, although the night was clear and the moon bright. - -The day following they spoke several partially dismantled vessels -whose crews were beating into the Bermudas for repairs. None of these, -however, had sighted the wreck of the Success. - -“They’ve gone to the bottom,” groaned poor Caleb that afternoon, as he -sat on the edge of the berth in his stateroom. - -He could not sleep, but had taken Mr. Coffin’s advice and tried to. - -“All gone--Brandon, whose dead father I promised I’d look out for him, -an’ that other poor lad, an’ the little girl. God help me! how can I go -back and tell Adoniram about this? - -“An’ then, we’ve not found the Silver Swan yet--nor air we likely to -after this gale. She’s gone to the bottom, too, mayhap, and Brandon’s -fortune along with her. Well----” - -Just here he was interrupted in his soliloquy by the hurried entrance -of Mr. Bolin. - -“Will you please come on deck, sir?” said the third officer, evidently -somewhat excited. “We have sighted what appears to be a steamer and a -dismantled vessel with her. Mr. Coffin wishes you to come up and see if -you can make her out.” - -But Caleb was out of the cabin before Mr. Bolin had finished speaking, -glass in hand. - -“Where is she?” he demanded. - -“Right ahead, captain,” replied Mr. Coffin. “There! you can see the -black smoke rising from the steamship’s funnels now. The wreck, if it -is a wreck, is between her and us.” - -Caleb got the range of the two vessels almost immediately, and it did -not take a very long look to assure him that his mate was right. - -“That’s a wreck, sure enough,” he declared, paying but very little -attention to the steamship. “Order the engineer to go ahead at full -speed.” - -Fifteen minutes later they were near enough to see the wreck quite -plainly. The steam vessel seemed to be lying quietly upon the sea now, -and as they looked a boat was lowered and pulled toward the dismantled -hulk. - -They were still several miles away, however, and could not see whether -the wreck was boarded by those in the small boat or not. - -“It strikes me,” began Mr. Coffin after a prolonged gazing through his -glass at the wreck, “that that doesn’t have the same appearance as that -vessel the boys are on. What do you think, Mr. Wetherbee?” - -Caleb had doubts in that direction himself. - -“I tell ye what it is,” he said: “the Success had a mast for’ard. This -one hain’t.” - -“It’s my opinion that’s the hull of a brig, just the same,” Mr. Coffin -declared. - -Suddenly Caleb uttered an exclamation. - -“That’s no steamship,” he declared. “See her colors and open ports. -Why, it’s a man o’ war!” - -“Right you are,” returned the mate. - -“It’s the Kearsarge,” added Mr. Bolin. “She was to come down this way, -you know. Going to the West Indies.” - -“One of her duties was to blow up derelicts--the Silver Swan among -them. Suppose this hull is the Swan!” cried Mr. Coffin. - -Caleb had fairly grown white in spite of his tan. - -“Great Peter!” he ejaculated. “Look-er-there!” - -The small boat had left the side of the wreck, and was now some -distance away from her. - -The whaleback was near enough to see that the officer commanding the -cutter had ordered the men to cease rowing and was standing up in the -bow of the boat. - -“They’re going to blow her up!” shouted Caleb. “Crowd on every ounce of -steam she’ll hold. We must stop it! Suppose that it is the Silver Swan!” - -He fairly groaned aloud, and in his excitement allowed the costly glass -to fall upon the deck, which treatment did not materially benefit it. - -Mr. Bolin darted away to the engine room, and in another moment the -funnels of the whaleback began to pour forth the blackest kind of -smoke, and the water beneath her stern was churned to foam by the rapid -beats of the propeller. - -They were all of a mile away from the wreck yet, and every instant -was precious. Caleb stumped up and down the deck, fairly wild with -apprehension, his eyes fixed on the cruiser’s cutter, in the bow of -which the officer seemed to be adjusting something. - -If the whaleback had been armed Caleb would have fired a shot to -attract the attention of the cruiser’s people, but there wasn’t a -weapon larger than Brandon’s rifle on the steamer. - -Mr. Coffin looked at his commander anxiously. He did not fully -understand why the captain wished to reach the Silver Swan and save it, -if _this was_ the Silver Swan; but he did not believe that they could -accomplish it. And he was right. - -The whaleback was still half a mile away from the scene of operations -when suddenly the officer in the cutter sat down, and the instant -following there was a loud explosion. - -A column of smoke and flame shot into the air, and when the smoke cloud -rose, only a few harmless splinters on the surface of the sea remained -to show the former position of the wreck! - -And then, when it was too late, the officer in the small boat -discovered the approach of the whaleback. - -Number Three was still driving ahead at full speed, and when her steam -was shut off she had such headway that she nearly passed the cruiser’s -cutter. - -Caleb, his voice trembling with apprehension, leaned over the rail and -shouted his question to the officer who had just “touched off” the -charge that had blown the derelict into atoms. - -“What craft is that you blew up?” he asked. - -“That was a derelict,” responded the officer, who was an ensign, in -surprise. - -“What was her name, d’ye know?” - -“She was sunken so low at the stern that we couldn’t read her name.” - -“But can’t you guess?” cried Caleb, in great exasperation. - -“Oh, there’s not much doubt in our minds as to who she was. She was one -we were ordered to destroy. The name on her bow was badly battered, but -we could make out part of it.” - -“Well, for heavens’ sake, what was it?” burst forth the wooden legged -captain wildly. “Don’t beat ’round the bush any longer.” - -The ensign began to grow as red as a peony. The old man’s manner of -questioning ruffled his dignity sorely. - -“To the best of my belief it was the brig Silver Swan, of Boston, U. S. -A.,” he declared stiffly. - - - - -CHAPTER XXXVI - -THE CASTAWAYS ON THE BRIG SUCCESS - - -TO Milly and Brandon on board the water logged brig, it seemed as -though the long night would never end. They crouched together over the -body of poor Swivel, until his clasp relaxed from their hands and he -sank into a deep sleep. - -Brandon did not believe that the injured boy would ever awake from that -unconsciousness; nevertheless, he made his way below to the cabin again -and brought up an armful of blankets to add to his comfort. - -He wrapped one about Milly, and she made him share it with her, when -Swivel was more comfortable. - -Thus sitting close together on the cold, wet deck, they conversed in -whispers till dawn; Milly, at Don’s earnest solicitation, relating all -that had occurred since the night he had escaped from the Success at -Savannah. - -It was rather a disconnected story, for the poor girl often broke into -weeping at the memory of her father’s violent death. She had sincerely -loved him, although he was a stern, rather morose man. - -It seemed that Leroyd had learned that the plans of himself and his -friends to delay the departure of the whaleback from New York had -failed, and that the steamer had touched at Savannah and departed the -very night the Success got in. - -Finding that Sneaky Al had already arrived by steamship from New York, -he promised Captain Frank an extra hundred dollars if he would land -only a portion of his goods and set sail for the Bermudas again. - -The brig’s commander could not resist this temptation, and therefore -the Success lay at Savannah but a day and two nights. Then, with -Messrs. Weeks and Leroyd aboard, she had sailed directly for that part -of the ocean in which the whaleback had run across her during the gale. - -Brandon also elicited the information that the brig had not been -successful in her search--had not seen a derelict, in fact, since -leaving Savannah--and that Leroyd was in a fiendish temper before the -gale came up. - -When that began, he and his friend, Weeks, turned to with the brig’s -crew and did all they could to keep her afloat. Captain Frank, however, -was crushed under a falling spar and instantly killed when the gale -first started in, and the first officer was washed overboard. - -When the brig became unmanageable and the crew rushed for the boats, -nobody thought, or at least nobody stopped, for the bereaved girl in -the cabin. She discovered that the crew had gone and left her only by -coming on deck after the water had begun to fill the cabin. - -Brandon and the captain’s daughter had ample time, before the sun -appeared, to get very well acquainted with each other. - -Don told her all about himself, about the object of the voyage of the -whaleback, and of the plot concocted by his uncle Arad and Messrs. -Leroyd and Weeks to find the Silver Swan and obtain the treasure aboard -her themselves. - -As soon as it _did_ grow light, Brandon made his way below again and -after a great deal of trouble lit an oil lamp and heated a little water -over its blaze. He was then able to make some warm drink for Swivel and -Milly, denying himself until she had swallowed some, and between them -they had forced a little of the mixture between the injured boy’s lips. - -After this Swivel brightened up a bit, and, as he did not try to talk, -the hemorrhage did not return. But he was very weak. - -Milly and Brandon ate a little solid food too, but their companion was -unable to do that. - -Now that it was light enough for them to see over the expanse of -waters, they found as they had feared, that the whaleback had left them -behind during the night. - -Not a sign of her presence nor of the presence of any vessel which -might come to their assistance, appeared. - -The condition of the Success worried them a great deal--or worried Don -and Milly at least--for she was gradually sinking at the stern, and the -water was gaining more rapidly than they liked in the cabin. Whereas it -had only been to Brandon’s knees when he had first gone below, it was -now up to his waist. - -During one of these trips of his to the flooded interior of the brig, -he heard Milly’s voice excitedly calling to him to come on deck. - -“What is it?” he asked, hastily making his appearance. - -“Look! look, Brandon!” cried the girl. - -She was standing up in the stern and looking over the starboard side. - -Brandon hurried toward her and followed the direction of her hand with -his eyes. - -Far across the tossing sea a dark object rose and fell upon the -surface. It was not far above the level of the water, and therefore, -though hardly three miles away, had until now remained unseen by the -voyagers of the Success. - -“Is it a wreck like this?” she inquired eagerly. - -“It must be,” said Brandon, after a careful examination. - -“Bring poor papa’s long glass up from his stateroom,” cried Milly. “You -can see it then more plainly.” - -The boy hurried to obey this suggestion and quickly brought the -instrument from the dead captain’s cabin. - -By the aid of the glass the shipwrecked boy and girl could quite -plainly view the second wreck, for wreck it was. There was no room for -doubt of that. - -“It’s the hull of a vessel like this,” Brandon declared, “though it’s -not sunken at the stern, and it rides the waves easier. - -“There isn’t a sign of a spar upon it--it’s swept as clean as this,” he -continued. “There must have been many vessels treated that way in the -storm. Derelicts will be plentiful enough.” - -He stopped with a startled exclamation, and stared at his companion in -perplexity. - -“What is it, Brandon?” Milly asked, noting his change of manner. - -“I was thinking,” he said slowly, “that if the Silver Swan--my father’s -old brig, you know--kept afloat through this last hurricane, she would -likely be in just such shape as yonder hulk.” - -“Oh, it couldn’t be possible, could it?” gasped the girl. “That would -be too wonderful a coincidence.” - -“Not as wonderful as you might think,” Brandon returned decisively, -gaining confidence in the idea now that some one opposed him. “We are -in the very part of the ocean--or at least, I have reason to think we -are--in which the Silver Swan was last reported. I tell you, Milly, it -may be she!” - -“If you could only get to her and see,” cried the young girl anxiously. - -“I--I will get to her!” declared Brandon, and then he handed the glass -to her and went back to sit by poor Swivel and think it over. - -Milly, however, remained to watch the distant wreck through the -instrument. - -By all appearances it was much more buoyant than the Success. Whereas -the latter staggered up the long swells and labored through the trough -of the sea, the strange derelict rode the waves like a duck, and, -propelled by some current, moved a good deal faster, though in the same -general direction as themselves. - -Brandon, meanwhile, sitting beside the injured boy, who was now -sleeping deeply, was turning over in his mind the project he had -suggested. - -He knew, even better than Milly, that the Success was sinking deeper -and deeper every hour, and that before evening the water might begin to -wash in over the stern. - -The ocean was rapidly becoming smooth. Together they would be able to -launch a small raft--a hatch covering, perhaps--place Swivel thereon, -and by using oars, or perhaps a small sail, might reach the distant -derelict quite easily. - -Whether it was the Silver Swan he had sighted, or not, it certainly -rode the swells better and seemed to be far more seaworthy than the -Success. - -Finally, when Milly came up from the stern, he broached his plan to her. - -“I don’t want to force you into this, Milly,” he said. “You shall have -the deciding vote. Perhaps I am influenced by the hope that yonder -vessel is the Silver Swan, and maybe this is a dreadfully foolish plan -for us to try. I think, though, that it is the best and wisest thing we -can do.” - -“What can we use for a raft?” the girl asked slowly. - -“One of the hatch covers. I have found a tool chest below--I can get at -it yet--and there are spars and pieces of canvas for a sail in the same -place. I saw them only this morning.” - -“Can we launch a raft?” asked the practical Milly. - -“I believe we can. It is growing calmer all the time, now, and the rail -is so low at the stern that we can push a well balanced raft into the -sea and load it afterward.” - -“And Swivel?” - -“I’m afraid,” said Brandon, looking down at the injured boy sadly, -“that whatever we do cannot affect Swivel. We can make him as -comfortable on the raft as elsewhere.” - -“Then let us do it,” agreed Milly energetically. “I have been watching -the other wreck and it seems to sail much better than the Success. The -old brig may go down now at any time.” - -And so they set to work at once at the task of building a raft. - - - - -CHAPTER XXXVII - -LEFT IN DOUBT - - -THE task they had set themselves was no child’s play, and this Brandon -and Milly soon discovered. But they were working for their lives, for -according to their reckoning, the Success would not remain above the -surface many hours. - -The captain’s daughter showed herself not only capable of handling -tools, but she was strong, too. For years she had sailed up and down -the seas with her father--nearly all her life, in fact--for her mother, -Brandon had discovered by questioning, had died when she was quite -young. - -This information assured him that there could be no reasonable doubt of -Milly Frank’s identity. But for the present he said nothing to the girl -about her relatives in New York. - -Milly’s life, therefore, had made her hardy and strong, although her -education was limited in many lines. - -But she had a good basis of hard, common sense to build upon, and with -a few terms at a well conducted school, she would make as well informed -a girl as one could find. - -With some trouble they managed to wrench away the fastenings of the -forward hatch, and with a heavy bit which Brandon found in the -captain’s chest ’tween decks, he was able to bore a hole of sufficient -size to receive the butt of the small spar. - -He brought two oars on deck also, and a square of sailcloth which was -bunglingly fashioned into a sail. - -Brandon proposed to leave nothing undone which would make the success -of their undertaking more sure. Something _might_ happen to keep them -from reaching the other wreck, so he brought up several cans of sea -biscuit and some canned meats from the cabin stores, and placed them in -readiness for loading the raft after it was launched. - -Then with the aid of heavy rollers and a short bar they got the raft -under way, and once it was started down the inclined deck they had no -trouble whatever in keeping it going. The only bother was to keep it -from moving too fast. - -Brandon found it impracticable to launch the raft from the stern, and -therefore cut away a piece of the rail on the starboard side wide -enough to admit of the passage of the lumbering hatch. - -They took the precaution to fasten a cable to the raft, that it might -not get away from them in its plunge overboard, and then, by an almost -superhuman effort, rolled the platform into the sea. - -It went in with a terrific splash, the sea water wetting both the -castaways a good deal, for they had to stand at the rail to steady the -raft’s plunge into the ocean. - -“Hurrah!” Brandon shouted. “It floats, and we shall be able to get -away.” - -He hastened to pull the hatch up under the brig’s rail; and, with -Milly’s aid, stepped the short mast. Then he placed the boxes and -provisions aboard and lashed them firmly, after which a bed was made -for Swivel on the raft. - -Once more he descended into the half submerged galley and made some -more warm drink for the injured boy, and this time Swivel was able to -eat a little cracker with it. - -They told him what they were about to do, and he seemed to take more -interest in the plan than he had in anything since the night before. - -“Can--can you carry me, Don?” he asked faintly. - -“I can if I don’t hurt you,” the other replied. “Now don’t try to talk, -Swivel; but, if I hurt you badly, touch me so I’ll know.” - -With this he lifted the slight form of the lad in his strong arms, and -carried him quickly, though easily, across the sloping deck and stepped -aboard the raft, which floated almost even with the brig’s rail. - -The sea had gone down very much now, and it was therefore a simple -matter to embark upon the hatch. - -Swivel was made comfortable among the blankets, his two friends hoisted -the rule sail, the painter was cast off, and the castaways moved slowly -away from the hulk of the Success. - -By this time it was quite late in the afternoon. Still there were -several hours of daylight left them, for in this latitude the sun does -not set very early, even in the spring. - -The time which had elapsed since they had first sighted the second -wreck had given this latter an opportunity to sail by the Success, for -she moved much faster than the water logged brig. The raft, however, -wafted along by the brisk breeze, began to overhaul the stranger at -once. By the aid of an oar, in lieu of a rudder, Brandon was able, with -little difficulty to keep headed toward their objective point. - -Milly, who had brought her father’s glass along, as well as the log -book of the Success, and all papers of any value belonging to her -father, occupied her time in trimming the sail, under Brandon’s -directions, and in gazing through the glass at the strange vessel. - -Soon the outlines of the latter became quite clearly visible. - -“It was a brig like papa’s,” declared the girl, scrutinizing the hull -which, although denuded of every inch of spar and rigging, still rode -the long swells as though perfectly seaworthy. - -“Can you see the stern, Milly?” Brandon asked, in excitement. - -“Yes.” - -“Is there a name on it? The Swan had her name on the stern?” - -“There is something on the stern, but it’s too far off yet for me to be -sure,” she replied. - -“The raft is behaving beautifully,” Brandon declared, “and we shall be -near enough presently for you to be sure of what you _do_ see.” - -Milly put down the glass and knelt by Swivel a moment, to place his -head more comfortably. Then she went back to the instrument again. - -Fifteen minutes passed before she uttered a word, while Brandon watched -her face with eager interest. Finally she passed him the glass and -seized the steering oar herself, although she said never a word. - -With hands that trembled slightly Brandon placed the instrument to his -eye and ranged it upon the stern of the derelict. Long and earnestly -did he examine the lettering upon it, and then closed the glass with a -snap. - -“The Silver Swan--thank God!” he said. - -“Oh, I’m so glad, for your sake, Don!” exclaimed Milly, tears of -happiness shining in her eyes. “You’ll get your father’s diamonds and -be rich.” - -“Riches on a wreck won’t do us much good,” returned Don grimly. “I’d -rather be a pauper ashore.” - -“Ah, but somebody will come very quickly now to take us off,” she said -confidently. - -“Perhaps. But, did you ever think, that perhaps somebody has been -before us?” - -“How do you mean?” - -“Why, I mean that perhaps somebody has boarded the brig already and -secured the diamonds.” - -“Who?” asked the girl doubtfully. “Who knows about it excepting your -Mr. Wetherbee and that Leroyd and his friend Weeks?” - -“Nobody that I know of.” - -“And nobody else knew where the jewels were hidden?” - -“Probably not.” - -“Then do you suppose the steamer has been here first?” - -[Illustration: LONG AND EARNESTLY DID HE EXAMINE THE LETTERING UPON IT -THEN CLOSED THE GLASS WITH A SNAP] - -“Oh, no; Caleb would have towed the old Swan to a place of safety if he -had found her--especially if she is as seaworthy as she appears to -be from this distance.” - -“Then what _do_ you mean?” demanded Milly in exasperation. - -“What about Leroyd and Weeks?” asked Brandon slowly. - -“Well, what about them?” - -“Do you suppose they are drowned?” - -“They may be.” - -“And then again they may not be. If they were picked up by some vessel -they might have still continued their search for the derelict; might -have found her by accident, in fact.” - -“Oh, Don,” cried the girl, “you are supposing altogether too much. -Don’t conjure up such disheartening ideas as that. Let us hope that we -are the first, who know about the treasure, to find the Silver Swan.” - -“Well, it doesn’t seem hardly possible that I should get the diamonds -without any more trouble,” Brandon said, with a sigh. “I’m afraid -there’s something wrong about it.” - -“Don’t talk that way, but be thankful that you haven’t had more -trouble--though, I should say you’d had almost enough,” returned Milly, -laughing a little. - - - - -CHAPTER XXXVIII - -HOW THE ENEMY APPEARED - - -SLOWLY the rude craft drew near the hull of the Silver Swan. The brig -floated as well as though she had never struck upon Reef Eight, nor -been buffeted by the gales of this southern sea for well nigh three -months. - -The recent storm had done little damage to her deck either, although -the rails were smashed in one or two places. Her wheel had been lashed -firmly, and strangely enough it still remained so, and now, in this -quiet sea, the brig held as even a keel as though she was well manned. - -Within two hours of the time the castaways had been assured that the -wreck they were nearing _was_ the Silver Swan, the raft came up under -her lee rail, and Brandon caught the bight of a cable over a pin on the -quarter. Then he leaped aboard himself and made the rope secure. - -The rail of the Silver Swan was so much higher above the surface of -the sea than that of the sinking Success had been that Brandon and -Milly had to fashion a “sling” of the sail, in which to get Swivel -aboard. The injured youth bore the pain this must have caused him -uncomplainingly and was soon made comfortable on the deck of this, -their new refuge. - -They did not let the raft float away, although they hoped that they -should not need it again, and Brandon even took the precaution of -fastening it with a second cable before they started to explore the -brig. - -The Silver Swan had been almost uninjured by her long journey with no -pilot but the fickle winds and currents of the ocean. The masts had, of -course, all gone in the first gale, and her crew had cut away every bit -of the wreckage before leaving her to her fate on the reef. - -The hatches had been battened down and the doors of the forecastle and -cabin likewise closed, so that the occasional seas which had washed -over her had done little toward injuring the interior. - -Leaving Milly to look out for Swivel, Brandon forced open the cabin -door (it had swelled badly during the long siege of stormy weather -which the brig had withstood) and went below. Naturally everything was -in confusion--tables, chairs, and what not overturned; but nothing -about the cabin seemed injured. - -The cook’s quarters showed a bad state of affairs, however, for there -wasn’t a whole dish (except the tin ones) in the place, and the stove -lay on its back kicking its four feet in the air as though in its last -expiring agonies. - -Brandon righted this useful utensil first, and mended the broken pipe -as best he could. Then, when he had a fire started in the thing, he -went on to examine the smaller cabins or staterooms. - -He knew his father’s well enough and looked in. But he could not bear -to enter that just now, and so fixed upon one, which should have -belonged to the second mate, for the use of poor Swivel. - -He went back to Milly and the injured boy then, and removed the latter -to the brig’s cabin. - -Milly, who was a capable girl in more ways than one, went to work -at once to get up a substantial meal from the stores which they had -brought from the Success, with the addition of some eatables belonging -to the provisions of the Swan. - -It was rapidly growing dark, and to prevent the liability of a -collision, Brandon hunted out some of the ship’s lanterns and hung two -in the bows, and another at the masthead, devoutly hoping that the -lights, placed in these peculiar positions, would attract the attention -of some passing vessel. - -Then the lamp in the cabin was filled and lighted, and for the first -time in forty-eight hours or more, they sat down to a comfortable meal. - -At least, Milly and Brandon sat down; Swivel remained in his berth, -with the door of the stateroom open, and watched them with a wan smile -on his pale face. - -“Now, Brandon, why don’t you see if the diamonds are here?” asked the -young girl, as they finished their supper. “I thought you would be -eager to look as soon as you got aboard.” - -Don glanced across the table at her curiously. - -“Do you know,” he said hesitatingly. “I’m half afraid to. It would be a -terrible disappointment if they should not be there--and perhaps they -are not.” - -“Come, come! don’t be foolish,” said practical Milly. “Take a look -in the secret closet--wherever it is--or I shall be tempted to do it -myself.” - -Brandon, thus urged, rose and approached the companionway. - -“Third panel, on port side,” he repeated. “That was Caleb’s direction, -if I remember rightly. Now let’s see.” - -He pressed on the designated panel, first one way and then another. It -seemed a trifle loose, but otherwise refused to move. - -“Maybe I’ve made a mistake,” he muttered, when suddenly, on his -pressing downward on the edge of the wood, a section of the panel -dropped out leaving a shallow, metal lined cavity displayed to view. - -“Bring the lamp, Milly,” he cried eagerly. - -The girl obeyed and held the light so that it might illuminate the -interior of the secret closet. There was something in the compartment! - -Brandon hastily thrust in his hand and drew forth a flat, heavy -package, sealed in oiled silk and bound with a cord. Hurrying to the -cabin table with his prize he tore off the cord, broke the seals, and -unwound the outer wrappings. - -Milly, quite as excited as himself, held the lamp closer, watching his -movements anxiously. - -Beneath the outer covering was a flat pouch of chamois skin, the flap -sealed at one end. This seal the youth broke without hesitation, and -in another instant had poured a glittering shower of gems upon the -polished surface of the cabin table. - -“Diamonds! diamonds! thousands of dollars’ worth!” cried Milly -delightedly, running her fingers through the little heap of glittering -stones and letting them fall in a flashing shower from her hands. - -The gems were uncut--at least by the hand of man--but even in their -crude state they sparkled wonderfully. - -For several moments they feasted their eyes on the brilliant spectacle, -and then Milly filled both hands with the precious gems and ran to show -Swivel. - -“Whew!” whispered that youth, his eyes growing round with wonder. “Wot -a lot of shiners!” - -“Don’t let him talk, Milly,” commanded Brandon, beginning to see that -it would never do for them to excite the sick boy by the sight of the -gems. “When he is better he can see them all.” - -The young girl came back with the jewels, smiling happily at her -friend. She seemed quite as joyful because of his good fortune as -though the gems were her own. - -Brandon took the precautions to close the door between the cabin and -Swivel’s stateroom soon after this, that the boy might go to sleep, and -then he and Milly sat down at the table and counted the diamonds. - -There were no very large gems among the lot, but they were of fair size -and of the purest white. - -It was late that night before the two castaways retired. Brandon -prepared what had once been Caleb Wetherbee’s quarters for Milly, but -he himself slept in the cabin, rolled up in a blanket on the floor, -that he might be near Swivel. - -They were so exhausted from their privations of the past day and a half -that they slept until far into the next forenoon. Swivel was actually -better, and had no more sinking spells, so that Milly and Brandon -began to hope for his recovery. - -Just after they rose Brandon saw a sailing vessel far down on the -horizon; but it passed by without noticing the brig. And once during -the day the smoke of a steam vessel blotted the lines where the sky and -sea met, far to the eastward. - -These momentary glimpses of other craft gave them some hope, for it -showed them that they were not entirely out of the track of shipping. - -That night Brandon hung the lanterns out again, and according to -arrangement with Milly, remained on deck to watch. She was to watch -days, and he at night, and he fulfilled his lonely vigil faithfully. - -But not a vessel appeared to gladden his lonely eyes. - -Milly rose early on that third day and prepared breakfast, after eating -which Brandon went to bed. The sky remained beautifully clear, and -they had nothing to fear from the elements, for the glass forecasted a -continued spell of fine weather. - -Milly took up her position with the long spy glass on the deck, and -swept the horizon for some sign of rescue. Occasionally she went down -to look in on Swivel, and about noon to prepare the dinner. - -When the meal was nearly ready the young girl ran up the companionway -stairs again for a final look before she summoned Brandon from his -stateroom. As she put the glass to her eye and gazed toward the west a -cry of surprise and joy burst from her lips. - -Approaching the derelict brig, with a great expanse of canvas spread to -the fresh breeze, was a small schooner, the water dashing white and -frothy from her bows! - -“Saved! saved!” gasped the girl. “Oh, thank God!” - -While she had been below the vessel had come in sight, and was now less -than half a mile from the wreck. - -What seemed strange, however, was that the schooner was laying a course -directly for the brig as though it was her intention to board her. - -“Brandon! Brandon!” she cried, running back to the cabin and rapping on -the door. - -“Aye, aye!” he shouted, and was out of his berth in a moment. - -“What is it?” he asked, appearing in the cabin. - -“There is a schooner coming right for us!” cried Milly, laughing and -crying for joy. “I’ve just discovered it. It’s about here.” - -She was about to dart out upon deck again, but Brandon grasped her arm. - -“Wait, Milly,” he said cautiously. “Have they seen you yet?” - -“No; but I want them to.” - -“Not yet. We don’t know what they may be. Let me look at them,” said -the boy rapidly. - -He seized the glass, and mounting to the top of the stairs, peered out -from the shelter of the companionway at the strange schooner. - -She lay to about a quarter of a mile away from the derelict, and a boat -was already half way between the vessel and the wreck. Brandon examined -the men in it intently. - -Only a moment did he scrutinize them, and then he dropped the glass -with a cry of alarm. He had recognized Jim Leroyd and the fellow Weeks -among the crew of the small boat! - - - - -CHAPTER XXXIX - -SHOWING HOW MR. WEEKS MADE HIS LAST MOVE - - -“WHAT is it, Brandon?” gasped Milly, seeing the look upon her -companion’s face. - -“Look! look!” whispered the youth, thrusting the glass into her hands. - -Milly gazed in terrified silence at the approaching boat. - -She, as well as Don, at once recognized the villainous Leroyd and his -friend, Sneaky Al, and her heart sank with fear. - -“What shall we do?” she inquired at last, turning to Brandon. - -The latter turned back into the cabin without a word, opened the secret -closet and grasping the package of diamonds thrust it into the breast -of his shirt. - -“I’ll hide in the hold,” he said, appearing to grasp the situation at -once. “I do not believe they’ll find me. Tell Swivel, and he’ll know -what to tell and what not to tell, if they try to pump him. - -“They needn’t know that I’m here at all, or that you know anything -about me. They’ll not dare to hurt you, Milly. But I shall be on hand -in case they try it.” - -“But what can you do against so many?” she returned, with a hysteric -laugh. - -“Something--you’ll see. They shan’t hurt you while I’m alive,” he -declared earnestly. - -“But suppose they take us off with them--Swivel and I?” - -“Go, of course,” returned Brandon promptly. “Leave me to shift for -myself. When you get ashore communicate with Adoniram Pepper & Co. of -New York, and tell them how I’m fixed. Good by, Milly!” - -He wrung her hand warmly and disappeared in the direction of the booby -hatch ’tween decks. At the same moment there were voices outside and -the noise of the schooner’s small boat scraping against the side of the -brig. - -Milly, with hands clasped tightly across her breast, as though in the -endeavor to still the heavy beating of her heart, remained standing -beside the cabin table as the men boarded the brig and entered the -cabin. - -The first to come below was the ill featured Leroyd himself, and close -behind him was Alfred Weeks and two other men from the crew of the -schooner. - -“Dash my top lights!” cried the sailor, as he caught sight of the young -girl standing there so silently. - -He retreated precipitately upon his friend Weeks, who was almost as -greatly astonished as himself. - -“How under the sun came you here, Miss Frank?” demanded Sneaky Al, -stepping forward. - -But Leroyd grabbed his arm and strove to drag him back. - -“Stop, man! ’tis not a human!” he gasped, his usually red face fairly -pallid. “It’s the spirit of the poor girl. I knowed how ’twould be -we’en we left her aboard the Success.” - -Weeks shook off his grasp in contempt. - -“I’m only too willing to meet such a charming ghost as this,” he said, -with a smirk, smiling at the young girl. “Don’t be a fool, Jim. It is -Miss Frank herself, though how she came here is the greatest of all -mysteries.” - -“’Tis the work o’ Davy Jones hisself,” muttered the sailor. - -The other two men, both low browed, sullen appearing fellows looked on -without comment. - -“How did you get here?” repeated Weeks. - -“We came from the Success just before she was about to sink,” Milly -declared. “Did you come to save us?” - -“_Us?_” cried Weeks, in utter amazement. “For goodness’ sake, who’s -with you?” - -“After poor papa was killed,” there was a little choke in Milly’s voice -here, “a vessel overhauled the Success and a boy tried to save me. He -brought a rope to the wreck, but it parted before we could haul in a -heavier cable, and the gale swept the other vessel away during the -night.” - -“Brave chap!” muttered Weeks. “Where is he now?” - -“There,” she said, pointing to the open door of the stateroom in which -Swivel was lying. “He is hurt.” - -“But that doesn’t explain how ye got here, miss,” said the sailor -suspiciously. - -“I hadn’t got to that, Mr. Leroyd. Had you been men, you would not -have left me to drown as you did, and then there would have been no -necessity for my remaining for three days on these two vessels.” - -“You misjudge us, I assure you,” Weeks hastened to say, as Leroyd -shrank back at the girl’s scornful words. “Both Leroyd and I were in -one boat and the second mate was in the other boat. He declared you to -be safe, and I thought, and so did Mr. Leroyd, that you were with him. - -“It was not until we were picked up by the schooner Natchez, of -Bermuda, and carried to those islands, that we discovered your -deplorable loss.” - -But Milly did not believe this plausible story. She had too vivid a -remembrance of Leroyd and the cowardly Weeks during the gale, to be -impressed by this tale. - -“This brig passed the Success on the second day after you left me, and -we made a raft and came to it, because it was so much more seaworthy -than papa’s vessel,” said Milly coldly. - -“You say this boy is hurt, eh?” said Weeks, stepping around to the -stateroom door and peering in at Swivel, who was sleeping heavily -despite the sound of voices. “Gee! he does look bad, doesn’t he?” - -“Well, wot in thunder shall we do?” growled Leroyd at length. “We’ve -got no time to spend in fooling, Al. No knowing what that--that other -craft is.” - -“Miss Milly,” Weeks assured her, without paying any attention to the -words of his companion, “we shall have the pleasure of taking you -and your brave young friend ashore with us--after we settle a little -business here.” - -“Well, I’m glad ter hear you gittin’ down ter business,” declared -Leroyd, with satisfaction. “Come, now, skin out of here, you fellers,” -he added, addressing the two men at the companionway. “We’ll come up or -call for you when we want ye.” - -The men departed and the sailor turned again to his partner. - -“Hurry!” he exclaimed eagerly. “Where’s the place you said they were -hid? It’s somewhere in the cabin here, isn’t it?” - -“Yes.” - -“Then send the gal on deck, too, and let’s rummage.” - -“We won’t be rude enough to do that,” said Weeks, with another smirk at -Milly. “We will just request the young lady not to speak of what she -sees us do.” - -“I don’t care. Anything, so long’s we get ’em and get out o’ here. -Suppose--” - -“Never mind supposing any longer. Let me see, now,” and Weeks walked -slowly to the upper end of the cabin and counted off three panels from -the companionway on the port side. - -Quickly his long finger touched the surface of the panel, pressing here -and there and rattling the loose board, and finally the panel dropped -down, disclosing the secret cupboard--empty! - -Leroyd darted forward. - -“What is it? Is it there?” he cried. - -“The infernal luck! it’s empty!” shouted Weeks, and with a volley of -maledictions he staggered back and dropped into the nearest chair. - -Leroyd was fairly purple. - -“Have you tricked me!” he yelled, seizing his partner by the shoulders -and shaking him. - -“No, you fool! why should I trick you? That is where Caleb Wetherbee -said the diamonds were hid.” - -“Sh!” growled the sailor. “D’ye want that gal ter know everything? She -knows too much now.” - -“She doesn’t know anything about this; why should she?” - -“Then, what’s become of them?” - -“I can tell you that,” returned Weeks. “Cale Wetherbee’s been here.” - -“And left the Silver Swan a derelict--almost as good as new--an’ him -with a steamer?” roared Leroyd. “Man, you’re dreaming!” - -“Then--what--has happened!” asked Alfred Weeks slowly. - -“The gal--the gal here,” declared Leroyd, turning fiercely upon Milly. -“She’s found ’em, I tell ye!” - -He advanced upon the shrinking girl so threateningly, that Milly -screamed, and rushed to the companionway. Leroyd pursued her, and Weeks -followed the angry sailor. - -Up to the deck darted the girl, and almost into the arms of one of the -men whom Leroyd had driven out of the brig’s cabin. The fellow looked -excited and he shouted to the angry sailor as soon as he saw him: - -“De steamer come--up queek. Mr. Leroyd! Dey put off-a boat already.” - -Milly, who had dodged past the speaker, turned her eyes to the -east--the opposite direction from which the schooner had appeared--and -beheld a steamship, her two funnels vomiting thick smoke, just rounded -to, less than two cable lengths away. - -It was the whaleback steamer, Number Three! - -Already a boat had put off from the whaleback and it was now being -swiftly propelled toward the Silver Swan. - -The two men whom Leroyd and Weeks had brought with them from the -schooner, had been smoking in the lee of the deck-house and had not -discovered the steamer’s approach until she was almost upon the -derelict. - -“Curses on it!” Weeks exclaimed as he took in the situation and -recognized the steamer, whose smoke they had beheld in the distance, -before boarding the brig. - -But Leroyd kept on after the fleeing Milly. He believed that she knew -something about the missing gems, or had them in her possession, and he -was determined to get them. - -Milly ran to the bows of the brig, with Leroyd close behind her. - -“Let that gal alone!” roared a voice from the approaching boat. “Give -way, boys! I won’t leave a whole bone in that scoundrel’s body, once I -get my paws on him.” - -In an instant the small boat was under the brig’s rail, and Caleb -Wetherbee himself was upon her deck with an agility quite surprising. -Mr. Coffin and two of the boat’s crew were right behind him. - -A moment later the panting girl, having eluded the clumsier sailor, was -behind the shelter of Caleb’s towering form and those of his companions. - -Weeks stopped Leroyd in his mad rush for the girl, and whispered a few -swift sentences in his ear. Then he stepped forward. - -“By what right do you board this brig, Mr. Wetherbee?” he asked. “This -is a derelict. We have seized her and propose to tow her to port for -salvage. I command you to leave her.” - -“How long since you boarded her for that purpose?” Mr. Coffin demanded, -for Caleb was fairly purple with rage and surprise. - -“Since half an hour ago,” replied Weeks calmly. - -“If that is the case, I think I have a prior claim,” suddenly -interrupted a voice. “I came aboard two days ago and I claim the Silver -Swan as mine by right of discovery!” - -The astounded company turned toward the cabin entrance and beheld -Brandon Tarr just appearing from below. - - - - -CHAPTER XL - -IN WHICH THE ENEMY IS DEFEATED AND THE QUEST OF THE SILVER SWAN IS ENDED - - -“BRANDON!” shouted Caleb; “it’s the boy himself!” - -But Leroyd uttered a howl of rage and sprang toward the youth, his face -aflame and his huge fist raised to strike. Caleb, however, despite his -wooden leg, was too quick for him. - -He flew to Don’s rescue, and ere Leroyd could reach his intended -victim, the old mariner felled the villain to the deck with one swing -of his powerful arm. - -Weeks, who had also dashed forward to aid in Brandon’s overthrow, was -seized by the doughty captain of the whaleback and tossed completely -over the brig’s rail. - -“Git out o’ here, the hull kit an’ bilin’ of ye!” Caleb roared, -starting for the two men belonging to the schooner. - -They obeyed with surprising alacrity, and the old man picked up the -dazed Leroyd and tossed him into the boat after them. Weeks, dripping -and sputtering, was hauled aboard by his companions, and the small boat -was rowed back to the schooner, while Brandon, unable to restrain his -emotion, threw up his hat and shouted, “Hurrah!” with all his might. - -It occupied the three castaways--Milly, Brandon, and Swivel--and -Mr. Coffin and Caleb, fully two hours to straighten out matters -satisfactorily. They had so much to tell and so much to explain for one -another’s benefit, that the whaleback had run in and the crew passed -a hawser from her stern to the bow of the brig, under Mr. Bolin’s -directions, ere the conference was ended. - -Words cannot well express the astonishment that those on the whaleback -felt at finding the castaways aboard the Silver Swan--or at finding the -brig itself. For the past twelve hours they had all believed that the -derelict was a victim of Uncle Sam’s feverish impatience to destroy all -obstructions to commerce in his ocean. - -Upon figuring the whole matter up, it was pretty evident that it was -the Success which the naval ensign had exploded, for she had been sunk -at the stern sufficiently to cover her name, and had been so battered -by the waves that the lettering on the bow was also probably unreadable. - -After believing, as they did, that the Swan was sunk and all her -treasures with her, the whaleback had sailed about in circles, seeking -the wreck of the Success, on which they believed Brandon and his two -companions to be. - -It was only by providential fortune that the brig had finally been -sighted, and the whaleback had steamed up just in time to wrest the -Silver Swan from Messrs. Leroyd and Weeks. - -Swivel was taken aboard the steamer and carefully examined by Lawrence -Coffin, who was no mean surgeon, and he pronounced the youth as -seriously, if not dangerously, injured. He had burst a blood vessel and -had sustained other internal injuries, and would probably be unfit for -work of any kind for a long time. - -“Best place for him is the Marine Hospital,” declared Mr. Coffin to -Brandon and Caleb that night in the steamer’s cabin. - -“Hospital nothin’!” exclaimed Caleb, with conviction. “The hospital -is all right for them as hain’t go no homes--like as I hadn’t, nor no -friends--a good deal as I _was_--nor nothing; but _that_ boy ain’t -goin’ to lack a shelter as long as _I’m_ alive.” - -“Best not take him on a sea voyage just yet, Mr. Wetherbee,” responded -Mr. Coffin seriously. - -“I don’t intend to. He’s goin’ ter live with me, though.” - -“But won’t you sail the Silver Swan?” asked the first officer. “She’s -as good as new and she’s yours, too, I understand.” - -“No, sir, I’m not. When the Silver Swan is in shape again, I shall put -Mr. Bolin in command of her. I’ve already spoken to him about it.” - -“Whew!” whistled Mr. Coffin. “And the whaleback?” - -“You’ll command her; that was the agreement I made with Adoniram before -we left New York.” - -“Thank you, Mr. Wetherbee,” exclaimed the first officer gratefully. -“But may I ask what you propose to do?” - -“I shall retire from the sea--that is, from commandin’ a ship, any -way.” - -“So you’re goin’ to keep bachelor’s hall, and going to take this Swivel -to it?” and Mr. Coffin shook his head gravely. “He really needs a -woman’s nursing.” - -Caleb grew very red in the face, and blew his nose furiously. - -“He--he’ll get it, Mr. Coffin,” he said hesitatingly. - -Both Brandon and the first officer looked at the old tar in blank -amazement. - -“I said he’d get it,” repeated Caleb solemnly, though with a rather -shamefaced look. “He’ll get it, sir, an’ from the trimmest little woman -ye ever see.” - -“It’s Miss Frances!” burst forth Brandon at length. - -“It is her, my lad. An’ hain’t I right erbout her bein’ a mighty trim -one?” - -“She is, indeed! She’s splendid!” cried Brandon enthusiastically, -seizing his friend’s mighty palm. - -Mr. Coffin also offered his congratulations, but went away afterward -with rather a dazed look on his face. - -He was pretty well acquainted with the old seaman, and he wondered, as -did Brandon, how under the sun Caleb had ever plucked up the courage to -ask Adoniram Pepper’s sister for her hand. - -“Yes, lad,” said the old man gravely; “I’ve been floating about from -sea to sea and from land to land for the better part of fifty years, -an’ now I’m goin’ ter lay back an’ take it easy for the rest of my -days.” - -And as Brandon wrung his hand again he felt that the old seaman fully -deserved it all. - - * * * * * - -In good time the whaleback, with her tow, the derelict brig, arrived in -New York, where the Silver Swan was at once sent to the shipyard for -repairs, and is now doing her owner good service as a merchantman. - -Adoniram Pepper & Co.’s scheme of recovering derelicts in general and -towing them in for their salvage, has never amounted to anything yet, -for directly following the trip of Number Three (rechristened the Milly -Frank, by the way), the owner received a good offer for putting the -whaleback in the European trade, and she is still carrying grain to -England, with Mr. Coffin as commander. - -Milly Frank’s joy at finding her relatives, of whose existence her -father had never told her, was only equaled by the joy of Adoniram -and Frances Pepper themselves in recovering their “little sister” -again--for as such Milly appears to them. - -Miss Frances is of course Miss Frances no longer; but with her husband, -she still occupies her brother’s house in New York, and Milly dwells -with them. - -Brandon, who is at present in the naval school, resides there also -during vacation, and calls the company of assorted humanity there -gathered “the happy family.” - -Swivel is in the West--that land of bracing and salubrious climate--for -after he recovered from the accident he sustained on the wreck, the -doctors told him that he could never live and be strong in the East -again. So, with the assistance of Caleb, Adoniram, and Brandon, who -quarreled not a little as to who should do the most for him, he was -sent West, and a glorious start in business life was given him in that -rapidly growing country. - -Brandon himself, though made independently rich by the sale of the -diamonds found by Anson Tarr, loves the sea too well to give it up -altogether, and, as I said, is in the naval academy at Annapolis. When -he is through school and gets his appointment, he and Milly may--but I -won’t anticipate. - -As for the disappointed Uncle Arad, he never pressed the matter of -Brandon’s arrest after the failure of the plot (hatched up by himself -and Messrs. Leroyd and Weeks) to convert his nephew’s property to his -own use. He still remains on the farm at Chopmist, and by report is as -crabbed and stingy as ever; but Brandon has had no desire to return to -the farm since his Quest of the Silver Swan was ended. - - -THE END - - - - -TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES: - - - Italicized text is surrounded by underscores: _italics_. - - Obvious typographical errors have been corrected. - - Inconsistencies in hyphenation have been standardized. - - Archaic or variant spelling has been retained. - -*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE QUEST OF THE SILVER -SWAN *** - -Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will -be renamed. - -Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright -law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works, -so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the -United States without permission and without paying copyright -royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part -of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project -Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm -concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark, -and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following -the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use -of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for -copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very -easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation -of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project -Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may -do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected -by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark -license, especially commercial redistribution. - -START: FULL LICENSE - -THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE -PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK - -To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free -distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work -(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project -Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full -Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at -www.gutenberg.org/license. - -Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project -Gutenberg-tm electronic works - -1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm -electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to -and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property -(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all -the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or -destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your -possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a -Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound -by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the -person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph -1.E.8. - -1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be -used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who -agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few -things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works -even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See -paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project -Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this -agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm -electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below. - -1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the -Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection -of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual -works in the collection are in the public domain in the United -States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the -United States and you are located in the United States, we do not -claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing, -displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as -all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope -that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting -free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm -works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the -Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily -comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the -same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when -you share it without charge with others. - -1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern -what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are -in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, -check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this -agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, -distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any -other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no -representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any -country other than the United States. - -1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: - -1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other -immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear -prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work -on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the -phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, -performed, viewed, copied or distributed: - - This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and - most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no - restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it - under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this - eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the - United States, you will have to check the laws of the country where - you are located before using this eBook. - -1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is -derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not -contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the -copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in -the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are -redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project -Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply -either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or -obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm -trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. - -1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted -with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution -must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any -additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms -will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works -posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the -beginning of this work. - -1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm -License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this -work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. - -1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this -electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without -prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with -active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project -Gutenberg-tm License. - -1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, -compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including -any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access -to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format -other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official -version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm website -(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense -to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means -of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain -Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the -full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. - -1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, -performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works -unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. - -1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing -access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works -provided that: - -* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from - the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method - you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed - to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has - agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project - Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid - within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are - legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty - payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project - Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in - Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg - Literary Archive Foundation." - -* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies - you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he - does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm - License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all - copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue - all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm - works. - -* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of - any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the - electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of - receipt of the work. - -* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free - distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. - -1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project -Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than -are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing -from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of -the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the Foundation as set -forth in Section 3 below. - -1.F. - -1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable -effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread -works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project -Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm -electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may -contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate -or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other -intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or -other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or -cannot be read by your equipment. - -1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right -of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project -Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project -Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project -Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all -liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal -fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT -LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE -PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE -TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE -LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR -INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH -DAMAGE. - -1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a -defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can -receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a -written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you -received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium -with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you -with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in -lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person -or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second -opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If -the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing -without further opportunities to fix the problem. - -1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth -in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO -OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT -LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. - -1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied -warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of -damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement -violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the -agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or -limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or -unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the -remaining provisions. - -1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the -trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone -providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in -accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the -production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm -electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, -including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of -the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this -or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or -additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any -Defect you cause. - -Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm - -Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of -electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of -computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It -exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations -from people in all walks of life. - -Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the -assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's -goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will -remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project -Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure -and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future -generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see -Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at -www.gutenberg.org - -Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation - -The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit -501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the -state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal -Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification -number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by -U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. - -The Foundation's business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, -Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up -to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's website -and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact - -Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg -Literary Archive Foundation - -Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without -widespread public support and donations to carry out its mission of -increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be -freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest -array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations -($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt -status with the IRS. - -The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating -charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United -States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a -considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up -with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations -where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND -DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular -state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate - -While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we -have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition -against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who -approach us with offers to donate. - -International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make -any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from -outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. - -Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation -methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other -ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To -donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate - -Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works - -Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project -Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be -freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and -distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of -volunteer support. - -Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed -editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in -the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not -necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper -edition. - -Most people start at our website which has the main PG search -facility: www.gutenberg.org - -This website includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, -including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to -subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. diff --git a/old/68182-0.zip b/old/68182-0.zip Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 85bb0c7..0000000 --- a/old/68182-0.zip +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h.zip b/old/68182-h.zip Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index a677be4..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h.zip +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h/68182-h.htm b/old/68182-h/68182-h.htm deleted file mode 100644 index 03f0e61..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/68182-h.htm +++ /dev/null @@ -1,11862 +0,0 @@ -<!DOCTYPE html> -<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en"> -<head> - <meta charset="UTF-8" /> - <title> - The Quest of the Silver Swan, by W. Bert Foster—A Project Gutenberg eBook - </title> - <link rel="icon" href="images/cover.jpg" type="image/x-cover" /> - <style> /* <![CDATA[ */ - -body { - margin-left: 10%; - margin-right: 10%; -} - - h1,h2 { - text-align: center; - clear: both; -} - -p { - margin-top: .51em; - text-align: justify; - margin-bottom: .49em; -} - -hr { - width: 33%; - margin-top: 2em; - margin-bottom: 2em; - margin-left: 33.5%; - margin-right: 33.5%; - clear: both; -} - -hr.tb {width: 45%; margin-left: 27.5%; margin-right: 27.5%;} -hr.tiny {width: 10%; margin-left: 45%; margin-right: 45%;} -hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;} -@media print { hr.chap {display: none; visibility: hidden;} } - - -div.chapter {page-break-before: always;} -h2.nobreak {page-break-before: avoid;} - -table { - margin-left: auto; - margin-right: auto; -} - -.tdrt {text-align: right; vertical-align: top;} -.tdrb {text-align: right; vertical-align: bottom;} -.tdhi {text-align: left; padding-left: 1em; text-indent: -1em;} - -.pagenum { - position: absolute; - left: 92%; - font-size: smaller; - text-align: right; - font-style: normal; - font-weight: normal; - font-variant: normal; - text-indent: 0; -} - - -.blockquot { - margin-left: 17.5%; - margin-right: 17.5%; -} - -.x-ebookmaker .blockquot { - margin-left: 7.5%; - margin-right: 7.5%; -} - -.indentleft {padding-left: 4em;} -.indentleft2 {padding-left: 8em;} -.indentleft3 {padding-left: 13em;} -.indentleft4 {padding-left: 2em;} -.indentright {padding-right: 1em;} -.indentright2 {padding-right: 7em;} -.indentright3 {padding-right: 3em;} -.indentright4 {padding-right: 5em;} -.indentright5 {padding-right: 10em;} - -.bbox {border: 2px solid; padding: 2em;} - -.center {text-align: center;} - -.right {text-align: right;} - -.hangingindent {text-indent: -1em; } - -.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;} - -.ph1 {text-align: center; font-size: large; font-weight: bold;} -.ph2 {text-align: center; font-size: xx-large; font-weight: bold;} - -div.titlepage {text-align: center; page-break-before: always; page-break-after: always;} -div.titlepage p {text-align: center; font-weight: bold; line-height: 1.5; margin-top: 2em;} - -.large {font-size: 125%;} - -.caption {font-weight: bold; text-align: center;} - -.x-ebookmaker .hide {display: none; visibility: hidden;} - -.figcenter { - margin: auto; - text-align: center; - page-break-inside: avoid; - max-width: 100%; -} - - - -.poetry-container {text-align: center;} -.poetry {display: inline-block; text-align: left;} -.poetry .verse {text-indent: -2.5em; padding-left: 3em;} -.poetry .stanza {margin: 1em auto;} -.poetry .first {text-indent: -3em; padding-left: 3em;} - -@media print { .poetry {display: block;} } -.x-ebookmaker .poetry {display: block;} - - -.transnote {background-color: #E6E6FA; - color: black; - font-size:smaller; - margin-left: 17.5%; - margin-right: 17.5%; - padding: 1em; - margin-bottom: 1em; - font-family:sans-serif, serif; } - - /* ]]> */ </style> -</head> -<body> -<p style='text-align:center; font-size:1.2em; font-weight:bold'>The Project Gutenberg eBook of The quest of the Silver Swan, by W. Bert Foster</p> -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and -most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions -whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms -of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online -at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you -are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws of the -country where you are located before using this eBook. -</div> - -<p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:0; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Title: The quest of the Silver Swan</p> -<p style='display:block; margin-left:2em; text-indent:0; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:1em;'>A land and sea tale for boys</p> -<p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:0; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Author: W. Bert Foster</p> -<p style='display:block; text-indent:0; margin:1em 0'>Release Date: May 26, 2022 [eBook #68182]</p> -<p style='display:block; text-indent:0; margin:1em 0'>Language: English</p> - <p style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:0; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em; text-align:left'>Produced by: D A Alexander, David E. Brown, and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net (This file was produced from images generously made available by the Library of Congress)</p> -<div style='margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:4em'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE QUEST OF THE SILVER SWAN ***</div> - -<div class="figcenter hide"><img src="images/coversmall.jpg" width="450" alt="" /></div> - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> -<div class="chapter"> -<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_frontispiece.jpg" alt="" /></div> -<p class="caption">“WELL, SHIPMATE, OUT GUNNING?”</p> -</div> - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="titlepage"> -<h1>THE QUEST OF THE<br /> -SILVER SWAN</h1> - -<p><span class="large">A Land and Sea Tale for Boys</span></p> - -<p>BY<br /> -<span class="large">W. BERT FOSTER</span></p> - -<p>Author of “In Alaskan Waters,” “With Washington at<br /> -Valley Forge,” “The Lost Galleon,” “The Treasure<br /> -of Southlake Farm,” etc.</p> - -<p><i>ILLUSTRATED</i></p> - -<p>NEW YORK<br /> -<span class="large">CHATTERTON-PECK COMPANY</span><br /> -PUBLISHERS</p> -</div> - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<div class="poetry-container"> -<div class="poetry"> -<div class="bbox"> -<div class="hangingindent"> -<p class="ph1">GOOD BOOKS FOR BOYS</p> - -<hr class="tb" /> - - - -<p>The Young Builders of Swiftdale. By Allen Chapman.<br /> -Cloth. Price, 60 cents.</p> - -<p>Andy the Acrobat. By Peter T. Harkness. Cloth.<br /> -Illustrated. Price, 60 cents.</p> - -<p>Canoe Boys and Camp Fires. By William Murray<br /> -Graydon. Cloth. Price, $1.00.</p> - -<p>From Office Boy to Reporter. By Howard R. Garis.<br /> -Cloth. Illustrated. Price, $1.00.</p> - -<p>With Axe and Flintlock. By George Waldo Browne.<br /> -Cloth. Illustrated. Price, $1.00.</p> - -<p>The Crimson Banner. By William D. Moffat. Cloth.<br /> -Price, $1.00.</p> - -<p>The Quest of the Silver Swan. By W. Bert Foster.<br /> -Cloth. Price, 75 cents.</p> - -<p> </p> - - -<p class="center">Copyright, by Frank A. Munsey Co., 1894 and 1895, as a serial.</p> -</div></div></div></div></div> - -<p class="center">Copyright, 1907, by Chatterton-Peck Company.</p> - -<hr class="tiny" /> - -<p class="center"><span class="smcap">The Quest of the Silver Swan.</span></p> - - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<h2 class="nobreak">CONTENTS</h2> -</div> - -<table> - -<tr><td class="tdrt"><small>CHAPTER</small></td><td class="tdrb" colspan="2"><small>PAGE</small></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">I.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Raft at Sea</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_9"> 9</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">II.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Introducing Brandon Tarr and Uncle Arad</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_21"> 21</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">III.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">An Account of the Wreck of The Silver Swan</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_34"> 34</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">IV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Brandon Comes to a Decision</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_40"> 40</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">V.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Uncle Arad Has Recourse to Legal Force</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_45"> 45</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">VI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Relating a Meeting Between Uncle Arad and the Sailor</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_51"> 51</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">VII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Introducing “Square” Holt and His Opinions</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_59"> 59</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">VIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Something About Leaving the Farm</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_66"> 66</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">IX.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Another Letter From New York</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_72"> 72</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">X.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Brandon’s Arrival at the Metropolis</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_79"> 79</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Firm of Adoniram Pepper</span> & <span class="smcap">Co.</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_85"> 85</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">In Which Brandon Ventures into Rather Disreputable Society</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_90"> 90</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Old Sailor with the Wooden Leg</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_98"> 98</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XIV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Old Sailor’s Excitement</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_103"> 103</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Caleb Receives a Startling Communication</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_110"> 110</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XVI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Telling How Brandon Bearded the Lion in His Lair</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_116"> 116</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XVII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">How the Omnipresent Weeks Proves his Right to the Term</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_123"> 123</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XVIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Brandon Listens to a Short Family History</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_130"> 130</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XIX.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Telling a Great Deal About Derelicts in General</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_137"> 137</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XX.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Contents of Several Interesting Documents</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_144"> 144</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">In Which Mr. Pepper Makes a Proposition to Caleb and Don</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_151"> 151</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Into Bad Company</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_156"> 156</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Mr. Alfred Weeks at a Certain Conference</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_163"> 163</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXIV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">How a Nefarious Compact was Formed</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_171"> 171</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Uncle Arad Makes an Announcement</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_176"> 176</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXVI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Caleb Wetherbee Obstructs the Course of the Law</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_183"> 183</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXVII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Wherein Brandon Tarr Conceals Himself</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_188"> 188</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXVIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Departure of the Whaleback, Number Three</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_197"> 197</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXIX.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Stowaway Aboard the Success</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_208"> 208</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXX.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Showing What Miss Milly Does for Brandon</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_217"> 217</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Wherein Number Three Approaches the Supposed Vicinity of the Silver Swan</span>     </td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_224"> 224</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Relating How the Silver Swan was Heard From</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_229"> 229</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">In Which Comrades in Courage Launch Themselves Upon the Deep</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_234"> 234</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXIV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Incidents of a Night of Peril</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_240"> 240</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXV.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Showing how Caleb Appeared on the Scene Just Too Late</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_250"> 250</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXVI.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">The Castaways on the Brig Success</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_257"> 257</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXVII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Left in Doubt</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_264"> 264</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXVIII.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">How the Enemy Appeared</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_270"> 270</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XXXIX.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">Showing How Mr. Weeks Made his Last Move</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_278"> 278</a></td></tr> - -<tr><td class="tdrt">XL.</td><td class="tdhi"> <span class="smcap">In Which the Enemy is Defeated and the Quest of the Silver Swan is Ended</span></td><td class="tdrb"><a href="#Page_286"> 286</a></td></tr> -</table> - - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_9">[9]</span> - -<p class="ph2">THE QUEST OF<br /> -THE SILVER SWAN</p> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER I<br /> - - -<small>THE RAFT AT SEA</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">The</span> sun, whose upper edge had just appeared -above the horizon, cast its first red beams aslant a -deserted wilderness of heaving billows.</p> - -<p>Here and there a flying fish, spurning its usual -element, cut the air like a swift ray of light, falling -back into the sea again after its short flight with -a splash that sent myriad drops flashing in the sunlight.</p> - -<p>There were not a few triangular objects, dark in -color, and looking like tiny sails, darting along the -surface of the sea, first in this direction and then in -that. There was a peculiar sinister motion to these -fleshy sails, an appearance to make the beholder shudder -involuntarily; for these objects were the dorsal -fins of sharks, and there is nothing more bloodthirsty -and cruel than these “tigers of the sea.”</p> - -<p>It was quite noticeable that these monsters had -gathered about an object which, in comparison with -the vast expanse of sea and sky, was but a speck.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_10">[10]</span> -It labored heavily upon the surface of the sea, and -seemed to possess a great attraction for the sharks.</p> - -<p>It was really a heavily built raft, more than twenty -feet in length, and with a short, stumpy mast lashed -upright amidships. Near each end was a long sea -chest, both placed across the raft, and there were -also a broken water butt and several empty cracker -boxes lashed firmly (as were the chests) to the -strongly built platform.</p> - -<p>At one end of this ungainly craft, behind one of -the chests, lay two men; at the further side of the -opposite chest reclined another.</p> - -<p>One might have thought the sea chests to be fortifications, -for all three men were heavily armed, and -each was extremely careful not to expose his person -to the party behind the opposite chest.</p> - -<p>Between the two boxes lay the figure of a fourth -man; but he was flat upon his face with his arms -spread out in a most unnatural attitude. He was evidently -dead.</p> - -<p>Of the two men who were at the forward end of -the raft (or what was the forward end for the time -being, the ocean currents having carried the craft -in various directions during the several past days), -of these two, I say, one was a person of imposing, if -not handsome, presence, with curling brown hair -streaked with gray, finely chiseled features, and skin -bronzed by wind and weather; but now the features -were most painfully emaciated, and a blood stained -bandage was wrapped about his brow.</p> - -<p>His companion was a hearty looking old sea dog, -well past the half century mark, but who had evidently<span class="pagenum" id="Page_11">[11]</span> -stood the privations they had undergone far -better than the first named.</p> - -<p>He was burned even darker than the other, was -of massive figure and leonine head, and possessed a -hand like a ham. One leg was bent up beneath him, -but the other was stretched out stiffly, and it took only -a casual glance to see that the old seaman had a -wooden leg.</p> - -<p>Every few moments the latter individual raised his -head carefully and peered over the chest, thus keeping -a sharp watch on the movements of the single -occupant of the space behind the other fortification.</p> - -<p>This person was a broad shouldered, deep chested -man, seemingly quite as powerful as the wooden -legged sailor. Privation and hardship had not improved -his appearance, either, for his raven black -beard and hair were matted and unkempt, and his -bronzed face had that peculiar, pinched expression -with which starvation marks its victims; and this -look did not make his naturally villainous features less -brutal.</p> - -<p>In truth, all three of these unfortunates were starving -to death; the fourth man, who lay so still upon -the rough boards between the two chests, was the -first victim of the hardships they had suffered for -the last ten days.</p> - -<p>These four men had been members of the ship’s -company of the good brig Silver Swan, bound to -Boston from Cape Town and Rio Janeiro. After -leaving the latter port three weeks before, several -severe storms had arisen and the brig was beaten terrifically -by the elements for days and days.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_12">[12]</span>Finally, after having every stick wrenched from -her and even the jury mast the crew had rigged, -stripped bare, the brig, now being totally unmanageable, -was blown upon a narrow and barren reef several -leagues to the south and west of Cuba.</p> - -<p>The crew, who had ere this most faithfully obeyed -the captain and mate, Caleb Wetherbee, now believing -the vessel about to go to pieces, madly rushed to -the boats, and lowering them into the heavy sea, lost -their lives in their attempt to leave the brig.</p> - -<p>Captain Tarr and mate Wetherbee were able to -save only two of the unfortunates—Paulo Montez, a -Brazilian, and Jim Leroyd, the latter the least worthy -of all the crew.</p> - -<p>These four had built the rude raft upon which they -had now floated so long, and not daring to remain -with the brig during another storm that seemed imminent, -they set sail in the lumbering craft and left -the well built and still seaworthy brig hard and fast -upon the reef.</p> - -<p>This storm, which had frightened them from the -Swan, was only severe enough to strip their rude mast -of its sail and rigging and drive them seemingly far -out of the course of other vessels, for not a sail had -they sighted since setting out on the raft.</p> - -<p>Slowly their provisions had disappeared, while the -now calmed sea carried them hither and thither as it -listed; and at last the captain and mate had decided to -put all hands upon still shorter allowance.</p> - -<p>At this, Leroyd, always an ugly and brutal fellow -even aboard ship, had rebelled, and had tried to stir up -his companion, Paulo, to mutiny against the two officers;<span class="pagenum" id="Page_13">[13]</span> -but the Brazilian was already too far gone to -join in any such scheme (in fact, he died the next -forenoon), and Caleb Wetherbee had driven Leroyd -to his present position behind the further chest, at -the point of his pistol.</p> - -<p>Captain Tarr, who had received a heavy blow on -the head from a falling block at the time of the brig’s -wreck, was far less able to stand the hardship than -either of his living companions, and, now that ten full -days had expired since leaving the Silver Swan, he -felt himself failing fast.</p> - -<p>Alone, he would have been unable to cope with -Leroyd; but Caleb Wetherbee stood by him like a -faithful dog and kept the villainous sailor in check. -As Leroyd had demanded his share of the water and -scanty store of provisions, the mate had, with careful -exactness, given him his third and then made -hint retire behind his chest again; for he could not -trust the fellow an instant.</p> - -<p>“The scoundrel would put two inches o’ steel between -both our ribs for the sake o’ gettin’ the whole -o’ this grub,” declared Caleb, keeping a firm grip upon -his pistol.</p> - -<p>“He’d only shorten my time a little, Cale,” gasped -Captain Tarr, a paroxysm of pain weakening him -terribly for the moment. “I can’t stand many such -times as <i>that</i>,” he added, when the agony had passed.</p> - -<p>“Brace up, cap’n,” said the mate cheerfully. -“You’ll pull through yet.”</p> - -<p>“Don’t deceive yourself, or try to deceive me, -Caleb,” responded Captain Tarr gloomily. “I know -my end is nigh, though I’m not an old man yet—younger<span class="pagenum" id="Page_14">[14]</span> -than you, old trusty, by ten years. And -my life’s been a failure, too,” he continued, more to -himself than to his companion.</p> - -<p>“Tut! tut! don’t talk like that ’ere. Ye’ll have ter -pull through for the sake o’ that boy o’ yourn, you know.”</p> - -<p>“I shall never see him again,” declared the injured -man, with confidence. “And how can I die -in peace when I know that I shall leave my son penniless?”</p> - -<p>“Penniless!” exclaimed Wetherbee. “Didn’t you -own the brig, an’ ain’t you been makin’ v’y’ges in her -for the past ten year?”</p> - -<p>“I <i>did</i> own the Silver Swan, and I <i>have</i> made paying -voyages with her,” replied the captain weakly; -“but, shame on me to have to say it, all my earnings -have been swallowed up by a speculation which turned -out to be utterly worthless. A sailor, Caleb, should -stick by the sea, and keep his money in shipping; -I went into a mine in Nevada and lost every cent I had -saved.”</p> - -<p>“But there was the Swan,” said the dumfounded -mate; “there’ll be the int’rest money on her—and a -good bit it should be, too.”</p> - -<p>“Aye, <i>should</i> be,” muttered Captain Tarr bitterly; -“but the brig is on that reef and there’s not a cent of -insurance on her.”</p> - -<p>“What! no insurance?” gasped Wetherbee.</p> - -<p>“No. When I left port last time my policy had -run out, and I hadn’t a cent to pay for having it renewed. -So, if the old brig’s bones whiten on that -reef, poor Brandon will not get a cent.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_15">[15]</span>“<i>If</i> they do,” exclaimed the mate in wonder.</p> - -<p>“Yes, <i>if</i> they do,” responded Captain Tarr, rising -on his elbow and speaking lower, so that there could -be no possibility of the man at the other end of the -raft hearing his words; “for it’s my firm conviction, -Caleb, that we’d done better to stick by the old Swan. -This last storm drove hard from the west’ard. Suppose -she’d slipped off again into deep water? She -didn’t leak enough to keep her sweet, in spite of the -terrific pounding she got from waves and rocks, and -she might float for weeks—aye, for months—and -you know she’d have plenty of company drifting up -and down the Atlantic coast.”</p> - -<p>“But that ain’t probable, cap’n, though I’ll grant -ye that we might have done better by stickin’ by her -a while longer.”</p> - -<p>“Probable or not, Caleb, I <i>feel</i> that it is true. You -know, they say a dying man can see some things -plainer than other folks.”</p> - -<p>Caleb was silenced by this, for he could not honestly -aver that he did not believe his old commander -to be near his end.</p> - -<p>“And we had a valuable cargo, too, you know—very -valuable,” murmured Captain Tarr. “I put -every cent I received from the sale of the goods we -took to Cape Town into this cargo, and would have -cleared a handsome profit—enough to have kept -both Brandon and me in good circumstances for a -year. And then, there is something else.”</p> - -<p>“Well, what is it?” Caleb asked, after taking a -squint over the top of their breastwork to make sure -that Leroyd had not ventured out.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_16">[16]</span>“If I’d got home with the Silver Swan, Caleb, I -should have been rich for life, and <i>you</i>, old trusty, -should have had the brig just as she stood, for the -cost of makin’ out the papers.”</p> - -<p>“What?” exclaimed Caleb.</p> - -<p>He looked at his commander for several moments, -and then shook his head slowly. He believed that -the privation they had suffered had at length affected -even Captain Horace Tarr’s brain.</p> - -<p>“I’m not crazy, Caleb,” said the captain faintly. -“I tell you I should have been immensely wealthy. -Brandon should have never wanted for anything as -long as he lived, nor should I; and I had already decided -to give the brig to you.”</p> - -<p>“What—what d’ye mean if ye <i>ain’t</i> crazy?” cried -Caleb, in bewilderment.</p> - -<p>“Do you remember the man who came aboard the -brig at Cape Town, just before we sailed?” asked -Captain Tarr, in a whisper, evidently saving his -strength as much as possible for his story. “He -was a friend of my brother Anson.”</p> - -<p>“Anson!” interjected Caleb. “Why, I supposed -<i>he</i> was dead.”</p> - -<p>“He is now,” replied the captain; “but instead of -dying several years ago, as we supposed, he had been -living in the interior of Cape Colony, and just before -he actually did die he gave a package (papers, this -man supposed them to be) to an acquaintance, to be -delivered to me. I happened to touch at Cape Town -before the friend of my brother had tried to communicate -with me by mail, and he brought the package -aboard the brig himself.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_17">[17]</span>“He did not know what he was carrying—he -never would have dared do it had he known—for -with a letter from Anson was a package, done up in -oil silk, of—diamonds of the purest water!”</p> - -<p>“Diamonds!” repeated Caleb.</p> - -<p>“Yes, diamonds—thousands of dollars’ worth—enough -to make one man, at least, fabulously rich!” -The captain slowly rolled his head from side to side. -“After all these years the luck of the Tarrs had -changed, Caleb. Fortune has ever played us false, -and even now, just when wealth was in our grasp, -it was snatched from us again.</p> - -<p>“After wandering up and down the earth for forty -years, Anson finally ‘struck it rich,’ and am I, who -was to profit by his good fortune, and the son whom I -love more than I do anything else on earth, to lose -this treasure after all?”</p> - -<p>He fell back upon the raft, and the exertion set -the wound in his head to bleeding again. A dark -stream appeared beneath the bandage and trickled -down his forehead, while he lay, gasping for breath, -upon the bit of sailcloth which served him for a bed.</p> - -<p>“What did you do with the diamonds?” the mate -asked, when the dying man had again become calm.</p> - -<p>“I—I have written a letter to Brandon, telling -him all about it,” gasped the captain. “That is what -I wrote the second day we were on the raft. I dared -not take them with me from the brig, and they are -hidden in the cabin. I know now that we made a -grave mistake in leaving the Silver Swan at all, for -she may hold together for months.</p> - -<p>“Take—take the papers from my pocket, Cale,”<span class="pagenum" id="Page_18">[18]</span> -he added, feebly unbuttoning his coat, “and keep -them. If you are saved I charge you to give them -to Brandon with your own hands, and I can trust you -to assist him in every possible way to recover his -fortune, should such a thing be possible.”</p> - -<p>The mate bent over the unfortunate owner of the -Silver Swan, and with trembling hands removed several -thick documents from his pocket and thrust them -into the breast of his flannel shirt.</p> - -<p>As he did so and turned again, he saw the scowling -visage of Jim Leroyd peering at them above his -chest. Quick as a flash he seized his pistol and aimed -it at the sailor; but Leroyd dodged out of view at -once. Without doubt, however, he had seen the papers -passed from the captain to mate Wetherbee.</p> - -<p>“Take good care of them, Cale,” whispered Captain -Tarr. “And let nobody else see them. I believe -that Leroyd suspected something back there at -Cape Town, for he came into the cabin on an errand -just as that friend of poor Anson gave the package -into my hands, and I caught him snooping about the -companionway several times afterward. It was he -I feared most when we left the brig, and therefore -dared not take the diamonds with me.”</p> - -<p>“I’ll shoot him yet,” muttered the old seaman -fiercely, with his weather eye cocked over the top of -the chest. “I hated the sight o’ that fellow when -he first boarded the brig at New York. His face is -enough to bring bad luck to any ship.”</p> - -<p>But the captain was not listening to him. He had -floated away into a restless slumber, from which he -only awoke once to whisper, “Remember, Cale!” and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_19">[19]</span> -then passed into a dreamless sleep from which there -could be no awakening in this world.</p> - -<p>Caleb Wetherbee closed the captain’s eyes tenderly, -wrapped him in the bit of sailcloth which had served -as his bed, and fastened his lifeless body so that no -unexpected roll of the raft would precipitate it into -the water. Then he took the scant share of food left -of the captain’s hoard, and religiously divided it into -two equal portions.</p> - -<p>“Jim!” he said, when this was done, allowing himself -but a moment to gloat over the pitifully meager -supply which he laid on the chest lid.</p> - -<p>“Aye, aye, sir!” responded the sailor gruffly, cautiously -raising his head from behind his fortification.</p> - -<p>“Captain Tarr is dead, Jim, and I have divided <i>his</i> -share o’ the grub. Put down your weapons and come -forward to the chest and take your part. Remember, -no slippery business or I’ll bore a hole in ye! Step -out now.”</p> - -<p>Suddenly the sailor arose, his ungainly, dwarfish -proportions being more manifest now that he was -on his feet, and approached his officer, stepping over -the body of Paulo without a glance at it.</p> - -<p>His fierce eyes lighted eagerly as he saw the little -supply of food (he had already consumed all his own), -and he seized it at once. While he did so he looked -at the wooden legged sailor with a crafty smile.</p> - -<p>“Wot was it the old man give ye, Caleb?” he -asked familiarly.</p> - -<p>The mate scowled fiercely at him, and did not reply.</p> - -<p>“Oh, ye needn’t act so onery,” went on Leroyd. -“<i>I</i> knowed there was somethin’—money I bet—that<span class="pagenum" id="Page_20">[20]</span> -was given to the old man at the Cape. He’s -acted like a new man ever since, and if there’s anything -in it, I’m goin’ ter hev my share, jest like this -share o’ the grub, now I tell ye!”</p> - -<p>“You take that food and git back to your place!” -roared Caleb, pointing the huge “bull dog,” which -had a bore like a rifle, at the fellow’s head. “An’ let -me tell you that I shall be on the watch, I shall, an’ -it’ll be a long say afore you catch Caleb Wetherbee -asleep. Ef I ain’t saved, <i>you</i> won’t be, let me tell you, -for ef I feel myself a-goin’ to Davy Jones, <i>you’ll go -along with me</i>!”</p> - -<p>Leroyd sneaked back to his place again, and -crouched behind the chest. In that position he could -not see the movements of Caleb, who, after a few moments’ -thought, deposited the packet of papers where -he believed no one would think of looking for them.</p> - -<p>“There!” he muttered grimly. “If I <i>do</i> foller -Cap’n Tarr, I reckon these papers’ll never do that -scoundrel any good, an’ he can throw this old hulk to -the sharks and welcome. If the cap’n’s boy don’t -profit by ’em, <i>nobody</i> shall.”</p> - -<p>Then he folded his arms, the pistol still in his -grasp, and continued his task of watching for the rescuing -sail, which it seemed would never come.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_21">[21]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER II<br /> - - -<small>INTRODUCING BRANDON TARR AND UNCLE ARAD</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Leading</span> from the village of Rockland, Rhode -Island, a wide, dusty country road, deeply rutted here -and there, winds up to the summit of a long ridge, the -highest land in that portion of the State, which past -generations have named Chopmist.</p> - -<p>It is a drizzly, chilly spring day, the showers pattering -down in true April style, the sun promising to -show his face every few minutes, and then, when you -are expecting his warming rays, down falls another -shower and Sol hides his face in despair.</p> - -<p>Near the highest part of the ridge, on the easterly -side of the road, stood an old, gambrel roofed, weather -beaten house, its end facing the road and its front door -at the side as though it, like its present owner, had -turned sourly away from the world, refusing even -to look out upon the highway which passed socially -near it.</p> - -<p>The rain dripped steadily into the moss covered -water butt at the corner of the house, and a bedraggled -chicken, who seemed not to possess enough -energy to get under better cover, sat humped up in a -most dismal manner under the lilac bush at the other -corner of the house.</p> - -<p>It was well nigh as dismal inside the house as out.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_22">[22]</span> -A miserable little fire of green wood sputtered and -hissed in an even more miserable stove, and the faded -yellow cambric curtain at the little window, did its -best (with the aid of the dirt, which was considerable) -to keep the light from penetrating the panes.</p> - -<p>At one end of the kitchen was a square deal table -littered with soiled dishes left from the morning -meal; the two or three chairs about the room were in -a state of great dilapidation; and even the old clock -on the mantel shelf ticked with a sort of rasping -groan, as though every stroke put its rheumatic old -wheels and springs in agony.</p> - -<p>Before the stove, in a sadly abused, wooden bottomed -armchair, and with his back humped up a good -deal like the chicken under the lilac bush outside, sat -an old man with weazened, wrinkled face, eyes like -a hawk’s, a beak-like nose, and a sparse settlement of -gray hairs on his crown and chin.</p> - -<p>He leaned forward in his seat, and both claw-like -hands clutching the arms of the chair, seemed to be -all that kept him from falling upon the stove.</p> - -<p>At the window, just where the light fell best upon -the book in his hand, sat a youth of sixteen years—a -well made, robust boy, whose brown hair curled about -his broad forehead, and whose face was not without -marks of real beauty.</p> - -<p>Just now his brows were knit in a slight frown, -and there was a flash of anger in his clear eyes.</p> - -<p>“I dunno what’s comin’ of ev’rything,” the old -man was saying, in a querulous tone. “Here ’tis the -first o’ April, an’ ’tain’t been weather fit ter plow a -furrer, or plant a seed, yit.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_23">[23]</span>“Well, I don’t see as it’s <i>my</i> fault, Uncle Arad,” -responded the boy by the window. “<i>I</i> don’t make the -weather.”</p> - -<p>“I dunno whether ye do or not,” the old man declared, -after staring across at him for an instant. -“I begin ter believe yer a regular Jonah—jest as -yer Uncle Anson was, an’ yer pa, too.”</p> - -<p>The boy turned away and looked out of the window -at this mention of his parent, and a close observer -might have seen his broad young shoulders -tremble with sudden emotion as he strove to check -the sobs which all but choked him.</p> - -<p>Whether the old man was a close enough observer -to see this or not, he nevertheless kept on in the same -strain.</p> - -<p>“One thing there is erbout it,” he remarked; “Anson -knew <i>he</i> was born ter ill luck, an’ he cleared out -an’ never dragged nobody else down ter poverty -with him. But your pa had ter marry—an’ see -what come of it!”</p> - -<p>“I don’t know as it affected <i>you</i> any,” rejoined the -boy, bitterly.</p> - -<p>“Yes, ’t’as, too! Ain’t I got you on my hands, -a-eatin’ of your head off, when there ain’t a sign of -a chance o’ gittin’ any work aout o’ ye?”</p> - -<p>“I reckon I’ve paid for my keep for more’n <i>one</i> -year,” the other declared vehemently; “and up to the -last time father went away he always paid you for my -board—he told me so himself.”</p> - -<p>“He did, did he?” exclaimed Uncle Arad, in anger. -“Well, he——”</p> - -<p>“Don’t you say my father lied!” cried the boy, his<span class="pagenum" id="Page_24">[24]</span> -eyes flashing and his fists clenched threateningly. “If -you do, you’ll wish you hadn’t.”</p> - -<p>“Well—I ain’t said so, hev I?” whined Uncle -Arad, fairly routed by this vehemence. “Ain’t you -a pretty boy to threaten an old man like me, Brandon -Tarr?”</p> - -<p>Brandon relapsed into sullen silence, and the old -man went on:</p> - -<p>“Mebbe Horace <i>thought</i> he paid your board, but -the little money he ever give me never more’n ha’f -covered the expense ye’ve been ter me, Don.”</p> - -<p>His hearer sniffed contemptuously at this. He -knew well enough that he had done a man’s work -about the Tarr place in summer, and all the chores -during winter before and after school hours, for the -better part of three years, and had amply repaid any -outlay the old man had made.</p> - -<p>Old Arad Tarr was reckoned as a miser by his -townsmen, and they were very nearly correct. By -inheritance the farm never belonged to him, for he -was the youngest son of old Abram Tarr, and had -been started in business by his father when he was -a young man, while his brother Ezra had the old -homestead, as the eldest son should.</p> - -<p>But reverses came to Ezra, of which the younger -brother, being successful in money matters, took advantage, -and when Ezra died at last (worked to death, -the neighbors said) the property came into Arad’s -hands. There was little enough left for the widow, -who soon followed her husband to the grave, and -for the two boys, Anson and Horace.</p> - -<p>Anson was of a roving, restless disposition, and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_25">[25]</span> -he soon became disgusted with the grinding methods -of old Arad, who sought to get double work out of -his two nephews. So he left the farm, and, allured -by visions of sudden wealth which led him all over -the world, he followed from one scheme to another, -never returning to the old place again, though his -brother, Horace, heard from him occasionally.</p> - -<p>The younger lad was not long in following his -brother’s footsteps (in leaving home, at least), and -went to sea, where he rose rapidly from the ranks -of the common sailor to the post of commander.</p> - -<p>He married a girl whom he had known in his boyhood, -and Brandon, the boy who was now left to -the tender mercies of the great uncle, was their only -child.</p> - -<p>By patient frugality Captain Tarr had amassed -sufficient money to purchase a brig called the Silver -Swan, and made several exceptionally fortunate voyages -to South and West African ports, and to -Oceanica.</p> - -<p>But after his wife’s death (she was always a delicate -woman) his only wish seemed to be to gain a -fortune that he might retire from the sea and live -with his son, in whom his whole heart was now bound. -There was a trace of the same visionary spirit in -Horace Tarr’s nature that had been the <i>motif</i> of his -brother Anson’s life, and hoping to gain great wealth -by a sudden turning of the wheel of fortune, he speculated -with his savings.</p> - -<p>Like many other men, he trusted too much in appearances -and was wofully deceived, and every penny<span class="pagenum" id="Page_26">[26]</span> -of his earnings for a number of voyages in the brig -was swept away.</p> - -<p>His last voyage had been to Cape Town, and on -the return passage the good Silver Swan had struck -on a rock somewhere off Cuba, and was a total loss, -for neither the vessel itself, nor the valuable cargo, -was insured for a penny’s worth.</p> - -<p>This had occurred nearly two months before, and -the first news Brandon and Uncle Arad had received -of the disaster was through the newspaper reports. -Two surviving members of the crew were picked up -by a New York bound steamship, from a raft which -had been afloat nearly two weeks, and but one of the -men was in a condition to give an intelligible account -of the wreck.</p> - -<p>From his story there could be but little doubt of -the total destruction of the Silver Swan and the loss -of every creature on board, excepting himself and -the mate, Caleb Wetherbee, who was so exhausted -that he had been taken at once to the marine hospital. -Captain Tarr had died on the raft, from hunger -and a wound in the head received during the -wrecking of his vessel.</p> - -<p>It was little wonder, then, with these painful facts -so fresh in his mind, that young Brandon Tarr found -it so hard to stifle his emotion while his great uncle -had been speaking. In fact, when presently the crabbed -old man opened his lips to speak again, he arose -hastily, threw down his book, and seized his hat and -coat.</p> - -<p>“I’m going out to see if I can pick off that flock -of crows I saw around this morning,” he said hastily.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_27">[27]</span> -“If you <i>do</i> get a chance to plant anything this spring, -they’ll pull it up as fast as you cover the seed.”</p> - -<p>“We kin put up scarecrows,” said Arad, with a -scowl, his dissertation on the “shiftlessness” of Don’s -father thus rudely broken off. “<i>I</i> can’t afford you -powder an’ shot ter throw away at them birds.”</p> - -<p>“Nobody asked you to pay for it,” returned the -boy gruffly, and buttoning the old coat about him, and -seizing his rifle from the hooks above the door, he -went out into the damp outside world, which, despite -its unpleasantness, was more bearable than the atmosphere -of the farm house kitchen.</p> - -<p>The farm which had come into Arad Tarr’s possession -in what he termed a “business way,” contained -quite one hundred acres of cultivated fields, rocky -pastures, and forest land.</p> - -<p>It was a productive farm and turned its owner a -pretty penny every year, but judging from the appearance -of the interior of the house and the dilapidated -condition of the barn and other outbuildings, -one would not have believed it.</p> - -<p>There was sufficient work on the farm every year -to keep six hired hands beside Brandon and the old -man, himself, “on the jump” every minute during -the spring, summer, and fall.</p> - -<p>In the winter they two alone managed to do the -chores, and old Arad even discharged the woman who -cooked for the men during the working season.</p> - -<p>As soon as the season opened, however, and the old -man was obliged to hire help, the woman (who was a -widow and lived during the winter with a married -sister in the neighborhood) was established again<span class="pagenum" id="Page_28">[28]</span> -in the Tarr house, and until the next winter they lived -in a manner that Brandon termed “like Christians,” -for she was a good cook and a neat housekeeper; but -left to their own devices during the cold weather, he -and his great uncle made sorry work of it.</p> - -<p>“The frost is pretty much out of the ground now,” -Brandon muttered as he crossed the littered barnyard, -“and this drizzle will mellow up the earth in -great shape. As soon as it stops, Uncle Arad will -dig right in and work to make up for lost time, I -s’pose.”</p> - -<p>He climbed the rail fence and jumped down into the -sodden field beyond, the tattered old army coat (left -by some hired hand and used by him in wet weather) -flapping dismally about his boots.</p> - -<p>“I wonder what’ll become of me now,” he continued, -still addressing himself, as he plodded across -the field, sinking ankle deep in the wet soil. “Now -that father’s gone there’s nothing left for me to do -but to shift for myself and earn my own living. Poor -father wanted me to get an education first before I -went into anything, but there’ll be no more chance -for that here. I can see plainly that Uncle Arad -means to shut down on school altogether now.</p> - -<p>“I’ll never get ahead any as long as I stay here -and slave for him,” he pursued. “He’ll be more exacting -than ever, now that father is gone—he didn’t -dare treat me <i>too</i> meanly before. He’ll make it up -now, I reckon, if I stay, and I just <i>won’t</i>!”</p> - -<p>He had been steadily approaching the woods and -at this juncture there was a rush of wings and a sudden -“caw! caw!”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_29">[29]</span>Crows are generally considered to be endowed with -a faculty for knowing when a gun is brought within -range, but this particular band must have been asleep, -for Brandon was quite within shooting distance as the -great birds labored heavily across the lots.</p> - -<p>The rifle, the lock of which he had kept dry beneath -his armpit, was at his shoulder in a twinkling, -there was a sharp report, and one of the birds fell -heavily to the ground, while its frightened companions -wheeled with loud outcry and were quickly out of -view behind the woods.</p> - -<p>Brandon walked on and picked up the fallen bird.</p> - -<p>“Shot his head pretty nearly off,” he muttered. -“I believe I’ll go West. Knowing how to shoot -might come in handy there,” and he laughed grimly.</p> - -<p>Then, with the bird in his hand, he continued his -previous course, and penetrated beneath the dripping -branches of the trees.</p> - -<p>Pushing his way through the brush for a rod or two -he reached a plainly defined path which, cutting obliquely -across the wood lot, connected the road on -which the Tarr house stood with the “pike” which -led to the city, fourteen miles away.</p> - -<p>Entering this path, he strolled leisurely on, his -mind intent upon the situation in which his father’s -death had placed him.</p> - -<p>“I haven’t a dollar, or not much more than that -sum,” he thought, “nor a friend, either. I can’t expect -anything but the toughest sort of a pull, wherever -I go or whatever I take up; but it can’t be worse than -’twould be here, working for Uncle Arad.”</p> - -<p>After traversing the path for some distance, Don<span class="pagenum" id="Page_30">[30]</span> -reached a spot where a rock cropped up beside the -way, and he rested himself on this, still studying on the -problem which had been so fully occupying his mind -for several weeks past.</p> - -<p>As he sat there, idly pulling handfuls of glossy -black feathers from the dead crow, the noise of a footstep -on the path in his rear caused him to spring up -and look in that direction.</p> - -<p>A man was coming down the path—a sinister -faced, heavily bearded man, who slouched along so -awkwardly that Brandon at first thought him lame. -But the boy had seen a few sailors, besides his father, -in his life, and quickly perceived that the stranger’s -gait was caused simply by a long experience of treading -the deck of a vessel at sea.</p> - -<p>He was a solidly built man, not below the medium -height, yet his head was set so low between his shoulders, -and thrust forward in such a way that it gave -him a dwarfed appearance. His hands were rammed -deeply into his pockets, an old felt hat was drawn -down over his eyes, and his aspect was generally seedy -and not altogether trustworthy.</p> - -<p>He started suddenly upon seeing the boy, and gazed -at him intently as he approached.</p> - -<p>“Well, shipmate, out gunning?” he demanded, in -a tone which was intended to be pleasant.</p> - -<p>“A little,” responded Brandon, kicking the body -of the dead crow into the bushes. “We’re always -gunning for those fellows up this way.”</p> - -<p>“Crows, eh?” said the man, stopping beside the -boy, who had rested himself on the rock again.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_31">[31]</span> -“They’re great chaps for pullin’ corn—faster’n you -farmers can plant it, eh?”</p> - -<p>Brandon nodded curtly, and wondered why the -tramp (as he supposed him) did not go along.</p> - -<p>“Look here, mate,” went on the man, after a moment, -“I’m lookin’ for somebody as lives about here, -by the name of Tarr——”</p> - -<p>“Why, you’re on the Tarr place now,” replied -Brandon, with sudden interest. “That’s <i>my</i> name, -too.”</p> - -<p>“No, it isn’t now!” exclaimed the stranger, in surprise.</p> - -<p>A quick flash of eagerness came over his face as he -spoke.</p> - -<p>“You’re not Brandon Tarr?” he added.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir,” replied Don, in surprise.</p> - -<p>“Not Captain Horace Tarr’s son! God bless ye, -my boy. Give us your hand!”</p> - -<p>The man seized the hand held out to him half -doubtfully, and shook it warmly, at the same time -seating himself beside the boy.</p> - -<p>“You knew my father?” asked Brandon, not very -favorably impressed by the man’s appearance, yet -knowing no real reason why he should not be friendly.</p> - -<p>“Knew him! Why, my boy, I was his best -friend!” declared the sailor. “Didn’t you ever hear -him speak of Cale Wetherbee?”</p> - -<p>“Caleb Wetherbee!” cried Don, with some pleasure.</p> - -<p>He had never seen his father’s mate, but he had -heard the captain speak of him many times. This -man did not quite come up to his expectation of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_32">[32]</span> -what the mate of the Silver Swan should have been, -but he knew that his father had trusted Caleb Wetherbee, -and that appearances are sometimes deceitful.</p> - -<p>“Indeed I <i>have</i> heard him speak of you many -times,” and the boy’s voice trembled slightly as he -offered his hand a second time far more warmly.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir,” repeated the sailor, blowing his nose -with ostentation, “I’m an old friend o’ your father’s. -He—he died in my arms.”</p> - -<p>Brandon wiped his own eyes hastily. He had -loved his father with all the strength of his nature, -and his heart was too sore yet to be rudely touched.</p> - -<p>“Why, jest before he—he died, he give me them -papers to send to ye, ye know.”</p> - -<p>As he said this the man flashed a quick, keen look -at Brandon, but it was lost upon him.</p> - -<p>“What papers?” he asked with some interest.</p> - -<p>“What papers?” repeated the sailor, springing -up. “D’ye mean ter say ye never got a package o’ -papers from me a—a month ergo, I reckon ’twas?”</p> - -<p>“I haven’t received anything through the mail since -the news came of the loss of the brig,” declared Don, -rising also.</p> - -<p>“Then that mis’rable swab of an ’orspital fellow -never sent ’em!” declared the man, with apparent -anger. “Ye see, lad, I was laid up quite a spell in -the ’orspital—our sufferings on that raft was jest -orful—an’ I couldn’t help myself. But w’en your -father died he left some papers with me ter be sent -ter you, an’ I got the ’orspital nurse to send ’em. An’ -you must hev got ’em—eh?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_33">[33]</span>“Not a thing,” replied Brandon convincingly. -“Were they of any value?”</p> - -<p>“Valible? I should say they was!” cried the sailor. -“Werry valible, indeed. Why, boy, they’d er made -our—I sh’d say <i>your</i>—fortune, an’ no mistake!”</p> - -<p>Without doubt his father’s old friend was strangely -moved by the intelligence he had received, and Don -could not but be interested in the matter.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_34">[34]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER III<br /> - - -<small>AN ACCOUNT OF THE WRECK OF THE SILVER SWAN</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">To</span> what did these papers bear reference?” Brandon -asked. “Father met with heavy misfortunes in -his investments last year, and every penny, excepting -the Swan itself, was lost. How could these papers -have benefited me?”</p> - -<p>“Well, that I don’t rightly know,” replied the -sailor slowly.</p> - -<p>He looked at the boy for several seconds with knitted -brows, evidently deep in thought. Brandon could -not help thinking what a rough looking specimen he -was, but remembering his father’s good opinion of -Caleb Wetherbee, he banished the impression as ungenerous.</p> - -<p>“I b’lieve I’ll tell ye it jest as it happened,” said -the man at length. “Sit down here again, boy, an’ -I’ll spin my yarn.”</p> - -<p>He drew forth a short, black pipe, and was soon -puffing away upon it, while comfortably seated beside -Don upon the rock.</p> - -<p>“’Twere the werry night we sailed from the Cape,” -he began, “that I was—er—in the cabin of the Silver -Swan, lookin’ at a new chart the cap’n had got, -when down comes a decently dressed chap—a landlubber,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_35">[35]</span> -ev’ry inch o’ him—an’ asks if this were -Cap’n Horace Tarr.</p> - -<p>“‘It is,’ says the cap’n.</p> - -<p>“‘Cap’n Horace Tarr, of Rhode Island, U. S. A.?’ -says he.</p> - -<p>“‘That’s me,’ says the cap’n ag’in.</p> - -<p>“‘Well, Cap’n Tarr,’ says the stranger chap, a-lookin’ -kinder squint eyed at me, ‘did you ever have -a brother Anson?’</p> - -<p>“Th’ cap’n noticed his lookin’ at me an’ says, afore -he answered the question:</p> - -<p>“‘Ye kin speak freely,’ says he, ‘this is my mate, -Cale Wetherbee, an’ there ain’t a squarer man, nor -an honester, as walks the deck terday,’ says he. ‘Yes, -I had a brother Anson; but I persume he’s dead.’</p> - -<p>“‘Yes, he is dead,’ said the stranger. ‘He died -up country, at a place they calls Kimberley, ’bout two -months ago.’</p> - -<p>“That was surprisin’ ter the cap’n, I reckon, an’ he -tol’ the feller that he’d supposed Anson Tarr dead -years before, as he hadn’t heard from him.</p> - -<p>“‘No, he died two months ago,’ says the man, ‘an’ -I was with him. He died o’ pneumony—was took -werry sudden.’</p> - -<p>“Nat’rally this news took the old man—I sh’d say -yer father—all aback, as it were, an’ he inquired -inter his brother’s death fully. Fin’ly the man drew -out a big package—papers he said they was—wot -Anson Tarr had given him ter be sure ter give ter the -cap’n when he sh’d see him. Then the feller went.</p> - -<p>“O’ course, the cap’n didn’t tell me wot the docyments -was, but I reckoned by his actions, an’ some<span class="pagenum" id="Page_36">[36]</span> -o’ the hints he let drop, that they was valible, an’ I—I -got it inter my head that ’twas erbout money—er -suthin’ o’ the kind—that your Uncle Anson -knowed of.</p> - -<p>“Wal, the Silver Swan, she left the Cape, ’n’ all -went well till arter we touched at Rio an’ was homeward -boun’. Then a gale struck us that stripped the -brig o’ ev’ry stick o’ timber an’ every rag o’ sail, an’ -druv her outer thet ’ere rock. There warn’t no hope -for the ol’ brig an’ she began to go ter pieces to once, -so we tried ter take to the boats.</p> - -<p>“But the boats was smashed an’ the only ones -left o’ the hull ship’s company was men Paulo Montez, -and yer father, an’—an’ another feller. We built the -raft and left the ol’ brig, just as she—er—slid off -er th’ rock an’ sunk inter the sea. It—it mos’ broke -yer father’s heart ter see the ol’ brig go down an’ I -felt m’self, jest as though I’d lost er—er friend, er -suthin!”</p> - -<p>The sailor paused in his narrative and drew hard -upon his pipe for a moment.</p> - -<p>“Wal, you know by the papers how we floated -around on that ’ere raf’ an’ how yer poor father was -took. He give me these papers just afore he died, an’ -made me promise ter git ’em ter you, ef I was saved. -He said you’d understand ’em ter oncet, an’,” looking -at Brandon keenly out of the corners of his eyes, “I -didn’t know but ye knew something about it already.”</p> - -<p>Brandon slowly shook his head.</p> - -<p>“No,” he said; “I can’t for the life of me think -what they could refer to.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_37">[37]</span>“No—no buried treasure, nor nothing of the -kind?” suggested the man hesitatingly.</p> - -<p>“I guess not!” exclaimed Don. “If I knew about -such a thing, you can bet I’d be after it right quickly, -for I don’t know any one who needs money just at -the present moment more than I.”</p> - -<p>“Well, I believe I’ll go,” cried the sailor, rising -hastily. “That ’orspital feller must hev forgotten -ter mail them papers, an’ I’ll git back ter New York -ter oncet, an’ see ’bout it. I b’lieve they’ll be of vally -to ye, an’ if ye want <i>my</i> help in any way, jest let me -know. I—I’ll give ye a place ter ’dress letters to, -an’ I’ll call there an’ git ’em.”</p> - -<p>He produced an old stump of a pencil from his -pocket and a ragged leather note case. From this he -drew forth a dog eared business card of some ship -chandler’s firm, on the blank side of which he wrote -in a remarkably bad hand:</p> - -<p class="center">CALEB WETHERBEE,<br /> -<span class="indentleft"><span class="smcap">New England Hotel,</span><br /> -<span class="indentleft2">Water Street,</span><br /> -<span class="indentleft3">New York</span>.</span></p> - -<p>Then he shook Don warmly by the hand, and promising -to get the papers from the “’orspital feller” at -once, struck away toward the city again, leaving the -boy in a statement of great bewilderment.</p> - -<p>He didn’t know what the papers could refer to, yet -like all boys who possess a good digestion and average -health, he had imagined enough to fancy a hundred -things that they <i>might</i> contain. Perhaps there<span class="pagenum" id="Page_38">[38]</span> -was some great fortune which his Uncle Anson had -known about, and had died before he could reap the -benefit of his knowledge.</p> - -<p>Yet, he felt an instinctive distrustfulness of this -Caleb Wetherbee. He was not at all the kind of man -he had expected him to be, for although Captain Tarr -had never said much about the personal appearance -of the mate of the Silver Swan, still Don had pictured -Caleb to his mind’s eye as a far different looking -being.</p> - -<p>As he stood there in the path, deep in thought, and -with his eyes fixed upon the spot where he had seen -the sailor disappear, the fluttering of a bit of paper -attracted his attention. He stooped and secured it, -finding it to be a greasy bit of newspaper that had -doubtless reposed for some days in the note case of -the sailor, and had fallen unnoticed to the ground -while he was penciling his address on the card now in -Don’s possession.</p> - -<p>One side of the scrap of paper was a portion of an -advertisement, but on the other side was a short item -of news which Don perused with growing interest.</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> - -<p><span class="smcap">Savannah, March 3.</span> The Brazilian steamship Montevideo, -which arrived here in the morning, reports having -sighted, about forty miles west of the island of Cuba, a derelict -brig, without masts or rigging of any kind, but with hull -in good condition. It was daylight, and by running close the -Montevideo’s captain made the wreck out to be the Silver -Swan, of Boston, which was reported as having been driven -on to Reef Number 8, east of Cuba, more than a month ago. -The two surviving members of the crew of the Silver Swan -were picked up from a raft, after twelve days of terrible suffering, -by the steamship Alexandria, of the New York and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_39">[39]</span> -Rio Line. The Montevideo’s officers report the brig as being -a most dangerous derelict, as in its present condition it may -keep afloat for months, having evidently withstood the shock -of grounding on the reef, and later being driven off by the -westerly gale of February 13th.</p> - -<p>Her position, when sighted by the Montevideo, has been -reported to the Hydrographic Office, and will appear on the -next monthly chart.</p> -</div> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_40">[40]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER IV<br /> - - -<small>BRANDON COMES TO A DECISION</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">The</span> first thought which flashed across Brandon -Tarr’s mind as he read the newspaper item quoted in -the previous chapter was that the story of the wreck -of the Silver Swan, as told by the old sailor, had been -totally misleading.</p> - -<p>“Why, he lied—point blank—to me!” he exclaimed, -“and with this very clipping in his pocket, -too.”</p> - -<p>He half started along the path as though to pursue -the sailor, and then thought better of it.</p> - -<p>“He declared that he saw the Swan go down with -his own eyes; and here she was afloat on the 13th of -March—a month after the wreck. He must have -wanted to keep the knowledge of that fact from me. -But what for? Ah! those papers!”</p> - -<p>With this Brandon dropped back on the rock again -and read the newspaper clipping through once more. -Then he went over the whole matter in his mind.</p> - -<p>What possible object could Caleb Wetherbee have -in coming to him and telling him the yarn he had, if -there was no foundation for it? There must be some -reason for the story, Brandon was sure.</p> - -<p>Evidently there had been papers either given into -the hands of the mate of the Silver Swan, or obtained<span class="pagenum" id="Page_41">[41]</span> -by him by dishonest means. These papers -must relate to some property of value which had belonged -to Anson Tarr, Don’s uncle, and, his cupidity -being aroused, the sailor was trying to convert -the knowledge contained in them to his own benefit.</p> - -<p>There was probably some “hitch” in the documents—something -the rascally mate could not understand, -but which he thought Brandon could explain. -Therefore, his trip to Chopmist from New -York to “pump” the captain’s son.</p> - -<p>“Without doubt,” said the boy, communing with -himself, “the papers were brought aboard the brig -just as this rascally Wetherbee said, and they were -from Uncle Anson. Let’s see, he said he died at Kimberley—why, -that’s right at the diamond mines!” -For like most boys with adventurous spirits and well -developed imagination, Brandon had devoured much -that had been written about the wonderful diamond -diggings of South Africa.</p> - -<p>“Perhaps—who knows?” his thoughts ran on, -“Uncle Anson ‘struck it rich’ at the diamond mines -before he died. There’s nothing impossible in that—excepting -the long run of ill luck which had cursed -this family.”</p> - -<p>He shook his head thoughtfully.</p> - -<p>“If Uncle Anson had owned a share in a paying -diamond mine, this rascally sailor would have known -at once that the papers relating to it could not benefit -him, for the ownership would be on record there in -Kimberley. It must, therefore, be that the property—whatever -it may be—is in such shape that it can be -removed from place to place—perhaps was brought<span class="pagenum" id="Page_42">[42]</span> -aboard the brig by the friend of Uncle Anson who -told father of his death.”</p> - -<p>For the moment the idea did not assist in the explanation -of the course of Caleb Wetherbee in retaining -the papers. But Brandon had set himself to the -task of reasoning out the mystery, and when one -thread failed him he took up another.</p> - -<p>“One would think,” he muttered, “that if there -had been any money brought aboard the brig, father -would have taken it on the raft with him when they -left; but still, would he?</p> - -<p>“According to the report the brig grounded on -Reef Number 8, and perhaps was not hurt below the -water line. The next gale from the west’ard blew -her off again. She is now a derelict, <i>and if the money -was hidden on board it would be there now</i>!”</p> - -<p>At this sudden thought Brandon sprang up in excitement -and paced up and down the path.</p> - -<p>He had often heard of the wrecks of vessels abandoned -in mid ocean floating thousands of miles without -a hand to guide their helms, a menace and danger -to all other craft. The Silver Swan might float -for months—aye, for years; such a thing was possible.</p> - -<p>“And if the money—if it <i>is</i> money—is hidden -aboard the brig, the one who finds the derelict first -will have it,” was the thought which came to him.</p> - -<p>“But why should the mate come to <i>me</i> about it?” -Brandon asked himself. “Why need he let <i>me</i> know -anything about the papers, or the treasure, if he -wished to recover it himself? Didn’t he know where -on the brig the money was hidden? Or didn’t the papers -tell that?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_43">[43]</span>He cudgled his brains for several minutes to think -<i>where</i> his father would have been likely to hide anything -of value on the brig. Was there any place -which only he and his father had known about?</p> - -<p>This idea suggested a train of reminiscences. He -had been aboard the Silver Swan several times while -she lay in Boston, and had been all over her.</p> - -<p>Once, possibly four years before (it seemed a long -time to him now), he had been alone with his father -in the cabin, and Captain Tarr had shown him an -ingeniously hidden sliding panel in the bulkhead, behind -which was a little steel lined cavity, in which -the captain kept his private papers.</p> - -<p>Perhaps Caleb Wetherbee did not know about this -cupboard, and it was this information that he wished -to get from him. The idea seemed probable enough, -for if he did not know where the treasure was hidden -on the brig, what good would the papers relating to it -be to him?</p> - -<p>“There may be a fortune there, just within my -grasp, and yet I not be able to get at it,” muttered -Don, pacing the rough path nervously.</p> - -<p>“Despite his former confidence in this Wetherbee, -father must have doubted him at the last and not -dared to take the treasure (if treasure it really is) -when he left the brig.</p> - -<p>“Instead, he gave him these papers, hoping the fellow -would be honest enough to place them in my -hands; but, still fearing to fully trust the mate, he -wrote his directions to me so blindly, that Wetherbee -is all at sea about what to do.</p> - -<p>“Wetherbee knows that the brig is afloat—this<span class="pagenum" id="Page_44">[44]</span> -clipping proves that—and he hoped to get the information -he wanted from me and then go in search -of the Silver Swan. <i>Why can I not go in search of -it myself?</i>”</p> - -<p>The thought almost staggered him for an instant, -yet to his boyish mind the plan seemed feasible -enough. He knew that derelicts are often carried by -the ocean currents for thousands of miles before they -sink, yet their movements are gradual, and by a close -study of the hydrographic charts he believed it would -be possible to locate the wrecked brig.</p> - -<p>“I’ve got no money, I know,” he thought, “at -least, not much; but I’ve health and strength and an -ordinary amount of pluck, and it will be strange if I -can’t accomplish my purpose if the old brig only -holds together long enough.”</p> - -<p>He looked at the soiled card the sailor had given -him.</p> - -<p>“‘New England Hotel, Water Street,’” he repeated. -“Some sailors’ boarding house, likely. I -believe—yes, I will—go to New York myself and -see this scoundrelly Wetherbee again. He can’t do -<i>much</i> without me, I fancy, and perhaps, after all, I -can use him to my own benefit. I ought to be as -smart as an ignorant old sailor like him.”</p> - -<p>He stood still a moment, gazing steadily at the -ground.</p> - -<p>“I’ll do it, I vow I will!” he exclaimed at last, -raising his head defiantly. “Uncle Arad’s got no -hold upon me and I’ll go. I’ll start tomorrow morning,” -with which determination he picked up his rifle -and left the woods.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_45">[45]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER V<br /> - - -<small>UNCLE ARAD HAS RECOURSE TO LEGAL FORCE</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">In</span> the several oceans of our great globe there are -many floating wrecks, abandoned for various causes -by their crews, which may float on and on, without -rudder or sail, for months, and even years. Especially -is this true of the North Atlantic Ocean, where, during -the past five years, nearly a thousand “derelicts,” -as these floating wrecks are called, were reported.</p> - -<p>The Hydrographic Office at Washington prints a -monthly chart on which all the derelicts reported by -incoming vessels are plainly marked, even their position -in the water being designated by a little picture -of the wreck.</p> - -<p>By this method of “keeping run” of the wrecks, -it has been found that some float thousands of miles -before they finally reach their ultimate port—Davy -Jones’ locker.</p> - -<p>The average life of these water logged hulks is, -however, but thirty days; otherwise the danger from -collision with them would be enormous and the loss -of life great. Many of those vessels which have left -port within the past few years and never again been -heard from, were doubtless victims of collisions with -some of these derelicts.</p> - -<p>Several more or less severe accidents have been<span class="pagenum" id="Page_46">[46]</span> -caused by them, and so numerous have they become -that, within the past few months, several vessels belonging -to our navy have gone “derelict cruising”—blowing -up and sinking the most dangerous wrecks -afloat in the North Atlantic.</p> - -<p>At the time of the Silver Swan’s reported loss, -however, it was everybody’s business to destroy the -vessels, and therefore nobody’s. At any time, however, -the hull of the brig, reported by the steamship -Montevideo as floating off Cuba, might be run into -and sunk by some other vessel, such collisions being -not at all uncommon.</p> - -<p>Brandon Tarr realized that there was but a small -chance of the Silver Swan being recovered, owing -to these circumstances; yet he would not have been a -Tarr had he not been willing to take the chance and -do all he could to secure what he was quite convinced -was a valuable treasure.</p> - -<p>Derelicts had been recovered and towed into port -for their salvage alone, and the Silver Swan was, he -knew, richly laden. It might also be possible to repair -the hull of the brig, for she was a well built -craft, and if she had withstood the shock of being -ground on the reef so well, she might even yet be -made to serve for several years.</p> - -<p>These thoughts flitted through the mind of the boy -as he slowly crossed the wet fields toward the farm -house.</p> - -<p>“I’ll go tomorrow morning—Uncle Arad or no -Uncle Arad,” he decided. “It won’t do to leave the -old fellow alone, so I’ll step down after dinner and -speak to Mrs. Hemingway about coming up here.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_47">[47]</span> -He will have to have her any way within a few days, -so it won’t much matter.”</p> - -<p>He didn’t really know how to broach the subject -to the old man, for he felt assured that his great -uncle would raise manifold objections to his departure. -He had lived at the farm four years now and -Uncle Arad had come to depend on him in many ways.</p> - -<p>They had eaten dinner—a most miserable meal—and -Don was washing the dishes before he spoke.</p> - -<p>“Uncle Arad,” he said, trying to talk in a most matter -of fact way, “now that father is—is gone -and I have nothing to look forward to, I believe I’ll -strike out for myself. I’m past sixteen and big -enough and old enough to look out for myself. I -think I shall get along faster by being out in the world -and brushing against folks, and I reckon I’ll go to -New York.”</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad fairly wilted into his seat, and stared -at Don in utter surprise.</p> - -<p>“Go to New York?” he gasped.</p> - -<p>“That’s what I said.”</p> - -<p>“Go to New York—jest when yer gittin’ of some -account ter me?”</p> - -<p>“Oh, I’ve been of some account to you for some -time, and any way father always paid my board before -last fall, you know,” said Don cheerfully.</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad snorted angrily, and his eyes began to -flash fire.</p> - -<p>“Paid your board!” he exclaimed. “I dunno -what put <i>that</i> inter your head.”</p> - -<p>“Father put it there, that’s who,” declared Don -hotly.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_48">[48]</span>“<i>I</i> never give him no receipts for board money,” -cried the old man. “You can’t show a one!”</p> - -<p>“I don’t suppose you did,” returned Don, with -scorn. “You never give receipts for anything if -you can help it. If you’d given receipts to your own -brother as you ought, you wouldn’t be in possession -of this farm now.”</p> - -<p>“I wouldn’t, hey?” cried the old man, goaded to -desperation by this remark, which he knew only too -well to be true. “You little upstart you! Ye’ll go -ter New York, whether ’r no, will ye?”</p> - -<p>He arose in his wrath and shook his bony fist in -Don’s face. The youth looked down upon him scornfully, -for the man would have been no match for him -at all.</p> - -<p>“Now don’t have a fit,” he said calmly. “I’m -going to step ’round to Mrs. Hemingway’s after dinner, -and get her to come up here and look after you. -You’ll need her any way, in a few days.”</p> - -<p>“It won’t matter! it won’t matter!” shrieked Uncle -Arad, exasperated by the boy’s coolness. “It won’t -matter, I s’pose, when I hev ter pay three dollars—<i>three -dollars</i>, mind ye—fur a hull week’s extry -work!”</p> - -<p>He fairly stamped about the room in his fury.</p> - -<p>“It don’t matter, eh, when I’ll have ter hire a man -ter take your place? Be you crazy, Brandon Tarr?”</p> - -<p>“Guess not,” responded Don, wiping the last dish -and hanging up the towel to dry. “You must think -<i>me</i> crazy, however. Do you s’pose I’d stayed here -this season without wages?”</p> - -<p>“Wages!” again shrieked the old man, to whom the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_49">[49]</span> -thought of paying out a penny was positive pain, -“Wages! an’ you a beggar—yes, sir, a beggar!—’pendent -upon my bounty, as it were.”</p> - -<p>Don smiled at this.</p> - -<p>“I’m a pretty sturdy beggar, as they used to call -’em in the old days,” he said.</p> - -<p>“Wal, any way, I’m your guardeen, an’ I’ll see if -you’re goin’ jest when you like.”</p> - -<p>Don laughed outright now.</p> - -<p>“My guardian!” he responded. “I’d like to know -<i>why</i> I should have any guardian. I’ve no property, -goodness knows. And as you said about the board -receipts, <i>where are your papers giving you any legal -control over me?</i>”</p> - -<p>The old man was utterly taken aback at this and -sat down again, glowering at his nephew angrily, -while the latter put on his hat and coat and departed -on his errand to Mrs. Hemingway’s.</p> - -<p>But Arad Tarr was not the man to see either money -or its equivalent slipping his grasp without strenuous -efforts to retain it. His nephew represented to him -just so much hard cash saved, for if Brandon went -away Uncle Arad realized that the hiring of an extra -hand would be an absolute necessity.</p> - -<p>Therefore, the boy had not been gone long before -the old man decided on a line of action. He struggled -into his own coat, locked up the house, and harnessed -a horse to a dilapidated light wagon. He was too -careful of his good vehicles to take anything but this -out on such a nasty day.</p> - -<p>“That boy is a-gettin’ too upstartish!” he declared, -climbing into the wagon and chirruping to the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_50">[50]</span> -horse. “He’s jest like Anson an’ Horace. There -was no livin’ with <i>them</i>, an’ now <i>he’s</i> got this fool -notion inter his head erbout goin’ away!</p> - -<p>“But I’ll git <i>that</i> aout o’ him,” he added, with emphasis. -“If I hain’t got no legal right ter his services, -I <i>will</i> have, now I tell ye! Arter all I’ve done -fur him an’ fur his shif’less, no ’count pa, I ain’t goin’ -ter let go o’ him till he comes of age—mos’ five -years yet.”</p> - -<p>He shook his head slowly at that thought. Five -years of Brandon’s services on the farm would be -worth all of twenty-five hundred dollars!</p> - -<p>He clucked to the horse and drove on the faster at -that. Suppose the boy should take it into his head -to go before he obtained the papers which he was -sure he could have made out? The idea was quite -agonizing.</p> - -<p>“I reckon Squire Holt kin fix it up for me in short -order,” he muttered, as he urged his horse into a -faster trot. “I’ll show that boy ’t he ain’t his own -master, by no means!”</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_51">[51]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER VI<br /> - - -<small>RELATING A MEETING BETWEEN UNCLE ARAD AND THE -SAILOR</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">The</span> old man drove on through the mud and slush -of the country road, the wheels of the rickety vehicle -first rattling over outcropping rocks and boulders, and -then splashing half way to their hubs in the yellow -mire.</p> - -<p>A mile beyond his own farm he turned into a -broader highway which trended to the right—the -city “pike.” Woods bordered the way on either -side and although the rain had ceased, the drops fell -in showers from the trees. It was a nasty day and -the horse splashed itself to the belly with the mire.</p> - -<p>Not many rods beyond the turn old Arad overtook a -man walking in the same direction that he was driving, -and as the farmer rattled up, the man stepped to -one side and hailed him.</p> - -<p>He was a bronzed and bearded fellow, dressed in -garments about as seedy as the miser’s own clothing, -and although he lacked all of twenty years of Arad’s -age, his back, as he stood there beside the cart path, -seemed almost as bent.</p> - -<p>“Hullo, shipmate!” was the man’s greeting, raising -his hand for the farmer to stop. “Goin’ toward -the city?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_52">[52]</span>“Wal, I be a piece,” replied Arad grudgingly.</p> - -<p>It was something of an effort for him to speak -civilly to a casual stranger. I presume he was afraid -of wearing out the small stock of civility he possessed.</p> - -<p>“Ye’re goin’ in ballast, I see,” said the stranger. -“Can’t ye stow me away there?”</p> - -<p>“Hey?” responded the farmer, who did not understand -the other’s figure of speech.</p> - -<p>“I say ye’re goin’ in ballast,” repeated the man; -“yer wagon’s empty, ye know. Give me a ride, -will ye?”</p> - -<p>“Wal, I dunno,” said Arad slowly, with a sudden -avaricious twinkle in his eye. “I know the team’s -empty, but th’ mare ain’t s’ limber ’s she might be, an’ -it’s hard trav’lin’.”</p> - -<p>“Got an eye on the main chance, ain’t ye, ye old -land shark?” muttered the man. Then he said aloud: -“How fur ye goin’ on this road?”</p> - -<p>“’Bout three mile furder.”</p> - -<p>“What’ll ye take me that fur, for?”</p> - -<p>“Wall, I dunno,” began Arad.</p> - -<p>“Come, I’ll give ye a quarter,” said the stranger, -fishing a handful of silver from the depths of his -pocket.</p> - -<p>The old man’s eyes flashed.</p> - -<p>“Jump aboard,” he said briefly, and the black -bearded man sprang to the seat with great agility.</p> - -<p>“Ye’re some limber,” said the old farmer, in admiration, -pocketing the quarter and starting up his -horse again.</p> - -<p>“<i>You’d</i> be if ye’d shinned up as many riggin’s as -I hev.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_53">[53]</span>“Ye’re a sailor, then?”</p> - -<p>“I be. No landlubber erbout me, is ther’? I -reckon ye don’t see many sailors in these parts?”</p> - -<p>“Ya-as we do,” snarled Arad impolitely; “more’n’ -we wanter sometimes. I got a nevvy who was a -sailor—a cap’n. Lost at sea erbout two months ergo. -Lef’ me er great, hulkin’ boy ter take keer of.”</p> - -<p>“Great Peter!” exclaimed the sailor, with some -astonishment. “Ye don’t mean Cap’n Horace Tarr?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I do mean Cap’n Horace Tarr,” growled -Arad. “He was my nevvy, an’ it’s his no ’count, -wuthless boy I’ve got on my han’s. My name’s Arad -Tarr—’n’ th’ only Tarr ’t ever knew ’nough ter make -money an’ keep it.”</p> - -<p>The sailor looked at the weazened old figure curiously.</p> - -<p>“He didn’t favor you none,” he said.</p> - -<p>“Who didn’t? Horace Tarr? I reckon he -didn’t!” exclaimed Arad. “He favored a ca’f more’n -he did anything else, ’cordin’ ter <i>my</i> notion. Did ye -know him?” added the old man curiously.</p> - -<p>“In course I did. I sailed with him—er—lots. -Why, I was with him this ’ere las’ v’y’ge o’ his.”</p> - -<p>“Ye don’t mean it!”</p> - -<p>“I guess I do.”</p> - -<p>“Wal, wal!” exclaimed Uncle Arad, roused out of -himself for a moment. “So you was on that raf’ fur -so long, eh? Must er been quite an experience. An’ -Horace is really dead, is he?”</p> - -<p>“Dead’s a door nail,” the sailor declared. “Can’t -be no mistake erbout <i>that</i>. We had ter pitch him -overboard—er—another feller and me; ’cause ’twas<span class="pagenum" id="Page_54">[54]</span> -so all fired hot, ye know. Him and Paulo Montez -both went ter the sharks.”</p> - -<p>The old man shuddered.</p> - -<p>“An’ he died without leavin’ a cent, eh? Poor’s -poverty! I allus knew how ’twould be. ’N’ I s’pose -Anson—fur he mus’ be dead by this time—died -poor, too.”</p> - -<p>The sailor looked at the old man sharply out of the -corners of his eyes, and after a minute spoke again.</p> - -<p>“Yes,” he said slowly, in confirmation of Uncle -Arad’s remark. “I was with the cap’n at the last.”</p> - -<p>“What ye doin’ ’way up here?” inquired the -farmer, with sudden interest.</p> - -<p>“Well, I come up ter see Cap’n Tarr’s boy.”</p> - -<p>“Hey?” ejaculated the farmer. “Come ter see -Brandon?”</p> - -<p>“That’s it,” said the sailor, nodding.</p> - -<p>“But ye didn’t see him?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I did; over yonder in the woods.”</p> - -<p>“Why, he didn’t say nothin’ erbout it ter me,” -gasped the old man.</p> - -<p>“Mebbe ye ain’t seen him since,” suggested the -sailor.</p> - -<p>“When was yer er-talkin’ with him?”</p> - -<p>“Long erbout two hours back, ’r so.”</p> - -<p>“’Fore dinner?”</p> - -<p>“I reckon so. I seen him over in the woods yonder, -an’ talked with him quite a spell. I started ’long -back towards the city a’gin, but I found out I’d lost—er—somethin’, -an’ went back ter hev er look -fur it.”</p> - -<p>“What was it ye lost?” asked Uncle Arad, with<span class="pagenum" id="Page_55">[55]</span> -perhaps a momentary thought that, if it was of value -and had been lost on his farm, he might be able to find -it himself.</p> - -<p>“Nothin’ but a piece of paper.”</p> - -<p>“Find it?”</p> - -<p>“Not me. Must ha’ blowed away. Howsomever, -that ain’t ter the p’int. It’s funny yer nevvy never -tol’ erbout meetin’ me.”</p> - -<p>Old Arad was silent for a minute.</p> - -<p>“I wish ye hadn’t come ’round here, fillin’ up his -head with fool notions,” he grumbled. “Seein’ you -must be what set him up ter leavin’ so sudden.”</p> - -<p>“Goin’ to leave ye, is he?” asked the sailor quickly.</p> - -<p>“He <i>thinks</i> he is,” returned the farmer, with a snarl. -“Th’ little upstart! But I’ll l’arn him who’s who, -now I tell ye? Goin’ ter New York, is he? Wal, I -reckon not.”</p> - -<p>“To New York? What’s he goin’ there fur? I -sh’d think ye’d want him right here on th’ farm,” said -the sailor, with a cunning smile.</p> - -<p>“So I do—an’ right here is where he’s goin’ ter -stay,” declared Uncle Arad wrathfully. “I’m er-goin’ -down ter Square Holt’s ter see erbout it now. -I’m either goin’ ter hev him bound ter me till he’s -twenty-one, ’r git p’inted him gardeen. <i>Then</i>, I -reckon he won’t talk no more erbout runnin’ off ter -New York.”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I reckon this place is the best fur a boy like -him,” acquiesced the sailor. “An’ then, ye orter be his -guardeen. S’posin’ he had prop’ty fallin’ to him now—you’d -orter hev th’ handlin’ of it till he’s of age.”</p> - -<p>“Prop’ty! I guess ther’ won’t be none ter fall to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_56">[56]</span> -him,” sniffed Uncle Arad. “<i>I</i> ain’t a dyin’ man, by -no means, an’ his pa didn’t leave a cent. Didn’t even -hev that brig o’ his’n insured.”</p> - -<p>“I dunno erbout that,” said the sailor shrewdly.</p> - -<p>“What don’t ye know erbout?” demanded Arad -suspiciously. “The Silver Swan wasn’t insured, were -she?”</p> - -<p>“I reckon not.”</p> - -<p>“Then what d’ye mean?”</p> - -<p>Arad’s piercing eyes were fixed searchingly on his -companion’s face, but the sailor was not easily disturbed.</p> - -<p>“Well, now, I’ll put a case to ye—jest a s’posin’ -case, now mind ye,” he said calmly, as Arad, now -thoroughly interested in the matter, let the old horse -walk along the muddy highway. “S’posin’ now this -’ere Cap’n Tarr had knowed erbout a buried treasure, -’r some sich thing, an’ he’d writ erbout it, an’ give the -papers ter another man—his mate, fur instance—ter -be given ter his son.</p> - -<p>“Now, nat’rally, if ther’ was any money in it fur -this Brandon, <i>you’d</i> orter know erbout it, hadn’t ye? -You bein’ th’ boy’s guardeen, you’d orter handle that -money; un’ if <i>I</i> could help you ter the gettin’ o’ that -money, <i>I’d</i> orter hev a part of it, eh?”</p> - -<p>Old Arad stared at him with wide open eyes, and -the hand which held the reins trembled visibly.</p> - -<p>“Now, s’posin’ the mate sends them papers to -Brandon through the mail, ’r writes a letter erbout -’em—<i>you’d</i> orter know it, hadn’t ye? You’d orter -see that letter, or them papers, an’ you’d jest drop me -a line, an’ <i>I</i> c’d help ye get ’em, ’cause I know all<span class="pagenum" id="Page_57">[57]</span> -erbout sich things, bein’ a sea farin’ man fur thirty -year.”</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad moistened his trembling lips before he -could speak.</p> - -<p>“But this is only s’posin’,” he said quaveringly.</p> - -<p>“But, <i>s’pose ’twas so!</i> S’pose I seen them papers -passed, an’ s’pose I heered Cap’n Tarr say with his -own lips ther’ was ’nough suthin ’r other (I couldn’t -ketch th’ word—gold, mebbe) there ter make a man -fabulously rich?”</p> - -<p>“Fabulously rich!” repeated Arad.</p> - -<p>“That’s it; fabulously rich, is wot he said. An’ if -it’s so, <i>you</i> orter to get the letters from the post office, -an’ open every one of ’em, hadn’t ye?”</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad nodded quickly.</p> - -<p>“O course ye had; and if the letter or papers sh’d -come from Caleb Wetherbee—thet’s the mate’s name; -he’s in the ’orspital yet—you’d let me know, an’ then -we’d see wot we sh’d see, eh?”</p> - -<p>The sailor poked the old man familiarly in the ribs -and slapped his own knee.</p> - -<p>“That’s wot we’d do, shipmate,” he said. “Wot -say ye? Ye’ll need me, fur I reckon wherever th’ -money’s hid, ye’ll need a sailor ter go ’long with ye—er -ter git it fur ye.”</p> - -<p>“I—I couldn’t go; my health ain’t good ’nough,” -declared the farmer. “Then—then—mebbe there -ain’t nothin’ in it.”</p> - -<p>“Well, mebbe there ain’t,” said the sailor calmly, -preparing to dismount as the old man pulled up before -a house; “an’ then ag’in mebbe there is. Leastways, -I adwise ye ter jest keep yer eyes open fur letters<span class="pagenum" id="Page_58">[58]</span> -f’om New York. An’ when one comes from -Caleb Wetherbee, p’r’aps ye’ll want ter talk with me -furder.”</p> - -<p>“Where—where kin I find ye?” Arad asked, in -a shaking voice.</p> - -<p>“Jest write ter Jim Leroyd, New England Hotel, -Water Street, New York—that’ll fetch me,” declared -the sailor briskly. “Now remember, old feller,” he -added meaningly, “ye won’t be able ter do nothin’ -with them papers ’thout me. If ye try it ye’ll be up a -stump ter oncet. Now, take keer o’ yerself!”</p> - -<p>He turned away and rolled along the road toward -the distant city, while Uncle Arad climbed down from -the wagon.</p> - -<p>“Fabulously rich!” he muttered to himself, as he -fastened the horse to the hitching post with trembling -hands.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_59">[59]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER VII<br /> - - -<small>INTRODUCING “SQUARE” HOLT AND HIS OPINIONS</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">“Square” Holt</span>, who was a justice of the peace as -well as the judge of the probate court of the town, -was a very tall and very angular individual with a -massive development of nose (old Arad Tarr’s was -as nothing beside it) and a wide mouth continually -drawn into a grim line, as though such a thing as a -smile had never crossed his imagination—if, indeed, -he had an imagination.</p> - -<p>He had no children of his own (which was an exceedingly -fortunate thing for the unborn generations) -and had apparently forgotten his own boyhood. Boys, -in his estimation, were made to work—the harder -the better. In this he was of the same opinion as -Uncle Arad Tarr.</p> - -<p>Old Arad was at once admitted to the front parlor -of the house at which he had stopped, which was -used by the judge as his office when he was not at the -town hall. Here, seated in one of the prim hair cloth -chairs, with which his soiled and badly fitting garments -hardly harmonized, the old man told his story.</p> - -<p>“That boy, square, comes o’ the shif’lessest kind o’ -stock, ye know, ef his gran’father <i>was</i> my own -brother,” he said, in conclusion. “You ’member -Ezra?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_60">[60]</span>“Oh yes, I remember Ezra,” said the judge, grimly.</p> - -<p>“Wal, then, ye know what a shif’less loose j’inted -critter he was in business matters, an’ Anson an’ Horace -was as like him as two peas aout o’ the same pod. -An’ now this ’ere Brandon hez got th’ same traits o’ -no ’count shif’lessness.”</p> - -<p>“Very likely, very likely,” said the other, with sternness. -“I’ve seen the youth, I think, out gunning quite -frequently—a most objectionable practice.”</p> - -<p>“Ye’re right, square,” old Arad exclaimed, with -eagerness. “Jest er firin’ erway good powder an’ -shot ’t cost money. Thet boy hez airnt money erhelpin’ -of the neighbors lots o’ times, ter waste on -powder an’ shot. He’s a dretful bad boy.”</p> - -<p>“From what you say, neighbor,” said the judge, -with confidence, “I should say that the proper place -for the young rascal was the State reform school——”</p> - -<p>“Oh, no, no, square,” exclaimed Arad, in sudden -terror at the thought of losing Don’s services in this -way. “’Tain’t as bad as that. I kin manage him, -once give me legal ’thority.</p> - -<p>“Ye see, his pa left him ’ithout a cent, an’ I thought -it didn’t make a bit er diff’rance ’bout his havin’ a -guardeen—’twould er been some expense, ye know, -ter hev th’ papers made aout; but since he’s got this -’ere wild goose notion o’ leavin’ me, I begin ter see -that I sh’d hev some holt on him fur—hem!—fur -his own good, as it were.”</p> - -<p>“Quite right,” declared the judge confidently. -“And so the boy—this Brandon—proposes to go -away at once, does he?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_61">[61]</span>“So he has th’ audacity ter tell me,” responded old -Arad. “He declared he was goin’ termorrer mornin’. -Ye know, square, I’m too broke up ’ith the rheumatiz -ter tackle him as he’d orter be tackled. A good hidin’ -would be th’ best thing fur him, in <i>my</i> ’pinion.”</p> - -<p>“And in my opinion, too,” quoth the judge. -“Now, of course this matter will have to be done -when the court meets next week, Mr. Tarr; but I’ll -come up and see the youth tonight, and I think that -between us we can make him see that this is the place -for him to stay, and that there is to be no running -away from it,” and the judge shut his thin lips together -very grimly.</p> - -<p>“That’s it, square; thank ’ee,” said the old man, -shambling out of the house. “Dretful weather we -been havin’, ain’t it?”</p> - -<p>Then he climbed into his wagon and drove back -toward home, chuckling as he went.</p> - -<p>“I reckon I’ve put a spoke in <i>his</i> wheel,” he muttered, -referring to his nephew.</p> - -<p>As he pursued his homeward way, however, -thoughts of the sailor with whom he had so recently -conversed, and of that conversation itself, filled his -mind.</p> - -<p>“I don’t persume thet ther’s anythin’ in it,” he muttered, -thoughtfully stroking the wisp of beard on his -pointed chin. “Horace Tarr never had no luck no-how, -an’ I don’t see how he’d come ter know anythin’ -erbout this ’ere treasure. P’r’aps that sailor was -jest a yarnin’ ter me.”</p> - -<p>Still, the old man could not drive the thought out of -his mind.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_62">[62]</span>“Fabulously rich!” he repeated. “That’s what he -heard Horace say. This ’ere mate of the Silver Swan -was a chum er Horace’s, like ’nough, an’ I s’pose if -ther’ <i>is</i> anythin’ in it, he’ll jes’ try ter git it himself. -An’ then—er—Brandon’ll never see a cent of it.</p> - -<p>“It really is my duty ter look aout fur th’ boy’s -int’rest,” continued the old hypocrite. “’F I’m goin’ -ter be his guardeen, I’d orter know what’s goin’ on; -an’ this <i>may</i> mean money fur—fur Brandon.”</p> - -<p>He wiped his wrinkled brow with a soiled handkerchief, -the reins lying idly on his knee the while. -Somehow, despite the chilliness of the day, the perspiration -stood in great drops upon his forehead.</p> - -<p>“S’posin’,” he thought, “ther’ should be a letter -at Sam Himes’ fur him now, f’om that Wetherbee -feller? ’Twouldn’t no way do fur a boy ter git letters -that his guardeen didn’t know nothin’ erbout, an’ -ther’ ain’t no doubt thet, if Brandon got it, he wouldn’t -show it ter me. I—I b’lieve I’ll drive ’round thet -way an’ see.”</p> - -<p>He touched up the mare again and, upon reaching -the forks of the road, turned to the north once more -and drove along the ridge until he reached a little -gambrel roofed cottage on the westerly side of the -highway.</p> - -<p>This was the post office where Sam Himes held -forth, and to which the lumbering old stage brought -one mail each day.</p> - -<p>Here he dismounted from the wagon again, and -went into the house, being greeted at the door by the -customary “Haow air ye?” of the postmaster.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_63">[63]</span>“I was jes’ thinkin’ er sendin’ daown ter your -haouse, Arad,” declared the postmaster, who was no -respecter of persons, and called everybody by his first -name, being familiar with them from the nature of his -calling. “Here’s a letter fur yeou an’ one fur th’ boy—Don.”</p> - -<p>He thrust two missives into the old man’s hand, and -Arad stumbled out to his wagon again, his fingers -shaking with excitement. Glancing at the two envelopes -he recognized one at once, and clutched it -avariciously. It was from a brokerage firm in New -York, and contained his monthly dividend for certain -investments which he had made.</p> - -<p>The other letter, however, he did not look at until -he had turned his horse about and started her jogging -along toward home again. Then he drew forth the -envelope and studied it carefully.</p> - -<p>It was addressed in a big, scrawling hand to: -“Master Brandon Tarr, Chopmist, Rhode Island,” -yet, despite the plainness of the address, old Arad, -after a hasty and half fearful glance around, broke the -seal and drew forth the inclosed page.</p> - -<p>He looked first at the signature, and finding it to -be “Caleb Wetherbee,” he began to peruse the epistle, -looking up from time to time to glance along the road, -that nobody might catch him in the act of reading the -letter intended only for his nephew’s eye.</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad’s sight was not so keen for written -words as it once had been, but he managed to stumble -through the document, which read as follows:</p> - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_64">[64]</span></p> - -<div class="blockquot"> -<p class="right"><span class="smcap">New York Marine Hospital</span>,<br /> -<span class="indentright">April the 2d, 1892.</span></p> - -<p><span class="smcap">Master Brandon Tarr</span>,</p> - -<p><span class="smcap">Sir</span>:—As I am laid up in dry dock, as you might say, and -can’t get up to see you right off as I promised your poor -father, I am taking the first chance these swabs of doctors -have given me, to write this.</p> - -<p>Me and another man was all that was saved off the raft, -as you probably know now, for your father was hurt so bad -that there wasn’t any chance for him. He died ten days after -we left the brig.</p> - -<p>I want you should pack up your togs, leave that farm -where no son of Captain Horace Tarr ought to dig all his -life, and come down here to New York to see me. I shall -be out of this hospital before long, and then we’ve got some -work to do, like I promised your father before he died.</p> - -<p>Captain Tarr put some papers in my hands which is of -great value, providing they can be used at once. It seems -your uncle Anson died several months ago in Kimberley, -South Africa, and while he was at Cape Town loading up -the brig, a fellow come aboard and told your father about it, -and brung these papers.</p> - -<p>Among the papers (though the fellow didn’t know it, so I -understood from the few words poor Captain Tarr let drop) -was a package of diamonds which he hid aboard the old brig, -and was afraid to take with him on the raft for fear of the -sailors that was with us. These papers I’ve got he said -would tell where the diamonds was hid. I ain’t opened them -yet, so I don’t know.</p> - -<p>Now you may think this here is no use because the Silver -Swan is wrecked; but I don’t believe she has gone to pieces -yet; nor your father didn’t think she would right off. We -would have done better by sticking to her, any way, I reckon. -She was driv upright onto the reef, and I’ll bet she’s sticking -there yet.</p> - -<p>If you come down here to once, and I can get onto my old -timber leg again, we’ll charter a boat and go down there and -see about it. If it is as your father said—and I believe it—there’s<span class="pagenum" id="Page_65">[65]</span> -enough of them diamonds to make you another Vanderbilt -or Jay Gould.</p> - -<p>Just you leave the land shark of an uncle that you’re staying -with, and trust yourself to</p> - -<p class="right"><span class="indentright2">Your true friend,</span><br /> -<span class="indentright"><span class="smcap">Caleb Wetherbee</span>,</span><br /> -Mate of the Silver Swan.</p> -</div> - - - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_66">[66]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER VIII<br /> - - -<small>SOMETHING ABOUT LEAVING THE FARM</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Certainly</span> Uncle Arad Tarr had never been so -filled with astonishment in his life as he was upon -reading the letter of the mate of the Silver Swan to -the captain’s son.</p> - -<p>Diamonds enough to make Brandon a second Vanderbilt! -The thought almost made Arad’s old heart -stand still.</p> - -<p>“Who’d er-thought it—who’d ever er-thought -it?” he muttered weakly, folding the letter once more, -and thrusting it into the pocket of his patched coat.</p> - -<p>Then he picked up the reins and drove on, shaking -his head slowly.</p> - -<p>“Diamonds enough ter make him rich!” he murmured, -with an avaricious contortion of his face. -“Jest ter think o’ Anson Tarr ever gittin’ more’n his -bread and butter. It don’t seem ter me he c’d ha’ got -’em honest.”</p> - -<p>He was very ready now, considering the guilty -thoughts there were in his own heart, to declare the -fortune gained by his nephew Anson to be dishonestly -obtained.</p> - -<p>“It jest stands ter reason,” he went on, “that this -’ere Caleb Wetherbee isn’t er—er trustworthy person -to hev charge o’ Brandon—or them di’monds either.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_67">[67]</span> -I mus’ hev them papers made out jes’ as soon as th’ -square kin do it, an’ then I kin find that ’ere wreck—er -hev it found—m’self.”</p> - -<p>His mind at once reverted to Jim Leroyd, the sailor -with whom he had entered into a compact to “divide -the spoils,” and he shook his head again doubtfully.</p> - -<p>“He ain’t jes’ th’ man I’d er chosen ter do th’ work -fur me,” muttered the old sinner; “but then, he’s the -old sailor I know, an’ it’s got ter take a sailor, I -s’pose, ter go ter them furrin parts.</p> - -<p>“He knows suthin’ erbout it already, too, an’ it -wouldn’t do ter let him git mad an’ go an’ tell this -’ere Wetherbee; then mebbe I couldn’t git th’ papers -from him. But th’ fust thing is ter hev thet ’p’intment -as guardeen fixed up.”</p> - -<p>Brandon was in the yard when he arrived, and -good naturedly put up the horse for him.</p> - -<p>“I’ve seen Mrs. Hemingway, uncle,” he said cheerfully, -“and she’ll be up here tomorrow morning. I -shall take the stage to town in the morning, and go to -New York on the evening train, I guess.”</p> - -<p>“Ye will, eh?” returned Uncle Arad, showing his -teeth.</p> - -<p>“Yes. Now you mustn’t get uppish, uncle. You -didn’t suppose I would stay here very long any way, -did you?”</p> - -<p>“I s’pect ye’ll stay here a spell,” replied the old -man, with a cunning leer. “I ain’t fed an’ su’ported -ye in lux’ry fur nigh four year fur nothin’. Ye’ll -stay here as my ward fur yer minor’ty, now I tell ye.”</p> - -<p>But Brandon was laughing over the thought of<span class="pagenum" id="Page_68">[68]</span> -Uncle Arad’s “luxury,” and did not hear the last of -his speech.</p> - -<p>He did the most of the chores about the house and -barn, as was usual, and helped prepare the extremely -frugal meal which Uncle Arad’s larder afforded.</p> - -<p>“By George!” he thought, as he set about this latter -task, “if I was in the forecastle of some old -‘hooker’ I shouldn’t have worse fare than this. I -declare I’ll go off tomorrow before breakfast. This -will be my last meal at Uncle Arad’s table for one -spell at least.”</p> - -<p>But he said nothing further about going away, -knowing that it would only anger the old man. Before -the dishes were cleared away after the meal, there -was the sound of wheels at the gate, and in a moment -somebody knocked sharply.</p> - -<p>Old Arad himself arose and hobbled to the door, -admitting “Square” Holt into the miserable den of -a kitchen. If it had been the President himself, the -old man would not have opened the “best room.”</p> - -<p>“Go aout an’ take the square’s boss ’roun’ ter the -shed,” harshly commanded Uncle Arad, and Brandon -did as he was bidden, vaguely suspecting that something -was brewing.</p> - -<p>When he came into the kitchen again after doing -the errand, the parrot beaked judge was ready for him.</p> - -<p>“Young man,” began the judge severely, “your -uncle, Mr. Tarr, who has done so much for you for -the past four years, tells me that you have made a -sorry return for all his kindness and bounty.”</p> - -<p>“In what?” demanded Brandon rather sharply, for<span class="pagenum" id="Page_69">[69]</span> -he considered this interference on the justice’s part -as wholly uncalled for.</p> - -<p>“Is <i>that</i> the way you speak to your elders, young -man?” cried the judge, aghast. “Have you no respect -for gray hairs?”</p> - -<p>“I do not see why I should respect <i>you</i>, Mr. Holt,” -replied Don, with some temper. “You’ve never given -me cause to and I consider that your questions and -remarks are entirely unwarranted. I propose to go -away from my uncle’s house (to whom, by the way, -my father paid three dollars per week board for me -up to last fall, and for whom I have done the work -of a regularly hired hand during most of the time I -have been here) I propose to go away, I say, and -nothing <i>you</i> or uncle can say will stop me!”</p> - -<p>“Hoighty toighty, young man!” cried the judge; -“do you realize to whom you are speaking?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I do,” responded Brandon hotly. “To one -who is known, far and wide, as the meanest man in -Scituate!”</p> - -<p>The judge’s ample nasal organ flushed to the color -of a well grown beet; but before he could reply old -Arad put in <i>his</i> oar:</p> - -<p>“What d’ye mean, ye little upstart?” (Fancy his -calling Brandon <i>little</i>, who already stood a good three -inches taller than himself!) “What d’ye mean, sayin’ -that I was ever paid fur yer keep? Ye’ve been nuthin’ -but an expense an’ trouble ter me ever since ye come -here.”</p> - -<p>“That’s an untruth, and you know it,” declared -Don, who had quite lost his temper by this time, and -did not behave himself in just the manner I should<span class="pagenum" id="Page_70">[70]</span> -have preferred my hero to behave; but Brandon Tarr -was a very human boy, and, I have found, heroes are -much like other folks and not by any means perfect.</p> - -<p>“Young man, mark my words!” sputtered -“Square” Holt, “you will yet come to some bad -end.”</p> - -<p>“I’ll git all this aout o’ ye, afore I’m done with ye, -Brandon Tarr,” declared Uncle Arad, “if I hev ter -hire somebody ter lick ye.”</p> - -<p>“You wouldn’t do that—you’re too stingy to hire -anybody to ‘lick’ me,” responded Don tartly. “Now -I don’t propose to listen to any more of this foolishness. -I’m going away, and I’m going away tomorrow -morning. I’ve eaten my last meal at this house, -Uncle Arad!”</p> - -<p>“Is that the way to speak to your guardian?” said -the judge, with horror in his tone. “Mr. Tarr, you -are too lenient with this young scoundrel. He should -be sent to the State reform school as I suggested.”</p> - -<p>“But then I wouldn’t get no work aout o’ him,” -the farmer hastened to say. “I—I’ve got ter git the -money back I’ve spent on him, ye know.”</p> - -<p>Brandon laughed scornfully.</p> - -<p>“I should like to know by what right you call him -my guardian, Mr. Holt?” he asked.</p> - -<p>“Wal, I’m goin’ ter be yer guardeen—right off,” -Arad hastened to inform him, before the “square” -could reply. “The square’s goin’ ter make the papers -aout ter oncet.”</p> - -<p>“They’ll be funny looking documents, I reckon,” -said Don, in disgust. “I understand that Mr. Holt<span class="pagenum" id="Page_71">[71]</span> -has done several pretty crooked things since he’s been -in office, but this is going a little too far.”</p> - -<p>“Young man!” cried the judge, trying to wither -the audacious youth with a glance.</p> - -<p>But Don didn’t “wither” at all.</p> - -<p>“If you know anything at all about law,” he said -to the judge, with sarcasm, “you know that a guardian -can’t be appointed in an hour. Legal notice -must be given and reason shown <i>why</i> a guardian -should be appointed. I’ve no property, and Uncle -Arad only wants to control me so as to have my work. -And, besides all that, I am old enough to choose my -own guardian, and you can bet your last cent that I -shouldn’t choose Arad Tarr.”</p> - -<p>“It ain’t so! ’tain’t no sich thing, is it, square?” -cried old Arad, in alarm. “Ain’t I th’ proper person -to be ’p’inted over my own nevvy? Ther’ ain’t nobody -else got anythin’ ter do with it.”</p> - -<p>“He can tell you what he likes,” responded Brandon -quickly; “but I’ve given you the facts. Now -I’ve heard enough of this, and I’m going to bed.” -Then he added, turning to Holt: “When you go out -to fleece a lamb next time, Mr. Holt, be pretty sure -that the lamb is just as innocent as you think it.”</p> - -<p>He turned away without another word then and -left the kitchen, mounting to his bedroom in the second -story of the old house, leaving the baffled conspirators -in a state of wrathful bewilderment.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_72">[72]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER IX<br /> - - -<small>ANOTHER LETTER FROM NEW YORK</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Mr. Tarr</span>,” declared the judge, when Brandon -had, for the moment, so successfully routed them and -retired, “you are doing a very wrong thing in shielding -that young reprobate from the reform school. -That’s where he belongs. Send him there, sir, send -him there!”</p> - -<p>“I never thought he’d ha’ shown disrespect fur the -law,” gasped Uncle Arad weakly.</p> - -<p>“Disrespect!” cried the judge, “I never was so -insulted in all my life. That boy will be hung yet, -you mark my words!”</p> - -<p>“I never thought it of Brandon,” said the farmer, -shaking his head.</p> - -<p>He seemed quite overcome to think that his nephew -had dared defy the law, or its representative. To -Uncle Arad the law was a very sacred thing; he always -aimed to keep within its pale in his transactions.</p> - -<p>“You’ll never be able to do anything with that boy -here,” declared “Square” Holt. “A strait jacket is -the only thing for him.”</p> - -<p>“But if he goes there what’ll be the use o’ my bein’ -his guardeen?” queried Arad.</p> - -<p>Then he hesitated an instant as a new phase of the -situation came to him.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_73">[73]</span>“If Brandon was under lock an’ key—jes’ where -I c’d put my han’ on him when I wanted him—I c’d -go right erbout this ’ere treasure business, an’ git it -fur—fur <i>him</i>,” he thought, yet shivering in his soul -at the thought of the wrong he was planning to do his -nephew.</p> - -<p>“I—I dunno but ye’re right, square,” he said -quaveringly. “I—I don’ wanter see th’ boy go right -ter perdition, ’fore my very eyes, as ye might say, -an’ if ye think the reformin’ influences o’ the institution -is what he needs——”</p> - -<p>“The best thing in the world for him,” declared the -judge, drawing on his driving gloves. “The <i>only</i> -thing, I might say, that will keep him out of jail—where -he belongs, the young villain!”</p> - -<p>“But—but haow kin it be fixed up?” asked Arad, -in some doubt.</p> - -<p>“You leave that to me,” said the judge pompously. -“I’ll show that young reprobate that he has defied the -wrong man when he defies <i>me</i>. I’ll give him all the -law he wants—more, perhaps, than he bargained -for.”</p> - -<p>“But s’pose he tries to run away in th’ mornin’, as -he threatened?”</p> - -<p>“All you’ve got to do, Mr. Tarr,” said the judge, -shaking one long finger at the farmer, “is to keep a -close watch on that young man. Don’t give him a -chance to run away. Lock him into his room tonight -and keep him there till we can—er, hem!—straighten -this out. I think it will be a very easy matter to place -the case before the court in such manner that the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_74">[74]</span> -necessity for immediate action will be at once admitted.</p> - -<p>“Why,” declared the judge, warming up to his -subject, “I wonder, sir, how you—an old man” (Uncle -Arad winced at that), “and in feeble health—have -been able to remain here alone with that young -scoundrel all this winter. I wonder that he has not -laid violent hands on you.”</p> - -<p>“Wal, he <i>has</i> been some abusive, square, but I -wouldn’t say nothin’ erbout that,” said Uncle Arad -hesitatingly.</p> - -<p>“Don’t compound villainy by shielding it,” responded -the judge, with righteous indignation. -“This matter has already gone too far. When our -quiet town is to be aroused and made a scene of riot, -such as has been enacted—er—<i>here</i> tonight, sir, it -is time something was done. Such young hoodlums -as this Brandon Tarr should be shut up where they -will do no harm to either their friends or neighbors.</p> - -<p>“If I had <i>my</i> way,” added the judge viciously, -“I’d shut up every boy in town in the reform school!”</p> - -<p>Then he marched out to his carriage, and Uncle -Arad, after locking the door, sat down to think the -matter over.</p> - -<p>If he was successful in his nefarious plan of shutting -Brandon up in the reformatory institution of the -State, the getting of the diamonds, which Captain -Tarr had hidden aboard the Silver Swan, would be all -plain sailing.</p> - -<p>Of course he would have to lose Brandon’s work -on the farm; but he had seen, by the boy’s open defiance -of “Square” Holt, that he cared nothing for<span class="pagenum" id="Page_75">[75]</span> -the law or its minion—and Uncle Arad dared not allow -his nephew out of his sight for fear he would run -away.</p> - -<p>To <i>his</i> mind there was very little doubt that the attempt -to shut Brandon up would be successful. Judge -Holt was a most powerful man (politically) in the -town, and he would leave no stone unturned to punish -the youth who had so fearlessly defied him.</p> - -<p>Judge Holt, although disliked by many of his -townsmen who realized that some of his methods and -actions were illegal, still swayed the town on election -days, and carried things with a high hand the remainder -of the year. Old Arad chuckled to think how -easily Brandon’s case would be settled by the doughty -“square.”</p> - -<p>Then, remembering the suggestion the judge had -made just before his departure, he rose hastily from -his chair and quietly ascended to the floor above. -Here Brandon and himself slept in two small bedrooms -on opposite sides of the hall.</p> - -<p>The doors were directly opposite each other, and, -although such things as locks were unknown in the -house on any except the outside doors, the old man -quickly lit upon a scheme that he thought remarkably -clever.</p> - -<p>He obtained a piece of stout clothes line and fastened -it back and forth from handle to handle of the -two bedroom doors, which, opening into their respective -rooms, were now arranged so that the occupants -of neither apartment could open the portals.</p> - -<p>Then, chuckling softly over his sharp trick, the old -farmer crept down the stairs once more to the kitchen,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_76">[76]</span> -feeling moderately sure of finding Brandon in his -room in the morning.</p> - -<p>But one narrow window, looking out upon the -barnyard, was in his nephew’s apartment, and as the -sash had long since been nailed in, and the shutters -closed on the outside, Uncle Arad felt secure on this -score.</p> - -<p>“I’ll starve him inter submission, ef I can’t do it -no other way,” he muttered angrily.</p> - -<p>Seating himself once more in his old armchair, he -drew forth the two letters obtained that day at the post -office, adjusted his steel bowed spectacles which, in -a moment of extravagance, he had purchased of a -traveling peddler, and opened the epistle from his -brokers which, heretofore, he had not read.</p> - -<p>He slit the envelope carefully with the blade of his -jack knife. More than one man had torn or otherwise -mutilated a check by opening an envelope too carelessly.</p> - -<p>But instead of the printed form and generous draft -which was the usual monthly inclosure of the firm, -all the envelope contained was a typewritten letter, -which the old farmer read with something like horror:</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> -<p class="right"><span class="indentright5">Office of</span><br /> -<span class="indentright3"><span class="smcap">Bensell, Bensell</span> & <span class="smcap">Marsden</span>,</span><br /> -<span class="indentright">513 Wall St., New York,</span><br /> -April 2, 1892.</p> - -<p><span class="smcap">Mr. Arab Tarr,<br /> -<span class="indentleft4">Chopmist, Rhode Island.</span></span></p> - -<p>Dear Sir:</p> - -<p>We beg to announce that owing to several accidents, causing -a large loss of rolling stock of the road, the B. P. & Q.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_77">[77]</span> -has dropped several points on the market and has passed its -monthly dividend.</p> - -<p>We would suggest that you hold on to your stock, however, -as this is a matter which will quickly adjust itself.</p> - -<p class="right"><span class="indentright5">Yours sincerely,</span><br /> -<span class="smcap">Bensell, Bensell</span> & <span class="smcap">Marsden</span>.</p> -</div> - -<p>The letter fluttered to the floor from Uncle Arad’s -nerveless fingers. To lose money was like losing his -very life, and this was no inconsiderable sum that had -gone. He had invested a large amount in B. P. & Q. -stock, and up to the present time it had paid large interest.</p> - -<p>“Them brokers air thieves! I know they be,” -cried the old man, breaking forth into vituperations -against the innocent firm of Bensell, Bensell & Marsden. -“Ye can’t trust ’em—not an inch! I don’t -b’lieve none o’ their lyin’ stories erbout the railroad’s -passin’ its div’dend. I—I’ll go ter New York m’self, -I declare I will!”</p> - -<p>He got up and paced the floor wrathfully.</p> - -<p>“Jes’ as soon as I git this matter o’ Brandon’s settled, -an’ git th’ farm work started with Jim Hemin’way -fur foreman, I’ll go. I ain’t er-goin’ ter be -cheated bare faced like this ’ere.”</p> - -<p>Then he thought a moment, and pulling Caleb -Wetherbee’s letter from its envelope again, read it -once more carefully.</p> - -<p>“I—I might look inter this w’ile I was there too,” -he muttered slowly. “I reckon I kin fin’ thet feller -I saw terday—Leroyd, his name was, an’ his address -was New England Hotel, Water Street. I shan’t furgit -thet right off.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_78">[78]</span>He shook his head slowly, thrust both letters into -his pocket, and then shambled off to bed in the room -off the kitchen as, having locked his nephew in, he -had also locked himself <i>out</i> of his usual bed chamber.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_79">[79]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER X<br /> - - -<small>BRANDON’S ARRIVAL AT THE METROPOLIS</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Long</span> habit had made Uncle Arad Tarr an extremely -early riser, and it had been his custom to -arouse Brandon as early as half past three or four -during the summer months, and never later than five-thirty -in winter. On the morning after he had fastened -the door of his nephew’s room, however, the -old man did not seek to disturb the boy, but rising -himself before five he went about the customary duties -of the house and barn.</p> - -<p>In this work he missed Brandon sadly; but having -made up his mind that the boy was bound to leave -him any way, old Arad was determined that he -should go to the reform school, and therefore he -would have to learn to do without his valuable services.</p> - -<p>To his unsophisticated mind, it seemed a very simple -matter indeed for a powerful local politician like -“Square” Holt to send his nephew to the State reformatory -institution, “and no questions asked.”</p> - -<p>But under our present system of humane laws, and -with our enlightened legal executives, an undeserved -incarceration in prison or reform school is seldom -known—outside of story books. Judge Holt was a -large man in his own community (and in his own estimation)<span class="pagenum" id="Page_80">[80]</span> -but he had never been beyond that community -far enough to learn how very small a man he -really was.</p> - -<p>After the arduous labor of feeding the stock and -poultry, drawing water and bringing in wood, old -Arad hardly felt equal to either the task of preparing -breakfast, or eating the same; but he did at last sit -down to what he termed “a cold snack” about seven -o’clock.</p> - -<p>“That ’ere boy sleeps like a pig,” he muttered, -with a groan, twisting about in his chair to get an -easy position for his rheumatic limbs. “I wonder -he hain’t begun er-kickin’ on th’ door, er suthin’, yit.”</p> - -<p>At that moment there was a noise behind him, and -turning about he beheld the subject of his thoughts -standing in the doorway leading to the floor above.</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad gave a shout expressing surprise and -anger, and sprang to his feet. Brandon had been surveying -him coolly, with a smile on his face, and now he -laughed outright.</p> - -<p>“Good morning, uncle,” he said.</p> - -<p>He was fully dressed in his best suit, hat, overcoat -and all, and carried a traveling bag in his hand.</p> - -<p>“How—how did ye git aout?” sputtered Uncle -Arad, in wonder.</p> - -<p>“How did I get out?”</p> - -<p>“Yes—haow did ye git aouto’ yer room?” cried -the old man.</p> - -<p>“I wasn’t in, therefore I didn’t have to get out,” responded -Brandon calmly.</p> - -<p>“Ye warn’t in?” repeated his bewildered relative.</p> - -<p>“That’s what I said. I wasn’t in. When you<span class="pagenum" id="Page_81">[81]</span> -crawled up stairs last night and took all that trouble -with the clothes line, I wasn’t in my room at all. I -expected some such delicate attention as that on your -part, uncle, so I took the trouble to remove my things -to the spare room at the other end of the hall, and -slept there.”</p> - -<p>The farmer fairly gnashed his teeth in rage.</p> - -<p>“Where be yeou goin’?” he demanded, planting -himself between his nephew and the door.</p> - -<p>“Why, uncle, I thought you knew that,” said Brandon, -raising his eyebrows in apparent surprise. “I -told you last night that I was going to New York. -I haven’t changed my mind since then, though I’ve -modified my plans somewhat. It’s such a pleasant -morning, I believe I’ll walk down to Rockland, take -the stage from there to Hope, and go to town on the -train.”</p> - -<p>“Yeou will, hey? Wal, I guess not!”</p> - -<p>Old Arad backed up against the door as though to -guard that way of escape. His lean form was trembling -with excitement, and he was really in a pitiable -state for so old a man.</p> - -<p>“Think not, eh?” said Brandon coolly.</p> - -<p>He came into the kitchen and deposited his traveling -bag on a chair, and then stepped across the room -and took his rifle down from the two hooks upon -which it rested.</p> - -<p>Old Arad uttered a shout of alarm and darted away -from the door to the opposite side of the table.</p> - -<p>“Goodness me! would you shoot me?” he gasped, -fairly white to his lips.</p> - -<p>“Don’t be a fool, uncle,” responded Brandon with<span class="pagenum" id="Page_82">[82]</span> -asperity, opening the hall door again and bringing in -a gun case which had been standing in the corner of -the other apartment. “The rifle isn’t loaded, and, -besides, what do you suppose I’d want to shoot you -for?”</p> - -<p>“Oh, you young villain, you!” groaned old Arad, -paying for his agile movements of the moment before -by several rheumatic twinges.</p> - -<p>“Thanks! Well, uncle, I guess I’ll be off. I don’t -suppose you’ll shake hands with a fellow?” and Brandon -stopped, with his hand on the door latch.</p> - -<p>“I’ll have ye a’rested afore ye git ter Rockland!” -the old man shouted, shaking his clenched fist at him.</p> - -<p>“You’d better not try it,” the boy declared, with -flashing eyes.</p> - -<p>Arad followed him outside, sputtering.</p> - -<p>“Ye’ll live ter rue this day, ye young villain!” he -cried. “I’ll show ye no mercy.”</p> - -<p>“All right; it’s all the same to me,” Brandon returned, -and whistling cheerfully, he went out of the -gate and started down the road with his burden of -traveling bag and gun case.</p> - -<p>It was a beautiful morning, despite the rain of the -day before. True, there were puddles of muddy water -standing in the road and patches of dirty snow in -the fence corners and under the hedges. But these -drawbacks did not serve to cloud either the clear azure -sky or Brandon’s bright hopes.</p> - -<p>Looking back at the old farm house once, before -turning the bend in the road, he had a glimpse of old -Arad driving furiously out of the yard.</p> - -<p>“He is going to see his familiar spirit, Holt,” muttered<span class="pagenum" id="Page_83">[83]</span> -Don, with a smile, “and lots of good may it -do him. I’ll be in town before they catch me, and -Judge Ebenezer Holt isn’t anywhere near as big a -man in town as he is here. I’ll risk all the harm they -can do me now.”</p> - -<p>He arrived at Rockland in time for the stage to -Hope, and at the latter village took the train for Providence. -Neither his uncle nor Holt had appeared, and -he made up his mind that he was well rid of them.</p> - -<p>Once aboard the cars he settled himself back in -his seat, and drew forth the scrap of newspaper which -had dropped from the old sailor’s note case the day -before. He read it through again carefully.</p> - -<p>“I’ve got nearly fifty dollars (wouldn’t uncle be -crazy if he knew it?) and although that isn’t a fortune, -still it ought to keep me for some time,” he -thought. “But, the question is, after I pump all I -can out of that Wetherbee, what had I better do?”</p> - -<p>He mused a moment in silence, and then took up the -connected train of his reflections again.</p> - -<p>“Fifty dollars ought to last me quite a spell—and -take me quite a way, too. Of course, I can’t hire a -boat in New York to go in search of the Silver Swan -with it; but I can watch the Hydrographic Office reports, -and find out in what general direction the brig’s -headed. Then I’ll get as near to her as possible and -see—what I shall see!</p> - -<p>“I’d give a cent” (probably he would have given -a good deal more) “if this Wetherbee was a different -sort of a man. It’s a mystery to me how father -ever trusted the fellow. I always supposed that<span class="pagenum" id="Page_84">[84]</span> -father had a keen insight into human nature; but a -man will be deceived at times, I suppose.</p> - -<p>“But I won’t let this treasure idea keep me from -going to work, and working hard, too. If I don’t -get the money, why I don’t want to be roaming about -the world like Uncle Anson, with nothing to do in -life but hunt for wealth. I believe I’ll get a place -on some vessel any way, for there’s a good deal of -the sailor in me as there was in father. We get it -from grandfather’s folks—the Brandons—I suppose.”</p> - -<p>He arrived at Providence before noon, and spent -the time until evening in looking about the business -portion, of the city, and especially about the wharves. -Then late in the afternoon he took the cars for New -York, arriving in the metropolis at such an hour that -to go to a hotel near the station seemed necessary.</p> - -<p>Although a country boy by bringing up, Brandon -was not easily disturbed by the magnitude of life in -the great city. In fact, he rather enjoyed it, and -after retiring to his room at the hotel, he went to sleep -without one apprehensive thought of what the morrow -might bring forth.</p> - - -<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_084.jpg" alt="" /></div> -<p class="caption">“GOODNESS ME! WOULD YOU SHOOT ME?”</p> - - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_85">[85]</span> -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XI<br /> - - -<small>THE FIRM OF ADONIRAM PEPPER & CO.</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Leaving</span> his bag and gun case at the hotel. Brandon -Tarr started out by nine o’clock on the following -morning, his first aim being to find and interview the -sailor who had already visited Chopmist for the purpose -of seeing him.</p> - -<p>“Caleb Wetherbee, New England Hotel. Water -Street,” was the address, and after considerable inquiry -he found the street in question.</p> - -<p>It was, however, the Battery end of it and no one -seemed to know anything about the New England -Hotel. Still, Don was not dismayed and pursued his -way, keeping his eyes open and himself alert among -the many new sights and sounds of the metropolis.</p> - -<p>The locality grew worse as he pursued his way, but -he was not to be frightened off by gangs of street -gamins, or crowds of half drunken men. Still, in -these days, Water Street isn’t as bad as it was once—at -least, not by daylight.</p> - -<p>As he wandered along he could see down the cross -streets to the wharves and water beyond, where all -sorts and conditions of seagoing craft were gathered -from all parts of the world. He sniffed the sea breeze, -too, which, to him, killed all the odor of the filth about -him.</p> - -<p>“That’s what I want to be—a sailor,” he muttered.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_86">[86]</span>Just then something caught his eye and he stopped -motionless on the sidewalk.</p> - -<p>On the opposite side of the street (the river side) -as though crowded off Front Street by its more pretentious -neighbors, was the office of a shipping firm. -It was in a low brick building, dingy and dirty as were -the structures about it, and a much battered sign over -the door read:</p> - -<p class="center">ADONIRAM PEPPER & CO.,<br /> -SHIPPING MERCHANTS.</p> - -<p>The name was what attracted Brandon’s attention -first. He had heard his father speak of it and of the -man who was “Adoniram Pepper & Co.,” and from -his description he had a desire to see this eccentric -personage.</p> - -<p>Perhaps, also, Mr. Pepper would know the locality -of the New England Hotel, and therefore Brandon -crossed the street and entered the dingy little front -office.</p> - -<p>On a high stool by a high desk just beside the window, -sat a man with a wonderful development of leg, -a terrific shock of the reddest hair imaginable, and a -shrewd, lean face, lit up by sharp, foxy eyes. His -face was smoothly shaven and the yellow skin was -covered with innumerable wrinkles like cracks in the -cheeks of a wax doll; but whether this individual was -twenty-five, or fifty-five, Brandon was unable to -guess.</p> - -<p>The man (a clerk, presumably) looked up with a -snarl at Brandon’s appearance.</p> - -<p>“Well, what do <i>you</i> want?” he demanded.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_87">[87]</span>“Is the firm in?” asked Don, almost laughing in -the other’s face, for the red haired clerk had a huge -daub of ink on the bridge of his nose and another on -his shirt front.</p> - -<p>“<i>I’m</i> the firm just now,” declared the man, glowering -at him as though he was a South Sea Islander -with cannibalistic tendencies.</p> - -<p>“Oh, you are, eh?” returned Brandon. “Well, I -want to see Mr. Pepper.”</p> - -<p>“You do, eh?” The clerk eyed him with still -greater disfavor. “You do, eh? Well you can’t see -Mr. Pepper.”</p> - -<p>“Why not?”</p> - -<p>“Well, for one reason he isn’t here—he ain’t down -yet—he’s gone away—he’s <i>dead</i>!”</p> - -<p>He slammed down his pen and jumped off the high -stool.</p> - -<p>“Git out o’ here you little rapscallion!” he roared, -evidently expecting Brandon to be frightened by his -vehemence. “We don’t allow no loafing ’round this -office. Git, I say, or——”</p> - -<p>At that instant the street door behind the amused -Brandon was opened, and with one glance at the -newcomer the clerk’s jaws shut together like a trap, -he turned about and bounded to his seat on the stool -with great ability, and seizing his pen went to work on -his books with monstrous energy.</p> - -<p>Brandon turned about also, surprised at these proceedings, -and found a short, pudgy looking little man -standing in the doorway of the office, gazing at the -clerk with a broad smile on his red face; but upon -looking closer the boy discovered that, although the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_88">[88]</span> -mouth was smiling, the gentleman’s eyes were very -stern indeed behind the gold rimmed eye glasses.</p> - -<p>“What is the meaning of this unseemly conduct, -Weeks?” he asked in a tone of displeasure.</p> - -<p>“I—I was just showin’ this—this young friend of -mine how—how a feller up to the Bow’ry acted -t’other night,” murmured the clerk, a sort of ghastly -red color mounting into his withered face beneath the -parchment-like skin.</p> - -<p>“The Bowery?” repeated the gentleman, severely, -and Brandon decided that this was no other than Mr. -Adoniram Pepper himself.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir; Bowery Theater, you know,” responded -the clerk glibly, with an imploring side glance at -Brandon. “’Twas in the play, ‘The Buccaneer’s -Bride,’ you know.”</p> - -<p>“No, I <i>don’t</i> know,” replied Mr. Pepper, in disgust. -“So this is your friend, is it?” and he turned -his gaze upon Brandon genially.</p> - -<p>“Our friendship is of rather short duration,” said -Don, smiling.</p> - -<p>“So I presume,” returned Mr. Pepper. “Did you -wish to see me?”</p> - -<p>“Just a moment, sir.”</p> - -<p>“I’ll give you two moments if you like.” Then he -turned again to the clerk and shook one fat finger at -him. “One of these days I’ll discharge you, Weeks,” -he said sternly.</p> - -<p>“I expect so,” groaned the clerk. “And then -what’ll I do?”</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper looked at him a moment silently.</p> - -<p>“Then you’ll go and lie somewhere else, I suppose. -You <i>will</i> lie, Alfred Weeks, and I suppose I might as<span class="pagenum" id="Page_89">[89]</span> -well keep you here and let you lie to me, as to turn -you loose upon your fellow men. Well, well! Now, -young man;” he turned with a sigh from the clerk -and again looked at Brandon.</p> - -<p>“I suppose you are Mr. Pepper?” began Brandon.</p> - -<p>“I—sup—pose—I—am,” replied the gentleman, -with great care, scrutinizing the face of the captain’s -son with marked interest.</p> - -<p>“Let’s see, what is your name?” he said: “or, no, -you needn’t tell me. I know it already. Your name -is Tarr, and you are Captain Horace Tarr’s son!”</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir, I am,” Brandon replied in surprise.</p> - -<p>“I knew it, I knew it!” declared Mr. Pepper, shaking -both the boy’s hands so violently that the eye -glasses, which had a hard enough time generally in -staying on the little man’s nose, tumbled off, and were -only caught and saved from destruction by great -agility on Mr. Pepper’s part.</p> - -<p>“My dear boy! I’d have known you if I’d met -you in Timbuctoo!” he declared. “Come into my office -and tell me all about yourself. I’ve been thinking -about you ever since—er—your poor father’s death. -I’ve got something to tell you, too.”</p> - -<p>He led Brandon toward the inner door, marked -“Private,” and opening it, disclosed a comfortably -furnished room with a fire in the grate, and a general -air of cheerfulness about it.</p> - -<p>“Come right in,” he repeated, and then shut the -door behind his visitor.</p> - -<p>But no sooner was the door closed than the acrobatic -clerk was off his stool, and had his ear fitted to -the keyhole with a celerity which denoted much practice -in the art of eavesdropping.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_90">[90]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XII<br /> - - -<small>IN WHICH BRANDON VENTURES INTO RATHER DISREPUTABLE -SOCIETY</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">My</span> dear boy, sit down!” exclaimed Mr. Pepper, -motioning Brandon to a chair. “Sit down and let -me look at you.”</p> - -<p>He himself took a chair at a desk by the window -and studied the boy intently for several moments. -Meanwhile Brandon was making a mental examination -of the shipping merchant as well.</p> - -<p>Adoniram Pepper was a little, rotund man with a -good deal of color in his face and very little hair on -his head. His mouth was always smiling, but at -times, as Brandon had already seen, the gray eves -could be very stern indeed behind the gold rimmed -glasses, which latter had such hard work remaining -upon Mr. Pepper’s squat nose.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir, you are the perfect picture of your -father,” declared the shipping merchant at last. “I -thought when I read of his death that we should never -see his like again; but you have the promise of all -his outward characteristics, at least. I hope you’ve -his inner ones, too.”</p> - -<p>“I hope so,” replied Brandon, pleased indeed at -such praise of his father.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_91">[91]</span>“He was a good man,” continued Mr. Pepper ruminatively. -“By the way, what’s your name?”</p> - -<p>“Brandon, sir.”</p> - -<p>“Oh yes, I remember now. Your father talked to -me of you. He wanted you to follow the sea, too, and -I suppose that is what you’ve come down here to New -York for, eh?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I hope to go to sea,” responded Brandon -slowly.</p> - -<p>Had he not remembered his experience with Caleb -Wetherbee, without doubt Brandon would have opened -his heart to the eccentric merchant and told him all; -but bearing in mind the (to him) evident treachery of -the mate of the Silver Swan, he was not ready to take -into his confidence every friend of his father who happened -to turn up.</p> - -<p>“I thought so, I thought so!” exclaimed Mr. Pepper, -rubbing his fat hands softly together. “The sea, -by all means, my boy. That’s where I’ve obtained my -living—and something beside—for many years, -though in a little different way from your father. -Captain Tarr commanded one of my vessels before he -purchased the Silver Swan.”</p> - -<p>“Yes, so he has told me,” responded Brandon.</p> - -<p>“It was a sad thing—his loss at sea,” said Mr. -Pepper.</p> - -<p>He still smiled, but there was moisture on his eye -glasses, and he removed and wiped them gently on a -silk handkerchief.</p> - -<p>“And he left you hardly a penny’s worth?” he -continued interrogatively.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_92">[92]</span>“I have only about fifty dollars,” Brandon replied -briefly.</p> - -<p>“Only fifty dollars,” repeated the shipping merchant -softly. “Not much—more than I had, though, when -I went out to seek my fortune; but I had friends—powerful -friends—and so have you, Brandon.”</p> - -<p>“Not many of them, I fancy,” Don returned, smiling.</p> - -<p>“Not many, perhaps: but <i>some</i>,” the other declared -with confidence, “and one of them is Adoniram Pepper.”</p> - -<p>“Thank you, Mr. Pepper,” said Don. “I hope I -shall be worthy of your kindness.”</p> - -<p>“No doubt of that—no doubt of that,” rejoined -the merchant, beaming upon him benignantly. “But -to <i>talk</i> isn’t enough for Adoniram Pepper; I want to -<i>do</i> something for you, my boy.”</p> - -<p>“I—I don’t know just what you can do for me, -sir,” said Brandon doubtfully.</p> - -<p>“Don’t know? Why, you want to go to sea, don’t -you?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir; I think I do.”</p> - -<p>“Then I <i>can</i> help you,” declared the merchant. -“I’ve several vessels—three are in port at the present -time—and it will be strange indeed if I can’t find -a berth on one of them for you.”</p> - -<p>“But I’m no sailor yet; I’ve got to learn,” objected -Don.</p> - -<p>“So I suppose; but I’ll risk your learning fast -enough. Now, where would you like to go, and what -position shall I give you?” and Mr. Pepper settled -himself deeper into his chair, and looked as though<span class="pagenum" id="Page_93">[93]</span> -he was prepared to offer Don any position he craved, -from cook’s assistant to captain.</p> - -<p>Brandon felt just a little bewildered by all this, and -probably showed his bewilderment on his face.</p> - -<p>“I’ll tell you what I have now,” went on Mr. Pepper. -“There’s the brig Calypso, loading for Port -Said—she sails tomorrow; and the clipper ship -Frances Pepper (my sister’s name, you know) unloading -from Rio, and bound back there and to Argentine -ports in a fortnight; and then there’s the whaleback, -Number Three.”</p> - -<p>“The whaleback?” queried Brandon in perplexity.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir, whaleback; a whaleback steamer, you -know. Didn’t you ever see one?”</p> - -<p>Brandon shook his head.</p> - -<p>“Well, you’ll have a chance to,” declared Mr. Pepper. -“These whalebacks are something new. Lots -o’ folks don’t believe in ’em; but I do. I bought the -third one the company ever built, and it lies at one of -my wharves now, being fitted up.”</p> - -<p>“But where will <i>that</i> go?” Brandon inquired with -interest.</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper rubbed his bald pate reflectively.</p> - -<p>“Well,” he said, “that I don’t know yet. I haven’t -decided. I’ve got a scheme, but whether ’twill work -or not, I can’t say. I must find a man to command her -first. I don’t suppose <i>you’d</i> feel like doing that, would -you?” and the ship owner laughed jollily.</p> - -<p>“I’m afraid not; perhaps, though, there’d be some -other place on her I could fill with satisfaction to -you.”</p> - -<p>“Perhaps so. If I put her in the passenger trade,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_94">[94]</span> -how would you like to be purser—assistant purser, of -course, till you learn the duties?”</p> - -<p>“I think I should like it,” replied Brandon, with -some hesitation, however; “provided, of course, that -I could take it at all.”</p> - -<p>“Eh? Not take it? Why not?” demanded Mr. -Pepper.</p> - -<p>“Well, first I want to see my father’s old mate—one -of the men saved from the raft, you know—about—well, -about a matter concerning the wreck. Perhaps, -then, if you can give me a berth, I’ll be able to -accept it.”</p> - -<p>“Going over to the hospital to see him, eh? I know -Caleb Wetherbee.”</p> - -<p>“No, he’s out of the hospital now. He gave me -his address—New England Hotel, on this very street—and -hunting for the place is what brought me here.”</p> - -<p>“Bless my soul!” cried the ship owner; “Caleb -out of hospital? Why, I didn’t expect he’d be ’round -for some time yet. The papers said he was pretty -nearly done for when he got to New York. It went -harder with him than it did with the other sailor—a -good deal harder.”</p> - -<p>Brandon looked at him curiously. If Caleb Wetherbee -was a particular friend of Mr. Pepper, the captain’s -son began to feel some doubt as to the latter’s -sincerity.</p> - -<p>“Perhaps you can tell me where the New England -Hotel is?” he asked.</p> - -<p>“Yes, it’s right along here on this side of the -street; several blocks away, perhaps. But,” he added, -“you don’t tell me that Caleb is <i>there</i>? Why, he<span class="pagenum" id="Page_95">[95]</span> -must be ’way down on his luck. I must see about -this.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper wrinkled his brow nervously and Brandon -rose.</p> - -<p>“Where are you going?”</p> - -<p>“Up to see this man—this mate of the Silver -Swan.”</p> - -<p>“Oh yes. Well, you tell him I’m coming up to -see him myself, today. It’s a mystery to me why he -should go to <i>that</i> place. I don’t understand it. How -was he looking when you saw him—for I take it you -<i>have</i> seen him?”</p> - -<p>“How do you mean—sick or well?”</p> - -<p>“Yes.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, he appeared in pretty fair health, I should -say,” replied Brandon, beginning to think that there -was something queer about it all.</p> - -<p>“Well, I’ll see him myself,” declared the merchant, -rising and giving the boy his hand. “I tell you what -we’ll do, Brandon. If you don’t get back here by -noon, I’ll step up and get you, and we’ll go to lunch -together; then afterward we’ll take a look at the -whaleback, if you like.”</p> - -<p>Brandon thanked him and opened the door into -the outer office, almost falling over Mr. Alfred Weeks, -who had his head suspiciously near the keyhole.</p> - -<p>“Lo—looking for my ruler that I dropped,” declared -the red haired clerk, as his employer’s eyes -rested sternly upon him.</p> - -<p>But as he passed out, Brandon noticed that the ruler -was on the high desk holding open the leaves of a -much tattered paper novel.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_96">[96]</span>“Funny sort of fellow for a respectable ship owner -to employ,” Brandon decided, as he made his way -along the crowded thoroughfare. “In fact, I guess -I’ll withhold my opinion of all three of these people -till I know ’em better—Wetherbee, Pepper, and his -clerk.”</p> - -<p>By closely scanning the signs on the buildings as he -passed, the captain’s son finally discovered the place -he sought. He came within an ace of not doing so, -however, for the words “New England Hotel” were -simply painted on a small strip of tin on one side of -the doorway, the rest of the sign space being devoted -to the words: John Brady, Wines, Liquors, and -Cigars.</p> - -<p>Brandon hesitated a moment before entering the -place. It was plainly a saloon of the worst type, the -“hotel” part evidently being but a “blind” by means -of which the bar could be kept open all night.</p> - -<p>Two or three disreputable men—sailors or longshoremen -by appearance—were hanging about the -door, but Brandon Tarr had a good deal of confidence -in his ability to take care of himself, and finally ascended -the steps.</p> - -<p>A sickening odor of stale tobacco smoke and bad -liquor assailed his nostrils as he stepped within the -room, and he was almost tempted to back out and give -up his intention of seeing Wetherbee. But the man -behind the bar—a villainous looking fellow with a -closely cropped head and red face—had seen him and -came briskly forward.</p> - -<p>“Well, young felley, what kin I do fur ye?” he -asked, in what was intended as a pleasant tone.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_97">[97]</span>Deciding that he was in for it, the captain’s son -walked forward to the bar and replied:</p> - -<p>“Nothing to drink, thank you. I’m looking for a -man who’s stopping here—Caleb Wetherbee.”</p> - -<p>The bartender eyed him curiously and repeated:</p> - -<p>“Caleb Wetherbee, eh? Well, I’ll see ’f he’s here.”</p> - -<p>He stepped back to a door leading into an inner -room and, opening it a crack, called to somebody inside. -There was a whispered conversation between -the men, and the bull necked individual came back to -the bar.</p> - -<p>“All right, m’ duck; he’s in dere,” he said, with a -grin, and a motion of his thumb toward the inner door. -“Yer don’t have ter send in no kyard.”</p> - -<p>Taking this as a permission to enter, Brandon -walked across the long saloon, littered with tables and -chairs, and its door covered with sawdust, and opened -the door.</p> - -<p>The apartment beyond was as badly furnished as -the outer room, there being only a square deal table -and several wooden bottomed chairs. In one of these -chairs before the table, with his head bowed upon -his arms, was the sailor whom Brandon had seen two -days before in the woods on his uncle’s farm back in -Chopmist, the only occupant of the place.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_98">[98]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XIII<br /> - - -<small>THE OLD SAILOR WITH THE WOODEN LEG</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">It</span> was only in the country—in the woods and -sheltered fence corners—that the patches of snow -still remained on this sixth day of April. In New -York the sun shone warmly upon the sidewalks, -washed clean by the shower of the night before, and -the tiny patches of grass in the parks and squares -were quite green again.</p> - -<p>About the middle of the forenoon a man stumped -along a street leading to what remains of the Battery -park—a man dressed in a half uniform of navy blue, -and with a face (where the beard did not hide the -cuticle) as brown as a berry.</p> - -<p>At first glance one would have pronounced this person -to be a sailor, and have been correct in the surmise, -too.</p> - -<p>The man’s frame was of huge mold, with massive -development of chest and limbs, and a head like a -lion’s. But his bronzed cheeks were somewhat hollow, -and his step halting, this latter not altogether -owing to the fact that his right leg had been amputated -at the knee and the deficiency supplied by an old -fashioned wooden leg.</p> - -<p>Still, despite his evident infirmity, the old seaman -looked cheerfully out upon the world on this bright<span class="pagenum" id="Page_99">[99]</span> -April morning, and pegged along the sidewalk and -into the park with smiling good nature.</p> - -<p>Not a beggar had accosted him during his walk -down town without having a nickel tossed to him, and -it was with vast contentment that the wooden legged -sailor at length seated himself upon a bench, from -which vantage point he could overlook the bay and -its multitudinous shipping.</p> - -<p>“Ah!” he exclaimed, sniffing the air which blew -in from the sea, like a hungry dog. “This is <i>life</i>, -this is! Thank heaven I’ve got away from them -swabs of doctors at last. Another week at that ere -hospital would ha’ been the death o’ me. Still, I -reckon they meant well ’nough.”</p> - -<p>He sat there for some time in cheerful silence, and -drank in the exhilarating air, his pea cloth jacket -thrown open to the breeze, baring the broad expanse -of flannel shirt beneath.</p> - -<p>“A few days o’ this’ll put me right on my feet,” he -said, with delight, “better’n all the tonics the old sawbones -ever invented. Lord! if I’d had this breeze -a-blowin’ inter my winder up there to the hospital, I’d -been out a fortnight ago.</p> - -<p>“The old man ain’t dead yet. It was a pretty hard -tug, I admit; but here I be!”</p> - -<p>He slapped his leg with such vigor that a flock of -sparrows flew up with sudden affright from the path; -but this energetic gesture was taken in another sense -by the group of urchins which had gathered near by -to talk and fight (much after the manner of their -feathered prototypes, by the way) over the morning’s -sale of papers.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_100">[100]</span>At the old man’s motion half a dozen of these sharp -eyed little rascals broke away from the group, and ran -shrieking toward him, wildly waving their few remaining wares -in his face.</p> - -<p>“’Ere you are, sir! <i>Tribune</i>, <i>Sun</i>, <i>World</i>!”</p> - -<p>“<i>Tribune</i>,” said the old sailor, laughing heartily as -though he saw something extremely ludicrous in their -mistake.</p> - -<p>“My last ’un, sir. Thankee!”</p> - -<p>The successful Arab pocketed his money and went -back to his friends, while the sailor slowly unfolded -the sheet and took up the thread of his reflections -again.</p> - -<p>“Once I get my sea legs on,” he thought, fumbling -in his pocket for a pair of huge, steel bowed spectacles, -which he carefully wiped and placed astride his nose -“once I get my sea legs on, I’ll take a trip up ter -Rhode Island and see the cap’n’s boy, unless he turns -up in answer to my letter.</p> - -<p>“Poor lad! he’s doubtless heart broken by Cap’n -Horace’s death, and won’t feel much like goin’ into -this ’ere treasure huntin’ business; but for his own -good I’ll have ter rouse him up. It would be what the -cap’n would wish, I know.”</p> - -<p>He let the paper lie idly on his knee a moment, and -a mist rose in his eyes.</p> - -<p>“Never mind if the old brig <i>has</i> gone to pieces before -we get there,” he muttered. “I’ve got a little -shot in the locker yet, an’ the boy shan’t come ter -want. I’ll do my duty by him as though he was my -own son, that I will!”</p> - -<p>He picked up the paper again, and turned naturally<span class="pagenum" id="Page_101">[101]</span> -to the shipping news, which he ran over carelessly, -smiling the while. Finally his eye was attracted by -something near the bottom of the column.</p> - -<p>“Eh, what’s this?” he exclaimed. “What’s this -about the Silver Swan?”</p> - -<p>With great excitement he read the following news -item, following each line of the text with his stumpy -forefinger:</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> - -<p>Captain Millington, of the English steamer Manitoba, which -arrived here yesterday from Brazil, reports that he passed a -very dangerous wreck in latitude 22:03, longitude 70:32. It -was the hull of a brig, apparently in good condition, but with -her masts snapped off close to the decks, and all her rigging -carried away. The name on her stern was Silver Swan, -Boston.</p> - -<p>This is the same derelict reported by the steamer Montevideo -at Savannah several weeks ago. According to Captain -Millington, the wreck of the brig is a great menace to all vessels -plying between this and South American ports, as its -course seems to be right across the great highway followed -by most of the steamship lines.</p> - -<p>It will be remembered that the Silver Swan was wrecked -over two months ago on Reef Eight, southwest of Cuba, -grounding, according to the report of the survivors of her -crew, upright on the rock. The captain of the Montevideo -sighted her not far from the reef, from which she was doubtless -loosened by the westerly gale of February 13th; but since -that time she has floated some distance to the north and east, -and if she follows the same tactics as many of her sister -derelicts, she may zigzag across the course of the South -American steamers for months.</p> - -<p>The cruisers Kearsarge and Vesuvius are both lying in port -at present, and it will be respectfully suggested to the Navy -Department that one or both of those vessels be sent to destroy -this and several others of the most dangerous derelicts -now floating off our coast.</p> -</div> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_102">[102]</span>“Shiver my timbers, sir!”</p> - -<p>With this forcible and exceedingly salty ejaculation, -the old sailor with the wooden leg dropped the newspaper -to the walk, and his spectacles along with it, and -springing up, trampled upon them both.</p> - -<p>But in his great excitement he noticed neither the -torn paper nor the ruined glasses. He stumped up -and down the walk for several moments before he became -calm enough to think coherently.</p> - -<p>In fact, the blue-coated policeman on the corner had -begun to eye him suspiciously.</p> - -<p>“The Silver Swan afloat—a derelict!” he muttered. -“This ’ere is a sitiwation I didn’t look for. -An’ then, them blasted cruisers are liable to go down -there and blow her into kingdom come any minute. -The Silver Swan on Reef Eight was bad enough, but -the Silver Swan afloat, at the mercy of the gales as -well as other vessels, is worse!</p> - -<p>“Now, what in creation’ll I do about it? I haven’t -heard from the boy yet, and there’s little enough time -as it is. Why, she might sink ’most any time with -all them di’monds the cap’n told about aboard her!</p> - -<p>“I’ll take a steamer to get down there ahead of -them confounded iron pots” (by this disrespectful -term did he designate Uncle Sam’s cruisers), “but -who under the canopy’s got a steamer to charter?</p> - -<p>“By the great horn spoon, I have it!” he exclaimed, -after a moment’s thought. “Adoniram Pepper -is just the fellow.”</p> - -<p>With this declaration he jammed his hat on his -head, and stumped off as rapidly as one good leg and -one wooden one could carry him, toward the shipping -merchant’s office on Water Street.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_103">[103]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XIV<br /> - - -<small>THE OLD SAILOR’S EXCITEMENT</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">As</span> the old sailor hurried along the street toward -the ship owner’s office he became calmer, and, being -a person who had all his life been taking greater or -less chances in his business of seagoing, he began to -look at the situation more composedly.</p> - -<p>The Silver Swan was without doubt in far greater -danger of destruction now than she had been while -hard and fast on the reef, but no amount of worrying -would better the matter, and therefore one might -accept the fact coolly. Then, besides, she had floated -unmolested for over six weeks already, and there was -a big chance for her doing so for six weeks or more -to come.</p> - -<p>“Blast these navy vessels any way, I say!” the old -man muttered, stumping along now at a moderate -gait. “They probably won’t be able to find her. And -if nothing collides with her, I reckon she’ll keep -afloat for one while, for I can swear myself that the -old brig warn’t injured none below the water line—she -went on that reef jest as easy!</p> - -<p>“She’s got the same chance o’ staying above board—the -Silver Swan has—as any other craft that’s -become a derelict. Look at the schooner W. L. White,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_104">[104]</span> -abandoned by her crew during the great storm of ’88. -She floated about the North Atlantic for the better -part of a year, before she went ashore at last on the -Hebrides.</p> - -<p>“An’ then there was the Weyer G. Sargent, mahogany -laden, floated fifty-five hundred mile, or more, -’cording to the pilot chart, a-swingin’ ’round the Atlantic -from New Foundland to the Azores for two -years. An’ there may be many another good ship -that’s got a bigger record ’n that at this very day, -down in the Sargasso sea. Oh, it might be worse.”</p> - -<p>Nevertheless, despite this cheerful view, the old -sailor’s forehead was knotted into a scowl as he opened -the door of the ship owner’s dingy office and entered. -The red haired clerk was alone at the desk and the -door of the private office was shut.</p> - -<p>“Well, you jail bird, are you here yet?” demanded -the visitor impolitely, eying the clerk with exceeding -disfavor.</p> - -<p>“Oh, is that you, Mr. Featherbee——”</p> - -<p>“Wetherbee, you scoundrel!” roared the sailor, in -a voice like a bull.</p> - -<p>“Oh, yes! I should say Wetherbee—er—that’s -what I meant,” the clerk hastened to say.</p> - -<p>It was remarkable to notice the difference between -the greeting accorded to Caleb Wetherbee and that -given young Brandon Tarr shortly before.</p> - -<p>“So you haven’t managed to get at Pepperpod’s -till and clear out, yet, eh?” demanded Caleb jocularly.</p> - -<p>Mr. Weeks scowled and grinned at the same time,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_105">[105]</span> -a feat that very few men can perform; but he made -no verbal reply to the question.</p> - -<p>“Where is he?” queried the sailor, nodding toward -the inner office. “In his den?”</p> - -<p>“He’s busy—engaged,” Mr. Weeks hastened to -say.</p> - -<p>“I believe you’re lying to me, Weeks,” returned the -sailor, after eying the fellow a moment. “You’d -rather lie than eat. Where’s Pepperpod?”</p> - -<p>“He—he really <i>is</i> engaged, sir,” declared Weeks, -who stood in mortal fear of the brawny sailor. “That -is, he told me to say so to anybody that called——”</p> - -<p>“I don’t doubt it—that’s what’s taught you to -lie,” cried Caleb, in disgust. “Well, I’m going to see -him if he’s engaged fifty times. Cut along now and -tell him I’m here.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Weeks slowly descended from his stool, evidently -unwilling to comply with the request.</p> - -<p>“Get a move on you,” the sailor commanded. “If -you don’t I’ll roast you over a slow fire. I’m just out -of the hospital and I’ve got an appetite like an ostrich—or -I’d never think of eating <i>you</i>.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Weeks unwillingly went to the inner door and -rapped on the panel. Then he turned the knob and -went in, remaining a few moments, and on making his -appearance again, held the portal open for Caleb.</p> - -<p>The sailor entered without a word and the clerk -closed the door behind him; then, as on the former occasion, -he applied his ear to the keyhole with a diligence -worthy of a better cause.</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper was sitting before his desk, which was -piled high with papers and letters. The day’s mail<span class="pagenum" id="Page_106">[106]</span> -had just been sent up from the wareroom office by -Mr. Marks, the ship owner’s trusted manager, or -“steward,” as Adoniram was in the habit of calling -him.</p> - -<p>Beginning business life more than fifty years before -in this very office, Mr. Pepper could not bring himself, -as his trade increased, to leave his old quarters, -and having found his manager to be a most trustworthy -man, he had shifted the burden of the more -arduous duties upon his younger shoulders, and himself -reposed contentedly amid the dust, the gloom, and -the cobwebs of the Water Street office.</p> - -<p>Thus it was that few people ever saw “Adoniram -Pepper & Co.” to know him; but to his old friends, -those of his boyhood and young manhood, Adoniram -was always the same.</p> - -<p>Naturally his acquaintance was mostly among seafaring -people, and it was no uncommon sight to see -old hulks of sea captains and ship owners, long past -their usefulness, steering a course for the Water Street -office on pleasant days, where they were sure to receive -a pleasant word from the little old gentleman, -if he was in, and not uncommonly a bit of silver to -spend for luxuries which “sailors’ homes” do not -supply.</p> - -<p>The old gentleman sprang up at once at Caleb’s -appearance, the unfortunate eye glasses jumping off -the chubby little nose as though they were endowed -with life. Mr. Pepper gave both his hands to the -huge sailor, who indeed looked gigantic beside the little -man, and begged him to sit down.</p> - -<p>“Well, Pepperpod, how are ye?” cried the sailor,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_107">[107]</span> -in a hearty roar that shook the light pieces of furniture -in the room, just as his bulk shook the chair he -had seated himself in.</p> - -<p>“First rate, old Timbertoes!” declared the old gentleman, -laughing merrily. “So you’re out of the hospital, -at last?”</p> - -<p>“I be, Adoniram, I be!” cried Caleb with satisfaction. -“Never was so glad o’ anythin’ in my life. -Them sawbones would have killed me if they’d kep’ -me there much longer.”</p> - -<p>“Well, well, Caleb, you was a mighty sick man—a -mighty sick man.”</p> - -<p>“I reckon I was,” responded the sailor reflectively.</p> - -<p>“The doctor wouldn’t let me come in to see you,” -said the merchant, smiling jovially; “so I had to content -myself with sending up things.”</p> - -<p>“Yes, you did,” said Caleb, turning on him sternly. -“I <i>did</i> think, Adoniram, that you wouldn’t waste your -money on such truck as that—a-sendin’ me white -grapes, an’ jellies, an’ bunches o’ posies.”</p> - -<p>He snorted in veriest scorn.</p> - -<p>“Well, er—er—you see, Caleb, I told Frances -about you and she took over the things herself,” said -Adoniram hesitatingly.</p> - -<p>“Hem!”</p> - -<p>The old sea dog flushed up like a girl and mopped -his suddenly heated face with a great bandanna, finally -saying gruffly:</p> - -<p>“You tell your sister, Miss Frances, that I am -mightily obleeged for ’em, Adoniram. They—er—jest -went to the right spot, you tell her; jest what I -needed to tone me up!”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_108">[108]</span>“You’d better come up and tell her yourself, Caleb,” -said the merchant, with a sly smile.</p> - -<p>“Well—er—mebbe I will. Thankee, Adoniram.”</p> - -<p>He was silent a moment, and then, suddenly bethinking -himself of the errand which had brought him -there, he turned upon the little merchant with a slap -of his knee which sounded throughout the office like a -gun shot.</p> - -<p>“But this ’ere ain’t what brought me here—not by -a long chalk. Ye know the Silver Swan, Adoniram? -Cap’n Horace Tarr’s brig ’t I was with when she -grounded on Reef Eight, two months and more ago?”</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper nodded.</p> - -<p>“Well, sir, she’s afloat.”</p> - -<p>“Afloat!”</p> - -<p>“That’s what I said; afloat! A-f-l-o-t-e,” responded -the sailor, spelling the word very carefully, -if a trifle erratically.</p> - -<p>“How—how can that be?”</p> - -<p>“Well, ye see she went aground jest like she was -goin’ inter stocks for repairs, and if we’d stuck by -her, it’s my opinion Cap’n Tarr’d ha’ been alive now.” -He stopped and blew his nose hastily. “Well, what -is, can’t be bettered, so we’ll say no more o’ that.</p> - -<p>“But what I’m gettin’ at is this: she went aground -all standin’, an’ the storm wot come up right arterwards, -blew her off ag’in. She’s been floating, according -to this morning’s paper, ever since.”</p> - -<p>“Well, well!” exclaimed Adoniram. “It’s too bad -her hull can’t be secured for the boy. If it’s still -sound——”</p> - -<p>“Sound as a dollar!”</p> - -<p>“Where is it floating?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_109">[109]</span>“’Cordin’ to the report of a cap’n wot sighted her, -she’s somewheres about latitude 22, longitude 70.”</p> - -<p>“A pretty valuable derelict, eh, Caleb?” said the -merchant, reflectively.</p> - -<p>“Valible? Well, I should say!” The old sailor -looked at his friend curiously a moment, and then -leaned forward and rested his huge hand on Adoniram’s -knee. “Besides a valible cargo wot we took -on at the Cape and Rio, <i>there’s enough diamonds hid -aboard that brig to make the boy a second Vanderbilt</i>!”</p> - -<p>“Mercy me!” exclaimed the merchant, and this -time the eye glasses leaped off their insecure resting -place and fell with a crash to the floor, the splintered -crystal flying in all directions.</p> - -<p>“Now you’ve done it, Adoniram!” ejaculated Caleb -in disgust. “What under the canopy a man -like you—with no nose to speak of—wants to try -to wear such tackle as them for, is beyond me.”</p> - -<p>“Well—er—Frances thinks they look better on -me than other kinds of glasses,” remarked the merchant -meekly.</p> - -<p>“Well—hem!—I s’pose they <i>do</i> look some better -on ye,” declared Caleb loyally, and then a slight noise -from the other side of the door caused him to jump up -and spring hastily to it.</p> - -<p>When he flung the door open, however, the red -haired clerk was astride his high stool with a look -of perfect innocence on his face; but Caleb was not -reassured. He shook his huge fist at the fellow, and -then shut the door again, turning the key in the lock -and hanging his hat upon the door knob for further -precaution.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_110">[110]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XV<br /> - - -<small>CALEB RECEIVES A STARTLING COMMUNICATION</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Some</span> of these days,” said Caleb, with decision, -when he had taken these precautions, “I shall wring -that scoundrel’s neck, Adoniram. I wonder at your -keeping him here.”</p> - -<p>“Well, you see, nobody else would have him,” responded -the merchant, as though that fact was reason -enough for <i>his</i> keeping the objectionable Mr. Weeks.</p> - -<p>“Ya-as—one o’ your blasted philanthropic notions,” -declared Caleb, with a snort denoting disgust. -“Well, he’ll rob and murder you some day and then -you’ll wish you’d heard to me. If ‘jail bird’ ain’t -written on <i>his</i> face, then I never saw it on no man’s.”</p> - -<p>“But, Caleb, what do you mean by the astounding -remark you just made about the Silver Swan?” asked -the merchant, drawing the sailor’s mind away from the -subject of Mr. Alfred Weeks and his frailties.</p> - -<p>“I’ll tell you about it,” said Caleb, in a lower tone, -seating himself by the desk again. “What I said is -straight, Pepper. There is hidden inside that hulk of -the Silver Swan, a lot o’ di’monds—how many, I -don’t know—but enough, according to Cap’n Horace’s -own words to make a man fabulously rich. -They belong to his boy, Brandon, and <i>we</i> must get ’em -for him.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_111">[111]</span>“I never knew a word about the stones till we was -on the raft. Cap’n Horace was pretty fur gone—any -one with half an eye could see <i>that</i>—and when -we’d been out several days an’ hadn’t sighted no ship, -he wrote a long letter to Brandon an’ give it to me -with a package of other papers.</p> - -<p>“I’ve got them papers right here at this identical -minute; but I ain’t opened ’em, ’cause it ain’t my -place to do so. They tells all about the di’monds an’ -how they come into Cap’n Horace’s han’s.</p> - -<p>“It seems that just afore we left the Cape a man -come aboard the Silver Swan and brought a package -of wot <i>he</i> thought was papers, to Cap’n Horace, from -his brother Anson.”</p> - -<p>“Why, Anson was dead long ago, I thought,” interrupted -Mr. Pepper.</p> - -<p>“So did everybody else think so; but he wasn’t. -He was dead, though, when this feller seed Cap’n -Horace, for he’d give the package into the man’s hands -when he was dying, for <i>him</i> to send to Cap’n Tarr. -But we put into the Cape afore the man got ’round -to sendin’ ’em to the States.</p> - -<p>“<i>He</i> never knew what a valible thing he was a -carryin’ ’round; but when the cap’n come to open -the package he found a lot o’ di’monds done up in a -separate wrapper. These he hid somewhere about -the brig—he tells about it in this letter to Brandon, -I b’lieve.</p> - -<p>“I wanted to know why he didn’t take ’em on the -raft when we left the brig, but it seems he misdoubted -himself about a rascally sailor we had with us—one -Jim Leroyd.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_112">[112]</span>“This ’ere Leroyd had been snoopin’ around the -cabin when the cap’n was given the diamonds, and he -thought the feller suspected something. So, not -knowing how it might go with any of us, he left the -gems on the brig, preferring to risk losin’ ’em altogether, -rather than to cause strife an’ p’r’aps bloodshed -on that raft.</p> - -<p>“An’ I reckon ’twas lucky he did so, fur we had -trouble enough with that swab Leroyd.”</p> - -<p>“Why, wasn’t he the man who was saved with -you?” asked the merchant.</p> - -<p>“That’s who.”</p> - -<p>“Tell me, Caleb,” said Mr. Pepper earnestly, “why -was it he stood the experience so much better than -you? Why, he was discharged from the hospital in -a week, so I understand, while you show traces of -the suffering you underwent even now.”</p> - -<p>Caleb closed his lips grimly and looked at the little -man in silence for several moments. Then he leaned -further forward and clutched his arm with one great -brown hand.</p> - -<p>“He had food that I didn’t have,” he whispered -hoarsely.</p> - -<p>“What!” cried Adoniram, shrinking back, his eyes -abulge.</p> - -<p>Caleb nodded slowly.</p> - -<p>“There were four of us on that raft. Paulo Montez—he -went first. We divided the food and water, an’ -that villain Leroyd ate his all up. Then we had ter -drive him behind his chest at the other end of the -raft, an’ keep him there at the point of our pistols.</p> - -<p>“Then the cap’n went, an’—an’—<i>I had to throw<span class="pagenum" id="Page_113">[113]</span> -him to the sharks to keep him out o’ the clutches o’ -that cannibal Leroyd!</i>”</p> - -<p>“Great heavens!” exclaimed the ship owner, shrinking -back into his chair, his face the picture of horrified -amazement.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir,” whispered Caleb; “he dragged poor -Paulo’s body back o’ that chest—an’—well, ’taint -no use talkin’! I ain’t said a word about it before to -any living creature. It’s only my word ag’in his, -at best. But I swear, Adoniram, I’d kill the hound -with as little compunction as I would a rat.</p> - -<p>“He’s been sneaking ’round the hospital, inquiring -about me, too,” continued the sailor. “He’s got his -eye on these papers, for he see Cap’n Horace give -’em to me. I reckon he don’t know what they’re -about, but he suspects there’s money in it. He was -’round to the hospital only last night, so the doctor -told me.</p> - -<p>“And now, Adoniram, wot I want o’ you is to help -me find this derelict before some o’ Uncle Sam’s -blasted iron pots go out after her. We must get the -boy down from that uncle’s place in Rhode Island——”</p> - -<p>“Why, didn’t you see him this morning?” asked -Mr. Pepper, in surprise.</p> - -<p>“See who?”</p> - -<p>“Why, the boy—Captain Tarr’s son, Brandon?”</p> - -<p>“What?” roared the sailor. “Then he’s here in -New York, is he?”</p> - -<p>“Why—of—course,” responded the merchant, in -bewilderment. “I thought you’d seen him again. He -started out to call on you not two hours ago. He<span class="pagenum" id="Page_114">[114]</span> -said you’d given him your address—at the New England -Hotel, just below here.</p> - -<p>“And what I want to say, Caleb is that I don’t -consider it a great proof of friendship on <i>your</i> part, -for you to go to such a place as that, even if you were -low in finances. I’d only be too glad to have you -come to my house and stay the rest of your natural -life—and so would Frances.”</p> - -<p>“Me!—at the New England Hotel!—why the -man’s crazy!” declared Caleb.</p> - -<p>“Ain’t you stopping there?” gasped the merchant.</p> - -<p>“Am I? Well. I guess not! I ain’t but just got -out o’ the hospital this blessed morning.”</p> - -<p>“Why, he said he’d seen you once, and you’d told -him to call at the New England Hotel.”</p> - -<p>“Who?” roared Caleb.</p> - -<p>“Brandon Tarr.”</p> - -<p>“Why, man alive, I never saw the lad in all my -life!”</p> - -<p>“Then,” declared Adoniram with energy, “there’s -foul play about it. When I came down this morning -I found the captain’s son waiting to see me. He’d -just come down from Rhode Island, I believe, and -he’d got your address—said he’d already seen you -once, mind you—and was going up to this place to -see you again.</p> - -<p>“I thought ’twas funny you should put up at such -a house, Caleb; but I didn’t know but perhaps you -were ‘on your uppers’” (Caleb snorted at this), “and -had gone there for cheapness. I told Brandon I’d -come up after him this noon and take him to lunch.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_115">[115]</span>But Caleb was on his feet now, and pacing the floor -like a caged lion.</p> - -<p>“I see it all—I see it all!” he declared. “It’s some -o’ that swab Leroyd’s work. Why, man alive, do you -know what the New England Hotel is? It’s one o’ -the wickedest places in New York. I know the den -well, and the feller as runs it, too. Why, the boy’s -in danger every moment he stays there!”</p> - -<p>He seized his hat and jammed it on his head again.</p> - -<p>“Ef anything’s happened to that boy, I’ll break -every bone in that scoundrel’s body!” he exclaimed, -seizing the door and throwing it wide open without -the formality of unlocking it.</p> - -<p>The splintered wood and broken lock flew in all -directions as he dashed through the doorway and -flung himself into the street, while Mr. Pepper remained -weakly in his chair, too utterly bewildered to -move, and the festive Mr. Weeks dodged behind the -high desk with alacrity, as the sailor went through -the outer office like a whirlwind.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_116">[116]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XVI<br /> - - -<small>TELLING HOW BRANDON BEARDED THE LION IN HIS -LAIR</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">As</span> Brandon Tarr entered the apartment behind -the bar room of the New England Hotel, the man -at the table raised his head and surveyed him surlily. -Evidently he had been drinking, and the liquor had -changed his mood greatly from that of the affable -sailor who had accosted the captain’s son in the Chopmist -woods.</p> - -<p>“Well, how came <i>you</i> here?” inquired the sailor, -in no very friendly tone, gazing at Brandon, with -bloodshot eyes.</p> - -<p>“I came down on the train.”</p> - -<p>“Ain’t you lost?”</p> - -<p>“Guess not,” responded the boy.</p> - -<p>The man shifted his position uneasily, keeping his -eyes fixed upon his visitor.</p> - -<p>“Can’t say as I expected to see you—just yet, -any way.”</p> - -<p>“No?” returned Brandon coolly.</p> - -<p>“Say! wot the blazes do you want, any way?” demanded -the sailor fiercely, after an instant’s silence. -“It won’t pay you to be sassy here, my lad, now I -can assure ye.”</p> - -<p>“Think so? Seems to me you’re not as glad to<span class="pagenum" id="Page_117">[117]</span> -see me as I reckoned you would be. It didn’t exactly -pay you to come ’way up to Rhode Island to pump -me, did it?”</p> - -<p>The fellow hissed out an oath between his teeth -and clinched his fist angrily.</p> - -<p>“You’re too fresh, you are!” he declared.</p> - -<p>“Maybe.”</p> - -<p>“So I went up there to pump you, eh?”</p> - -<p>“I reckon.”</p> - -<p>“And what did <i>you</i> come down here for?”</p> - -<p>“To pump you,” responded the captain’s son, laughing.</p> - -<p>The sailor stared at him in utter amazement for a -moment.</p> - -<p>“Of all the swabs——” he began, but Brandon -interrupted him.</p> - -<p>“See here, Wetherbee, I’ve come here for a purpose. -My father intrusted you with some papers for -me (though why he ever did so <i>I</i> don’t see—I mistrusted -your ugly face the first time I ever saw it), -and now you are trying to play me false.”</p> - -<p>“You know too much!” roared the sailor, rising -and thumping the table with his clenched fist.</p> - -<p>“Yes, I <i>do</i> know too much for your good—or for -the success of your plot,” Brandon replied, with cool -sarcasm. “See this?”</p> - -<p>He took the bit of newspaper from his pocket and -tossed it upon the table before the man.</p> - -<p>“What is it?” demanded the sailor, clutching at the -clipping.</p> - -<p>“The newspaper item stating that the Silver Swan -is a derelict, instead of being sunken, as you declared<span class="pagenum" id="Page_118">[118]</span> -to me. Had I not found it in the woods after you -left, I might have still believed your lying yarn, Wetherbee.”</p> - -<p>The sailor crumpled the bit of paper in his fist and -shook the clenched member in the boy’s face.</p> - -<p>“Young man,” he said with emphasis, “ye think -ye’re smart; but do ye know that ye’re likely ter git -inter trouble ’fore ye get out o’ this place? I don’t -’low no boy ter sass me.”</p> - -<p>“I’m sorry for that,” said Brandon, thinking the -fellow’s threat but mere bombastic eloquence; “for I -reckon you’ll have to stand it.”</p> - -<p>His very fearlessness caused the man to hesitate -ere he used violence, for it <i>might</i> be that the boy had -friends within call. The sailor therefore bit his thick -lip in fury, and poured a shower of vituperations upon -his visitor’s head.</p> - -<p>“Let me tell you something else, also,” continued -Brandon. “I propose to have those papers that -father gave you.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, you do?” half screamed the man, stamping -up and down the room in ungovernable rage.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir; and no amount of swearing will scare -me. Those papers are mine and if you won’t give -them up peaceably, the law will make you.”</p> - -<p>Suddenly the man stopped storming and became -more tranquil.</p> - -<p>“So you’re goin’ ter law erbout it, be ye?”</p> - -<p>“No, I don’t think I’ll have to; I think you’ll see -plain enough that it will be best for you to give them -up. By your own confession you don’t know where -the treasure is hid; <i>but I do</i>. Somehow I’m going<span class="pagenum" id="Page_119">[119]</span> -to find the wreck of the brig and get—whatever it -was father hid. But first, I want those papers that I -may know <i>what</i> the—the treasure consists of.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, ye do? Well, how be ye goin’ ter prove that -I’ve got the docyments?”</p> - -<p>“Very easily indeed,” Brandon responded frankly. -“I’m going to look up the sailor who was with you on -the raft. If father gave you the papers <i>he</i> doubtless -knows it, and I don’t believe that there are <i>two</i> men -as dishonest as you, Wetherbee.”</p> - -<p>“So you know where the old man has hid the stuff, -hey? An’ yer goin’ ter see th’—th’ other sailor an’ -git his evidence, be ye?”</p> - -<p>The man’s ugly face turned a deep reddish hue and -he reached out his hands and clutched the empty chair -as though he were strangling somebody. The gesture -was so terribly realistic and the man’s face so diabolical, -that Brandon involuntarily shrank back.</p> - -<p>“You little fool!” hissed the other slowly. -“You’ve put yourself right inter my han’s an’ let me -tell ye I’m a bad man ter monkey with. I’ve let ye -hev it all your own way so fur, but now ’twill be <i>my</i> -turn, an’ don’t you forgit it! Ye know where thet -treasure is hidden aboard the brig, hey? Then, by -the great jib boom, ye’ll tell me or <i>ye’ll never git out -o’ here alive</i>!”</p> - -<p>As he uttered the threat he sprang upon the boy -so suddenly that Brandon was totally unprepared for -the assault. His victim was no match for his great -strength, and was borne to the floor at once.</p> - -<p>The villain’s hand upon his throat deprived the boy<span class="pagenum" id="Page_120">[120]</span> -of all power of utterance, and he felt himself being -slowly choked into insensibility.</p> - -<p>Suddenly the door between the apartment and the -bar room was flung wide open as though a small -hurricane had descended upon the establishment of -the New England Hotel. Don’s villainous assailant—big -and burly though he was—was seized in a grip -of iron, pulled from his victim, and thrown bodily to -the other side of the room.</p> - -<p>“You scoundrel!” roared Caleb (for it was he) -in a voice that made the chandelier tremble. “Would -you kill the lad?”</p> - -<p>But Brandon, now that the pressure was removed -from his throat, was on his feet in a moment, staring -curiously at the big, wooden legged sailor.</p> - -<p>“Just saved you from adding murder to your other -sins, did I?” continued the mate of the Silver Swan. -“Did he hurt you, lad?”</p> - -<p>“Guess I’m all right,” responded Brandon, feeling -of his throat as his assailant arose to his feet, scowling -ferociously at the newcomer.</p> - -<p>“I’ll live to see you hung yet, Jim Leroyd!” Caleb -declared, shaking his huge fist at the sailor.</p> - -<p>“Great Scott!” exclaimed Brandon; “is <i>that</i> his -name? Why, he told me he was Caleb Wetherbee!”</p> - -<p>“He did, eh? Blast his impudence! Let me tell -you, lad, if Cale Wetherbee looked like that scoundrel, -he’d go drown himself for very shame. <i>I’m</i> Caleb -Wetherbee, myself, and <i>you</i>, I reckon, are Brandon -Tarr.”</p> - -<p>Brandon was fairly stupefied by this announcement.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_121">[121]</span>“But what about the—the papers father put into -his hands for me?” he asked, breathlessly.</p> - -<p>“Your father give <i>him</i> papers, lad? Well, I reckon -not! He’s lied to ye.”</p> - -<p>“Then he hasn’t them?”</p> - -<p>“Not he. I’ve got ’em myself, safe and sound.”</p> - -<p>“You have them?” repeated Brandon.</p> - -<p>“That I have,” replied the mate confidently, “and -what’s more, I’ve got ’em right here!”</p> - -<p>At this juncture the door behind them opened and -the red faced barkeeper came into the room.</p> - -<p>“Look er-here, wot’s de meanin’ of all dis, hey?” -he demanded, eying Caleb with disfavor.</p> - -<p>“Oh, it’s you, is it?” said the wooden legged sailor, -in disgust. “I know <i>you</i>, Jack Brady. Get out -here, you walking beer keg! I’m having a private -seance with this gentleman,” intimating the cowed -Leroyd.</p> - -<p>A quick look of intelligence passed between Leroyd -and the bartender.</p> - -<p>“Ye’re tryin’ ter kick up a shindy in dis place, dat’s -wot ye’re at!” declared the latter, rolling up his -sleeves, belligerently.</p> - -<p>“Yes, and I’ll kick up a bigger row before I’m -through,” Caleb replied threateningly. “Now you -run out and play, sonny, while I talk to my friend, -Mr. Leroyd, here.”</p> - -<p>This so angered the pugilistic looking man that he -made a dash at the big sailor; but the consequences -were exceedingly unpleasant.</p> - -<p>Caleb’s hammer-like fist swung round with the force -of a pile driver, and an ox would have fallen before<span class="pagenum" id="Page_122">[122]</span> -that blow. As Mr. Brady himself would have put -it, he was “knocked out in one round.”</p> - -<p>But the treacherous Leroyd, taking advantage of -his friend’s attack on the mate, sprang upon Caleb -from the other side. This flank movement was totally -unexpected, and, weakened by his long confinement -in the hospital, the mate of the Silver Swan could not -hold his own with his former shipmate.</p> - -<p>Both went to the floor with a crash, and as they -fell Leroyd tore open his antagonist’s coat and seized -a flat leather case from the mate’s inside pocket. -Dealing one heavy blow on the other’s upturned face, -the scoundrel sprang up and disappeared like a shot -through the door at the opposite end of the apartment.</p> - -<p>“Stop him!” roared Caleb, and Brandon, who had -stood utterly bewildered and helpless throughout the -scene, sprang forward to the door.</p> - -<p>“The papers! He’s stolen the papers!” he gasped, -seizing the knob and trying to pull open the door.</p> - -<p>But the key had been turned in the lock and the -stout door baffled all his attempts upon it.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_123">[123]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XVII<br /> - - -<small>HOW THE OMNIPRESENT WEEKS PROVES HIS RIGHT TO -THE TERM</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Hampered</span> as he was by his wooden leg, it was -several moments before the old sailor could get upon -his feet, and the festive Mr. Brady, maddened and almost -blinded by the blow he had received in the first -of the fracas, would have pitched into him had not -Brandon threatened the fellow with one of the heavy -chairs with which the room was furnished.</p> - -<p>“I’ll make dis the sorriest day er your life, ye -bloomin’ big brute!” declared Mr. Brady, holding one -hand to his bruised face, and shaking the other fist -at the sailor. “I’ll have ye jugged—that’s wot I’ll -do——”</p> - -<p>And just then he stopped, for in the doorway leading -to the bar room stood Adoniram Pepper, flushed -and breathless, and behind him the burly forms of -two blue-coated policemen.</p> - -<p>“Thank goodness, the boy is safe!” gasped the -little merchant. “Are <i>you</i> hurt, Caleb?”</p> - -<p>“Some shaken up, but that’s all, shipmate,” declared -the mate of the Silver Swan. “I got here just -in time to keep that brute Leroyd from choking the -lad to death.”</p> - -<p>“Mercy! and where is he now?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_124">[124]</span>“Skipped, I reckon,” responded Caleb briefly, -brushing the sawdust off his clothing.</p> - -<p>“But he’s stolen the papers,” said Brandon.</p> - -<p>“Not the papers your father gave Caleb?” cried -the little man. “He must be captured at once!”</p> - -<p>“Yes, he robbed me,” said Caleb slowly; “but -whether he got anything o’ much value or not is another -question. Let’s get out o’ here, ’Doniram, and -take account o’ cargo.”</p> - -<p>Just here the policemen crowded into the room.</p> - -<p>“Has your man got away, sir?” one of them asked -Mr. Pepper.</p> - -<p>“I’m afraid he has, officer—unless you want this -fellow arrested, Caleb?” indicating the saloon keeper.</p> - -<p>At this Brady began to storm and rave disgracefully.</p> - -<p>“Come, quit that, Brady!” commanded officer Mullen. -“You’re deep in this, I’ve no doubt. You want -to walk a chalk line now, or I’ll have your license taken -away. D’ye understand?”</p> - -<p>Mr. Brady subsided at this threat, and the party -filed out.</p> - -<p>“It’s all right now, officer,” said Adoniram, slipping -something into Mr. Mullen’s hand. “We won’t -trouble you further. If anything more comes of it, -I’ll step around and see the captain myself.”</p> - -<p>The two policemen nodded and Mr. Pepper led his -friends back to his office.</p> - -<p>On the way Brandon explained his previous connection -with the villain Leroyd, and recounted what -had occurred at the New England Hotel before Caleb’s -timely appearance.</p> - -<p>“Well, I reckon you were just what Leroyd told<span class="pagenum" id="Page_125">[125]</span> -you—a little too fresh,” was the comment of the mate -of the Silver Swan. “’Twas only by luck that ye -warn’t garroted by that scoundrel. There’s been more -than one man gone into that dive that never come out -arterwards, now I tell ye.”</p> - -<p>“You are wrong, Caleb,” declared Mr. Pepper confidently -“It was not luck—’twas Providence.”</p> - -<p>“Mebbe you’re right, old man,” returned the mate. -“Now, lad, come in here and tell us all about yourself -before we do anything further. We want to get a -thorough understanding o’ the case.”</p> - -<p>They had arrived at the shipping merchant’s office, -but it was locked and Mr. Pepper had to use his own -private pass key.</p> - -<p>“Weeks has gone out,” the old gentleman explained, -ushering them in. “It’s his dinner hour.”</p> - -<p>“I’m glad the swab’s out of the way,” growled the -sailor. “I don’t see what you keep that prying, sneaking -rascal about here for any way. He’ll do you some -damage some time, ’Doniram.”</p> - -<p>“I—I should dislike to discharge him,” said the -old gentleman gently. “He—he is an unfortunate -fellow——”</p> - -<p>“Unfortunate!” snorted the mate in disgust.</p> - -<p>“Yes, unfortunate, Caleb. Even his face is against -him. Who would want such a looking fellow around -an office? And office work is all he knows how to do. -Marks wouldn’t keep him down to the other office, so -I <i>had</i> to take him up here.”</p> - -<p>“Had to!”</p> - -<p>Caleb stared at his old friend in pitying surprise.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_126">[126]</span>“’Doniram,” he said, “you—make—me—weary!”</p> - -<p>Then he shook his head sadly and dropped heavily -into a chair he had formerly occupied near the merchant’s -desk.</p> - -<p>“Come,” he said, turning to Brandon, holding out -his hand affectionately, “come and sit down here beside -me, my lad. We want to know each other better—you -and I—and I’ve got a good deal to say to ye.</p> - -<p>“Your father’s last words to me was ‘Remember, -Cale!’ an’ they referred to the fac’ that he’d left me -in charge o’ you—an’ of your property. An’ I’m -rememberin’, though that hospital business delayed me -a good bit.”</p> - -<p>“But, Caleb,” said the merchant nervously, “what -will you do about those—those diamonds,” and he -looked at Brandon smilingly, “now that that scamp -has stolen the captain’s papers?”</p> - -<p>“Diamonds?” echoed Brandon.</p> - -<p>“Aye, diamonds—lashin’s of ’em!” the sailor declared -earnestly. “If yer father was ter be believed—an’ -<i>you</i> know whether or not to believe him as well -as <i>I</i>—there’s di’monds hid aboard that brig, enough -to make you a rich man, my lad.”</p> - -<p>“But the papers?” repeated Mr. Pepper.</p> - -<p>“Blast the papers!” exclaimed the sailor, slapping -his thigh impatiently. “They don’t amount to a row -of pins.”</p> - -<p>“But they’ll tell that Leroyd all about the treasure -and just where to find it,” said Brandon.</p> - -<p>“And you won’t know <i>where</i> to look for it aboard -the Silver Swan,” Mr. Pepper chimed in.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_127">[127]</span>“I won’t hey?” responded Caleb with a snort of -disgust. “Sure of that, be ye?”</p> - -<p>“I think I know where father would place the gems -for safe keeping,” said Brandon, slowly.</p> - -<p>“Yes, an’ I reckon <i>I</i> know, too,” the mate declared. -“There’s a sliding panel in the cabin—eh, -lad?”</p> - -<p>Brandon nodded acquiescence.</p> - -<p>“Yes, that’s it,” went on the sailor; “it come to me -just now when I was a-thinkin’ of the matter. We -useter keep our private papers in that ’ere hole in the -bulkhead. It’s the third panel on the port side front -the companionway.”</p> - -<p>“Sh!” exclaimed the merchant, “suppose somebody -should overhear you.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, that sneak Weeks isn’t here,” replied Caleb -carelessly. “You don’t have anybody else working -for you here who would snoop like him, do you, ’Doniram?”</p> - -<p>The merchant shook his head with a mild smile.</p> - -<p>“Well, then,” said the mate of the Silver Swan, -“we can get down to business. We understand each -other, eh, lad? Ye’ll put yourself under our care, an’ -’Doniram an’ I’ll see you through this thing.”</p> - -<p>“I’m only too glad to have your help,” cried Don -warmly. “Alone I can do nothing; but with you to -help me, Mr. Wetherbee——”</p> - -<p>“Drop that!” thundered Caleb. “Don’t you ‘mister’ -me, blast yer impudence! I’m Cale Wetherbee -to <i>you</i>, as I was to yer father.”</p> - -<p>Then he added more mildly:</p> - -<p>“You can count on me, Don. And you can count<span class="pagenum" id="Page_128">[128]</span> -on Pepperpod, here, every time, eh?” and he nodded -to the ship owner.</p> - -<p>“That you can, Don,” rejoined Mr. Pepper. “And -already I have a vessel I can place at your disposal. -It is the whaleback steamer I spoke of this morning. -You shall have her and go in quest of the Silver -Swan.”</p> - -<p>“A whaleback, hey?” repeated Caleb quickly, with -a doubtful shake of his head. “I don’t know much -about them new fangled things.”</p> - -<p>“Well, you shall before long,” Mr. Pepper declared. -“With her you can beat any of these cruisers to the -brig, and get the diamonds before they blow her sky -high.</p> - -<p>“Now, let us go out to lunch; it is long past my -regular hour,” he continued. “I will close the office -for the day and you must both go home with me. -Wait, I’ll telephone to Marks.”</p> - -<p>“Let me git my clo’es brushed before we go up -town, ’Doniram,” exclaimed Caleb, in sudden haste. -“I’ve got sawdust all over me.”</p> - -<p>“All right,” the merchant responded, giving the -call for the wareroom office (it was a private line); -“you’ll find a whisk broom in that wardrobe there. -Don can brush you.”</p> - -<p>The sailor arose and walked over to the wardrobe.</p> - -<p>“Dem the thing! how it sticks,” he remarked impatiently, -tugging at the handle.</p> - -<p>Then he exerted his great strength and the door -flew open with surprising suddenness, and with it, -to the startled amazement of the entire party, came the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_129">[129]</span> -red haired clerk, Alfred Weeks, clinging vainly to the -inner knob.</p> - -<p>The momentum of his exit fairly threw him across -the small room, where he dropped into a chair which -happened to stand handy, gazing, the picture of fright, -at the infuriated sailor.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_130">[130]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XVIII<br /> - - -<small>BRANDON LISTENS TO A SHORT FAMILY HISTORY</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Weeks!</span> Weeks! I wouldn’t have thought it of -you,” exclaimed Adoniram Pepper sorrowfully, turning -away from the ’phone to gaze sternly at the rascally -clerk.</p> - -<p>“Wouldn’t have thought it of him?” roared Caleb. -“’Doniram, you’re a fool! It’s just exactly what you -might have expected of him. Oh, you—you swab, -you!” he added, shaking his fist at the trembling culprit. -“I wish I had you aboard ship. If I wouldn’t -haze you!”</p> - -<p>Then he sprang at the fellow, and seizing him ere -he could escape, tossed him face downward over his -knee, and, while he held him with one hand, delivered -a most energetic spanking with the other huge palm, -to his squirming prisoner’s manifest discomfort.</p> - -<p>“Oh! oh! oh!” roared Weeks, almost black in the -face. “Oh, he’s a-murderin’ me I Let me go! Oh! -oh!”</p> - -<p>“Stop your bawling, Alfred,” Mr. Pepper commanded, -as the breathless sailor released the scamp -and placed him upright with no gentle force.</p> - -<p>Brandon, who had been well nigh convulsed with -laughter at the mode of punishment the clerk had received,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_131">[131]</span> -had not thought it possible for the jolly Adoniram -to ever appear so stern as he did now.</p> - -<p>“Weeks,” continued the merchant, the customary -smile totally eradicated from his features, “Weeks, I -have done my best for you for ten years. I’ve helped -you the best I know how. I have shielded you from -those who would have given you over to justice more -than once, for your petty crimes. Now, sir, I am -through with you!</p> - -<p>“This offense is unpardonable. You may go down -to the other office and draw your salary to the end of -the month, and never let me see you again until you -have become a respectable member of society, and -shown by your actions, not by words, that you are -such. Go at once, sir!”</p> - -<p>Weeks hesitated an instant as though he contemplated -making an appeal to his old employer for mercy; -but the look on Mr. Pepper’s face forbade that. The -old merchant was an embodiment of justice now; -mercy for the rascally clerk had flown.</p> - -<p>Picking up his hat, he limped silently to the door, -but ere he disappeared he turned and looked at Brandon, -who, in spite of himself, was unable to keep his -face straight. He glared at the laughing youth an instant, -and then the real nature of the fellow flashed -out from beneath the veneer of apparently harmless -impudence and cunning.</p> - -<p>His dark, old looking face flushed deeply red, his -narrow eyes flashed with sudden rage, and he shook -his clenched fist at Brandon Tarr with insane fury.</p> - -<p>“I’ll even things up with <i>you</i>, you young whelp!”<span class="pagenum" id="Page_132">[132]</span> -he hissed, and in another moment limped out of the -place.</p> - -<p>“A nice fellow you’ve harbored, there, ’Doniram, -just as I told you,” Caleb declared. “He’ll knife you -some dark night, if you’re not careful.”</p> - -<p>But Adoniram only shook his head sadly and returned -to the telephone. After talking to his manager -several minutes, he picked up his hat and gloves and -led the way out of the office, locking it behind him.</p> - -<p>“Adoniram Pepper & Co. will take a holiday today,” -he said, his old jovial smile returning. “First -let us go to lunch.”</p> - -<p>They were all too hungry by this time to go far -before attending to the wants of the inner man; but -notwithstanding that they were so far down town, -Adoniram was able to introduce them to a very comfortable -looking little chop house. He also, despite -their protestations, settled the checks himself, and then -telephoned to Brandon’s hotel and to the Marine Hospital -for the luggage of both his guests to be sent to -his up town residence.</p> - -<p>“We’ll go up leisurely and give the baggage a -chance to get there before us,” said the merchant, as -they left the restaurant; “then Frances will know that -company is coming.”</p> - -<p>So they saw a bit of New York for Brandon’s benefit, -arriving at the large, though plain looking house -in which the merchant resided, just before six o’clock.</p> - -<p>Brandon noticed, as they neared their destination, -that the old sailor seemed ill at ease, and that the conversation -was being mostly carried on by Mr. Pepper -and himself. He did not understand this until they<span class="pagenum" id="Page_133">[133]</span> -were in the house, and the old merchant had gone to -summon his sister to meet his guests.</p> - -<p>Caleb seemed terribly nervous. He sat on the edge -of the substantial, upholstered chair and twisted his -hat between his huge hands, his face and neck of -flaming hue, while his eyes were downcast, and he -started at every sound.</p> - -<p>Finally, as the merchant did not return at once, -Caleb drew forth his bandanna and blew his nose furiously.</p> - -<p>“This ’ere is terrible, isn’t it, lad?” he muttered -hoarsely, to Brandon, who had been eying him in great -surprise.</p> - -<p>“What is, Caleb?”</p> - -<p>“This ’ere meeting ladies, ye know,” responded the -mate of the Silver Swan in a mild roar, laboring under -the delusion that he was speaking very low indeed.</p> - -<p>“There isn’t but one, Caleb,” replied Don encouragingly.</p> - -<p>“I—I know it,” said Caleb, with a groan; “but -she’s—she’s th’ spankin’est craft ever yer see! Sails -allus new and fresh, riggin’ all taut—I tell ye, lad, -it allus rattles me for fear I ain’t all trim.”</p> - -<p>“You look first rate, Caleb,” Brandon assured him, -stifling a desire to laugh as the old seaman evidently -considered the occasion so serious. “I wouldn’t -worry.”</p> - -<p>“That’s easy enough for <i>you</i> to say,” returned -Caleb, with another shake of his head. “You -wouldn’t be Cap’n Horace’s son if ye didn’t find it all -plain sailin’ in a city droorin’ room, same’s on th’<span class="pagenum" id="Page_134">[134]</span> -ship’s deck; but with me it’s different. Oh, Lordy! -she’s hove in sight.”</p> - -<p>There was a rustle of silken skirts, and Brandon -looked up to see Miss Frances Pepper entering the -room.</p> - -<p>She was short and plump like her brother, though -of considerable less weight, and she smiled like him. -But otherwise Miss Pepper was rather prim and exact -in her appearance, manner, and dress. As the sailor -had said “her rigging was all taut,” and she looked -as though she had just stepped out of a bandbox.</p> - -<p>“My old friend. Mr. Whitherbee!” she exclaimed, -holding out her hand to Caleb with unfeigned warmth.</p> - -<p>“Wetherbee—Caleb Wetherbee, ma’am,” responded -Caleb, in a monotone growl, seizing the tips -of the lady’s fingers as though they were as fragile -as glass, and he feared to crush them in his calloused -palm.</p> - -<p>“Oh, yes—Mr. Wetherbee,” she replied brightly, -gazing frankly into the old seaman’s face, which naturally -added materially to poor Caleb’s confusion. “I -was very sorry to hear about your illness, and am glad -you have at length been released from the hospital -ward.”</p> - -<p>Then she turned to Brandon who had also risen. -She went up to him, and seizing both his hands imprinted -a motherly kiss upon his forehead.</p> - -<p>The youth saw that her soft brown eyes, which could -not possibly look stern as could her brother’s gray -ones, were filled with tears.</p> - -<p>“God bless you, my boy!” she said, in a low tone.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_135">[135]</span> -“I knew your father, Captain Tarr, and a very nice -man he was. You are like him.</p> - -<p>“And now, brother,” added Miss Frances briskly, -“if you will take Mr. Wetherbee to his room to prepare -for dinner, I will show Brandon to <i>his</i> apartment. -Dinner will be ready in twenty minutes.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper, who had entered behind his sister, bore -Caleb off as she had commanded, to a room on the -lower floor, while Brandon was led up stairs by Miss -Frances. The house was nicely though plainly furnished, -evidences of comfort rather than of great -wealth being apparent.</p> - -<p>Everywhere, on mantel and table, and in the niches -of the hall, were innumerable curiosities in the line -of shells and coral brought from all parts of the world.</p> - -<p>Miss Frances ushered Brandon into a very prettily -furnished chamber on the second floor—almost too -daintily furnished for a boy’s room, in fact. Innumerable -bits of fancy work and the like, without doubt -the work of feminine fingers, adorned the place: yet -all was fashioned in a style of at least twenty years -back.</p> - -<p>Above the bed, in a heavily gilded frame, was a -large portrait of a young woman—not exactly a beautiful -woman, but one with a very sweet and lovable -face—which smiled down upon the visitor and attracted -his attention at once.</p> - -<p>Miss Frances noticed his glance, and lingered a -moment at the door.</p> - -<p>“It was our little sister Milly,” she said softly. -“This was her room years ago. She was more than -twenty years younger than Adoniram and I.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_136">[136]</span>“Then she died?” queried Don softly, still gazing -up at the smiling face.</p> - -<p>“No, she married against father’s wishes. Father -was a very stern, proud man; not at all like Adoniram, -who, I am afraid, is not stern enough for his good,” -and she smiled a little; but there was moisture in her -eyes as she gazed up at the portrait.</p> - -<p>“She was a lovely girl—at least <i>we</i> thought so—and -she was father’s favorite, too. But she married -a poor sea captain by the name of Frank, in direct opposition -to father’s command, and so he cast her off.</p> - -<p>“He forbade Adoniram or me having anything to -do with her, or to help her in any way, and she herself -put it out of our power to do so, by going to the -other side of the world with her husband. Several -years later we heard of her death, and were told that -there was a child; but although Adoniram has done -all he could he has never been able to find this Captain -Frank.”</p> - -<p>The old lady wiped her eyes before continuing.</p> - -<p>“After father died we had this room fixed just as -she used to have it, and had that picture hung there.</p> - -<p>“Now, Brandon, I won’t bother you longer. There -is your satchel, which the expressman brought an hour -ago. If you want anything, please ring.”</p> - -<p>Then she departed, and left the captain’s son to -make ready for dinner.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_137">[137]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XIX<br /> - - -<small>TELLING A GREAT DEAL ABOUT DERELICTS IN GENERAL</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Although</span> there seemed to be everything for comfort -about the Pepper mansion, the habits of the household -were most simple. Miss Frances was evidently -a woman of very domestic tastes, and had a vital interest -in all her household arrangements. Yet there -appeared to be plenty of servants about.</p> - -<p>When dinner was over, the merchant had a short -conference with his manager, Mr. Marks, who always -came to report on matters at the close of the day; -after which he took his two guests into the library, -and the all absorbing topic of the search for the Silver -Swan was broached by Caleb, who had now regained -some of his wonted confidence.</p> - -<p>“This ’ere delay is a bad thing,” the old sailor declared, -when Miss Frances had left them to talk the -matter over. “If I hadn’t been laid up all these -weeks in the hospital, I sh’d ha’ follered up the brig -long before, and had the di’monds. Now we’ve got -two—yes, three—circumstances against us.</p> - -<p>“First and foremost is the fact that the Swan has -already been afloat ’most two months, an’ that’s longer -than the majority of derelicts last. Then these confounded -cruisers may get after her any minute, which -will be remarkably bad for our plans. And thirdly,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_138">[138]</span> -as the parsons say, there’s that rascal Leroyd. He’s -not the man I think him if he doesn’t make a break -for the wreck at once.”</p> - -<p>“And he’s got the papers, too,” interjected Mr. Pepper.</p> - -<p>Caleb smiled at this, but said nothing in reply, continuing -his remarks:</p> - -<p>“Now, I’ve seen a good many derelicts in my time—a -good many—but if the Silver Swan is in the -shape I think her, she’s liable (setting aside accident) -to float for months. And she’s got lots of company, -too.”</p> - -<p>“I should think these derelicts would be dreadfully -dangerous,” suggested Brandon, with all the curiosity -of a boy about anything pertaining to sea and sea going.</p> - -<p>“They are,” declared Caleb; “more dangerous, it’s -likely, than anybody dreams of. Many a good ship—steamers -and sailing vessels both—has doubtless gone -to Davy Jones’ Locker because of them. Take one o’ -these ’ere European steamships making time across -the ocean; she strikes a derelict—a coal laden one, -mebbe; they’re the most dangerous—and we never -hear of her again.</p> - -<p>“I’ll never forget something that happened when -I was mate of the American bark Neptune, several -years ago. The Neptune were a mighty speedy craft, -an’ Cap’n Tollman was a terror for crowding on all -sail.</p> - -<p>“We was scuddin’ along one dark night before a -stiff easterly gale, an’ I had the deck. It was just before -eight bells—half past three o’clock, mebbe—when<span class="pagenum" id="Page_139">[139]</span> -all to onct the man on lookout gave a yell that -fairly riz my hair on end.</p> - -<p>“‘A wreck! dead ahead!’ he yelled. ‘Down with -your helm! hard down!’</p> - -<p>“I jumped to the wheel myself an’ helped the helmsman -swing ’er over. Right up before us loomed the -dim, black form of a vessel—her stern under water, -an’ her bowsprit straight up. I tell ye, for about two -minutes I was dead sure ’twas all day with the old -Neptune, and us along with her.</p> - -<p>“However she did it I dunno, but she answered her -helm quicker ’n she did afore or since. She jest -shaved the wreck, some of the cordage fastened to the -upright bowsprit catching in our spars an’ being torn -away, an’ we slipped by without any damage. But -I don’t want to have a closer shave than <i>that</i>.”</p> - -<p>“That was a close call, Cale,” said Mr. Pepper reflectively. -“I’ve a man in my employ—Richards his -name is; he sails this trip as captain of the Calypso—who -came originally from New Brunswick. A regular -‘blue-nose’ he is, and a good sailor.</p> - -<p>“Well, he was one of the crew of the ‘Joggins -raft’ as it was called, that left the Bay of Fundy for -New York several years ago.”</p> - -<p>“And a mighty foolish thing that was, too,” interrupted -Caleb, shaking his head. “It’s a merciful -Providence that that thing didn’t occasion half a -dozen wrecks; but it didn’t, as far as anybody knows.”</p> - -<p>“Richards tells a pretty thrilling story of his experience,” -the merchant continued, seeing that Brandon -was interested in the tale. “Lumber and coal -laden derelicts are considered the most dangerous, eh,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_140">[140]</span> -Caleb? And this Joggins raft was probably the most -perilous object that was ever set afloat.</p> - -<p>“The raft was composed of 27,000 great tree trunks, -bound together with chains, and it weighed something -like eleven thousand tons. The hawsers by which it -was towed, parted in a hurricane, and the raft went to -pieces south of Nantasket. For a good many months -the logs were reported as scattered over a great portion -of the North Atlantic. As Caleb says, however, -they did no damage, but the hydrographic charts during -the time were plentifully decorated with them.”</p> - -<p>“What are these hydrographic charts?” asked -Brandon, with interest. “That clipping Leroyd lost -and which I found, mentioned the matter of the Swan’s -being reported to the Hydrographic Office at Washington. -What did it mean?”</p> - -<p>“Well,” responded Mr. Pepper, while Caleb, at the -little merchant’s request, filled and smoked his evening -pipe, “when these abandoned wrecks are sighted by -incoming steamers, they are reported at once to the -Hydrographic Office at the capitol, the latitude and -longitude, name of the vessel if known, and her position -in the water, being given.</p> - -<p>“As fast as messages of this kind are received at -the office they are posted on a big blackboard on which -is inscribed an outline map of the North Atlantic. -The position of each derelict is indicated by a pin stuck -into the board, and thrust at the same time through a -square scrap of paper.</p> - -<p>“On this bit of paper is inscribed in red ink the -name of the deserted craft, if it is known, together -with a minute picture showing the attitude of the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_141">[141]</span> -vessel, whether bottom up, sunken at the stern, or -what not.</p> - -<p>“These little pictures are reproduced on the next -pilot chart (which is a monthly publication), and -changes are made in the chart as frequently as the -derelicts are reported.”</p> - -<p>“Seems to me, ’Doniram,” remarked Caleb, puffing -away with vast content at the pipe—“seems to me -you know a good deal about this derelict business.”</p> - -<p>The little man seemed strangely confused at this, -and his jolly face blushed a deep red as he shifted his -position restlessly.</p> - -<p>“Well,” he said slowly. “I <i>have</i> been looking it -up lately. I—I had an idea—a scheme, you know—that -caused me to study the matter some. Seems -odd, too, doesn’t it, with the matter of the Silver Swan -coming right on top of it?”</p> - -<p>But here Brandon, whose thoughts had been wandering -a little, interrupted any further questioning on -the sailor’s part.</p> - -<p>“I’m dreadfully sorry that that rascally Leroyd got -away with the letter father wrote me,” he said reflectively.</p> - -<p>Caleb looked at him with a smile, and removed his -pipe from between his lips.</p> - -<p>“Did I say he <i>had</i> got away with it?” he said.</p> - -<p>“Eh?” interjected Adoniram, quickly.</p> - -<p>“What do you mean?” queried Brandon.</p> - -<p>“See here,” said Caleb, enjoying their surprise, -“You’ve been running this pretty much by yourselves. -<i>I</i> haven’t said that the swab got away with the papers, -have I?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_142">[142]</span>“For pity’s sake, what <i>did</i> he steal then?” demanded -Brandon, springing to his feet.</p> - -<p>“Well,” returned the mate of the Silver Swan, “by -my reckoning he got an old pocketbook with some -worthless bills of lading in it and about ten dollars in -money—an’ much good may it do him.”</p> - -<p>“Why—why—” sputtered Mr. Pepper, staring at -the smiling sailor in amazement.</p> - -<p>“Now, don’t be in a hurry,” urged Caleb. “I -<i>didn’t</i> say the papers were stolen, so don’t ye accuse -me o’ that. Ye both jumped at that conclusion and -I let you think so, for as I’d made a fool of myself -once by lettin’ folks know I had ’em, I reckoned I -wouldn’t do it again.</p> - -<p>“But now,” he added, “if ye think this is the time -and place to see them papers, I can perduce ’em ter -oncet.”</p> - -<p>“Where are they? Let’s see ’em,” urged Brandon, -in excitement.</p> - -<p>“All right, my lad. If you says the word, why -here goes.”</p> - -<p>The old sailor laid his pipe down, and coolly began -to unstrap his wooden leg. The implement was an old -fashioned affair, consisting of a smoothly turned stick -at the lower end hardly larger than a broom handle, -but swelling as it rose, to the semblance of a leg.</p> - -<p>In a moment he had it off and to the surprise of his -two friends this swelled portion of the imitation limb -was hollow. From this cavity he drew forth first a -bulky wallet and then a package of papers wrapped in -oiled paper.</p> - -<p>“There ye be,” he declared, with satisfaction. “If<span class="pagenum" id="Page_143">[143]</span> -<i>I’d</i> known about them di’monds afore we left the brig, -I sh’d have had the cap’n let me hide ’em in this ’ere -timber leg. Then we’d have been saved a mighty -sight o’ bother.”</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_144">[144]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XX<br /> - - -<small>THE CONTENTS OF SEVERAL INTERESTING DOCUMENTS</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Well</span>, of all things!” ejaculated Mr. Pepper, as -the old sailor produced the papers from their queer -repository, while Brandon burst out laughing.</p> - -<p>“There’s some reasons for being grateful for even -a wooden leg,” remarked Caleb grimly. “I hid those -papers there when I was aboard the raft, and if I’d -passed in my checks I reckon papers an’ all would -have gone to the sharks, for Leroyd would never have -thought to look there for ’em.”</p> - -<p>Then he strapped the artificial limb in place again, -and gravely handed the package to Brandon. The boy -had lost all desire to laugh now, for he was in possession -of the last written words of his father, and for a -moment his hands trembled and his eyes filled with -tears.</p> - -<p>“Open it, my lad,” said the sailor. “I haven’t -touched the wrapper since Cap’n Horace gave it to -me.”</p> - -<p>Brandon untied the string which bound the package, -and removed the oiled paper. There were several -folded documents within and one was marked:</p> - -<p class="center">“To my son, Brandon,<br /> -<span class="indentleft2">Horace Tarr.”</span></p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_145">[145]</span>Don quickly opened the paper, recognizing the chirography -of the dead captain at once, although much -of the writing was blurred and illy formed, showing -how great a tax the effort had been for the injured -and dying man. It read as follows:</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> -<p class="right"><span class="indentright"><span class="smcap">On Board the Raft,</span></span><br /> -<span class="smcap">Tuesday Noon.</span></p> - -<p><span class="smcap">My Beloved Son</span>:</p> - -<p>We have now been on this raft two days, and I feel that -my end is drawing near, although my companions will doubtless -escape. But I have received a terrible blow on the head, -and my sufferings at times are frightful; therefore I know I -am not long for this world.</p> - -<p>Oh, that I might see you again, my son! That I might be -spared to reach you, and to put into your hand the power to -make you the wealthy man I should have been had I lived. -But no; it could not be. Fortune has at last come to the -Tarrs, but I shall not share it; your uncle Anson was not -benefited by it, and death will overtake me soon, too. But -you, my son, I pray may regain the fortune which I have -hidden aboard the brig.</p> - -<p>We committed a grave error in leaving the wreck; I know -that now. The hull of the Silver Swan was uninjured, and -she may outlast many gales. I shall put these papers into -Caleb Wetherbee’s hands ere I am called, and he, I know, -will help you to regain the fortune which first belonged to -Anson. Be guided by him, and trust him fully.</p> - -<p>The letter from your uncle will explain all about the diamonds, -and how he came in possession of them. I dared not -take the gems with me from the brig, for Leroyd knew about -them, or suspected their presence, and he would have killed -us all for them, I fear.</p> - -<p>But they are hidden in the steel lined closet—the one I -showed you in the cabin. Caleb knows where it is. Go to -the reef at once and get the jewels, before some one else gets -there. There are diamonds enough to make you fabulously -rich, if Anson appraised them rightly.</p> - -<p>I am so weak that I cannot write longer.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_146">[146]</span>These will probably be my last words on earth to you, my -son. Live uprightly; fear God; and hold sacred your mother’s -memory. God bless you, my boy! Farewell!</p> - -<p class="right"><span class="indentright4">Your loving father,</span><br /> -<span class="smcap">Horace Tarr</span>.</p> -</div> - -<p>Tears fairly blinded Don’s eyes as he finished reading -the missive. He passed it to Mr. Pepper, who, -in turn, passed it to Caleb.</p> - -<p>“He was a good man,” declared Adoniram softly, -while the old sailor blew his nose loudly, and wiped -the suspicious moisture from his eyes.</p> - -<p>“That he were!” responded the latter. “Cap’n -Horace were all that he tells you to be, Don.”</p> - -<p>“Please God, I’ll be worthy of his memory,” said -Brandon quietly. “If we are fortunate enough to -obtain any of this treasure he speaks of. I hope I -shall use it wisely, and as he would wish.”</p> - -<p>“Don’t you fear—we’ll get it, lad,” Caleb assured -him earnestly. “I feel it in my bones we will.”</p> - -<p>“What else was there in the package?” asked the -merchant curiously.</p> - -<p>“There were two other papers,” Brandon replied. -“One is my father’s will.”</p> - -<p>He picked that up from his lap and opened it.</p> - -<p>“Why,” he exclaimed, “you are named as executor, -Mr. Pepper.”</p> - -<p>He passed the legal document to Adoniram who adjusted -the eye glasses (of which a new pair had been -purchased), and examined it with manifest surprise.</p> - -<p>“This is a legal will, as sure as I am alive!” he -exclaimed. “It was drawn up at Rio by an American -lawyer—a Mr. Bromley. Properly signed and witnessed.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_147">[147]</span>“Well, you’ll look out for it, won’t you?” said -Caleb, who was eager to hear the other paper—the -letter from Anson Tarr to his brother—read.</p> - -<p>“Of course. But let me tell you its contents,” replied -the merchant. “It is short and to the point, -Caleb. <i>You</i> are given the Silver Swan, in fee simple, -and everything else goes to Brandon, here.”</p> - -<p>He read the paragraph which secured all the property -of which Captain Tarr had been possessed, excepting -the brig, to Brandon, including “certain uncut -diamonds, roughly estimated at two hundred thousand -dollars.”</p> - -<p>“Two hundred thousand!” repeated Brandon, in -bewilderment.</p> - -<p>“Quite a pile, my boy,” said Caleb. “That is, if -we get ’em.”</p> - -<p>“And you and I, Caleb,” concluded Mr. Pepper, -“are joint guardians of Don.”</p> - -<p>“All right, all right,” cried the impatient sailor. -“But let’s hear the other letter, my lad. Read it out.”</p> - -<p>Thus urged, Brandon unfolded the third paper, and -read its contents aloud:</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> -<p class="right"><span class="indentright">“<span class="smcap">Kimberley, South Africa</span>,</span><br /> -“November the 27th, 1891.</p> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Brother Horace</span>:</p> - -<p>“Probably you have long since believed me dead, and I -have given you good reason for that belief, for, if I am not -mistaken, it was eight years ago, after my miserable failure -at the Australian gold diggings, that I last wrote to you.</p> - -<p>“I intended then that you should never hear from me again. -I was a failure—a complete failure, I believed—and I determined -to tempt fortune no further. With this intention -I went to an island in the Pacific, and buried myself there,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_148">[148]</span> -with only natives and one other white man for company, for -six years.</p> - -<p>“Then the old roving spirit awoke in me again, and I -longed to try my luck once more where other men were gaining -wealth. The news of the rich finds here in the diamond -fields reached even our lonely isle, and finally I could not -resist the temptation longer, and came here, leaving my companion -to dwell alone among the natives. I have been here -now the better part of a year and, at last, have been successful!</p> - -<p>“Two months ago I struck a pocket in the hills, and out -of a trench less than two rods in length, I have dug what I -believe to be at least forty thousand pounds’ worth of diamonds -of exceptional purity. But the diggings have now -petered out.</p> - -<p>“I kept the find a secret, and got all there was myself, excepting -a small number which my black digger ran away with, -and now I am afraid I shall not live to enjoy my riches.</p> - -<p>“Perhaps it is as well. You know that riches have ever -taken wings with us, and I should probably lose all in some -other venture. I hope that you, Horace, will do better with -them than I, for to you, brother, and to your boy, if he has -lived, I bequeath the gems.</p> - -<p>“I have been very ill now several days and the physician -tells me that I am in a very bad way. Exposure to all sorts -of weather in every kind of climate, is telling on me. Therefore -I do write this to you, my brother, and take precaution -to have the letter and the package of uncut stones sent to -you.</p> - -<p>“Nobody here knows of my find. It is safest to trust nobody -in such a place as this. I propose to give the letter and -the gems, all in a sealed packet, to a friend, who is the most -trustworthy man I know, and have him give them to you. -He will believe the package to contain nothing but papers, -and therefore you will stand a good chance of getting the -diamonds safely.</p> - -<p>“Good by for this world, Horace. May the luck of the -Tarrs be changed with this find of mine.</p> - -<p class="right"><span class="indentright3">“Your brother,</span><br /> -“<span class="smcap">Anson Tarr</span>.”</p> -</div> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_149">[149]</span>“Well,” exclaimed Caleb, with a sigh, as Brandon -folded the document, “we’ve got the rights of it at -last. Two hundred thousand dollars wuth o’ di’monds—for -that’s what forty thousand pounds mean, I take -it, eh, ’Doniram?”</p> - -<p>“About that,” said the merchant. “You will be a -very rich man, Don.”</p> - -<p>“Let’s not count our chickens too soon,” said the -youth, trying to stifle his excitement. “It seems too -bewilderingly good to be true.”</p> - -<p>“That’s a good idea about not countin’ our chickens,” -said Caleb. “But we’ll have a whack at ’em -just as soon as possible, my lad.”</p> - -<p>“And you’ll let me furnish the vessel,” the merchant -added.</p> - -<p>“Let’s see,” said the old sailor. “You was saying -something about havin’ one all ready. ’Doniram, -wasn’t you?”</p> - -<p>“One that can be ready in a week’s time, any way; -and the craft you want, too—a whaleback.”</p> - -<p>“I dunno,” said Caleb slowly. “I don’t fancy them -new fangled things. What under the sun did you ever -get a whaleback steamer for?”</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper looked at his old friend curiously, and -his little eyes twinkled.</p> - -<p>“Well,” he said reflectively, “oddly enough, I -purchased Number Three from the American Barge -Company for the very purpose for which you wish to -use it.”</p> - -<p>“What?” shouted Caleb.</p> - -<p>“Not to go in search of the Silver Swan?” cried -Brandon, in wonder.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_150">[150]</span>“No, not exactly that; but to go in quest of derelicts -in general.”</p> - -<p>“Another of your crazy ideas, ’Doniram!” Caleb -declared finally.</p> - -<p>“Perhaps; but I notice that most of my ‘crazy -ideas’ turn out pretty successfully, old Timbertoes,” -said the little merchant jovially. “If you’ll give me -a chance, though, I’ll explain how I came to think of -<i>this</i> ‘crazy idea.’”</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_151">[151]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXI<br /> - - -<small>IN WHICH MR. PEPPER MAKES A PROPOSITION TO CALEB -AND DON</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">You</span> see,” the ship owner began, as soon as he -was assured of the attention of his audience, “I have -had my eye on these whaleback steamers from the -start. Three years ago, you know, nobody but Captain -Alexander MacDougall, the inventor, knew anything -about them.</p> - -<p>“We are altogether too conservative here in the -East,” continued Adoniram warmly. “It takes the -Westerners to get hold of new things, and practically -test them. These whalebacks are a Western idea -and were first used and tested on the Great Lakes.</p> - -<p>“You don’t seem to realize, Caleb, that the boat -was never built which could sail as easily as those -whalebacks. In the heaviest gales they only roll -slightly, as a log would at sea. The waves can beat -against the curved steel sides of the craft as much as -they like, or wash clean over her; but the boat is not -affected by them in the least.”</p> - -<p>“It’s the most wonderful thing I ever heard of,” -Brandon declared.</p> - -<p>“They <i>are</i> wonderful boats, as you will declare, -yourself, when you see Number Three, tomorrow,” -Adoniram returned. “My whaleback is 265 feet long,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_152">[152]</span> -38 feet beam, and 24 feet deep. She is warranted to -carry 3,000 tons of grain on a sixteen and one half foot -draft. You see, for her size, she carries an enormous -cargo, for between the collision bulkhead forward, and -the bulkhead in front of the engine room aft, the whole -inside of the craft is open for lading.</p> - -<p>“But my scheme—the reason I bought this vessel, -in fact—is this,” went on Mr. Pepper.</p> - -<p>He hesitated a moment, and looked just a little -doubtfully at Caleb.</p> - -<p>“I presume this <i>is</i> what you will call a ‘crazy idea,’ -Caleb,” he said. “Several months ago my attention -was drawn to the fact that great numbers of these -derelicts now afloat in the Atlantic, north of the -equator, are richly laden merchant vessels on whose -cargoes and hulls a large salvage might be demanded -by any vessel towing them into port.</p> - -<p>“Now and then, you know, it happens that somebody -<i>does</i> recover a derelict with a valuable cargo. -In these times, when the crews of American ships, -and even many of the officers, are ignorant and untrustworthy -fellows, lacking altogether the honor arm -perseverance which were characteristics of sailors -forty years ago (I don’t say that <i>all</i> are so, but many) -under these circumstances, I say, many a vessel which -might be worked safely into port, is abandoned in -mid ocean by the frightened crew.</p> - -<p>“With a vessel like Number Three one could recover -and tow into port many of these hulks, and net -a large salvage from the owners. Vessels which -would not be worth saving themselves, might still contain -articles which it would pay to transfer to the hold<span class="pagenum" id="Page_153">[153]</span> -of the whaleback, before they were sunk; for it was -my intention to have Number Three destroy all the -wrecks which are not worth saving.</p> - -<p>“I have even sounded the Washington officials in -the matter of aiding me in the work of destroying -these derelicts; but I find that the Hydrographic Office -is trying to get an appropriation from Congress to -build a vessel of about 800 tons burden, especially for -the work of blowing up these wrecks. Until that -matter is decided, of course I can get no bonus on -what I do.</p> - -<p>“Nevertheless,” Mr. Pepper continued, “I believe -that there is money enough in it to amply reward me -for my outlay. Why, look at that New England -whaler which found the British ship Resolute fast in -the ice of Melville Bay in the summer of ’55.</p> - -<p>“She was one of three vessels sent out by the British -government to find Sir John Franklin. She was -‘nipped’ by the ice in the winter of ’51 and was abandoned. -The whaler brought her to New London, and -Congress bought her for $200,000 salvage and sent -her to England. Of course, I shouldn’t expect to get -many such prizes as that,” and the little man laughed, -“but I do expect to make a handsome profit on the -venture.”</p> - -<p>“Take, for instance, the case of the Silver Swan. -I’ll make you a proposition, Brandon, and you see if it -isn’t a fair one. Caleb shall judge himself. I’ll send -the whaleback out after the brig at my own expense. -If we are successful and find the derelict and tow her -to port, I will take the cargo (I know it to be a valuable -one) for my pains—of course, not including the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_154">[154]</span> -diamonds, which are your own personal property, my -boy. The brig herself is Caleb’s, any way, according -to the terms of your father’s will. Now what do you -say?”</p> - -<p>“I say it’s a good offer!” exclaimed Caleb, slapping -his thigh heartily. “You’re a man and a gentleman, -Adoniram. And far from thinking this scheme -of yours crazy, I think well of it—mighty well.”</p> - -<p>“That’s because it ‘hits you where you live,’ as the -saying is,” returned Mr. Pepper, smiling slily.</p> - -<p>“Oh, I don’t know anything about whalebacks,” -began Caleb.</p> - -<p>“But you will,” the merchant declared, interrupting -him. “I haven’t got through with my proposition yet.”</p> - -<p>“Fire ahead, old man,” said Caleb puffing steadily -on his pipe.</p> - -<p>“Well, then, first I want you for the captain of the -steamer, Caleb.”</p> - -<p>“Yes, so I supposed,” remarked the mate of the -Silver Swan imperturbably. “What else?”</p> - -<p>“I want Brandon for second mate.”</p> - -<p>“Me?” exclaimed Don. “Why, I never was -aboard a steamship in my life.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, that doesn’t make any difference, Don,” returned -Caleb sarcastically. “It would be just like -him (if he wanted to) to send the vessel out with -every blessed one of the crew landlubbers. It don’t -make a particle o’ difference.”</p> - -<p>“Now, Caleb,” said the merchant deprecatingly.</p> - -<p>“No, Adoniram, we can’t do it. The boy knows -nothing at all about a steamship, and I know but little -more.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_155">[155]</span>“You’ve been mate on a steamer, Caleb.”</p> - -<p>“On a dredger, you mean,” returned the old sailor, -in disgust.</p> - -<p>“There’s no reason why you can’t do it—both of -you,” the ship owner declared. “If I’m satisfied, <i>you</i> -ought to be. I’ve already engaged Lawrence Coffin -for mate.”</p> - -<p>“Coffin!” ejaculated Caleb, his face lighting up, -as he forgot to pull on his pipe in his interest. “Got -<i>him</i>, eh? Well, that puts a different complexion on -the matter. I could sail the Great Eastern with Lawrence -Coffin for mate.”</p> - -<p>“I thought so,” said Mr. Pepper, laughing gleefully. -“Then I’ve got a man by the name of Bolin for third. -He’s a good man, and knows his business, too.”</p> - -<p>“That would make Don’s duties pretty light,” said -Caleb reflectively.</p> - -<p>“Of course. I shall put in rather a larger crew -than a whaleback usually carries—fourteen at least,” -Mr. Pepper added; “to handle the cargoes I shall -expect the steamer to recover.”</p> - -<p>“Well, well,” said Caleb, rising; “let’s sleep on it. -It’s never best to decide on anything too quickly.”</p> - -<p>“If you’ll take up with my offer,” concluded the -merchant, rising, too, “the craft can be made ready, -and you can get away this day week.”</p> - -<p>“Let’s think it over,” repeated the old sailor, bound -not to be hurried into the business; but Don went to -bed so excited by the prospect that it was hours before -he was able to sleep.</p> - -<p>“Did a fellow <i>ever</i> have a better chance for fun -and adventure?” was his last thought as he finally -sank into a fitful slumber.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_156">[156]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXII<br /> - - -<small>INTO BAD COMPANY</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">If</span> I were to follow up my own inclinations I should -much prefer to stay in the company of Brandon Tarr -and of his two good friends, the honest, hearty old -seaman, Caleb Wetherbee, and the jovial, philanthropic -ship owner, Adoniram Pepper. And I feel sure that -the reader, too, would much prefer to remain with -them.</p> - -<p>But, for the sake of better understanding that which -is to follow, I shall be obliged for a short time to request -the company of the reader in entirely different -scenes, and among rather disreputable characters.</p> - -<p>Mr. Alfred Weeks, who had been in receipt of so -many favors in times past from the firm of Adoniram -Pepper & Co., is the first person who will receive our -attention.</p> - -<p>Weeks was “an effect of a cause.” He was of the -slums, his ancestry came from the slums; he was simply, -by accident of education (compulsory education, -by the way) once removed from the usual “gutter -snipe” of the city streets.</p> - -<p>Who his parents were, he could not, for the life of -him, have told. I do not mean to suggest for an instant -that Weeks was not to be pitied; but that he was -deserving of pity I deny. He had been saved from<span class="pagenum" id="Page_157">[157]</span> -the debasing influences of the reform school in his -youth by a philanthropic gentleman (who might have -been the twin of Adoniram Pepper), and sent to a -Western State where he was clothed, fed, and educated -by a kind hearted farmer, whom he repaid by theft -and by finally running away.</p> - -<p>Then he went from one thing to another, and from -place to place, and you may be sure that neither his -morals nor his habits improved during the progression. -Finally at twenty-five, he drifted back to the -metropolis, and quickly found his old level again—the -slums. Here he likewise discovered many of the -acquaintances of his youth, for he had been a boy of -twelve when he had been sent West.</p> - -<p>Among these old friends he was known as -“Sneaky” (a very appropriate appellation, as we have -seen), “Alfred Weeks” being the name given him -by his Western benefactor. The fellow was a most -accomplished hypocrite and it was by the exercise of -this attribute that he had obtained the situation as -Adoniram Pepper’s clerk, and kept it for ten years, -despite many of his evil deeds coming to the knowledge -of the shipping merchant.</p> - -<p>Not one of the three persons who had been in the -office that afternoon when his presence in the wardrobe -was discovered, realized how thoroughly bad at -heart Weeks was, or how dangerous an enemy they -had made. Even Caleb Wetherbee did not fully recognize -it.</p> - -<p>But they <i>had</i> made an enemy, and within twenty-four -hours that enemy was at work to undermine and -thwart their plans.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_158">[158]</span>Weeks had overheard enough of the story of the -Silver Swan and her valuable cargo to make it an -easy matter for him to decide on a line of action which -might lead to his own benefit, as well as to the compassing -of his much desired revenge.</p> - -<p>He solaced his wounded feelings the evening after -his dismissal from the ship owner’s office by a trip to -his favorite resort—the Bowery Theater—where he -again drank in the highly colored sentences and romantic -tableaux of that great drama “The Buccaneer’s -Bride.” Unfortunately, however, he was -forced to remain standing during the play for obvious -reasons; the seats of the theater were not cushioned.</p> - -<p>The next forenoon he adorned himself in the height -of Bowery style, and strolled down past the scene of -his former labors and on toward that rendezvous -known as the New England Hotel. He had his plans -already mapped out, and the first thing to do was to -join forces with Jim Leroyd, whom he knew very well -by reputation, at least, as did a great many others -among the denizens of lower New York.</p> - -<p>But as he strolled along Water Street he discovered -something which slightly changed his plans. Perhaps, -to be exact, I should say that he discovered <i>somebody</i>.</p> - -<p>On the opposite side of the thoroughfare was a -weazen faced old man, with bowed shoulders, and not -altogether steady feet. He was dressed in rusty black -clothes of a pattern far remote from the present day.</p> - -<p>Evidently he was quite confused by his surroundings -and by the crowd which jostled him on the walk.</p> - -<p>“What a chance for a ‘bunco man,’” exclaimed the -festive Alfred, under his breath. “That’s country,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_159">[159]</span> -sure enough. I wonder how it ever got here all -alone,” and the philanthropic ex-clerk crossed the -street at once and fell into the old man’s wake.</p> - -<p>Despite his countrified manner, however, there was -an air of shrewd, suspicious intelligence about the man -of the rusty habiliments. Fortunately for the success -of his further plans, Weeks did not seek to accost him -at once.</p> - -<p>Had he done so he would have aroused the countryman’s -suspicions. The latter had come warned and -forearmed against strangers who sought his acquaintance.</p> - -<p>As they went along, the old man ahead and Weeks -in the rear, the latter discovered that the countryman -was seeking for something. He went along slowly, -with his eyes fixed on the signs on either side, studying -each new one as it came in view with apparent interest.</p> - -<p>Finally he stopped on the corner of a cross street -and looked about him at the rushing, hurried life -in perplexity. Now was Mr. Week’s chance.</p> - -<p>He strolled slowly along toward the old fellow, the -only person without an apparent object, in that whole -multitude.</p> - -<p>As the ex-clerk expected, the countryman accosted -him.</p> - -<p>“Say, mister,” he said, in his harsh, cracked voice, -which rose plainly above the noise of the street, “kin -you tell me the whereabouts of the New England Hotel?”</p> - -<p>“Whew!” thought Mr. Weeks. “Pretty shady locality<span class="pagenum" id="Page_160">[160]</span> -for a respectable farmer. Wonder what the old -fellow wants <i>there</i>?”</p> - -<p>Then aloud he said:</p> - -<p>“I’m going along there myself, sir; it is several -blocks yet.”</p> - -<p>“Wal, ’t seems ter me,” snarled the other, taking -his place by the side of Weeks, “thet this ’ere street -hain’t got no end, nor no numbers ter speak of. I -looked in one o’ them things over at the hotel—a -d’rectory I b’lieve the clerk called it—but I don’t see -as it helped me any.”</p> - -<p>“It’s pretty hard for a stranger to find his way about -New York, that’s a fact.”</p> - -<p>The old fellow flashed a sudden look at his companion, -which was not lost on the sly Weeks. The -farmer had “read up” on “bunco men” and their -ways, and expected that the polite stranger would suggest -showing him about the city a little.</p> - -<p>But Weeks didn’t; he wasn’t that kind.</p> - -<p>Finding that the fellow seemed totally uninterested -as to whether he found his way about the metropolis -or not, the countryman gained a little confidence in his -new acquaintance.</p> - -<p>“New York streets hain’t much like Providence -streets,” he said. “Ye <i>kin</i> find yer way ’round them; -but I defy any one ter know whether they’re goin’ -straight here, or not.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Weeks smiled and nodded, but let the other do -most of the talking. He went on the principle that -if you give a fool rope enough he’ll hang himself; -and although the old fellow thought himself -exceedingly shrewd, and took pains to dodge the real<span class="pagenum" id="Page_161">[161]</span> -object of his visit to New York, in seeking to be pleasant -to his new acquaintance he “gave the whole thing -dead away,” as the astute Alfred mentally expressed it.</p> - -<p>“Ye see,” said the old man. “I’m down here -a-lookin for my nevvy, Brandon, who’s run away from -me. Nothing else would ha’ got me down here right -in the beginnin’ of the spring work.”</p> - -<p>Weeks started slightly, but otherwise showed no -signs of special interest; but as the old fellow ran on -about the terrible state he expected his affairs would -be in because of his absence, Mr. Alfred Weeks did -some pretty tall thinking.</p> - -<p>“Brandon is no common name,” so the ex-clerk -communed with himself. “I bet there hasn’t been <i>two</i> -Brandons come to New York within the past few -days—both from Rhode Island, too.</p> - -<p>“This is the old uncle I heard the young chap -mention. He’s down here after the boy, eh? But -I’m betting there’s something else behind it. Now, -let’s see; what does he want at the New England Hotel?</p> - -<p>“Leroyd, so young Tarr said, had been up to Rhode -Island to see him.” Weeks thought, continuing his -train of reasoning. “Passed himself off to <i>him</i>, at -least, as old Wetherbee. Oh, Jim’s a keen one, he is! -Now Leroyd’s at the hotel—at least, he <i>has</i> been. -What is this old scarecrow going there for?</p> - -<p>“There’s a great big rat in the toe of this stocking,” -Mr. Weeks assured himself. “This uncle is an old -scamp, that’s <i>my</i> opinion.” (Mr. Weeks knew a -scamp when he saw one—excepting when he looked<span class="pagenum" id="Page_162">[162]</span> -in the glass.) “I’d wager a good deal that he and -Jim understand each other pretty well.</p> - -<p>“Probably Jim has let the old fellow into the fact -that there’s treasure aboard that brig, hoping to get -him to back him in an attempt to find it. By the cast -in the old man’s eye, I reckon he’s always on the -lookout for the almighty dollar. Now, he and Jim -are going to try and hitch horses together, I bet. And -am I in this? I betcher! with both feet!”</p> - -<p>With this elegant expression, Mr. Weeks drew up -before the uninviting resort known as the New England -Hotel.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_163">[163]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXIII<br /> - - -<small>MR. ALFRED WEEKS AT A CERTAIN CONFERENCE</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Here</span> we are, mister,” said the ex-clerk; “see, -there’s the sign—New England Hotel. Did you expect -to find your runaway nephew here?”</p> - -<p>“No-o,” replied old Arad Tarr, eying the place with -a good deal of disfavor.</p> - -<p>“See here,” said Weeks slowly, “I’ve been trying -to remember whereabouts I’ve heard that name ‘Brandon’ -before. It’s not a common name, you know.”</p> - -<p>“No, ’taint common. D’ye thing ye’ve seen -Brandon since he’s been here in New York? He’s -only been here two days, I reckon,” said old Arad -eagerly.</p> - -<p>“Perhaps.”</p> - -<p>“Where was he?” queried the old man. “I’m his -lawful guardeen, an’ I’m a-goin’ ter hev him back, -now I tell ye!”</p> - -<p>“Let’s see; his name is Brandon Tarr, isn’t it?”</p> - -<p>“That’s it; that’s it,” Arad declared.</p> - -<p>“And he came from Chopmist, Rhode Island?”</p> - -<p>“Sartin. You must have seen him, mister.”</p> - -<p>“I guess I have,” said Weeks reflectively. “He -was the son of a Captain Horace Tarr, lost at sea on -the Silver Swan not long ago, eh?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_164">[164]</span>“The very feller!” cried Arad, with manifest delight.</p> - -<p>“Then I guess I can help you find him,” declared -Weeks cheerfully. “Let’s go inside and I’ll tell you -how I happened to run across him. It’s not a very -nice looking place, this isn’t; but they know me here -and it won’t be safe for them to treat any of my friends -crooked.”</p> - -<p>The old man, who had forgotten all about bunco -men and their ilk in his anxiety to recover his nephew, -followed him into the bar room. The place was but -poorly patronized at this hour of the day, and with a -nod to Brady, who, his face adorned with a most beautiful -black eye, was behind the bar, Weeks led the -way to an empty table in the further corner.</p> - -<p>“What’ll you an’ your friend hev ter drink?” inquired -Mr. Brady, with an atrocious grin.</p> - -<p>“Oh, a bottle of sarsaparilla,” responded Weeks -carelessly, and when the bull necked barkeeper had -brought it, the ex-clerk paid for the refreshment himself.</p> - -<p>Old Arad had looked rather scared at the appearance -of the bottle. His mind at once reverted to the -stories he had read in the local paper at home (which -paper he had borrowed from a neighbor, by the way) -of countrymen being decoyed into dens in New York -and treated to drugged liquor.</p> - -<p>But as Weeks allowed the bottle to stand on the -table between them untouched throughout their conference, -the old man felt easier in his mind.</p> - -<p>“Ye say ye’ve seen Brandon?” inquired Arad,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_165">[165]</span> -when Jack Brady had returned to his position behind -the bar, and there was nobody within earshot.</p> - -<p>“Yes. I’ll tell you how it was. You see, Mr. -Tarr—that’s your name, isn’t it?—I have a position -in a shipping merchant’s office as clerk. The -office is—er—closed today, so I am out. This -office is that of Adoniram Pepper & Co. Ever hear -of them?”</p> - -<p>Old Arad shook his head negatively.</p> - -<p>“Pepper was a great friend of this Brandon’s -father, so I understand.”</p> - -<p>“Mebbe,” snarled the farmer. “Cap’n Tarr’s -friends warn’t <i>my</i> friends.”</p> - -<p>“No? Well, your nephew steered straight for -Pepper’s office, and I believe that he’s staying at the -old man’s house now—he and a man by the name of -Caleb Wetherbee.”</p> - -<p>“Caleb Wetherbee? Gracious Peter!” ejaculated -the old man. “Hez he found <i>him</i> so soon.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Weeks nodded briefly.</p> - -<p>“This Wetherbee was mate of the Silver Swan.”</p> - -<p>“That’s the man,” muttered Arad hopelessly.</p> - -<p>“I take it you didn’t want your nephew and this -Wetherbee to meet?” suggested Weeks shrewdly.</p> - -<p>“No—o——well, I dunno. I—I’m erfraid -’twon’t be so easy to git Brandon back ter the -farm ef he’s found this mate.”</p> - -<p>“Perhaps we can fix it up,” said Weeks cheerfully.</p> - -<p>“D’ye think so?”</p> - -<p>“Let’s see; are you his legal guardian?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I be,” declared Arad savagely; “on’y the -papers ain’t made aout.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_166">[166]</span>“I don’t really see, then, how you can bring it about -until you are appointed,” said Mr. Weeks slowly.</p> - -<p>“I jest kin!” asserted Arad, with confidence. “I -gotter warrant here for him.”</p> - -<p>“Whew!” The astute Weeks looked at the old sinner -admiringly. “Well, well! you <i>are</i> a smart one. -What’s the charge?”</p> - -<p>“Robbing me,” responded the old man. “The day -he run away he took ’most fifty dollars outer a—a -beury droor. Dretful bad boy is that Brandon.”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I should think so. Well, with that warrant -I should think you had him pretty straight.”</p> - -<p>“D’ye think I kin find him all right?” asked Arad -anxiously.</p> - -<p>“If you can’t, I can,” responded Weeks. “I know -where to put my hand on him.”</p> - -<p>At that moment a door at the rear of the room -(within a few feet of the table at which they were -seated, in fact) opened, and a man entered. Weeks -recognized him at once as Jim Leroyd; he had seen -him before, although he could claim no speaking acquaintance -with him.</p> - -<p>Old Arad also saw and recognized the newcomer, -and as the sailor passed along the room, he caught -sight of the old farmer.</p> - -<p>“Why, dash my top lights!” he exclaimed, in surprise. -“Ef here ain’t Mr. Tarr!”</p> - -<p>He stepped back to the table and grasped the -old man’s hand most cordially, at the same time casting -a suspicious glance at Weeks. He knew the ex-clerk -by reputation, as Weeks knew <i>him</i>.</p> - -<p>“Don’t ye be up ter any funny biz with this gentleman,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_167">[167]</span> -Sneaky,” he said, with a scowl. “He’s my -friend.”</p> - -<p>“Don’t you fret,” responded Weeks. “He and I -were talking about his nephew, Brandon Tarr, who -was up to see you yesterday——”</p> - -<p>Mr. Leroyd uttered a volley of choice profanity -at this, and Arad was greatly surprised.</p> - -<p>“Came ter see yeou?” he gasped. “Er—erbout -that matter we was a-talkin’ of, Mr. Leroyd? Ye -know I—I’m his legal guardeen——”</p> - -<p>“Don’t ye be scared, Mr. Tarr,” said Weeks, who -understood the circumstances pretty well, “I can vouch -for Jim, here, not playing you false.”</p> - -<p>“What do you know about it, anyway?” growled -Jim uglily.</p> - -<p>“Now, sit down and keep cool, Leroyd,” urged -Weeks. “I know <i>all</i> about it. I know about your -little scheme to gobble the—the <i>treasure</i> aboard the -Silver Swan——”</p> - -<p>“Sh!” exclaimed Leroyd fiercely. “You know too -much, young feller.”</p> - -<p>“No, I know just enough, and I’ll prove it to you.”</p> - -<p>“I s’pose ye think ye kin force yer way inter this, -but ye’re mistaken. This is the private affair o’ Mr. -Tarr an’ me, an’ I warn ye ter keep yer nose out.”</p> - -<p>He arose as he spoke, his fierce eyes fixed threateningly -upon Weeks’ impassive face.</p> - -<p>“You come with me, Mr. Tarr, where we can talk -the matter over privately. We don’t want nothin’ o’ -that swab.”</p> - -<p>The red headed ex-clerk fairly laughed aloud at -this.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_168">[168]</span>“See here, Leroyd,” he said, still coolly: “you made -a break for those papers yesterday, I believe. What -did you get?”</p> - -<p>“Hey?” roared the sailor.</p> - -<p>“I said that you made a break for those papers of -Cale Wetherbee’s yesterday,” repeated Weeks, slowly -and distinctly. “Now, what did you get?”</p> - -<p>“Not a blamed thing,” responded the sailor frankly, -after an instant’s hesitation.</p> - -<p>“That’s what I thought. I thought Cale Wetherbee -took it altogether too coolly if you <i>had</i> made a -haul worth anything. Now, I could tell you something, -if I thought ’twould be worth my while.”</p> - -<p>“What is it?”</p> - -<p>“Do you know what the treasure hidden aboard -the brig consists of?”</p> - -<p>“No,” replied Leroyd shortly, while old Arad gazed -from one to the other in bewilderment.</p> - -<p>“Well, I do,” declared Weeks.</p> - -<p>“Ye do?”</p> - -<p>“Sure. I heard that Wetherbee and the boy and -old man Pepper talking it over.”</p> - -<p>“Who’s Pepper?” growled Leroyd.</p> - -<p>“He’s the feller who is going to back ’em in this -hunt for the brig. He’s going to furnish the vessel -and all.”</p> - -<p>“Curses on the luck!” growled the sailor again.</p> - -<p>Here old Arad interposed. The old man’s hands -were trembling violently, and his face was pale with -excitement.</p> - -<p>“We—we must stop ’em—they ain’t got no right -ter do it,” he sputtered. “Horace Tarr was my nevvy,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_169">[169]</span> -an’ I’m the guardeen o’ that boy. There hain’t nobody -else got no right to go arter them di’monds.”</p> - -<p>“Diamonds!” exclaimed Leroyd. “Is <i>that</i> the -treasure?”</p> - -<p>“Ye—es,” replied Arad hesitatingly, looking at -Weeks. “I—I found a letter from this Wetherbee, -the mate of the Silver Swan, an’ it says so. Horace’s -brother Anson got ’em in South Afriky.”</p> - -<p>“Good for you, old feller,” said Leroyd admiringly. -“Ye did take my advice, didn’t ye?”</p> - -<p>Old Arad rubbed his hands together as though -washing them with imaginary soap, and grinned.</p> - -<p>“Yes, diamonds is the treasure,” Weeks rejoined -calmly. “Now, you’ll start right off to find the brig -with Mr. Tarr here to back you with money, eh, -Leroyd?”</p> - -<p>“Never ye mind <i>what</i> I’ll do,” returned Jim, uglily. -“I tell ye this hain’t none o’ your funeral, so you keep -out of it, Sneaky.”</p> - -<p>“Are you sure?” asked Weeks, with a tantalizing -smile.</p> - -<p>“Yes, I’m sure!” roared the enraged sailor.</p> - -<p>“Well, don’t holler so loud,” the red haired one -admonished him. “But I think you’re mistaken.”</p> - -<p>Leroyd glared at him like an angry bull dog but -said nothing.</p> - -<p>“Now I s’pose,” continued Weeks, cocking his eye -at the smoke begrimmed ceiling of the bar room, -“that you expect to get a vessel an’ go in pursuit of -the Silver Swan; and that when you’ve got her you’ll -tow her in port, an’ you’ll have the salvage—that’ll -be a pretty good sum.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_170">[170]</span>“And the di’monds,” interjected Arad, with an avaricious -chuckle.</p> - -<p>“Oh, will you?” said Weeks with cool sarcasm. -“That remains to be seen. You’ll have the brig fast -enough: but how’ll you get the stones?”</p> - -<p>“Why, ef we git the brig won’t the diamonds be -aboard her?” queried Arad.</p> - -<p>“Yes, they will; but <i>where will they be</i>, aboard her? -Can you tell me that?”</p> - -<p>Arad’s jaw fell and he stared blankly at the shrewd -Weeks. Even Leroyd was visibly moved by this -statement.</p> - -<p>“You don’t know where the diamonds are hidden,” -continued Weeks, pursuing his advantage. “You -might tear that whole brig to pieces an’ not find ’em, -<i>but I know just where they are and I can put my -hand right on ’em</i>!”</p> - -<p>“You kin?” gasped old Arad.</p> - -<p>“Is that straight, Sneaky?” demanded Leroyd, with -interest.</p> - -<p>Weeks nodded calmly.</p> - -<p>“I believe you’re lying,” the sailor declared.</p> - -<p>“Well you can think so if you want to,” said the -ex-clerk, rising, “and I’ll go now and find somebody -to go in with me on this scheme, and I’ll run my -chances of getting to the brig first. You can have the -old hulk and welcome after I’ve been aboard her five -minutes, Leroyd.</p> - -<p>“But, if you’ll let me in on the ground floor of this,” -he continued, “and give me one third of all there is -in it, why all right. If you don’t, probably you’ll get -nothing, while me and the other fellow’ll get it <i>all</i>,” -and Mr. Weeks smiled benignantly upon his audience.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_171">[171]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXIV<br /> - - -<small>HOW A NEFARIOUS COMPACT WAS FORMED</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">But</span> yeou can’t do that!” cried old Arad Tarr, -the first to break the silence after Mr. Weeks had delivered -what might be termed his “ultimatum.” -“There hasn’t anybody got airy right ter go arter them -di’monds, but them I send.”</p> - -<p>“That is where you make an error, Mr. Tarr,” responded -Weeks cheerfully. “This is what is called -‘treasure trove;’ the fellow who gets there first has -the best right to it.”</p> - -<p>“It ben’t so, is it?” whined the old man, appealing -to Leroyd.</p> - -<p>“Yes, I s’pose it is,” admitted the sailor, with a -growl. “He’s got us foul, old man.”</p> - -<p>“Now, don’t talk that way, Leroyd,” exclaimed -Weeks briskly. “We three must strike hands and share -evenly in this thing. You need me, any way, though -I can get along without either of you; for you know -it wouldn’t take me long to find a man to back me -with a couple of hundred dollars against the chance -of winning thousands.”</p> - -<p>“Well, you’re right,” said the sailor, seeing that it -would be for his advantage to make terms with -“Sneaky Al,” as the red haired Weeks was familiarly -called.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_172">[172]</span>“Two hundred dollars is an awful lot of money ter -risk,” muttered old Arad, knowing that he was the -one who would be expected to furnish the “sinews of -war.”</p> - -<p>“’Tain’t much compared with mebbe three hundred -thousand dollars. I heered Cap’n Tarr say, myself, -that there was enough o’ them di’monds, ter make a -man fabulously rich,” responded Leroyd quickly. -“That’d be a clean hundred thousand for each of us.”</p> - -<p>“But ef I furnish the money I’d oughter hev more -o’ th’ returns,” declared the farmer, who was quite -as sharp as either of his companions.</p> - -<p>“Come, we won’t quarrel over that,” the sailor declared, -rising again. “But we want to talk this matter -over where it’s more quiet like. I’ve got a room -here. Let’s go up to it, where we shan’t be disturbed.”</p> - -<p>“Now you’re talking sense,” Weeks declared, rising -gingerly from the chair in which he had again -seated himself.</p> - -<p>At that instant Mr. Brady, who had been kept busy -at the bar by transient customers for the past half -hour, called Leroyd over to him.</p> - -<p>“Now, look a-here, Jim,” he said, in a hoarse aside, -“wot be you an’ Sneaky Al up to? Dere ain’t goin’ -ter be no game played on dat countryman here, see? -Ye got me inter ’nough trouble yest’day. Ef I hadn’t -a pull in dis ward, dey’d er—nabbed me, sure.”</p> - -<p>“Don’t you fret, Jack,” responded Leroyd reassuringly. -“We ain’t inter any bunco business. The old -man knows what he’s about, ef he <i>does</i> look like a hay-seed. -Ef he don’t do <i>us</i>, it’ll be lucky.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_173">[173]</span>“Well, what’s de game?” Brady demanded.</p> - -<p>“Never you mind, old man. We’re just going up -stairs for a private confab, an’ ef things turn out right, -I kin promise a cool hundred for keeping your mouth -shut. Savey?”</p> - -<p>Brady nodded.</p> - -<p>“I’m mum,” he said, with satisfaction. “On’y I -don’t want dem cops down on me ag’in, so mind yer -eye.”</p> - -<p>Armed with a bottle and glasses, Leroyd led the way -into a small room a good deal nearer the roof of the -building, in which the New England Hotel was located. -His two companions, however, left the sailor -to dispose of the refreshments alone; the old farmer -because he had never used liquor in any shape at home, -and Weeks because he proposed to keep his brain perfectly -clear that he might be sure to retain the “whip -hand” of the other conspirators.</p> - -<p>It is not my purpose to report verbatim the plans of -the three villains. Let it suffice to say that after much -discussion, and by virtue of coaxings, threatenings, -promises, and what not, the sailor and Weeks (who -saw at once that it would be for their mutual advantage -to play into each other’s hands) obtained old -Arad Tarr’s consent to furnish them with the sum of -over two hundred dollars (and more if it was found -to be actually needed) with which to charter the -vessel.</p> - -<p>You may be sure that the two rascals never worked -harder (with their tongues) for two hundred dollars -in their lives, for the amount looked as large to old -Arad as ten thousand would to almost any other man.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_174">[174]</span>The plot of the conspirators likewise included the -discovery of Brandon’s whereabouts and his arrest on -the charge of robbery, as set forth in the warrant -with which Arad supplied himself before he left -Rhode Island. This part of the scheme Weeks proposed -to attend to.</p> - -<p>Then, with a great deal of flourish and legal formula, -the astute Mr. Weeks drew up a most wonderful -document (he was well versed in legal phrases), -which bound each of the three, Arad Tarr, James Leroyd, -and Alfred Weeks, to a co-partnership, the object -of which was to seek and obtain the floating hulk -of the Silver Swan, and the treasure thereon, the profit -of the venture to be divided equally between them, -excepting the sum of one thousand dollars which was -to go to Arad Tarr under <i>any</i> circumstances. And, -of course, the document wasn’t worth the paper on -which it was written.</p> - -<p>But the old man didn’t know this. He was a great -worshiper of the law, and he trusted in the legality of -the paper to hold his partners to their promises. He -lost sight, however, of the fact that the two men were -going together on the quest for the Silver Swan, and -that he—well, <i>he</i> was to stay at home, and <i>wait</i>. -Waiting isn’t very hard work, to be sure; but it is -terribly wearing.</p> - -<p>These several things having been accomplished, and -it being long past noon, the conspirators went their -different ways—old Arad to interview the brokerage -firm of Bensell, Bensell & Marsden, which, he was -sure, was cheating him out of his dividends: Weeks -to hunt up a scaly friend of his to serve the warrant<span class="pagenum" id="Page_175">[175]</span> -upon unsuspicious Brandon; and Leroyd to look about -for a vessel which could be converted to their purpose -in the shortest possible time.</p> - -<p>And now, let us return to Brandon and his two -good friends, Caleb Wetherbee and Adoniram Pepper, -and find out how much progress <i>they</i> have made in the -quest of the Silver Swan.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_176">[176]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXV<br /> - - -<small>UNCLE ARAD MAKES AN ANNOUNCEMENT</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">If</span> Caleb Wetherbee passed as sleepless a night as -did his young friend, Brandon, he showed no signs -of it when he appeared the next morning. They were -a very jolly party indeed at the breakfast table, for -the old sailor had recovered, to some extent at least, -his equanimity when in the presence of Miss Frances.</p> - -<p>“Now, Caleb, have you decided to accept my offer -of last evening?” Adoniram inquired, as they arose -after the meal.</p> - -<p>“Let’s see the steamer,” returned the sailor, noncommittally; -so the merchant and his two guests went -down to the docks at once.</p> - -<p>To a person who has never seen a whaleback -steamer, the first view of one is certainly a most surprising -sight. He is at once reminded of Jules Verne’s -great story of the Nautilus, the wonderful steel ship -which could sail equally well below and upon the -surface of the ocean.</p> - -<p>Number Three was more than two hundred feet in -length, and was shaped like a huge cigar, the blunt -end, oddly enough, being the bow. This blunt “nose” -is what suggested the term “pig,” as applied to the -whalebacks when first they appeared on the Great -Lakes.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_177">[177]</span>At the forward end of the steamer a turret arose -from the curved deck, furnished with one of the -American Ship Windlass Co.’s steam windlasses (with -the capstan above), and with hand steering gear, the -shaft and hub of the wheel being of brass to avoid -affecting the compass.</p> - -<p>The cabin aft, which was fifteen feet above the -deck, and therefore presented a most astonishing appearance, -was supported by two turrets, and several -strong ventilating pipes, the latter connecting with the -engine room, fire hold, and cargo hold.</p> - -<p>A low rail ran from bow to stern of the steamer, -on either side, inclosing the turrets within its shelter, -thus making it possible for the crew to go from the -aft to the forward turrets.</p> - -<p>The deck, however, was so curved that the feat -would not be easy to perform in rough weather, if -the whaleback <i>did</i> roll as do other vessels.</p> - -<p>“Ye call that a steamer, do ye?” demanded Caleb, -in disgust, when he first caught sight of Number -Three; but after he had gone aboard, and seen and -understood the advantages the whaleback possessed -over the other seagoing craft, he no longer scoffed.</p> - -<p>Adoniram first led them to the officers’ quarters. -These were finished in oak, and furnished almost as -sumptuously as the cabin of a fancy yacht. The suite -contained a dining room of comfortable size, and a -chart room and offices on the port side of the cabin.</p> - -<p>Below deck were the quarters of the crew, forward -and aft, and they were as comfortable as those on a -palatial ocean steamship.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_178">[178]</span>“It’s a wonderful boat,” Brandon declared, as they -examined the engine.</p> - -<p>“It is that,” the ship owner assented. “I paid a -pretty penny for her, but she’s worth it—every cent. -She’ll outride any gale that ever blew, as long as you -keep her in deep water. ’Twould be hard to sink her.</p> - -<p>“In the matter of ballast,” he continued, “there are -arrangements for carrying eight hundred ton of water—water -is used altogether for ballast in these whalebacks. -Then the engines are of the newest build, too, -you see.</p> - -<p>“The steam is generated from these two steel -boilers, each eleven and a half feet in diameter by the -same in length, possessing a working pressure of one -hundred and twenty-five pounds. If the engine goes -back on you, you will have to get out the oars and -row ashore, for there is no chance for raising a sail,” -and the jolly ship owner laughed good naturedly.</p> - -<p>“Well, I’ve been to sea on a good many craft—most -anything that would float, in fact, from a torpedo -boat to a Chinese junk—but this takes the bun,” -Caleb declared as they stepped upon the dock again.</p> - -<p>“Then I take it you’ll try your hand at this?” -Adoniram asked slily.</p> - -<p>“Oh, yes, I s’ppose so, Pepperpod—and the boy, -too. By the way, does Lawrence Coffin know anything -about this craft?”</p> - -<p>“He went to West Superior (where she was built) -and came down in her,” declared the merchant.</p> - -<p>“It’s all right, then. He’ll know what to do if we -get to sea and the blamed thing should roll over.”</p> - -<p>But despite the fact that he scoffed at the vessel,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_179">[179]</span> -Caleb set to work with his customary energy to make -ready for the voyage.</p> - -<p>The ship owner gave him <i>carte blanche</i> to provision -the whaleback and secure the crew. The engineers -and firemen were already engaged and the work of -making ready for sea went on rapidly.</p> - -<p>Caleb being a worker himself, expected a good deal -of everybody about him and Brandon found himself -with plenty to do during the next two days. He ran -errands, and bought provisions under the old sailor’s -directions, and saw to the storing away of the articles -purchased.</p> - -<p>On the morning of the third day, however, came -an interruption, and one which promised to be most -serious.</p> - -<p>In these times of hurried preparation Caleb and his -young second mate made the Water Street office of -Adoniram Pepper & Co. their headquarters. They -were in and out of the place a score of times a day to -the satisfaction of Adoniram, but, if the truth were -told, to the great annoyance of the solemn faced young -man whom Mr. Marks had sent up from the other -office to take the place of the departed Weeks.</p> - -<p>About ten o’clock on this forenoon Brandon ran in -to see if he could find Caleb, as that individual was not -at the dock where lay the whaleback, and where the -boy had expected to meet him.</p> - -<p>“Where do you suppose he has gone?” Don asked -of Mr. Pepper, who, good soul, seemed to have no -other business on hand but the getting ready of the -steamer.</p> - -<p>“I don’t know, I’m sure. You’d better sit down,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_180">[180]</span> -my boy, and wait for him,” advised Adoniram kindly. -“He’s sure to turn up here, first or last.”</p> - -<p>So Brandon sat down, striving to stifle his impatience. -He had not waited ten minutes, however, -when the door of the outer office was opened, and -somebody entered.</p> - -<p>“Here he is now,” exclaimed the youth, thinking he -heard Caleb’s voice.</p> - -<p>He threw open the door between the two offices, -gave one glance into the apartment beyond, and staggered -to the nearest chair in utter amazement.</p> - -<p>“Great Peter! it’s Uncle Arad!” he gasped, in -answer to Adoniram’s questioning exclamation, and -the next instant Uncle Arad himself appeared at the -open portal of the private office.</p> - -<p>“Thar ye air, ye young reskil!” exclaimed the old -man, shaking his bony forefinger at the youth.</p> - -<p>Behind him was another man—a clean shaven, -foxy looking fellow, who, when old Arad had pointed -the boy out, stepped quickly into the room.</p> - -<p>“Well, well!” exclaimed Brandon, recovering in -part from his surprise. “Who’d have thought of -seeing <i>you</i> here, Uncle Arad!”</p> - -<p>“Not yeou, I warrant!” cackled the old man shrilly. -“I s’pose ye thought ye c’d git off scott free with yer -ill gotten gains, didn’t ye?”</p> - -<p>“What?”</p> - -<p>Brandon’s face flamed up redly, and he sprang to -his feet in rage.</p> - -<p>“What do you mean?” he demanded.</p> - -<p>“Don’t ye let him escape, officer!” the farmer exclaimed, -shrinking back. “He’s quick’s a cat.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_181">[181]</span>But here Adoniram took a hand in the proceedings.</p> - -<p>“I should like to know, sir, what you mean by -this?” he said, his gray eyes flashing behind the tip -tilted eye glasses. “Brandon is under <i>my</i> care, sir, and -I will not allow such remarks to be addressed to him.”</p> - -<p>No one would have believed that it was the jolly -Adoniram, to see his face now. The habitual smile -had disappeared entirely.</p> - -<p>“I dunno who yeou be,” Arad replied defiantly; -“but I kin tell ye who I be, purty quick. I’m Arad -Tarr; this young reskil here is my nevvy; an’ I’m his -nateral an’ lawful guardeen.”</p> - -<p>“Ah!” said Mr. Pepper, with quiet sarcasm. “So -you are his guardian, are you? How long since?”</p> - -<p>“How long since?” repeated the old man, in a -rage. “I’ll show ye! I’ve <i>allus</i> been his guardeen—leastways, -since his pa died.”</p> - -<p>“Which occurred a little over two months ago,” -said Adoniram briefly. “Now, Mr. Tarr, for I suppose -that is your name, where are your papers making -you this lad’s guardian? Who appointed you?”</p> - -<p>“I’m his nateral guardeen now,” old Arad declared -slowly; “but I’m goin’ to be ’p’inted by the court.”</p> - -<p>“What court?”</p> - -<p>“The Court o’ Probate, o’ Scituate, R. I.,” responded -the farmer pompously.</p> - -<p>“Well, I think not,” said Adoniram, who was probably -never more angry in his life than at that moment. -“You have made a slight mistake, Mr. Tarr.”</p> - -<p>“Hey?” returned the farmer, growing red in the -face, and looking daggers at the little merchant.</p> - -<p>“I say you have made a slight mistake. You will<span class="pagenum" id="Page_182">[182]</span> -<i>not</i> be appointed guardian of Brandon, by any court -in the land. Did it ever occur to you that Captain -Horace Tarr might have made a will?”</p> - -<p>“A will?” gasped the old man.</p> - -<p>“Yes, sir, a will.”</p> - -<p>“But he didn’t hev nothin’ ter will, ’ceptin——”</p> - -<p>“Well, excepting what?” Mr. Pepper demanded, as -the other hesitated.</p> - -<p>“Nothin’.”</p> - -<p>“Well, he <i>did</i> have something to will, and he appointed -me joint guardian, with another gentleman, -and <i>you</i>, Mr. Tarr, are <i>not</i> the party named to assist -me. We have already made application in the New -York courts to have the appointment allowed and the -will has been presented for probate.”</p> - -<p>“I—I don’t believe it!” shouted Arad.</p> - -<p>“You’re not obliged to. But that doesn’t affect -the facts of the case, just the same.”</p> - -<p>For a moment the farmer was quite nonplussed: -but then he looked at the man he had brought with -him again, and his faith revived.</p> - -<p>“Ye can’t escape me this way, ye young varmint!” -he exclaimed, turning upon Brandon as though he -were some way at fault for the wrecking of his plans. -“Mebbe I hain’t your guardeen, but I’ve power -’nough right here ter lug ye back ter Scituate an’ put -yer through fur stealin’ that money.”</p> - -<p>“What money?” demanded Brandon, white with -rage. “To what do you refer?”</p> - -<p>“That fifty dollars ye stole f’om me—that’s what -I mean,” old Arad declared. “Th’ money ye stoled -f’om my beury droor. I gotter warrant right here fur -ye, ’n’ this officer ter serve it!”</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_183">[183]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXVI<br /> - - -<small>CALEB WETHERBEE OBSTRUCTS THE COURSE OF THE LAW</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Brandon</span> was fairly paralyzed by Uncle Arad’s announcement. -He had realized that the old man was -sorely disappointed at his inability to keep him on the -farm. He had not, however, believed he would follow -him clear to New York, and hatch up such a scheme as -this to get him again in his power.</p> - -<p>“You old scoundrel!” he exclaimed, too enraged -for the moment to remember that he was speaking to -a man whose age, if not his character, should command -his respect.</p> - -<p>“Hush, Don,” commanded Adoniram Pepper admonishingly. -“It will not better matters to vituperate. -Mr. Tarr,” he added, turning to the farmer, “do -you realize what a serious charge you have made -against your nephew?”</p> - -<p>“I reckon I do,” Arad declared with vigor. “I -got it all down here on er warrant—Squire Holt -made it aout hisself. I’m er-goin’ ter hev that boy -arrested for burglarizing me. Now you go erhead, -Mr. Officer, an’ arrest him.”</p> - -<p>“Wait a moment,” and Adoniram stepped quickly -in front of Don before the foxy looking man could lay -his hand upon the boy’s shoulder.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_184">[184]</span>“Let me see that warrant?” he said.</p> - -<p>The officer passed the paper over with a flourish, -and Adoniram examined it closely.</p> - -<p>“Why,” he exclaimed, shortly, “this is returnable -to the Rhode Island courts.”</p> - -<p>“Of course it is,” snarled old Arad.</p> - -<p>“But do you propose taking the boy back to Rhode -Island?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, I do.”</p> - -<p>“But can’t this be settled here, officer?” asked -Adoniram nervously, knowing that any such delay as -this would ruin their plans for an early start after the -Silver Swan.</p> - -<p>“No, sir; the robbery was committed in Rhode -Island—it must be tried there,” replied the officer, -with a crafty smile.</p> - -<p>Adoniram handed the warrant back in utter bewilderment; -but at that juncture the door opened -again, and Caleb Wetherbee himself stumped in.</p> - -<p>“Hey! what’s this?” the old seaman demanded, -seeing instantly that something was up.</p> - -<p>Old Arad tried to shrink out of sight behind the -officer’s back as he viewed Caleb’s fear inspiring proportions.</p> - -<p>“This is my <i>dear</i> Uncle Arad, Caleb,” Brandon -hastened to say, “and he has come all the way from -Rhode Island to arrest me and take me back.”</p> - -<p>“For what?” cried Caleb, aghast.</p> - -<p>“For robbing him; so he says. Isn’t he kind?”</p> - -<p>Brandon was fairly furious, but he trusted in the -old seaman to get him out of his relative’s clutches.</p> - -<p>“Robbing him!”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_185">[185]</span>Caleb’s face grew red with rage.</p> - -<p>“What d’ye mean, ye old scamp?”</p> - -<p>“He <i>hez</i> robbed me,” Arad shrieked.</p> - -<p>“See here,” Caleb said coolly, “this looks to me like -petty persecution, don’t it to you, ’Doniram? I reckon -the courts would see it that way, too.”</p> - -<p>“The courts’ll send that reskil ter the State reform -school—that’s what they’ll do,” Arad declared.</p> - -<p>“So it’s locking him up you’re after, eh?” returned -Caleb. “Now, Brandon, don’t you worry about this. -We kin have it fixed up in no time.”</p> - -<p>“But the boy’s got to be taken to Rhode Island,” -exclaimed Adoniram. “It will be a matter of weeks.”</p> - -<p>“Weeks?” roared Caleb. “Why, the steamer sails -Tuesday. He can’t go.”</p> - -<p>“I guess, mister, that you won’t have much to do -with it,” remarked the man with the warrant officiously. -“This warrant is returnable to the Rhode Island -courts, and to Rhode Island he must go. If the boy -had wanted to go on a voyage he shouldn’t have stolen -the money.”</p> - -<p>Caleb actually roared at this and shook his huge fist -in the fellow’s face. Adoniram hastened to keep the -peace.</p> - -<p>“How do we know you are an officer?” he demanded -sternly. “This is a most atrocious action on -Mr. Tarr’s part, and for all we know you may be -party to it.”</p> - -<p>The officer smiled slily, and throwing back his coat -showed his badge.</p> - -<p>“I’m a dep’ty sheriff an’ don’t you fear,” he said. -“The boy must come along.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_186">[186]</span>But as he reached out to clutch Don, the big sailor -seized the youth and whirled him in behind him, placing -himself between the officer and his prisoner.</p> - -<p>“Don’t be too fast,” he said.</p> - -<p>“Do you dare resist arrest?” the officer demanded -angrily.</p> - -<p>“Nobody’s resisted you, yet.”</p> - -<p>His huge bulk, however, barred all approach to -Don, who was now between all the others and the -outer door.</p> - -<p>“If you arrest this boy you’ll seriously inconvenience -our plans, an’ we’ll make you sweat for it, now -I tell ye.”</p> - -<p>“I don’t care; I’m er—goin’ ter hev him took up!” -shrieked old Arad, to whom all this delay was agonizing.</p> - -<p>“You shut that trap of yours!” roared Caleb, turning -upon the old man in a fury. “Don’t ye dare open -it ag’in w’ile ye’re here, or there’ll be an assault case -in court, too.”</p> - -<p>Old Arad dodged back out of range of the sailor’s -brawny fist with great celerity.</p> - -<p>“Do——don’t ye let him tetch me, officer,” he implored, -jerking his bandanna from the pocket of his -shiny old black coat, and wiping his face nervously.</p> - -<p>With the handkerchief came forth a letter which fell -at Mr. Pepper’s feet; but for the moment nobody but -the merchant himself saw it.</p> - -<p>Brandon, who was directly behind the seaman, -leaned forward and whispered something in Caleb’s -ear. The old seaman’s face lit up in an instant, and -he changed his position so that his burly form completely<span class="pagenum" id="Page_187">[187]</span> -blocked the doorway leading into the outer -office.</p> - -<p>“So you won’t settle this thing out o’ court, eh?” -he demanded.</p> - -<p>The officer shook his head.</p> - -<p>“It’s gone too far,” he said.</p> - -<p>“It has, hey?” Caleb exclaimed in wrath. “Well, -so’ve <i>you</i> gone too far.” Then he exclaimed, turning -to Don: “Leg it, lad! We’ll outwit the landlubber -yet.”</p> - -<p>“Hi! stop him! stop him!” shrieked Uncle Arad, -for at the instant Caleb had spoken, Don had -darted back to the street door and thrown it open.</p> - -<p>“Good by, Uncle Arad!” the captain’s son cried -mockingly. “I’ll see you when I’ve returned from -the West Indies.”</p> - -<p>He was out in a moment, and the door slammed behind -him.</p> - -<p>The deputy sheriff sprang forward to follow, but -Caleb managed to get his wooden leg in the way, and -the officer measured his length on the office floor, while -Uncle Arad, fairly wild with rage, danced up and -down, and shrieked for the police.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_188">[188]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXVII<br /> - - -<small>WHEREIN BRANDON TARR CONCEALS HIMSELF</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">The</span> doughty deputy sheriff was on his feet in an -instant, and with a wrathy glance at Caleb, dashed out -of the office after the fleeing Brandon. If he did not -make the arrest he would fail to get his money, and -he did not propose to lose that.</p> - -<p>But Uncle Arad could not get to the door without -passing Caleb and he hardly dared do that. Just -then the big seaman looked in no mood to be tampered -with. The farmer, however, <i>did</i> sputter out something -about having the law on everybody in general.</p> - -<p>“Bring on all the law you want to, you old scarecrow,” -responded Caleb, vigorously mopping his face. -“I reckon we kin take care of it. What ye got there, -Adoniram?”</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper had picked up the letter which had -fallen from old Arad’s pocket, and was looking at the -superscription in a puzzled manner.</p> - -<p>Arad caught sight of the epistle as quickly as did -Caleb.</p> - -<p>“That’s mine! give it here!” he cried, making a -snatch at the paper.</p> - -<p>But Adoniram held it out of his reach.</p> - -<p>“I don’t see how you make that out, Mr. Tarr,” he -said quietly. “This letter is not addressed to you.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_189">[189]</span> -It is in <i>your</i> handwriting, Caleb, and is addressed to -‘Master Brandon Tarr, Chopmist, Rhode Island.’”</p> - -<p>“Oh, you swab!” exclaimed the old tar, with a -withering glance of contempt at old Arad, as he seized -the letter. “This ’ere’s what I wrote the boy w’en -I was in the hospital—w’ich same he never got. -Now, how came <i>you</i> by it? You old land shark!”</p> - -<p>Arad was undeniably frightened. Although he -might explain the fact of his opening Don’s letter as -eminently proper, to himself, he well knew that he -could not make these friends of his nephew see it in -the same light.</p> - -<p>“I—I—it came arter Brandon went away,” he -gasped in excuse.</p> - -<p>“It did, hey?” exclaimed Caleb suspiciously.</p> - -<p>Mr. Pepper took the envelope again and examined -the postmark critically.</p> - -<p>“Hum—um,” he said slowly, “postmarked in New -York on the third; received on the afternoon of the -fourth at the Chopmist post office. I’m afraid, my -dear sir, that that yarn won’t wash.”</p> - -<p>Uncle Arad was speechless, and looked from one -to the other of the stern faced men in doubt.</p> - -<p>“He—he was my nevvy; didn’t I hev a right ter -see what he had written ter him?”</p> - -<p>“You can bet ye didn’t,” Caleb declared with confidence, -and with a slight wink at Adoniram. “Let -me tell ye, Mr. Tarr, that openin’ other folks’ correspondence -is actionable, as the lawyers say. I reckon -that you’ve laid yourself li’ble to gettin’ arrested yourself, -old man.”</p> - -<p>“Ye—ye can’t do it,” sputtered Arad.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_190">[190]</span>“If that monkey of a sheriff finds Brandon (w’ich -same I reckon he won’t), we’ll see if we can’t give -<i>you</i> a taste of the same medicine.”</p> - -<p>The old man was undeniably frightened and edged -towards the door.</p> - -<p>“I guess I better go,” he remarked hesitatingly. -“I dunno as that officer’ll be able ter ketch thet reskil.”</p> - -<p>“No, I don’t b’lieve he will myself,” Caleb declared. -“And if you want to keep your own skin whole, you’d -best see that he doesn’t touch the lad.”</p> - -<p>Old Arad slunk out without another word, and the -two friends allowed him to depart in contemptuous -silence.</p> - -<p>When he had disappeared Adoniram turned to the -sailor at once.</p> - -<p>“Where has Don gone, Caleb?” he asked anxiously.</p> - -<p>“You’ve got me. He told me he was goin’ to skip, -and for us to go ahead with the preparations for getting -off next week, just the same. He’d lay low till -the old scamp had given it up, and then slip aboard -the steamer. Oh, the boy’s all right.”</p> - -<p>“He is, if that sheriff doesn’t find him,” said the -merchant doubtfully.</p> - -<p>“I’ll risk that,” responded Caleb, who had vast confidence -in Brandon’s ability to take care of himself.</p> - -<p>But Adoniram shook his head.</p> - -<p>“New York is a bad place for a boy to be alone in. -Where will he go?”</p> - -<p>“Down to the pier, I reckon, and hide aboard the -steamer. I’ll agree to put him away there so that no -measly faced sheriff like <i>that</i> fellow can find him.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_191">[191]</span>“It’s a bad business,” declared Mr. Pepper, shaking -his head slowly. “If he hadn’t run off there might -have been some way of fixing it up so that he wouldn’t -have had to go back to Rhode Island, and thus delay -the sailing of the steamer. We might have scared the -uncle out of prosecuting him. He was badly frightened -as it was.”</p> - -<p>Caleb gazed at his friend for several moments with -a quizzical smile upon his face.</p> - -<p>“Do you know, Adoniram,” he said at length, “I -b’lieve you’re too innocent for this wicked world.”</p> - -<p>“How do you mean?” asked the merchant, flushing -a little, yet smiling.</p> - -<p>“Well, you don’t seem to see anything fishy in all -this.”</p> - -<p>“Fishy?”</p> - -<p>“Yes, fishy,” returned Caleb, sitting down and -speaking confidentially. “Several things make me believe -that you (and me, too) haven’t been half awake -in this business.”</p> - -<p>“I certainly do not understand you,” declared -Adoniram.</p> - -<p>“Well, give me a chance to explain, will you?” said -the sailor impatiently. “You seem to think that this -old land shark of an uncle of the boy’s is just trying to -get him back on the farm, and has hatched up this -robbery business for that purpose? I don’t suppose -you think Don stole any money from him, do you?” -he added.</p> - -<p>“Not for an instant!” the merchant replied emphatically.</p> - -<p>“That’s what I thought. Well, as I say, you suppose<span class="pagenum" id="Page_192">[192]</span> -he wants Brandon back on the farm—wants his -work, in fact?”</p> - -<p>“Ye—es.”</p> - -<p>“Well, did it ever strike you, ’Doniram,” Caleb -pursued, with a smile of superiority on his face—“did -it ever strike you that if he was successful in -proving Brandon guilty, the boy would be locked up -and then <i>nobody</i> would get his valuable services—nobody -except the State?”</p> - -<p>“Why, that’s so.”</p> - -<p>“Of course it’s so.”</p> - -<p>“Then, what is his object in persecuting the poor -lad? Is he doing it just out of spite?”</p> - -<p>“Now, see here; does that look reasonable? Do -you think for a moment that an old codger like him—stingy -as they make ’em—d’ye think he’d go ter the -expense o’ comin ’way down here to New York out -of revenge simply? Well, I guess not!”</p> - -<p>“Then, what is he up to?” demanded Adoniram, -in bewilderment.</p> - -<p>“Well, of that <i>I’m</i> not sure, of course; but,” said -Caleb, with vehemence, “I’m willing to risk my -hull advance that he’s onter this di’mond business.</p> - -<p>“Why, Pepper, how could he help being? Didn’t -he get that letter of mine, an’ didn’t I give the hull -thing away in it, like the blamed idiot I was? Man -alive, a sharper like that feller would sell his immortal -soul for a silver dollar. What <i>wouldn’t</i> he -for a big stake like this?”</p> - -<p>“But—” began Adoniram.</p> - -<p>“Hold on a minute and let me finish,” urged Caleb. -“That scoundrel Leroyd was up to Chopmist, mind ye.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_193">[193]</span> -Who knows but what he an’ old Arad Tarr have -hitched hosses and gone inter this together? I haven’t -told either you or Brandon, for I didn’t want to worry -you, but I learned yesterday that Jim is tryin’ ter charter -a craft of some kind—you an’ I know what for.</p> - -<p>“He’s got no money; what rascal of a sailor ever -has? He must have backing, then. And who is more -likely to be the backer than the old sharper who’s -just gone out of here! I tell ye, ’Doniram, <i>they’re -after them di’monds</i>, and it behooves us ter git up an’ -dust if we want ter beat ’em.”</p> - -<p>The ship owner shook his head unconvinced.</p> - -<p>“You may be right, of course, Caleb; I don’t say -it is an impossibility. But it strikes me that your -conclusions are rather far fetched. They are not -reasonable.”</p> - -<p>“Well, we’ll see,” responded the old seaman, pursing -up his lips. “I shall miss Brandon’s help—a -handier lad I never see—but he will have to lay low -till after the whaleback sails.”</p> - -<p>He went back to the work of getting the steamer -ready for departure, expecting every hour that Brandon -would appear. But the captain’s son did not -show up that day, nor the next.</p> - -<p>Monday came and Number Three was all ready for -sailing. Her crew of twenty men, beside the officers, -were aboard.</p> - -<p>The first and third mates were likewise present, the -former, Mr. Coffin, being a tall, shrewd looking, pleasant -faced man, who eternally chewed on the end of a -cigar (except when eating or sleeping) although he -was never seen to light one; and Mr. Bolin, the third,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_194">[194]</span> -a keen, alert little man who looked hardly older than -Brandon himself.</p> - -<p>But Brandon did not come. The new captain of -the whaleback, and the owner himself, were greatly -worried by the boy’s continued absence.</p> - -<p>They had already set on foot inquiry for the youth’s -whereabouts, but nothing had come of it.</p> - -<p>They did discover that Uncle Arad had gone back -to Rhode Island, and gone back alone. The “scaly” -ward politician who held the onerous position of -deputy sheriff, and who had sought to arrest the boy, -had not been successful, Brandon’s friends knew, -for the man haunted the pier at which the whaleback -lay, day and night.</p> - -<p>“If he don’t come tonight, Adoniram,” Caleb declared, -“we shall sail in the morning, just the same—and -that by the first streak of light, too. <i>You</i> will be -here, and I can trust you to look out for the lad. <i>I</i> -must be away after those di’monds. Don’ll turn up -all right, I know right well; and we mustn’t let them -swabs get ahead of us, and reach the brig first.”</p> - -<p>He had taken the precaution ere this to have his own -and Brandon’s effects brought down to the boat. He -was ready, in fact, to cast off and steam away from -the dock at a moment’s notice.</p> - -<p>As the evening approached Caleb ordered the fires -built under the boilers, and everything to be made -ready for instant departure. Adoniram Pepper came -down after dinner and remained in the whaleback’s -cabin, hoping to see Brandon once again before the -steamer sailed.</p> - -<p>Caleb was too anxious to keep still at all, but<span class="pagenum" id="Page_195">[195]</span> -tramped back and forth, occasionally making trips to -the wheelman’s turret in which he had stationed Mr. -Coffin and one of the sailors, so as to have no delay -in starting, no matter what should happen.</p> - -<p>“By Jove, this beats blockade running at Savannah -in the sixties,” muttered the first mate, after one of his -commander’s anxious trips to the forward turret to see -that all was right. “This youngster they’re taking -all this trouble for must be a most remarkable boy.”</p> - -<p>“There’s two fellows watching the steamer from -the wharf,” Caleb declared, entering the cabin again.</p> - -<p>Just then there was a sound outside, and a heavy -knock sounded at the cabin door. Caleb pulled it -open in an instant.</p> - -<p>Without stood three burly police officers.</p> - -<p>“Well, well!” exclaimed Mr. Pepper, in wonder.</p> - -<p>“What do <i>you</i> want?” Caleb demanded, inclined to -be a little combative.</p> - -<p>“Beg pardon, sir,” said the spokesman of the two, -nodding respectfully to Mr. Pepper, “but we’ve been -sent to search the steamer for a boy against whom -this man holds a warrant,” and the officer motioned to -a third individual who stood without. It was the -deputy sheriff.</p> - -<p>“Very well,” said Mr. Pepper quietly.</p> - -<p>“Search and be hanged,” growled Caleb, glowering -at the man with the warrant. “If you can find him -you’ll have better luck than we.”</p> - -<p>He refused to assist them in any way, however, and -Mr. Bolin politely showed the party over the whole -steamer. But of course, they found not a sign of -Brandon.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_196">[196]</span>After nearly an hour’s search the officers gave it -up and departed, Caleb hurling after them several -sarcastic remarks about their supposed intellectual -accomplishments—or rather, their lack of such accomplishments.</p> - -<p>The deputy sheriff, whose name was Snaggs, by the -way, would not give it up, however, but still remained -on the wharf.</p> - -<p>Mr. Coffin, who had begun to take a lively interest -in the proceedings, was pacing the inclined deck of -the whaleback on the side furtherest from the pier, -a few minutes past midnight (everybody on board -was still awake at even this late hour) when his ear -caught the sound of a gentle splash in the black waters -just below him.</p> - -<p>He stopped instantly and leaned over the rail.</p> - -<p>“Hist!” whispered a voice out of the darkness. -“Toss me a rope. I want to come aboard.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Coffin was not a man to show his emotions, -and therefore, without a word, he dropped the end of -a bit of cable into the water, just where he could see -the faint outlines of the owner of the voice.</p> - -<p>Hidden by the wheelhouse from the view of anybody -who might be on the wharf, he assisted the person -aboard, and in a minute the mysterious visitor -stood upon the iron plates at Mr. Coffin’s side.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_197">[197]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXVIII<br /> - - -<small>THE DEPARTURE OF THE WHALEBACK, NUMBER THREE</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">No</span> emergency was ever too great for Lawrence -Coffin. The appearance of the stranger whom he had -lifted over the rail to the steamer’s deck may have -surprised him; but he gave no visible sign.</p> - -<p>The instant the fellow was on his feet, Mr. Coffin -slid open the door of the wheelhouse and pushed the -newcomer in.</p> - -<p>“Jackson,” he said sharply, to the man inside, “go -for Captain Wetherbee.”</p> - -<p>Then he turned to the dripping figure that stood -just within the door of the turret.</p> - -<p>The stranger was a youth of fifteen or sixteen, with -a sharp, intelligent face, and his saturated clothing -was little more than rags.</p> - -<p>“Hullo!” said the mate, “<i>you’re</i> not Brandon -Tarr, I take it.”</p> - -<p>“You kin bet on that, mister,” responded the youth -grinning. “An’ you, I reckon, ain’t Cale Wetherbee. -He’s got a wooden leg.”</p> - -<p>“I’ve sent for Mr. Wetherbee,” replied Mr. Coffin. -“What do you want?”</p> - -<p>“I’ll tell th’ boss, wot I was told ter see,” declared -the fellow shrewdly.</p> - -<p>The youth was evidently of that great class of individuals<span class="pagenum" id="Page_198">[198]</span> -known as “street gamins” who, in New York -City, are numbered by the thousand.</p> - -<p>He was thin and muscular, quick in his movements, -and his eyes were shifty and uneasy, not from any -lack of frankness or honesty, perhaps, but because -his mode of life forced him to be ever on the watch for -what might “happen next.”</p> - -<p>Mr. Coffin had hardly made this mental inventory -of the fellow, when Caleb, accompanied by Mr. Pepper, -came forward. The strange youth evidently recognized -the captain of the whaleback at once as the -individual he wished to see.</p> - -<p>“You’re Captain Wetherbee,” he said quickly fumbling -in the inside of his coarse flannel shirt (the shirt -and trousers were all he had on) “I got somethin’ -fur you from Brandon Tarr.”</p> - -<p>“Where is he?” cried Mr. Pepper, in great excitement.</p> - -<p>“He’s gone to sea, boss,” responded the boy calmly.</p> - -<p>“Hey!” roared Caleb, and then the messenger -brought forth that which he was fumbling for—a -little waterproof matchbox.</p> - -<p>“Gone to sea?” repeated Adoniram, in bewilderment.</p> - -<p>“Dat’s it,” said the boy. “He went day ’fore -yest’day mornin’ in de Success.”</p> - -<p>But Caleb had opened the matchbox and drawn -forth the folded paper it contained.</p> - -<p>“It’s a letter—the young rascal! Why didn’t he -come himself?”</p> - -<p>“Didn’t I tell ye he’d gone ter sea?” demanded the -youth in disgust.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_199">[199]</span>“Listen to this,” exclaimed Caleb, paying not the -least attention to the messenger’s words, and he read -the closely written page aloud:</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Dear Caleb</span>—Swivel is going to make a break with this -letter for me, although the Success sails, we understand, in -an hour or two. He can tell you how I came aboard here, so -I won’t stop to do that.</p> - -<p>“What I want to say is, that Leroyd is aboard and that the -brig will touch at Savannah for Mr. Pepper’s old clerk, Mr. -Weeks, who is in the plot to find the Silver Swan, too. I -shall leave her at Savannah if it is a possibility.</p> - -<p>“If you get into Savannah while she is there, however, and -I don’t appear, try to find some way of getting me out. I’m -afraid of Leroyd—or, that is, I should be if he knew I was -here.</p> - -<p>“I’ve got enough to eat and drink to last me a long time -and am comfortable. I can make another raid on the pantry, -too, if I run short.</p> - -<p>“Look out for Swivel; he’s a good fellow. He can tell -you all that I would like to, if space and time did not forbid.</p> - -<p class="right"><span class="indentright2">“Yours sincerely,</span><br /> -“<span class="smcap">Brandon Tarr</span>.</p> - -<p>“P. S. We’ll beat these scamps and get the Silver Swan -yet.”</p> -</div> - -<p>“Well, well!” commented Mr. Pepper, in amazement. -“What will that boy do next?”</p> - -<p>“The young rascal!” Caleb exclaimed in vexation. -“What does he mean by cutting up such didoes as -this? Aboard the very vessel the scoundrels have -chartered, hey?”</p> - -<p>“But how did he get there?” cried Adoniram wonderingly.</p> - -<p>“This young man ought to be able to tell that,” -suggested Mr. Coffin, referring to the dripping youth.</p> - -<p>Caleb looked from the open letter to the boy.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_200">[200]</span>“So you’re Swivel, eh?” he demanded.</p> - -<p>The lad grinned and nodded.</p> - -<p>“Well, suppose you explain this mystery.”</p> - -<p>But here Adoniram interposed.</p> - -<p>“Let us take him to the cabin, and give him something -dry to put on. He’ll catch his death of cold -here.”</p> - -<p>“’Nough said. Come on,” said Caleb leading the -way.</p> - -<p>Fifteen minutes later the youth who rejoiced in the -name of Swivel was inside of warm and dry garments, -several sizes too large for him, and was telling his -story to a most appreciative audience.</p> - -<p>I will not give it in detail, and in Swivel’s bad grammar; -a less rambling account will suffice.</p> - -<p>When Brandon Tarr had made his rapid retreat -from the office of Adoniram Pepper and Co. he had -run across the street, dodged around the first corner, -and then walked hastily up town. He determined to -keep away from the office for the remainder of the -day, hoping to tire out both Uncle Arad and the deputy -sheriff.</p> - -<p>Finally he took a car and rode over to Brooklyn, -and it was there that he fell in with Swivel, who was a -veritable street gamin—a “wharf-rat” even—though -a good hearted and not an altogether bad principled -one.</p> - -<p>It being a time in the day when there were no papers -to sell, Swivel (wherever the boy got the name -he didn’t know, and it would have been hard to trace -its origin) was blacking boots, and while he shined -Brandon’s the two boys scraped up an acquaintance.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_201">[201]</span>Fearing that Uncle Arad or the officer, or perhaps -both, would be on the watch about the shipping merchant’s -office, or the steamer dock, Brandon decided -that Swivel would be a good one to have along with -him to send ahead as “scout,” and for a small sum the -gamin agreed.</p> - -<p>Brandon was a country boy, and was unfamiliar -with city ways or city conveniences. It never crossed -his mind to use the telephone communicating with his -friends, and Swivel knew very little about telephones, -any way.</p> - -<p>So they waited until toward evening and then -came back to New York.</p> - -<p>Water Street and its vicinity, and the docks, were -as familiar to Swivel as were the lanes and woods -of Chopmist to Brandon. By devious ways the gamin -led the captain’s son to the ship owner’s office, but it -was quite dark by that time and the place was closed.</p> - -<p>So they went to the pier at which the whaleback -lay, and here Swivel showed that he was of great use -to Brandon, for had it not been for him, his employer -would have run straight into a trap. The deputy -sheriff, Snaggs, was watching the steamer, and no -less a person than Mr. Alfred Weeks himself, was -talking with him.</p> - -<p>By careful maneuvering the two boys got into a position -from which they could hear some of the conversation -of the two rascals; but the way to the steamer -was right under Snaggs’ eye, and Brandon dared not -attempt it.</p> - -<p>By intently listening, the captain’s son heard several -important items of news, and, greatly to his astonishment,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_202">[202]</span> -discovered that Uncle Arad, Leroyd, and Mr. -Weeks himself were playing right into each other’s -hands, and that their object was to keep Brandon -from getting back to his friends, and thus delay the -sailing of the whaleback so that the craft on which the -plotters expected to sail might get away first.</p> - -<p>Snaggs was to keep a sharp lookout from the shoreward -side of the whaleback and there was already a -man in a boat patroling the riverside that Brandon -might not return from that direction, and a third person -was “shadowing” Adoniram Pepper’s residence. -The ship owner’s office would be watched during the -day.</p> - -<p>As soon as Brandon made his appearance he was to -be seized at once on the strength of the Rhode Island -warrant and sent back to Chopmist. This, the conspirators -hoped, would keep Caleb Wetherbee from -sailing for several weeks, and by that time Leroyd -and the ex-clerk expected to overhaul the Silver Swan—that -is, this is what Weeks and Leroyd themselves -were planning to do; but the former took care to say -nothing about the Silver Swan to the deputy sheriff.</p> - -<p>Finding that there was no chance to get aboard the -whaleback just then, and having heard Weeks say that -he was going to meet Leroyd and that they two were -to go that night and see the vessel and her commander, -Brandon decided to follow them, and find out the name -of the craft and where she lay, believing that the information -would be of value to himself and to his friends.</p> - -<p>Piloted by Swivel, Brandon followed “Sneaky Al” -to the New England Hotel and while the ex-clerk -went inside for Leroyd the two boys waited without,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_203">[203]</span> -and then took up the trail again when the two conspirators -appeared.</p> - -<p>The sailor and Weeks went over to Brooklyn and -after two hours’ dodging and running and hiding, they -tracked the rascals to the brig Success, lying at a -Brooklyn wharf.</p> - -<p>Brandon decided that it would never do to be so -near and not hear the plans the villains made with the -captain of the Success, so he rashly crept aboard and -listened to the conversation at the cabin skylight. And -this was when he got into trouble.</p> - -<p>He heard the two plotters agree with the captain -of the vessel (who was not in the scheme at all) to pay -two hundred dollars for six week’s use of the brig, -providing the Success put to sea at once.</p> - -<p>She already had a very fair cargo for Savannah, -and the agreement was that she should put in at that -port for the time necessary for the cargo to be landed.</p> - -<p>Thus, of course, the captain, who was the owner as -well, was going to make a very good thing out of it, -indeed. He asked no questions as to what use the brig -was to be put to; and he agreed to allow Leroyd to -accompany him to Savannah, where Weeks would -meet them.</p> - -<p>Brandon made a shrewd guess that the ex-clerk was -to remain in New York until he was certain of <i>his</i> -capture and incarceration; then he would reach Savannah -by steamer.</p> - -<p>It was quite evident that the two rascals had managed -to “boil” more money out of old Arad Tarr than -they had first expected, and could afford to be more -lavish with their funds.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_204">[204]</span>But, as I said, the boys, by venturing aboard the -Success, got into trouble. Somebody came aft while -they were listening to the conference below, and to -escape discovery, they dodged down the after hatch.</p> - -<p>The crew of the Success were already aboard, and -the two men who constituted the “anchor watch” -remained near the open hatchway (the other hatches -were battened down), and the two boys were unable -to leave the hold.</p> - -<p>Morning came, and found them still there. The -cargo was nearly all in, and the crew went to work -to finish the lading by daylight. Brandon and Swivel -retreated into the bows of the vessel, and managed to -remain hidden all day.</p> - -<p>They did not dare leave the hold, although they -suffered extremely from lack of food and water, for -Leroyd had come aboard to superintend the work, and -would have seen them.</p> - -<p>At evening the hatches were battened down, and the -unintentional stowaways were left in darkness. But -Swivel, who a shrewd and sharp eyed lad, had noticed -a small door in the cabin bulkhead by which the cook -doubtless entered the hold for provisions from time to -time.</p> - -<p>With their pocket knives they forced the fastenings -of this door and Swivel made a raid into the pantry, -which was left unguarded, and returned laden with -provisions enough to last them a week if need be. He -secured a big “beaker” of water, too.</p> - -<p>Brandon also discovered the ship’s provisions stored -near the bows, and was sure that he could stand a -siege.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_205">[205]</span>Leroyd, they ascertained, hardly ever left the cabin -or deck of the Success, and Brandon dared not venture out. -At last, after talking the whole matter over, -Swivel agreed to take the risk of giving himself up -as a stowaway, and thus get put ashore before the -brig started.</p> - -<p>Then he was to make his way to the whaleback and -explain Brandon’s situation to Caleb.</p> - -<p>The captain’s son wrote his letter and placed it -in the matchbox, which Swivel in turn had hidden -in the breast of his shirt. Then the gamin pounded -on the hatch until the crew heard him and let him out.</p> - -<p>Naturally the captain of the Success was angry -enough, for the brig was already to sail, and they were -getting the lines cast off, so he summoned a night -watchman from the dock, who took the unlucky Swivel -in charge and handed him over to a policeman.</p> - -<p>This was a phase of the situation which neither of -the boys had considered. But there was no way out -of it, and the gamin spent the day in the police station, -for it was Sunday.</p> - -<p>He was brought before the magistrate the next -morning, but of course there was nobody to appear -against him, so he was discharged with a reprimand. -The police captain, however, kept him busy about the -station until late in the afternoon, before he would let -him go.</p> - -<p>“He kep’ me jugglin’ wid er mop er wipin’ up de -floor,” as the gamin expressed it to his hearers.</p> - -<p>As soon as he was free he had hurried to the New -York side; but upon reaching the vicinity of the whaleback<span class="pagenum" id="Page_206">[206]</span> -he discovered that the “patrol line” was drawn -even closer than before.</p> - -<p>Snaggs and two of his friends were on duty, for as -the time approached for the sailing, they decided -that if Brandon came back he would do so very soon.</p> - -<p>Swivel had seen the raid the policemen made under -the deputy’s instigation, and after the bluecoats were -safely out of the way, he had slipped into the water -and made for the steamer.</p> - -<p>“An’ here I is,” he said, in conclusion. “Dey -didn’t ketch me, nor dat Brandon Tarr, nuther. We’s -too fly for ’em.”</p> - -<p>“Of all the scrapes I ever heard of, this is the -worst,” Adoniram exclaimed in comment.</p> - -<p>But Caleb, now that his fears for Don’s safety were -somewhat allayed, seemed rather to enjoy the situation.</p> - -<p>“Oh, that boy’s smart,” he declared, with a chuckle. -“I’ll risk him even if he is in that vessel’s hold. Leroyd -won’t get the best of <i>him</i>. Probably, too, the -captain of the Success is not a bad sort of a fellow, -an’ he won’t see the boy maltreated.</p> - -<p>“I feel better, ’Doniram, and with your permission -we’ll get under way at once.”</p> - -<p>“But what shall we do with this lad?” asked the -little merchant, nodding and smiling at Swivel. “He’s -deserving of much praise for his honesty and faithfulness.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, take me along, will yer?” exclaimed the -gamin, with eagerness. “I’ll work <i>hard</i> ef ye will! -I jest wanter see dis thing out, I do! I like dat -Brandon Tarr, an’ I wanter see him git the di’monts<span class="pagenum" id="Page_207">[207]</span> -wot he said was on dat wreck yer arter. Say, lemme -go, will yer?”</p> - -<p>Caleb looked at the ship owner in perplexity.</p> - -<p>“Oh, take him, Caleb,” said Adoniram quickly. -“It may be the making of the lad to get him off the -city streets. He deserves it.”</p> - -<p>“So be it then,” said Caleb, rising. “Now, Mr. -Coffin and Mr. Bolin—to work! You’ll have to go -ashore at once, Adoniram. I shall have Number -Three out of her berth in half an hour.”</p> - -<p>Steam was got up, the crew flew about their several -duties under the energetic commands of the officers, -and within a short time the whaleback, to the manifest -disappointment of Mr. Snaggs, who watched proceedings -from the shadow of the wharf, cast off her -lines and steamed down the bay into the darkness of -the night.</p> - -<p>Thus did she begin the voyage whose object was the -finding of the wreck of the Silver Swan.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_208">[208]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXIX<br /> - - -<small>THE STOWAWAY ABOARD THE SUCCESS</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">As</span> we know, Brandon Tarr had no intention of remaining -long away from his friends when he slipped -out of Adoniram Pepper’s office to escape arrest on -the fraudulent charge of robbery, concocted by Uncle -Arad.</p> - -<p>The events which followed, however, made it necessary -for him to remain away, and, finally, to go to -sea as a stowaway in the hold of the Success, the vessel -chartered by the conspirators to make search for -the Silver Swan.</p> - -<p>After the friendly street gamin, Swivel, left him in -the hold, in the early hours of Sunday morning, Brandon -of course had no means of knowing what had become -of him—whether he had accomplished his purpose -of getting away from the brig before she sailed, -or whether, because she was short handed, the captain -of the Success had retained him.</p> - -<p>After Swivel was let up on deck, and the hatch -closed, however, Brandon heard nothing further, except -the heavy tramping of the sailors, the creaking of -the ropes, and the hoarse roars of command from the -officers.</p> - -<p>The work of getting the Success away from the -dock went rapidly on.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_209">[209]</span>Quite fortunately for the stowaway, the hold of the -Success was little more than two thirds filled with -Savannah goods. In the bows, beside a great many -bags and boxes and barrels of provisions for the use -of the crew, there were likewise spare sails, cordage, -etc.</p> - -<p>It would be a very easy matter indeed for him to -hide among the stuff if any one came into the hold.</p> - -<p>The scent of bilge water was not at all strong, for -the Success was a comparatively new vessel and had -evidently been recently pumped out.</p> - -<p>Brandon judged her to be about the size of the -Silver Swan, much the same sort of craft in fact, and, -like his father’s vessel, the Success was a “tramp.”</p> - -<p>It was night—or at least a gloomy twilight—at -all times in the hold; but Brandon thought that it was -surely daylight by the time the brig was under way.</p> - -<p>She was taken down the river by a fussy little steam -tug and then, meeting the swells of the Atlantic, and -a brisk gale springing up, she shook out her sails and -dropped the tug astern.</p> - -<p>Brandon was fearful that he might be sick, for he -had never really been to sea and the brig pitched not -a little in the waves of the ocean.</p> - -<p>To reduce the possibility of this misfortune to a -minimum, he ate but sparingly the first day or two -out, and by that time all “squeamish” feelings passed -away.</p> - -<p>It was dreadfully dull in the dark hold, however. -Of food and water he had a sufficiency, although the -latter was warm and brackish; but there was absolutely -nothing for him to do to pass away the time.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_210">[210]</span> -There was not even the spice of danger about his situation, -for nobody came into the hold.</p> - -<p>He dared not explore much at first, for he was -afraid that he might be heard from the cabin or forecastle.</p> - -<p>During a slight blow which came up the fourth day, -however, while the spars and cordage were creaking -so that all other sounds were drowned, he felt perfectly -safe in moving about. If he could not hear -what went on outside, nobody outside would be likely -to hear him.</p> - -<p>On this day, however, he received several tumbles, -for the ship occasionally pitched so suddenly that he -was carried completely off his feet. Nothing worse -happened to him, though, than the barking of his elbows -and knees.</p> - -<p>Gaining confidence in his ability to get around without -being discovered, he changed his position more -frequently after this. The weather remained fair for -some time following this small blow, and Brandon -hung about the cabin bulkhead, striving to hear more -of Leroyd’s plans, if possible.</p> - -<p>It was plain that the captain of the brig knew nothing -of the real plans of the conspirators. They had -told him what they pleased, and he was to ask no questions.</p> - -<p>It was not long, however, before the stowaway discovered -something which was quite a surprise to him. -There was a woman on board the brig; he heard the -rustle of her garments, and occasionally the tones of a -female voice.</p> - -<p>At first he thought her to be the captain’s wife, but<span class="pagenum" id="Page_211">[211]</span> -because of the youthfulness of her tones and some -words which the captain addressed to her, he changed -this opinion, and decided that she was his daughter.</p> - -<p>Brandon was quite interested in her, for a girl on -a sailing vessel was certainly a novelty. He was sure -she must be a “jolly one,” as he expressed it, to sail -with her father on a merchantman. Not many girls -would have the pluck to do that.</p> - -<p>As the days passed by, and the Success fled on before -the favoring gales, drawing nearer and nearer to -Savannah, Brandon became correspondingly worried -over the obstructions to a safe escape from the brig, -which were presented to his mind.</p> - -<p>Once the brig reached port and the hatches were -opened, it would be “all day” with him. Nothing -but a miracle would save him from falling into the -hands of Jim Leroyd, and he didn’t like to think of -that.</p> - -<p>He had good reason to believe that the rascally -sailor would not hesitate to injure him in any way -possible.</p> - -<p>Naturally his mind reverted to the trap in the cabin -bulkhead by which Swivel had gained access to the -cook’s galley, as a possible means of escape before the -hatches were removed. If the brig reached Savannah -late in the day, doubtless the hatches would remain -battened down till the next morning. In that case -the trap might be his salvation.</p> - -<p>Several times during the voyage the steward, sometimes -with a seaman with him, entered the hold by -this door, for something among the stores. At such<span class="pagenum" id="Page_212">[212]</span> -times Brandon “laid low” and his presence was not -discovered.</p> - -<p>What little food he had purloined from the stores -was not noticed either.</p> - -<p>Therefore, as the brig drew nearer to her destination -Brandon set about studying the topography of -the cabin—its entrances and exits—and how he -could best pass through it and reach the deck without -attracting the attention of anybody on board.</p> - -<p>All this scouting had to be done at night, of course, -and many were his narrow escapes while engaged in -this most perilous undertaking.</p> - -<p>“Nothing ventured, nothing gained,” was the motto -of the Tarrs, father and son. In Captain Tarr’s case, -and in that of his brother Anson, it had been, as a -usual thing, a good deal of <i>venture</i> and little <i>gain</i>.</p> - -<p>The same motive, however, was predominant in -Brandon’s nature, and he took many risks in thus -scouting about the brig’s cabin that almost any other -boy would not have taken.</p> - -<p>One night he had cautiously set the narrow door -leading into the steward’s pantry ajar, and sat just -under it in the darkness of the hold, trying to discover -if all but the officers, excepting the one in command -of the watch, had turned in.</p> - -<p>There was a light in the outer cabin, but he could -not see into the room from where he sat, and he dared -not enter the pantry until he was sure that the cabin -was unoccupied. Occasionally a sound of low conversation -would reach his ears from the deck, but -otherwise all was still.</p> - - -<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_212.jpg" alt="" /></div> -<p class="caption">“I’M A STOWAWAY. I’VE BEEN IN THE HOLD SINCE<br /> WE LEFT -NEW YORK.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_213">[213]</span>“I believe I’ll risk it,” he declared, after remaining -in a listening attitude for nearly half an hour. “I -need water badly—my throat is well nigh parched—and -if I could learn whether the lamp was usually left -turned up like that, whether the cabin was empty or -<i>not</i>, I might know better how to act when I do try to -escape.”</p> - -<p>Finally he crawled through the opening and crept -softly to the cabin door. The apartment was empty—or -it appeared to be—although there was a chair -drawn up to the table, and some books lay there as -though having been in recent use.</p> - -<p>“Guess I’d better not stay,” thought the stowaway -nervously. “But I must have a drink.”</p> - -<p>He turned back into the cook’s galley, and took -a deep draught from a bucket he found there. Just -as he was about to leave the place he was electrified -by hearing a voice say,</p> - -<p>“What are <i>you</i> doing here?”</p> - -<p>Brandon wheeled about like a flash. There framed -by the cabin doorway was a young girl—the girl -whose voice he had heard more than once since his -incarceration in the hold of the Success—the captain’s -daughter!</p> - -<p>“Who are you? What do you want!” she repeated, -eying him fearlessly, though with a puzzled -expression of countenance. “I never remember having -seen <i>you</i> before.”</p> - -<p>Brandon was suddenly conscious that his long captivity -in the vessel’s hold had not improved his personal -appearance, and with his feeling of fright at -being discovered, there was also considerable vexation -at being seen in such a plight by a lady.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_214">[214]</span>The girl was bright looking and intelligent, with -a face which attracted the boy greatly; in fact, he was -almost tempted to believe that he had seen her somewhere, -so familiar did she appear.</p> - -<p>Dressed in a simple blue flannel yachting suit, trimmed -with white braid, which set off her plump figure -to great advantage, she was a pleasing picture.</p> - -<p>“Why don’t you answer me?” she demanded in -vexation, as Brandon continued silent.</p> - -<p>“Sh! don’t give me away,” begged the boy, taking -a step nearer. “I’m a stowaway, I’ve been in the -hold ever since we left New York.”</p> - -<p>“Another stowaway!” she exclaimed, but in a lower -tone. “Why father found one just before we left -port.”</p> - -<p>“I know it,” returned Brandon. “He was with -me. What did they do with him?”</p> - -<p>“Father gave him into the hands of the police,” -replied the girl gravely. “He’s very hard on stowaways. -Why did you get into the hold?”</p> - -<p>“Because I <i>had</i> to; yes, I did—actually had to,” -declared Brandon, in a whisper. “I can’t tell you -the whole story now; but I will some time. I haven’t -done anything wrong—excepting taking a few provisions -from the ship’s stores. Those I will pay you -for now,” and he took his purse from the pocket of -his stained and ragged coat.</p> - -<p>“No, no!” cried the girl, drawing back, “I do not -want your money.”</p> - -<p>“Then I shall leave it, as I first intended, on the -cabin table when we get to Savannah.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_215">[215]</span>“But the men will find you when we get in, even -if I <i>don’t</i> tell father.”</p> - -<p>“I hope not,” Brandon replied, so earnestly that -the captain’s daughter looked at him curiously.</p> - -<p>“Is there anybody aboard whom you fear?” she -asked shrewdly.</p> - -<p>“Yes, there is. It is that evil looking man—the -one who has chartered the brig—Jim Leroyd.”</p> - -<p>“He!” she exclaimed, in surprise. Then after a -little silence she added:</p> - -<p>“He <i>is</i> an evil looking man; I’ve told father so -more than once, but he says that a man is not always -as bad as he looks. Father has seen so many people -and so much of the world, that I seldom question his -judgment; but I have been impressed from the first -that there was something wrong about him—and -about that Mr. Weeks, who is in partnership with -him, and whom we expect to meet at Savannah.</p> - -<p>“It is a strange thing—this searching for a derelict -brig—any way. I tell father that there is something -wrong back of it.”</p> - -<p>“There <i>is</i>,” Brandon declared. “I don’t dare tell -you about it now. You won’t let anybody know I’m -here, will you?”</p> - -<p>“No—o, I’ll promise that. It wasn’t right to stow -yourself away aboard the brig, but you look honest—although -you <i>are</i> awfully dirty and ragged,” said this -most plain spoken young lady.</p> - -<p>“I know it; I look terribly,” whispered Don, creeping -through the door into the hold again. Then he -turned about and asked, “What is your name, please?”</p> - -<p>“Milly Frank.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_216">[216]</span>“Thank you; and mine is Brandon Tarr. Some -time I can explain all this to you, and you will see -that I did the only thing I could in stowing myself -away here.”</p> - -<p>“But how do you expect to get out?”</p> - -<p>“I hope we’ll get to port in the night. If we do, -then I’ll try to slip out through the cabin.”</p> - -<p>“Somebody will catch you.”</p> - -<p>“I hope not.”</p> - -<p>“We-ell, I <i>hope</i>, not, too,” said Miss Milly frankly. -“I don’t suppose it is just right, but I’ll try to help -you. If I see a chance for you to get away I’ll come -to this door and knock—see, like this.”</p> - -<p>She knocked twice in succession, but lightly, so that -nobody might hear her but the stowaway.</p> - -<p>“Thank you—thank you!” murmured the boy, -and then he shut the trap quickly, for a heavy step -sounded from the cabin without.</p> - -<p>Somebody had come down from the deck—probably -the officer of the watch.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_217">[217]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXX<br /> - - -<small>SHOWING WHAT MISS MILLY DOES FOR BRANDON</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Brandon</span> crept away from the trap in the bulkhead, -fearing that at any moment the person who had entered -the outer cabin during his conversation with the -captain’s daughter, might strive to capture him. He -was afraid that the person had heard his movements -in descending into the cargo hold again; but if the -newcomer <i>did</i> hear anything, Milly evidently convinced -him that there was nothing unusual going on, -for Brandon was not disturbed.</p> - -<p>Then ensued for the stowaway a period of anxious -waiting. The very fact that some hope of successful -escape had been held out to him, made the waiting -all the harder to bear.</p> - -<p>Each hour was bringing the Success nearer to Savannah, -and Brandon remained near the bulkhead all -the time, so as to miss no communication from his -fair assistant.</p> - -<p>Miss Milly seemed to really enjoy her secret knowledge -of the stowaway’s presence, and before the Success -reached port she several times called him to the -bulkhead, ostensibly for the purpose of finding out -if he was all right, and was not going hungry. She -supplied him with water, too, these last two or three<span class="pagenum" id="Page_218">[218]</span> -days, and he no longer had to leave the hold on midnight -foraging expeditions.</p> - -<p>“We shall be in this evening—perhaps before dark—so -father told me last night,” she whispered to him -one morning, and Brandon’s heart leaped for joy at -the information.</p> - -<p>Slowly, indeed, did that day pass.</p> - -<p>The Success was beating up toward Savannah -against a light head wind, which gave promise of -becoming an off shore gale before it was through with. -Fortunately, the brig escaped it, taking a tug about -the middle of the afternoon, and pulling into her dock -about dark.</p> - -<p>“Thank Heaven!” was Brandon’s mental ejaculation, -when this information was whispered through -the crack in the bulkhead door to him, and he was -indeed devoutly grateful.</p> - -<p>His life in the hold from the time of departure -from New York, had been a continual fever of impatience -and doubt, and now that the real danger of -attempting to escape was at hand, he was rejoiced. -In a short time he would know whether he was to be -free, or in Jim Leroyd’s power.</p> - -<p>Milly had informed him that Captain Frank was -exceedingly hard on all stowaways (as sea captains -usually are, in fact), and he had no doubt but that he -would be placed in a very uncomfortable, if not dangerous, -position if the doughty captain should discover -him.</p> - -<p>Leroyd, of course, would step forward at once and -declare that he (Brandon) was wanted in New York -for robbery, and that fact could be proved by telegraphing,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_219">[219]</span> -should the Savannah officers desire to do -so. Then, if the whaleback steamer was not in, he -should be absolutely friendless, and at the mercy of -the vindictive sailor.</p> - -<p>He lay close up against the door of the bulkhead -all through the early evening. Some of the crew, he -judged by what he heard, were allowed to go ashore -for a few hours, and a part of the officers went with -them—which officers, however, he could not tell.</p> - -<p>There was both a first and second mate on the Success.</p> - -<p>Brandon had no means of telling the time, but it -must have been well along towards ten o’clock—perhaps -later—when he heard the two gentle raps for -which he had been so anxiously listening.</p> - -<p>“Are you there, Brandon?” whispered the captain’s -daughter, and as Don pulled the door slightly -ajar, she seized his hand, and aided him through the -opening.</p> - -<p>“Is the coast clear?” he asked anxiously.</p> - -<p>“Sh! Yes, father and Mr. Marsh have gone up -town with some of the men, and Mr. Barry has finally -gone to bed.” (Mr. Barry was the second officer.) -“I was afraid that he’d never stop talking to me. I -had to fairly <i>freeze</i> him out,” and the merry girl -laughed softly.</p> - -<p>“But Leroyd?” pursued Brandon.</p> - -<p>“He’s gone, too.”</p> - -<p>“To bed?”</p> - -<p>“No; up the street. I hope you can get off the -brig before any of them get back. Now hurry.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_220">[220]</span>“You’re a good girl, Miss Milly. I hope I shall -be able to repay you some time.”</p> - -<p>“Hush! go along now,” she said, smiling, but pushing -him toward the companionway. “What’s that -for?” for Brandon had thrust a little wad of bank -notes into her hand.</p> - -<p>“It is to pay for the stores I broke into below. -Take it, and put it where your father will see it. -Good by.”</p> - -<p>He started up the ladder, but came back again to -ask,</p> - -<p>“Is there a steamer in the bay? Did you get in -time enough to see?”</p> - -<p>“Lots of them.”</p> - -<p>“No, I should have said a whaleback steamer?”</p> - -<p>“What are those—oh, I know what you mean. A -great long, steel boat, with cabins way up above the -hull, and no deck to speak of.”</p> - -<p>“That’s it,” said Brandon eagerly.</p> - -<p>“Yes, there <i>is</i> one here. I saw it and meant to -ask father what it was. I thought it was a dredger -of some kind,” and Milly laughed again gleefully. -“Is that a steamer?”</p> - -<p>“Yes. My friends are aboard her.”</p> - -<p>“Then you will find them,” she returned delightedly. -“That funny boat lies not far from our dock. -Now go, or somebody will catch you.”</p> - -<p>Brandon crept noiselessly up the steps at this command, -and peered out across the deck. A sailor sat -on the rail some rods away, but his back was towards -him; nobody else was in sight.</p> - -<p>“Now’s my chance,” muttered Don, and springing<span class="pagenum" id="Page_221">[221]</span> -quickly up the remaining steps, he darted as noiselessly -as a shadow across the deck, and leaped upon -the pier. An instant later he was on the street, and -slinking along in the shadow of the buildings, hurried -away from the vicinity.</p> - -<p>He did not know in which direction the “funny -boat” Milly had seen, lay, but went blindly along, his -only care for the moment being to escape from the -neighborhood of the Success and from his enemy, -Jim Leroyd.</p> - -<p>The street he followed kept close to the wharves—skirted -the waterfront in fact—and he passed many -sailors; but he kept in the shadow as much as possible -and nobody remarked about his apparel or the grime -on his face and hands.</p> - -<p>Suddenly, as he approached a great pier, where -several large vessels were lying, he caught sight of -a familiar figure coming down the street toward him. -There was no mistaking that rolling, peculiar gait, -nor the sound of the sharp “tap, tap” of the steel -shod leg on the wooden pavement.</p> - -<p>It was Caleb Wetherbee!</p> - -<p>“Oh, Cale!” Brandon almost shouted, and running -forward fairly threw himself into the sailor’s arms.</p> - -<p>“By the jumping Jehosophat!” cried the startled -Caleb, and then, recognizing the boy, despite his rags -and dirt, he uttered a loud “hurrah!” which left no -doubt in Brandon’s mind as to the sailor’s satisfaction -at seeing him once more.</p> - -<p>But in a moment, he pushed the boy away from -him and holding him by both shoulders, peered down -upon him curiously.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_222">[222]</span>“Well, well!” he exclaimed. “Where in the name -o’ Davy Jones have you been? Ye look as though -you’d been stowed away in the hold o’ a coal barge -for a month.”</p> - -<p>“Well, I <i>have</i> been stowed away in a brig’s hold—she -got in only this evening. I’ve just got away from -her. Did you get my note by Swivel?”</p> - -<p>“I did, my lad.”</p> - -<p>“And Swivel himself?”</p> - -<p>“He’s aboard the steamer.”</p> - -<p>“I’m glad of that,” declared Brandon. “I hoped -you’d be kind to him. He did me a lot of favors, and -I shan’t be able to repay him for some time to come. -Now, have you heard anything further from the Silver -Swan?”</p> - -<p>“I have, my lad, this very afternoon. She was -sighted two weeks ago by a steamship from Rio to -New York. Adoniram telegraphed me. But there’s -something else that ain’t so pleasin’.”</p> - -<p>“What’s that, Caleb?”</p> - -<p>“The Kearsarge has been ordered to destroy several -of these derelicts, the Silver Swan included, on -her way down the coast to Havana. She sails tomorrow, -I hear.”</p> - -<p>“Then we haven’t any time to lose,” Brandon exclaimed. -“Let’s go aboard at once, Cale. The first -thing I want is a wash—I’m as dirty as a pig—and -then I’ll tell you the whole story.”</p> - -<p>“We’ll do so right now,” declared the big captain. -“Come on. My boat’s down here. Number Three -lays off some way.”</p> - -<p>He hurried Brandon down to the dock, and they<span class="pagenum" id="Page_223">[223]</span> -were quickly seated in the steamer’s small boat, and -the men pulled out to the long, low, odd looking craft, -which, since her arrival in the bay three days before, -had attracted an enormous amount of attention.</p> - -<p>“She sails like a swan, Don,” declared Caleb, who, -from openly scoffing at the whaleback, had begun -fairly to worship her. “I never see anything beat it. -She can outsail any cruiser in the navy, I believe, an’ -if we don’t reach the Silver Swan in her first, it’s -because somethin’ busts!” with which forcible declaration -he helped the boy over the low rail to the iron -deck of the steamer.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_224">[224]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXI<br /> - - -<small>WHEREIN NUMBER THREE APPROACHES THE SUPPOSED -VICINITY OF THE SILVER SWAN</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">We’ll</span> be off at once,” Caleb Wetherbee declared, -as soon as he had stepped upon the deck of the whaleback. -“Go up to the cabin, Don, and tell the steward -to fix you out with a bath and some clean clothes. -You know which stateroom yours is.”</p> - -<p>Gladly did Brandon avail himself of this opportunity, -and while Caleb was personally seeing to the matter -of getting under way, he indulged in the luxury of a -bath and a full change of clothing.</p> - -<p>Before he was presentable again, Number Three -had steam up (the fires had only been banked), and -was moving slowly away from Savannah.</p> - -<p>“Quick connections on this trip, eh, lad?” Caleb -said, rubbing his hands gleefully, as he entered the -cabin and found Brandon “clothed and in his right -mind” again, as the youth himself expressed it. -“Three hours ago you were in the hold of the brig, -wasn’t you? Now, let’s hear your yarn.”</p> - -<p>Brandon complied with his request, giving fullest -details of his incarceration in the hold of the Success.</p> - -<p>“That ’ere is a mighty plucky girl,” was Caleb’s admiring -comment when the tale was finished. “What -d’ye say her name was?”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_225">[225]</span>“Milly Frank; the cap’n is her father, and he owns -the brig himself.”</p> - -<p>“Frank—Frank,” repeated Caleb slowly. “That -has a familiar sound.”</p> - -<p>“It has to me, too,” said Brandon slowly. “I’ve -been trying to think, ever since I met the girl, where -I had heard her name and seen her face, too, for both -seem familiar.”</p> - -<p>“I have it!” suddenly exclaimed Caleb, smiting his -thigh.</p> - -<p>“Well?”</p> - -<p>“Frank was the name of the chap as Adoniram’s -sister married—the little one, ye know.”</p> - -<p>“You’re right. And her name was Milly, too,” -Brandon rejoined eagerly. “Bet you this was a -daughter of hers. I thought her face looked familiar, -and now I think of it, it was because she looked so -much like the face of Milly Pepper—her picture -hung in the room they gave me at Mr. Pepper’s.”</p> - -<p>“’Twould tickle ’Doniram ’most to death to know -he had a niece,” Caleb said.</p> - -<p>“And Miss Frances, too. As soon as we find the -Silver Swan we must look up the Success.... -And that reminds me, Caleb. You say you’ve heard -of the wreck again?”</p> - -<p>The captain of the whaleback drew a telegram from -his pocket and passed it over to his young second officer.</p> - -<p>“That’s from ’Doniram. As I said, I got it this -afternoon.”</p> - -<p>This was the message:</p> - - - -<div class="blockquot"> - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_226">[226]</span>Rio steamship Creole Prince arrived this a. m., reports Silver -Swan as being sighted March 23rd, latitude 27:18, longitude -68:30.</p> -</div> - -<p>“Still moving northeast, isn’t she?” Brandon said, -handing back the yellow slip.</p> - -<p>“In course.”</p> - -<p>“And what was that you told me about the Kearsarge?”</p> - -<p>“Here’s the evening paper,” responded Caleb, handing -over a folded sheet. “There’s the item,” and he -pointed with his stumpy forefinger to a marked passage -which read as follows:</p> - -<div class="blockquot"> - -<p>The Department has ordered the Kearsarge to leave the -Chesapeake tomorrow on her trip to the West Indies. Her -commander has received special orders to destroy several of -the most dangerous derelicts which are at present infesting -the coast below Hatteras, and especially off the Bermudas. -The hull of the Hattie Marvin, floating bottom upwards north -of Bermuda, and that of the Silver Swan, south of the same -islands, both of which have been frequently reported of late -and are exceedingly dangerous, will have the early attention -of the midshipmen, who consider the excitement of blowing -up derelicts a boon indeed.</p> -</div> - -<p>“We have a good start of her,” Brandon declared -with satisfaction. “It will be because we’re not smart -if we can’t find the Silver Swan first.”</p> - -<p>“Right, lad. An’ we <i>will</i> find her, too,” said Caleb -hopefully.</p> - -<p>“And about Swivel,” went on Don, changing the -subject; “where is he?”</p> - -<p>“He’s below with the men. Smart lad, he is, an’ -I reckon we’ll make quite a man of him yet.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_227">[227]</span>“I must do something for him—if I get those diamonds,” -Brandon added. “Now, Captain Wetherbee, -with your permission I’ll turn in and get some -sleep, for I haven’t slept decently for a week, I was -so worried.”</p> - -<p>At sunrise the whaleback had left the mouth of the -Savannah river, and the shores were low down on the -horizon behind them. At sunset, when Brandon finally -arose from a long slumber, the steamer was alone -on a vast extent of heaving, restless sea. The land -had entirely disappeared.</p> - -<p>Brandon took up his duties of second officer with -enthusiasm. He had everything to learn—or about -everything—but the work was right along the line -of his strongest taste. He loved it, and therefore went -about it earnestly, and learned rapidly.</p> - -<p>Messrs. Coffin and Bolin assisted him in every way -possible, for they were greatly attracted to the boy. -Of course, Caleb was ever his faithful mentor and -teacher, and Brandon soon fell into the ways and -duties of the ship, and accredited himself very well, -indeed.</p> - -<p>The swift steamer kept on her southeasterly course -for several days without incident of importance. No -derelicts were sighted, and but few vessels.</p> - -<p>Brandon was told, however, that coming down from -New York the whaleback had sighted two wrecks, but -the captain dared not delay to investigate them until -the principal object of the voyage was accomplished. -Caleb determined to let all other derelicts but the -Silver Swan severely alone.</p> - -<p>The whaleback passed the Bermudas low down on<span class="pagenum" id="Page_228">[228]</span> -the sea line, and being well supplied with fuel kept -on toward that portion of the ocean where the hull -of the Silver Swan was supposed to be making her objectless -voyage.</p> - -<p>A sharp lookout was kept day and night, but it was -not until after the Bermudas had faded from sight -that anything other than passing sailing vessels and -steamers were sighted. At night the whaleback ran -very slowly, indeed, so that naught might escape her, -but during the day she traveled at a high rate of -speed.</p> - -<p>Just before sunrise one morning Brandon was -aroused by a commotion on deck. He leaped from -his berth at once, and having been to sea long enough -now to know how to dress quickly, was outside in less -than a minute. Then he made out what the lookout -on the top of the forward turret was shouting:</p> - -<p>“Wreck—dead ahead, sir!”</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_229">[229]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXII<br /> - - -<small>RELATING HOW THE SILVER SWAN WAS HEARD FROM</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">As</span> the sun rose and lit up the sea more fully Brandon -could plainly view the wreck which the steamer -was now rapidly approaching.</p> - -<p>It was not, he believed at first glance, the Silver -Swan. It was the hull of a vessel, sunk a good deal -at the stern; but one mast was standing, and a great -tangle of cordage and torn sails was still attached -to it.</p> - -<p>“That’s never the Silver Swan, lad,” Caleb declared. -“She was swept as clean as a whistle. This -was a square rigged vessel, however.”</p> - -<p>The steamer ran in very close to the wreck, and -Brandon made out the words, “Porpoise, New -Haven,” under the bows.</p> - -<p>The derelict gave every appearance of being what -Mr. Coffin called “an old stager,” and labored in the -seas most heavily.</p> - -<p>“That’s a mighty dangerous wreck,” Caleb declared -reflectively, as the whaleback steamed slowly by. “It -wouldn’t take long to sink her, although ’twould cost -something. What d’ye say, Mr. Coffin—will you -go aboard her, and if she isn’t worth towing in, drop -enough dynamite into her hold to blow her up? You<span class="pagenum" id="Page_230">[230]</span> -know how to run that battery Mr. Pepper had put -aboard.”</p> - -<p>“Aye, aye, sir,” the first officer replied, and bustled -away to order a boat launched at once.</p> - -<p>By special request Brandon was allowed to accompany -the expedition. The old hulk was found to be -in ballast, and Mr. Coffin therefore placed a quantity -of the powerful explosive in her hold, attached the -wire, and they pulled back toward the steamer.</p> - -<p>When the small boat was out of danger the officer -touched the button and an instant later the still morning -air was shattered by a terrific roar.</p> - -<p>The wreck seemed almost to rise from the sea, a -great volume of fire and smoke issued from her amidships, -and she broke in two, the water rushing in and -filling the interior with a sound like the echo of the -explosion.</p> - -<p>Slowly the derelict settled, her stern going first, until -the very tip of the tottering mast disappeared below -the surface. Only a few splintered deck timbers, -which would soon follow the ship to the bottom, remained -to show where the hulk had disappeared.</p> - -<p>“Good job, that,” Caleb declared, when the boat -had returned to the steamer, “though it cost us three -hours’ time. That hulk had been floating for nearly -a year, according to the pilot charts.”</p> - -<p>The second day after the blowing up of the derelict -Porpoise, a steamship was sighted by the whaleback. -It was the City of Havana, of the James E. Ward line, -and, by running in close, Caleb was able to hold converse -with the ship’s captain.</p> - -<p>To the satisfaction of the captain of Number Three,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_231">[231]</span> -the City of Havana’s commander could, and did, give -him some information about the derelict brig of which -they were in search.</p> - -<p>The steamship had sighted the Silver Swan in latitude -28, longitude 69:13, and reported the vessel in -a remarkable state of preservation. The spring storms -had not appeared to damage her much.</p> - -<p>This news was hailed joyfully by Caleb and Brandon, -and the course of the whaleback was changed a -little more to the east.</p> - -<p>The weather, however, which had been all that they -could wish thus far since leaving Savannah, began to -get nasty. The sea became short and choppy, though -without apparently affecting the sailing of the whaleback, -and the sky looked bad.</p> - -<p>Finally, after a day or two of this, a dead calm occurred, -and Caleb shook his head sagely.</p> - -<p>“We’re goin’ to ketch it,” he declared, “an’ we’ll -have a chance to find out how the steamer rides in a -gale, whether we want to or not.”</p> - -<p>And he was right. While the whaleback steamed -slowly ahead, a heavy swell came on, although there -was not a breath of air stirring. The sea heaved and -rolled, seemingly in throes of agony.</p> - -<p>At first the cause was entirely submarine. At -length, however, there was a groaning, moaning sound, -which gradually increased in volume, until, with a -sudden roar, the hurricane swooped down upon them. -The waves were tossed toward the wind driven, leaden -clouds with awful fury, breaking like surf over the -whaleback; but the steamer withstood the fearful<span class="pagenum" id="Page_232">[232]</span> -shocks as easily as she had the choppy waves which -preceded the gale.</p> - -<p>She kept but little headway, however, and as the -black night shut down about the craft, Brandon -realized fully the terrible risks and hazardous chances -taken by “those who go down to the sea in ships.”</p> - -<p>For two days the gale continued, but with less fury -than signaled its first appearance. Number Three -might have put back into Bermuda, but she acted so -well that Caleb decided to stay outside and thus lose -no possible opportunity of sighting the Silver Swan.</p> - -<p>Brandon had never contemplated what a storm at -sea meant before and he was thankful indeed that he -was not upon a sailing vessel.</p> - -<p>During the first of the gale they had sighted several -vessels, with close reefed sails, scudding before the -wind, but all were riding the sea well.</p> - -<p>Late in the afternoon of the second day, however, -the lookout, who was lashed to the top of the wheelhouse, -reported a wreck ahead.</p> - -<p>At first Caleb and Brandon, who were both armed -with glasses, could not make it out clearly enough to -decide what it was.</p> - -<p>Finally the old seaman declared with conviction.</p> - -<p>“It’s the hull of a vessel an’ her masts have been -carried away sure.”</p> - -<p>“Do you think it is the brig, Caleb?” the young -second mate asked eagerly.</p> - -<p>“Ye got me there. It <i>may</i> be, and then ag’in it -may not. We’ll run down an’ see.”</p> - -<p>The storm was by no means abating and Caleb -dared not run very close to the wreck.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_233">[233]</span>As they approached it, however, the former mate -of the Silver Swan became convinced that it was not -the wreck they sought. He was familiar with every -line of Captain Horace Tarr’s vessel and this, he declared, -was not it.</p> - -<p>Suddenly Swivel’s sharp eyes caught sight of something -which the others had not seen.</p> - -<p>“There’s something tied to that stump of a mast, -sir,” he exclaimed, pointing toward the forward part -of the wreck. “It’s a flag o’ some kind.”</p> - -<p>“It’s a signal!” Mr. Coffin declared. “There’s -some poor soul on the wreck. See—there he is.”</p> - -<p>At the instant he spoke they all descried a moving -figure on the derelict—some one, who, clinging -with one hand to the cordage which still hung to the -mast, with the other waved a signal frantically at the -approaching steamer.</p> - -<p>“Great Heavens!” exclaimed Mr. Coffin, strongly -moved by the scene. “What shall we do? No mortal -man can help him in this gale.”</p> - -<p>“We must do something,” Caleb replied.</p> - -<p>“A boat couldn’t live in this sea, sir,” said the first -officer despairingly.</p> - -<p>“We must try to throw him a line.”</p> - -<p>But upon trial it was found that it would be exceedingly -hazardous to run down near enough to the -wreck for that. The hull was rolling so frightfully -that it might turn completely over at any moment and -carry the steamer to the bottom with it should they run -in too near.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_234">[234]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXIII<br /> - - -<small>IN WHICH COMRADES IN COURAGE LAUNCH THEMSELVES -UPON THE DEEP</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Brandon’s</span> glass had been turned upon the figure -on the wreck for the few moments during which the -others had been discussing the possibility of saving -the poor creature. Now he exclaimed hurriedly.</p> - -<p>“That’s not a man—it’s a woman! Don’t you see -her skirts blowing in the gale? She is alone on the -wreck.”</p> - -<p>Caleb seized his own glass again, and Mr. Bolin -dived into the cabin for his.</p> - -<p>“You’re right, lad,” the captain declared. “Either -all the men have been swept overboard, or the white -livered rascals have taken to the boats and abandoned -her.”</p> - -<p>But Brandon was making other discoveries. As the -steamer cut through the huge waves, approaching -nearer and nearer to the wreck, something about the -outlines of the female figure seemed familiar to him.</p> - -<p>He knew the face which was turned pleadingly -toward the steamer—the powerful glass revealed -every feature clearly.</p> - -<p>It was Milly Frank!</p> - -<p>At the instant of Brandon’s discovery, the steamer -gave a sudden roll, and he was thrown partially from<span class="pagenum" id="Page_235">[235]</span> -his balance and his glass wavered an instant from the -girl’s face.</p> - -<p>In that instant the stern of the fated vessel came -within range of his vision and he plainly saw the word -“Success” painted in tarnished gold lettering upon it.</p> - -<p>“Caleb! Caleb!” he cried, forgetting for the moment -to apply the proper term of respect to the captain -which, according to the quarter deck etiquette, he -should have done, “that’s the Success, and the <i>girl</i> -is the captain’s daughter!”</p> - -<p>“Oh, it can’t be, lad!” cried the old man, unwilling -to believe such a fact possible.</p> - -<p>“It is the Success—I see her name,” Mr. Bolin -declared.</p> - -<p>“Poor little girl! poor little girl!” exclaimed the -honest old sailor brokenly. “We can’t stand here and -see her perish.”</p> - -<p>“I shan’t,” Brandon affirmed, passing his own glass -to Mr. Coffin.</p> - -<p>“What can you do, lad?” queried Caleb. “The -gale’s not abating a mite.”</p> - -<p>“All that we can do I see, sir, is to stand by till -the sea goes down, and then, God willing, take her -off,” said Mr. Coffin.</p> - -<p>“Why, that old hulk may sink at any moment!” -cried Brandon. “I won’t stay idle and see that girl -drown after all she has done for me.”</p> - -<p>“An’ it’s Adoniram’s niece—no doubt of it,” murmured -Caleb.</p> - -<p>“That is another reason why we should try to save -her. I haven’t forgotten all that Mr. Pepper has done -for me,” declared Brandon decidedly.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_236">[236]</span>“But, lad, lad, what can we do?” gasped the captain. -“It’s not a living possibility to send a boat to -that brig, and I dare not risk the lives of all these -men in my care by running in near enough for a -cable to be thrown.”</p> - -<p>“And the girl probably couldn’t fasten it, if we -did,” added Mr. Bolin.</p> - -<p>“Then we must do something else. Run by her, -Caleb, and I’ll carry a rope to the brig.”</p> - -<p>“You’re crazy!” cried Mr. Coffin.</p> - -<p>“Maybe I am,” Brandon returned, his face white -and set; “but I shall do it.”</p> - -<p>Swivel, who was clinging to a guard rope within -hearing, struck in with him.</p> - -<p>“Lemme do it, Brandon—I mean Mr. Tarr. I kin -swim like a fish.”</p> - -<p>“Nobody shall go but myself,” the boy declared, -with emphasis. “I won’t suggest a perilous undertaking -and not be the one to carry it out.”</p> - -<p>“Cap’n Tarr right over again,” Caleb muttered.</p> - -<p>Then he turned suddenly upon his young second -officer.</p> - -<p>“Kick off your shoes, lad, and try it. If it’s the -Lord’s will that you accomplish it, well and good; if -you can’t, we’ll haul you back. Quick, now! I’ll -order Mike to go ahead full speed.”</p> - -<p>Before the words were scarcely out of the captain’s -mouth, Brandon had kicked off his light shoes.</p> - -<p>Swivel, who could not be taught strict quarter deck -manners, followed the young officer’s example.</p> - -<p>“What are you about, you young limb o’ Satan?” -demanded Mr. Coffin, catching hint at this.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_237">[237]</span>“Ef he goes, I’m goin’ an’ you ain’t goin’ ter stop -me, Mr. Coffin,” announced the gamin. “I’m in dis!”</p> - -<p>“Behave yourself,” Brandon commanded, quickly -knotting a light, strong cable about his waist, while -Mr. Bolin fastened a life preserver beneath his arms. -“One is enough.”</p> - -<p>“Den I’m de one!” the boy declared vehemently, -and dodging Mr. Coffin’s outstretched arm, he seized -a second coil of rope, one end of which was fastened -to a ring in the deck, and ran to the stern of the -steamer.</p> - -<p>“Come back here!” roared the first mate angrily. -“I’ll rope’s end you, you little scamp!”</p> - -<p>“You’ll have ter do it when I get back from dat -wreck!” returned the boy, with an impish grin, and -the steamer having now forged ahead of the laboring -brig, and Brandon being all ready, the fearless Swivel -also dropped over the rail, and clinging with one -hand a moment, let go simultaneously with his friend -and patron.</p> - -<p>Brandon tried to send him back, but it was too late -then. The first wave seized them in its embrace and -they were carried far out from the steamer’s stern.</p> - -<p>The cork belt kept the young second mate above -the waves, but even with this assistance, he found himself -much less able to cope with the heavy seas than -was his companion.</p> - -<p>Swivel dived through the rollers like a gull, keeping -faithfully by his friend’s side; and had it not been for -the street gamin, Brandon afterward declared that he -should never have reached the wreck alive.</p> - -<p>He had no idea how furious the waves were until<span class="pagenum" id="Page_238">[238]</span> -he was among them, battling for his life, and trying -to reach the distant brig.</p> - -<p>It was a terrific struggle, lasting perhaps not five -minutes, but a few more seconds would have completely -exhausted him.</p> - -<p>A great wave suddenly swept them directly under -the brig’s bows. Swivel seized Brandon’s hand with -one of his own and with the other grabbed a rope -trailing over the rail of the wreck.</p> - -<p>Fortunately the other end of the rope was securely -fastened, and with an almost superhuman effort Swivel -raised Brandon until the second mate of the whaleback -could grasp the rail.</p> - -<p>In another moment Brandon was aboard the brig, -and had pulled Swivel over the rail after him.</p> - -<p>“Wot—did—I—tell—ye?” gasped the gamin, -whose spirit no amount of danger could quench. -“Two heads <i>is</i> better’n one, ef one <i>is</i> a cabbage head. -Where’s de girl?”</p> - -<p>But Milly was already creeping forward to their -position on her hands and knees.</p> - -<p>“How can you take me back?” she asked at once, -her voice sounding as firmly above the gale as though -danger was the farthest of anything from her thoughts.</p> - -<p>Then she recognized Brandon.</p> - -<p>“You?” she exclaimed, in surprise. “I never -thought of you being on that steamer.”</p> - -<p>“I didn’t forget what you did for me,” Brandon -said in reply. “I’d have risked a good deal more -than this for you.”</p> - -<p>“You couldn’t risk any more,” she declared firmly; -“for you’ve risked your life.”</p> - -<p>Meanwhile Swivel was signaling to those on the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_239">[239]</span> -steamer to attach a heavier cable to the one tied about -his waist. This was done in a short time, and then -all three of the endangered ones laid hold and pulled -the cable in, hand over hand.</p> - -<p>It was hard work. The heavy rope was wet and -unmanageable, and the strain on their young muscles -was terrible.</p> - -<p>Milly worked as unceasingly as did the two boys, -but the cable came across the tossing waves but slowly.</p> - -<p>“Where are the crew—where is your father?” -asked Brandon.</p> - -<p>The girl’s face worked pitifully at this question.</p> - -<p>“Father is dead,” she sobbed, “and the crew took -to the boats while I was below. That was early this -morning.”</p> - -<p>“And you’ve been here alone ever since!” said -Brandon pityingly.</p> - -<p>At that instant there was a slight exclamation from -Swivel, and the small cable by which they were endeavoring -to gain the larger one, came in over the rail -with fearful suddenness.</p> - -<p>All three were sent sprawling on the deck.</p> - -<p>“What is it?” gasped Milly.</p> - -<p>“The rope’s parted,” cried Brandon in horror.</p> - -<p>“Never mind; don’t you give up, missy,” Swivel -exclaimed. “We’ve got anoder rope yet. Where’s -de end o’ dat rope you had tied ’round you, Brandon?” -he demanded.</p> - -<p>Brandon only groaned.</p> - -<p>“Where is it?” shrieked the other lad, fairly shaking -him in his impatience.</p> - -<p>“I cast it loose,” was the disheartening reply. “It -is gone!”</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_240">[240]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXIV<br /> - - -<small>THE INCIDENTS OF A NIGHT OF PERIL</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Night</span> was shutting down over the face of the -storm tossed ocean—night of the blackest and wildest -description. Already the outlines of the steamer -ahead were scarcely visible from the bows of the -water logged brig.</p> - -<p>By a series of misfortunes (Brandon Tarr bitterly -accused himself of causing the crowning mischance of -them all) the three unfortunates on the Success were -entirely cut off from escape.</p> - -<p>“Oh,” cried Milly, in bitterness of spirit second -only to Brandon’s own, “you have lost your lives for -me—both of you. I am not worthy of it!”</p> - -<p>“Don’t ye lose heart, missy,” Swivel declared, with -a courage he was far from feeling. “Th’ ship hain’t -sunk.”</p> - -<p>“No one but God Himself knows how long it will -keep afloat, though,” Brandon returned despairingly.</p> - -<p>“And the gale is increasing again, too,” added Milly -softly.</p> - -<p>“This is the last end of it, that’s wot I think,” declared -Swivel cheerfully. “It’ll blow itself out now -purty soon.”</p> - -<p>Brandon could not look at the situation thus hopefully,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_241">[241]</span> -but he determined to say nothing further to make -the girl despair.</p> - -<p>Swivel’s tone shamed him into thinking of her -rather than of himself.</p> - -<p>The men on board the steamer, had ere this discovered -what had happened, but they could do nothing -to assist the three on the brig.</p> - -<p>It was absolutely necessary to keep some headway—considerable, -in fact—on the whaleback, to prevent -her from swinging around into the trough of the -waves. Every moment they were getting farther and -farther away from the doomed derelict.</p> - -<p>Caleb roared something to them through the trumpet, -but the distance and the howling of the gale prevented -them from making out what he said. The -wind and spray beat upon them alternately as they -crouched together in the high bows, and every other -sound but that of the elements was drowned.</p> - -<p>“Come back in the shelter of the mast,” Brandon -shouted at last. “We can do nothing further here. -Our position is so exposed that we may be washed off -before we know it.”</p> - -<p>Each of the boys grasped an arm of the captain’s -daughter and with no little trouble they managed to -reach the great tangle of rigging and shreds of canvas -which hung about the one remaining mast.</p> - -<p>The topmast had long since been carried away, but -the main spar still defied the storm, writhing and twisting -like a thing of life in the fierce grasp of the gale.</p> - -<p>Here, crouching under its lee, the shipwrecked boys -and girl clung to the stiffened ropes with hands little -less stiffened by the cold and water.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_242">[242]</span>As an extra precaution they bound themselves together, -and then fastened the same rope to the mast, -knowing that a wave might board the lumbering brig -at any moment and sweep everything on it that was -not fastened, into the sea.</p> - -<p>Occasionally, as the wreck climbed heavily to the -summit of an enormous roller, they could catch a -glimpse of the steamer’s lights; but as the hours -dragged slowly on, these became less and less distinct.</p> - -<p>Without doubt the whaleback was drawing slowly -away from the wreck, and the worst of it was, those on -the steamer probably did not suspect it.</p> - -<p>The castaways had no means of showing their -whereabouts by lights, and the steamer was too far -away, and had been since the darkness shut down, for -those aboard her to see the outlines of the brig. -Therefore Caleb Wetherbee and his officers had no -means of knowing that the steamer was traveling -nearly two miles to the brig’s one.</p> - -<p>Suddenly there was a flash of light from the -steamer’s deck, and a rocket went hurtling upwards -into the leaden sky, to fall in showers of sparks into -the sea. It was a message of hope to the unfortunates -on the brig—it was meant as such, at least—but -they had no way of replying to it.</p> - -<p>“Aren’t there any rockets aboard?” asked Brandon -of the captain’s daughter.</p> - -<p>“There may be, but I do not know where,” the girl -replied; “and the cabin is half filled with water, too.”</p> - -<p>“Never mind if it is; I believe I’ll try to find them. -There must be something of the kind aboard.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_243">[243]</span>“Ye’d better stay here,” Swivel warned him anxiously. -“I don’t like ter see ye git out o’ sight.”</p> - -<p>“Don’t you think I can take care of myself?” -Brandon demanded.</p> - -<p>“Not alone,” was the prompt reply. “I reckon -’at none of us can’t take very good keer of ourselves -in this gale. We’d best not git too fur apart.”</p> - -<p>“Well, I’m going to try to get into the cabin,” -Brandon added. “Nothing ventured, nothing -gained.”</p> - -<p>He unfastened the rope from about his waist, and -in spite of the objections of his two companions, crept -aft toward the cabin companionway.</p> - -<p>The feat was not of the easiest, as he quickly found; -but once having determined to do it, he would not give -up.</p> - -<p>The door of the cabin was jammed fast, but after -some little maneuvering he was able to force an entrance -and descended into the apartment, which was -knee deep with water washed in from the heavy seas -which had broken over the brig during the day.</p> - -<p>There was no means of lighting a lantern, however, -and after rummaging about in the darkness for half -an hour, he had to return to the deck without having -accomplished anything.</p> - -<p>As he stepped outside again, he found the brig pitching -worse than ever. The gale was full of “flaws” -now—a sure sign that it was blowing itself out—but -occasionally it would rise to greater fury than -it had shown in all the two previous days.</p> - -<p>Just as he reached the deck one of these sudden -squalls occurred, and a huge green roller swept in<span class="pagenum" id="Page_244">[244]</span> -over the stern of the brig, and advanced with lightning -speed along the deck, sweeping wreckage and all else -before it.</p> - -<p>Brandon had just closed the door, and by clinging -to the handle, was able to keep himself from being -washed overboard; but he was almost drowned during -the few moments while the wave filled the companionway.</p> - -<p>As it passed, there was a sudden crack forward, and -even above the shriek of the gale, he heard Swivel’s -cry of alarm.</p> - -<p>With a rush and roar like the fall of a mighty forest -tree, the mast, splitting at the deck, toppled over -across the rail.</p> - -<p>Brandon uttered a despairing shout, for it seemed -impossible for the wreck ever to right herself, the -weight of the fallen spar dragged her over so far.</p> - -<p>But providentially the mast had split clear off at -the deck, and after staggering a moment from the -blow, the brig shook off her incumbrance, and came to -an even keel again.</p> - -<p>But following the falling of the mast came a shriek -from Milly Frank which pierced his very soul.</p> - -<p>“Brandon! Brandon! Help!”</p> - -<p>With that cry ringing in his ears, the boy dashed -forward along the slippery deck and reached the spot -where he had left his companions.</p> - -<p>“Quick! this way!” called the girl’s clear voice, and -darting to the rail he was just able to grasp the captain’s -daughter and drag her back from the cruel sea.</p> - -<p>“Now him!” commanded the girl, and pulling in<span class="pagenum" id="Page_245">[245]</span> -the line which was still attached to her waist, Brandon -drew the form of Swivel out of the waves.</p> - -<p>“Oh, he is dead!” cried Milly in agony. “He -saved me, Brandon. When the mast fell he cut the -rope and took me in his arms and ran, but one of the -ropes tripped him up and we were washed to the rail -by that great wave.”</p> - -<p>“I hope he isn’t dead—oh, I hope not!” Brandon -returned, kneeling down beside the motionless boy, -and chafing his forehead tenderly.</p> - -<p>Milly took one of the poor street gamin’s hands in -her own and chafed it likewise.</p> - -<p>Probably never before during his miserable, eventful -existence had Swivel known such gentleness. His -life had been hard indeed, and it looked as though its -lamp had gone out now in the performance of a noble -and courageous deed.</p> - -<p>There on the storm swept deck Milly and Brandon -knelt for nearly an hour before the unconscious boy -showed the least sign of life.</p> - -<p>Then the eyelids fluttered a little and he drew in his -breath with a slight sigh.</p> - -<p>“He’s coming to!” Brandon exclaimed.</p> - -<p>But although poor Swivel opened his eyes once or -twice, it was a long time before he seemed to realize -where he was or what had happened.</p> - -<p>At last he whispered brokenly.</p> - -<p>“Don’t—don’t—fret yerself—missy—I’m—I’m -goin’ ter be all right.”</p> - -<p>“Are you in pain, Swivel?” queried Brandon, having -almost to shout to make himself heard.</p> - -<p>Milly was crying softly. The strain of the last<span class="pagenum" id="Page_246">[246]</span> -twenty hours was beginning to tell on even her bravery -and fortitude.</p> - -<p>“Dret—dretful!” gasped the injured boy weakly.</p> - -<p>Brandon had to place his ear almost to his lips to -distinguish his words.</p> - -<p>“Right—here,” and he laid his hand feebly on his -chest.</p> - -<p>“That’s where he struck across the rail,” declared -Milly, when Brandon had repeated these words to -her. “Oh, the poor fellow has been hurt internally. -<i>Do</i> you think the morning will ever come, Brandon?”</p> - -<p>“I’m afraid it will come very soon for him, poor -boy,” replied Don meaningly, and there were tears in -his own eyes.</p> - -<p>Swivel had closed his eyes and a strange, grayish -pallor was spreading over his drawn features.</p> - -<p>His hearing seemed wonderfully acute, however. -He heard the word “morning” at least, and his eyes -flew open again and he struggled to raise himself on -his elbow.</p> - -<p>“<i>Is</i> it morning now?” he asked feebly.</p> - -<p>“No, no,” replied Brandon soothingly. “Not yet, -Swivel. Don’t exert yourself. Lie down again.”</p> - -<p>The injured youth strove to speak once more, but -suddenly fell back upon the rude pillow Don had made -of his coat, and a stream of blood flowed from his -lips.</p> - -<p>Milly uttered a startled gasp, but Brandon hastily -wiped the poor fellow’s lips, and after a moment the -hemorrhage ceased.</p> - -<p>But they looked at each other meaningly. They -had lost all hope now of the shock not proving fatal.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_247">[247]</span>While they had watched Swivel, the gale, as though -at last satisfied with its cruel work, had gradually lessened. -The wind ceased almost wholly within the next -hour, although the waves did not entirely go down.</p> - -<p>Swivel lay motionless during all this time, occasionally -opening his eyes to gaze up into the faces of his -two friends, whom he could see quite clearly, but -otherwise showing no sign of life.</p> - -<p>Finally he attempted to speak again.</p> - -<p>“It’s—it’s hard—on me—ain’t it?” he gasped, -in Brandon’s ear. “I—I—don’ wanter die.”</p> - -<p>His friend did not know what to say in reply to -this, but Milly seized his hand and tried to comfort -him.</p> - -<p>“Don’t be afraid. Swivel,” she said, trying to make -her own faith serve for the dying fellow too. “It will -be better over there.”</p> - -<p>“Mebbee—mebbee they won’t let me come.”</p> - -<p>“Yes, you may, if you ask, Swivel. Don’t you love -God?”</p> - -<p>“I hain’t—hain’t never—heered—much erbout -Him,” returned the lad. “I heered the chap at the -mission—school talk erbout—erbout Him some. I—I -never paid much ’tention.”</p> - -<p>His voice was stronger now, but in a moment the -blood gushed from his lips again.</p> - -<p>“Don’t talk—oh, don’t talk, Swivel?” cried Brandon -beseechingly.</p> - -<p>“’Twon’t matter—not much,” the boy returned, after -a few minutes.</p> - -<p>He felt blindly for Brandon’s hand and seized it<span class="pagenum" id="Page_248">[248]</span> -tightly. Milly, still kneeling on the opposite side, held -the other.</p> - -<p>“Can’t ye say a prayer, like—like that feller in the -mission did—er one o’ them hymns?” he muttered.</p> - -<p>The boy and girl crouching above him looked into -each other’s faces a moment in silence.</p> - -<p>Brandon Tarr might have faced a thousand dangers -without shrinking, but he could not do this. It remained -for Milly to comply with the poor boy’s request.</p> - -<p>After the terrific howling of the gale, the night -seemed strangely still now. The hurrying, leaden -clouds were fast breaking up, and here and there a -ray of moonlight pierced their folds and lit up the -froth flecked summits of the tossing billows.</p> - -<p>One narrow band of light fell across her pale face -as she raised it toward the frowning heavens and began -to sing:</p> - -<div class="poetry-container"> -<div class="poetry"> -<div class="stanza"> -<div class="first">“Jesus, Saviour, pilot me,</div> -<div class="verse">Over life’s tempestuous sea;</div> -<div class="verse">Unknown waves before me roll,</div> -<div class="verse">Hiding rock and treach’rous shoal:</div> -<div class="verse">Chart and compass come from the Thee:</div> -<div class="verse">Jesus, Saviour, pilot me.</div> -</div> -<div class="stanza"> -<div class="first">“When at last I near the shore,</div> -<div class="verse">And the fearful breakers roar</div> -<div class="verse">Twixt me and the peaceful rest,</div> -<div class="verse">Then, while leaning on Thy breast,</div> -<div class="verse">May I hear Thee say to me,</div> -<div class="verse">‘Fear not, I will pilot thee’!”</div> -</div></div></div> - -<p>Faintly at first, but mounting higher and clearer, -rose the sweet girlish voice, and not only the poor<span class="pagenum" id="Page_249">[249]</span> -street gamin, but Brandon himself listened entranced.</p> - -<p>When the beautiful hymn was finished, Brandon felt -that it was a prayer not only for him whose spirit -might at any moment depart, but for Milly and himself, -who should remain behind at the mercy of the -storm tossed sea.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_250">[250]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXV<br /> - - -<small>SHOWING HOW CALEB APPEARED ON THE SCENE JUST -TOO LATE</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">The</span> anxiety of Caleb Wetherbee for Brandon’s -safety was really pitiful to behold. When the cable -parted which attached the wrecked brig to the steamer, -the captain at once realized that his ward and his two -companions were in a very serious predicament.</p> - -<p>There was absolutely nothing that those aboard the -whaleback could do in that howling gale to assist in -the rescue of the castaways.</p> - -<p>Occasionally Caleb had a rocket fired to show the -unfortunate trio that he was remaining near them; -but, as we know, that was very sorry comfort to Brandon -and his two companions. It simply served to convince -them how rapidly Number Three was leaving -them astern.</p> - -<p>On one point Caleb’s calculations were very much -amiss. He was running the whaleback as slowly as -practicable, keeping just enough headway on to keep -her from broaching to; but he failed to realize that -even at that speed he was sailing two miles or more -to the brig’s one.</p> - -<p>Of course, when once the night had shut down it -was impossible for anybody aboard the steamer to -see the outlines of the wreck, and therefore this fact<span class="pagenum" id="Page_251">[251]</span> -escaped their attention. The water logged Success -moved at a snail’s pace, and all night long the steamer -drew away from her, so that, after the storm had -cleared away and the sun rose, not a sign of the brig -appeared.</p> - -<p>“Has she sunk?” queried Caleb in distress, as, in -company with his two remaining officers, he swept -the horizon with his glass.</p> - -<p>“Rather, we have left her behind,” declared Mr. -Coffin, making a shrewd guess as to the real facts -in the case. “The brig must have sailed slower than -we supposed.”</p> - -<p>“Then we must turn about at once and run back,” -Caleb declared, and the necessary orders were given.</p> - -<p>The day following the cessation of the gale was -most beautiful, but Caleb cared nothing for that. He -neither ate nor slept, but remained on deck nearly all -the time, scanning the wide stretch of sea visible from -the top of the after cabin.</p> - -<p>The day passed and night came on, however, without -a sign of the wreck appearing.</p> - -<p>During this time the steamer had been running in -a direction generally south; while the gale was on -she had run northeast. The whole day being spent -in fruitless search in this direction, however, Caleb -commanded the steamer to be put about again at -evening.</p> - -<p>All that second night she ran slowly to the eastward, -thus allowing for the supposed drift of the -Success, but they saw no signs of the derelict, although -the night was clear and the moon bright.</p> - -<p>The day following they spoke several partially dismantled<span class="pagenum" id="Page_252">[252]</span> -vessels whose crews were beating into the -Bermudas for repairs. None of these, however, had -sighted the wreck of the Success.</p> - -<p>“They’ve gone to the bottom,” groaned poor Caleb -that afternoon, as he sat on the edge of the berth in -his stateroom.</p> - -<p>He could not sleep, but had taken Mr. Coffin’s advice -and tried to.</p> - -<p>“All gone—Brandon, whose dead father I promised -I’d look out for him, an’ that other poor lad, an’ -the little girl. God help me! how can I go back and -tell Adoniram about this?</p> - -<p>“An’ then, we’ve not found the Silver Swan yet—nor -air we likely to after this gale. She’s gone to -the bottom, too, mayhap, and Brandon’s fortune along -with her. Well——”</p> - -<p>Just here he was interrupted in his soliloquy by the -hurried entrance of Mr. Bolin.</p> - -<p>“Will you please come on deck, sir?” said the -third officer, evidently somewhat excited. “We have -sighted what appears to be a steamer and a dismantled -vessel with her. Mr. Coffin wishes you to come up -and see if you can make her out.”</p> - -<p>But Caleb was out of the cabin before Mr. Bolin -had finished speaking, glass in hand.</p> - -<p>“Where is she?” he demanded.</p> - -<p>“Right ahead, captain,” replied Mr. Coffin. -“There! you can see the black smoke rising from the -steamship’s funnels now. The wreck, if it is a wreck, -is between her and us.”</p> - -<p>Caleb got the range of the two vessels almost immediately,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_253">[253]</span> -and it did not take a very long look to assure -him that his mate was right.</p> - -<p>“That’s a wreck, sure enough,” he declared, paying -but very little attention to the steamship. “Order -the engineer to go ahead at full speed.”</p> - -<p>Fifteen minutes later they were near enough to see -the wreck quite plainly. The steam vessel seemed -to be lying quietly upon the sea now, and as they -looked a boat was lowered and pulled toward the dismantled -hulk.</p> - -<p>They were still several miles away, however, and -could not see whether the wreck was boarded by those -in the small boat or not.</p> - -<p>“It strikes me,” began Mr. Coffin after a prolonged -gazing through his glass at the wreck, “that that -doesn’t have the same appearance as that vessel the -boys are on. What do you think, Mr. Wetherbee?”</p> - -<p>Caleb had doubts in that direction himself.</p> - -<p>“I tell ye what it is,” he said: “the Success had -a mast for’ard. This one hain’t.”</p> - -<p>“It’s my opinion that’s the hull of a brig, just the -same,” Mr. Coffin declared.</p> - -<p>Suddenly Caleb uttered an exclamation.</p> - -<p>“That’s no steamship,” he declared. “See her -colors and open ports. Why, it’s a man o’ war!”</p> - -<p>“Right you are,” returned the mate.</p> - -<p>“It’s the Kearsarge,” added Mr. Bolin. “She was -to come down this way, you know. Going to the West -Indies.”</p> - -<p>“One of her duties was to blow up derelicts—the -Silver Swan among them. Suppose this hull is the -Swan!” cried Mr. Coffin.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_254">[254]</span>Caleb had fairly grown white in spite of his tan.</p> - -<p>“Great Peter!” he ejaculated. “Look-er-there!”</p> - -<p>The small boat had left the side of the wreck, and -was now some distance away from her.</p> - -<p>The whaleback was near enough to see that the officer -commanding the cutter had ordered the men to -cease rowing and was standing up in the bow of the -boat.</p> - -<p>“They’re going to blow her up!” shouted Caleb. -“Crowd on every ounce of steam she’ll hold. We -must stop it! Suppose that it is the Silver Swan!”</p> - -<p>He fairly groaned aloud, and in his excitement allowed -the costly glass to fall upon the deck, which -treatment did not materially benefit it.</p> - -<p>Mr. Bolin darted away to the engine room, and in -another moment the funnels of the whaleback began -to pour forth the blackest kind of smoke, and the -water beneath her stern was churned to foam by the -rapid beats of the propeller.</p> - -<p>They were all of a mile away from the wreck yet, -and every instant was precious. Caleb stumped up -and down the deck, fairly wild with apprehension, his -eyes fixed on the cruiser’s cutter, in the bow of which -the officer seemed to be adjusting something.</p> - -<p>If the whaleback had been armed Caleb would have -fired a shot to attract the attention of the cruiser’s -people, but there wasn’t a weapon larger than Brandon’s -rifle on the steamer.</p> - -<p>Mr. Coffin looked at his commander anxiously. He -did not fully understand why the captain wished to -reach the Silver Swan and save it, if <i>this was</i> the<span class="pagenum" id="Page_255">[255]</span> -Silver Swan; but he did not believe that they could -accomplish it. And he was right.</p> - -<p>The whaleback was still half a mile away from the -scene of operations when suddenly the officer in the -cutter sat down, and the instant following there was a -loud explosion.</p> - -<p>A column of smoke and flame shot into the air, and -when the smoke cloud rose, only a few harmless -splinters on the surface of the sea remained to show -the former position of the wreck!</p> - -<p>And then, when it was too late, the officer in the -small boat discovered the approach of the whaleback.</p> - -<p>Number Three was still driving ahead at full speed, -and when her steam was shut off she had such headway -that she nearly passed the cruiser’s cutter.</p> - -<p>Caleb, his voice trembling with apprehension, leaned -over the rail and shouted his question to the officer -who had just “touched off” the charge that had -blown the derelict into atoms.</p> - -<p>“What craft is that you blew up?” he asked.</p> - -<p>“That was a derelict,” responded the officer, who -was an ensign, in surprise.</p> - -<p>“What was her name, d’ye know?”</p> - -<p>“She was sunken so low at the stern that we -couldn’t read her name.”</p> - -<p>“But can’t you guess?” cried Caleb, in great exasperation.</p> - -<p>“Oh, there’s not much doubt in our minds as to -who she was. She was one we were ordered to -destroy. The name on her bow was badly battered, -but we could make out part of it.”</p> - -<p>“Well, for heavens’ sake, what was it?” burst forth<span class="pagenum" id="Page_256">[256]</span> -the wooden legged captain wildly. “Don’t beat -’round the bush any longer.”</p> - -<p>The ensign began to grow as red as a peony. The -old man’s manner of questioning ruffled his dignity -sorely.</p> - -<p>“To the best of my belief it was the brig Silver -Swan, of Boston, U. S. A.,” he declared stiffly.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_257">[257]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXVI<br /> - - -<small>THE CASTAWAYS ON THE BRIG SUCCESS</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">To</span> Milly and Brandon on board the water logged -brig, it seemed as though the long night would never -end. They crouched together over the body of poor -Swivel, until his clasp relaxed from their hands and -he sank into a deep sleep.</p> - -<p>Brandon did not believe that the injured boy would -ever awake from that unconsciousness; nevertheless, -he made his way below to the cabin again and brought -up an armful of blankets to add to his comfort.</p> - -<p>He wrapped one about Milly, and she made him -share it with her, when Swivel was more comfortable.</p> - -<p>Thus sitting close together on the cold, wet deck, -they conversed in whispers till dawn; Milly, at Don’s -earnest solicitation, relating all that had occurred since -the night he had escaped from the Success at Savannah.</p> - -<p>It was rather a disconnected story, for the poor girl -often broke into weeping at the memory of her father’s -violent death. She had sincerely loved him, although -he was a stern, rather morose man.</p> - -<p>It seemed that Leroyd had learned that the plans -of himself and his friends to delay the departure of -the whaleback from New York had failed, and that<span class="pagenum" id="Page_258">[258]</span> -the steamer had touched at Savannah and departed -the very night the Success got in.</p> - -<p>Finding that Sneaky Al had already arrived by -steamship from New York, he promised Captain -Frank an extra hundred dollars if he would land only -a portion of his goods and set sail for the Bermudas -again.</p> - -<p>The brig’s commander could not resist this temptation, -and therefore the Success lay at Savannah -but a day and two nights. Then, with Messrs. Weeks -and Leroyd aboard, she had sailed directly for that -part of the ocean in which the whaleback had run -across her during the gale.</p> - -<p>Brandon also elicited the information that the brig -had not been successful in her search—had not seen -a derelict, in fact, since leaving Savannah—and that -Leroyd was in a fiendish temper before the gale came -up.</p> - -<p>When that began, he and his friend, Weeks, turned -to with the brig’s crew and did all they could to keep -her afloat. Captain Frank, however, was crushed under -a falling spar and instantly killed when the gale -first started in, and the first officer was washed overboard.</p> - -<p>When the brig became unmanageable and the crew -rushed for the boats, nobody thought, or at least nobody -stopped, for the bereaved girl in the cabin. She -discovered that the crew had gone and left her only -by coming on deck after the water had begun to fill -the cabin.</p> - -<p>Brandon and the captain’s daughter had ample time,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_259">[259]</span> -before the sun appeared, to get very well acquainted -with each other.</p> - -<p>Don told her all about himself, about the object of -the voyage of the whaleback, and of the plot concocted -by his uncle Arad and Messrs. Leroyd and Weeks to -find the Silver Swan and obtain the treasure aboard -her themselves.</p> - -<p>As soon as it <i>did</i> grow light, Brandon made his way -below again and after a great deal of trouble lit an oil -lamp and heated a little water over its blaze. He was -then able to make some warm drink for Swivel and -Milly, denying himself until she had swallowed some, -and between them they had forced a little of the mixture -between the injured boy’s lips.</p> - -<p>After this Swivel brightened up a bit, and, as he -did not try to talk, the hemorrhage did not return. -But he was very weak.</p> - -<p>Milly and Brandon ate a little solid food too, but -their companion was unable to do that.</p> - -<p>Now that it was light enough for them to see over -the expanse of waters, they found as they had feared, -that the whaleback had left them behind during the -night.</p> - -<p>Not a sign of her presence nor of the presence of -any vessel which might come to their assistance, appeared.</p> - -<p>The condition of the Success worried them a great -deal—or worried Don and Milly at least—for she -was gradually sinking at the stern, and the water -was gaining more rapidly than they liked in the cabin. -Whereas it had only been to Brandon’s knees when -he had first gone below, it was now up to his waist.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_260">[260]</span>During one of these trips of his to the flooded interior -of the brig, he heard Milly’s voice excitedly -calling to him to come on deck.</p> - -<p>“What is it?” he asked, hastily making his appearance.</p> - -<p>“Look! look, Brandon!” cried the girl.</p> - -<p>She was standing up in the stern and looking over -the starboard side.</p> - -<p>Brandon hurried toward her and followed the direction -of her hand with his eyes.</p> - -<p>Far across the tossing sea a dark object rose and -fell upon the surface. It was not far above the level -of the water, and therefore, though hardly three miles -away, had until now remained unseen by the voyagers -of the Success.</p> - -<p>“Is it a wreck like this?” she inquired eagerly.</p> - -<p>“It must be,” said Brandon, after a careful examination.</p> - -<p>“Bring poor papa’s long glass up from his stateroom,” -cried Milly. “You can see it then more -plainly.”</p> - -<p>The boy hurried to obey this suggestion and quickly -brought the instrument from the dead captain’s cabin.</p> - -<p>By the aid of the glass the shipwrecked boy and -girl could quite plainly view the second wreck, for -wreck it was. There was no room for doubt of that.</p> - -<p>“It’s the hull of a vessel like this,” Brandon declared, -“though it’s not sunken at the stern, and it -rides the waves easier.</p> - -<p>“There isn’t a sign of a spar upon it—it’s swept -as clean as this,” he continued. “There must have<span class="pagenum" id="Page_261">[261]</span> -been many vessels treated that way in the storm. -Derelicts will be plentiful enough.”</p> - -<p>He stopped with a startled exclamation, and stared -at his companion in perplexity.</p> - -<p>“What is it, Brandon?” Milly asked, noting his -change of manner.</p> - -<p>“I was thinking,” he said slowly, “that if the Silver -Swan—my father’s old brig, you know—kept afloat -through this last hurricane, she would likely be in just -such shape as yonder hulk.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, it couldn’t be possible, could it?” gasped the -girl. “That would be too wonderful a coincidence.”</p> - -<p>“Not as wonderful as you might think,” Brandon -returned decisively, gaining confidence in the idea now -that some one opposed him. “We are in the very -part of the ocean—or at least, I have reason to think -we are—in which the Silver Swan was last reported. -I tell you, Milly, it may be she!”</p> - -<p>“If you could only get to her and see,” cried the -young girl anxiously.</p> - -<p>“I—I will get to her!” declared Brandon, and -then he handed the glass to her and went back to sit -by poor Swivel and think it over.</p> - -<p>Milly, however, remained to watch the distant wreck -through the instrument.</p> - -<p>By all appearances it was much more buoyant than -the Success. Whereas the latter staggered up the -long swells and labored through the trough of the sea, -the strange derelict rode the waves like a duck, and, -propelled by some current, moved a good deal faster, -though in the same general direction as themselves.</p> - -<p>Brandon, meanwhile, sitting beside the injured boy,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_262">[262]</span> -who was now sleeping deeply, was turning over in -his mind the project he had suggested.</p> - -<p>He knew, even better than Milly, that the Success -was sinking deeper and deeper every hour, and that -before evening the water might begin to wash in over -the stern.</p> - -<p>The ocean was rapidly becoming smooth. Together -they would be able to launch a small raft—a hatch -covering, perhaps—place Swivel thereon, and by -using oars, or perhaps a small sail, might reach the -distant derelict quite easily.</p> - -<p>Whether it was the Silver Swan he had sighted, or -not, it certainly rode the swells better and seemed to -be far more seaworthy than the Success.</p> - -<p>Finally, when Milly came up from the stern, he -broached his plan to her.</p> - -<p>“I don’t want to force you into this, Milly,” he -said. “You shall have the deciding vote. Perhaps I -am influenced by the hope that yonder vessel is the -Silver Swan, and maybe this is a dreadfully foolish -plan for us to try. I think, though, that it is the best -and wisest thing we can do.”</p> - -<p>“What can we use for a raft?” the girl asked -slowly.</p> - -<p>“One of the hatch covers. I have found a tool -chest below—I can get at it yet—and there are -spars and pieces of canvas for a sail in the same place. -I saw them only this morning.”</p> - -<p>“Can we launch a raft?” asked the practical Milly.</p> - -<p>“I believe we can. It is growing calmer all the -time, now, and the rail is so low at the stern that we<span class="pagenum" id="Page_263">[263]</span> -can push a well balanced raft into the sea and load it -afterward.”</p> - -<p>“And Swivel?”</p> - -<p>“I’m afraid,” said Brandon, looking down at the -injured boy sadly, “that whatever we do cannot affect -Swivel. We can make him as comfortable on the -raft as elsewhere.”</p> - -<p>“Then let us do it,” agreed Milly energetically. -“I have been watching the other wreck and it seems -to sail much better than the Success. The old brig -may go down now at any time.”</p> - -<p>And so they set to work at once at the task of building -a raft.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_264">[264]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXVII<br /> - - -<small>LEFT IN DOUBT</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">The</span> task they had set themselves was no child’s -play, and this Brandon and Milly soon discovered. -But they were working for their lives, for according -to their reckoning, the Success would not remain above -the surface many hours.</p> - -<p>The captain’s daughter showed herself not only -capable of handling tools, but she was strong, too. -For years she had sailed up and down the seas with -her father—nearly all her life, in fact—for her -mother, Brandon had discovered by questioning, had -died when she was quite young.</p> - -<p>This information assured him that there could be -no reasonable doubt of Milly Frank’s identity. But -for the present he said nothing to the girl about her -relatives in New York.</p> - -<p>Milly’s life, therefore, had made her hardy and -strong, although her education was limited in many -lines.</p> - -<p>But she had a good basis of hard, common sense to -build upon, and with a few terms at a well conducted -school, she would make as well informed a girl as -one could find.</p> - -<p>With some trouble they managed to wrench away -the fastenings of the forward hatch, and with a heavy<span class="pagenum" id="Page_265">[265]</span> -bit which Brandon found in the captain’s chest ’tween -decks, he was able to bore a hole of sufficient size to -receive the butt of the small spar.</p> - -<p>He brought two oars on deck also, and a square of -sailcloth which was bunglingly fashioned into a sail.</p> - -<p>Brandon proposed to leave nothing undone which -would make the success of their undertaking more -sure. Something <i>might</i> happen to keep them from -reaching the other wreck, so he brought up several -cans of sea biscuit and some canned meats from the -cabin stores, and placed them in readiness for loading -the raft after it was launched.</p> - -<p>Then with the aid of heavy rollers and a short bar -they got the raft under way, and once it was started -down the inclined deck they had no trouble whatever -in keeping it going. The only bother was to keep it -from moving too fast.</p> - -<p>Brandon found it impracticable to launch the raft -from the stern, and therefore cut away a piece of the -rail on the starboard side wide enough to admit of -the passage of the lumbering hatch.</p> - -<p>They took the precaution to fasten a cable to the -raft, that it might not get away from them in its -plunge overboard, and then, by an almost superhuman -effort, rolled the platform into the sea.</p> - -<p>It went in with a terrific splash, the sea water wetting -both the castaways a good deal, for they had to -stand at the rail to steady the raft’s plunge into the -ocean.</p> - -<p>“Hurrah!” Brandon shouted. “It floats, and we -shall be able to get away.”</p> - -<p>He hastened to pull the hatch up under the brig’s<span class="pagenum" id="Page_266">[266]</span> -rail; and, with Milly’s aid, stepped the short mast. -Then he placed the boxes and provisions aboard and -lashed them firmly, after which a bed was made for -Swivel on the raft.</p> - -<p>Once more he descended into the half submerged -galley and made some more warm drink for the injured -boy, and this time Swivel was able to eat a -little cracker with it.</p> - -<p>They told him what they were about to do, and he -seemed to take more interest in the plan than he had -in anything since the night before.</p> - -<p>“Can—can you carry me, Don?” he asked faintly.</p> - -<p>“I can if I don’t hurt you,” the other replied. -“Now don’t try to talk, Swivel; but, if I hurt you -badly, touch me so I’ll know.”</p> - -<p>With this he lifted the slight form of the lad in -his strong arms, and carried him quickly, though easily, -across the sloping deck and stepped aboard the raft, -which floated almost even with the brig’s rail.</p> - -<p>The sea had gone down very much now, and it was -therefore a simple matter to embark upon the hatch.</p> - -<p>Swivel was made comfortable among the blankets, -his two friends hoisted the rule sail, the painter was -cast off, and the castaways moved slowly away from -the hulk of the Success.</p> - -<p>By this time it was quite late in the afternoon. Still -there were several hours of daylight left them, for in -this latitude the sun does not set very early, even in -the spring.</p> - -<p>The time which had elapsed since they had first -sighted the second wreck had given this latter an opportunity -to sail by the Success, for she moved much<span class="pagenum" id="Page_267">[267]</span> -faster than the water logged brig. The raft, however, -wafted along by the brisk breeze, began to overhaul -the stranger at once. By the aid of an oar, in -lieu of a rudder, Brandon was able, with little difficulty -to keep headed toward their objective point.</p> - -<p>Milly, who had brought her father’s glass along, as -well as the log book of the Success, and all papers of -any value belonging to her father, occupied her time -in trimming the sail, under Brandon’s directions, and -in gazing through the glass at the strange vessel.</p> - -<p>Soon the outlines of the latter became quite clearly -visible.</p> - -<p>“It was a brig like papa’s,” declared the girl, scrutinizing -the hull which, although denuded of every -inch of spar and rigging, still rode the long swells as -though perfectly seaworthy.</p> - -<p>“Can you see the stern, Milly?” Brandon asked, -in excitement.</p> - -<p>“Yes.”</p> - -<p>“Is there a name on it? The Swan had her name -on the stern?”</p> - -<p>“There is something on the stern, but it’s too far -off yet for me to be sure,” she replied.</p> - -<p>“The raft is behaving beautifully,” Brandon declared, -“and we shall be near enough presently for -you to be sure of what you <i>do</i> see.”</p> - -<p>Milly put down the glass and knelt by Swivel a -moment, to place his head more comfortably. Then -she went back to the instrument again.</p> - -<p>Fifteen minutes passed before she uttered a word, -while Brandon watched her face with eager interest.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_268">[268]</span> -Finally she passed him the glass and seized the steering -oar herself, although she said never a word.</p> - -<p>With hands that trembled slightly Brandon placed -the instrument to his eye and ranged it upon the stern -of the derelict. Long and earnestly did he examine -the lettering upon it, and then closed the glass with a -snap.</p> - -<p>“The Silver Swan—thank God!” he said.</p> - -<p>“Oh, I’m so glad, for your sake, Don!” exclaimed -Milly, tears of happiness shining in her eyes. “You’ll -get your father’s diamonds and be rich.”</p> - -<p>“Riches on a wreck won’t do us much good,” returned -Don grimly. “I’d rather be a pauper ashore.”</p> - -<p>“Ah, but somebody will come very quickly now to -take us off,” she said confidently.</p> - -<p>“Perhaps. But, did you ever think, that perhaps -somebody has been before us?”</p> - -<p>“How do you mean?”</p> - -<p>“Why, I mean that perhaps somebody has boarded -the brig already and secured the diamonds.”</p> - -<p>“Who?” asked the girl doubtfully. “Who knows -about it excepting your Mr. Wetherbee and that Leroyd -and his friend Weeks?”</p> - -<p>“Nobody that I know of.”</p> - -<p>“And nobody else knew where the jewels were hidden?”</p> - -<p>“Probably not.”</p> - -<p>“Then do you suppose the steamer has been here -first?”</p> - - -<div class="figcenter"><img src="images/i_268.jpg" alt="" /></div> -<p class="caption">LONG AND EARNESTLY DID HE EXAMINE THE LETTERING<br /> UPON IT THEN CLOSED THE GLASS WITH -A SNAP</p> - -<p>“Oh, no; Caleb would have towed the old Swan to -a place of safety if he had found her—especially if<span class="pagenum" id="Page_269">[269]</span> -she is as seaworthy as she appears to be from this -distance.”</p> - -<p>“Then what <i>do</i> you mean?” demanded Milly in exasperation.</p> - -<p>“What about Leroyd and Weeks?” asked Brandon -slowly.</p> - -<p>“Well, what about them?”</p> - -<p>“Do you suppose they are drowned?”</p> - -<p>“They may be.”</p> - -<p>“And then again they may not be. If they were -picked up by some vessel they might have still continued -their search for the derelict; might have found -her by accident, in fact.”</p> - -<p>“Oh, Don,” cried the girl, “you are supposing altogether -too much. Don’t conjure up such disheartening -ideas as that. Let us hope that we are the -first, who know about the treasure, to find the Silver -Swan.”</p> - -<p>“Well, it doesn’t seem hardly possible that I should -get the diamonds without any more trouble,” Brandon -said, with a sigh. “I’m afraid there’s something -wrong about it.”</p> - -<p>“Don’t talk that way, but be thankful that you -haven’t had more trouble—though, I should say -you’d had almost enough,” returned Milly, laughing -a little.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_270">[270]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXVIII<br /> - - -<small>HOW THE ENEMY APPEARED</small></h2> -</div> - -<p><span class="smcap">Slowly</span> the rude craft drew near the hull of the -Silver Swan. The brig floated as well as though she -had never struck upon Reef Eight, nor been buffeted -by the gales of this southern sea for well nigh three -months.</p> - -<p>The recent storm had done little damage to her -deck either, although the rails were smashed in one -or two places. Her wheel had been lashed firmly, -and strangely enough it still remained so, and now, -in this quiet sea, the brig held as even a keel as though -she was well manned.</p> - -<p>Within two hours of the time the castaways had -been assured that the wreck they were nearing <i>was</i> -the Silver Swan, the raft came up under her lee rail, -and Brandon caught the bight of a cable over a pin -on the quarter. Then he leaped aboard himself and -made the rope secure.</p> - -<p>The rail of the Silver Swan was so much higher -above the surface of the sea than that of the sinking -Success had been that Brandon and Milly had to fashion -a “sling” of the sail, in which to get Swivel -aboard. The injured youth bore the pain this must -have caused him uncomplainingly and was soon made -comfortable on the deck of this, their new refuge.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_271">[271]</span>They did not let the raft float away, although they -hoped that they should not need it again, and Brandon -even took the precaution of fastening it with a -second cable before they started to explore the brig.</p> - -<p>The Silver Swan had been almost uninjured by her -long journey with no pilot but the fickle winds and -currents of the ocean. The masts had, of course, all -gone in the first gale, and her crew had cut away every -bit of the wreckage before leaving her to her fate on -the reef.</p> - -<p>The hatches had been battened down and the doors -of the forecastle and cabin likewise closed, so that the -occasional seas which had washed over her had done -little toward injuring the interior.</p> - -<p>Leaving Milly to look out for Swivel, Brandon -forced open the cabin door (it had swelled badly during -the long siege of stormy weather which the brig -had withstood) and went below. Naturally everything -was in confusion—tables, chairs, and what not -overturned; but nothing about the cabin seemed injured.</p> - -<p>The cook’s quarters showed a bad state of affairs, -however, for there wasn’t a whole dish (except the tin -ones) in the place, and the stove lay on its back kicking -its four feet in the air as though in its last expiring -agonies.</p> - -<p>Brandon righted this useful utensil first, and mended -the broken pipe as best he could. Then, when he had -a fire started in the thing, he went on to examine the -smaller cabins or staterooms.</p> - -<p>He knew his father’s well enough and looked in. -But he could not bear to enter that just now, and so<span class="pagenum" id="Page_272">[272]</span> -fixed upon one, which should have belonged to the second -mate, for the use of poor Swivel.</p> - -<p>He went back to Milly and the injured boy then, -and removed the latter to the brig’s cabin.</p> - -<p>Milly, who was a capable girl in more ways than -one, went to work at once to get up a substantial meal -from the stores which they had brought from the Success, -with the addition of some eatables belonging to -the provisions of the Swan.</p> - -<p>It was rapidly growing dark, and to prevent the -liability of a collision, Brandon hunted out some of the -ship’s lanterns and hung two in the bows, and another -at the masthead, devoutly hoping that the lights, placed -in these peculiar positions, would attract the attention -of some passing vessel.</p> - -<p>Then the lamp in the cabin was filled and lighted, -and for the first time in forty-eight hours or more, -they sat down to a comfortable meal.</p> - -<p>At least, Milly and Brandon sat down; Swivel remained -in his berth, with the door of the stateroom -open, and watched them with a wan smile on his pale -face.</p> - -<p>“Now, Brandon, why don’t you see if the diamonds -are here?” asked the young girl, as they finished their -supper. “I thought you would be eager to look as -soon as you got aboard.”</p> - -<p>Don glanced across the table at her curiously.</p> - -<p>“Do you know,” he said hesitatingly. “I’m half -afraid to. It would be a terrible disappointment if -they should not be there—and perhaps they are not.”</p> - -<p>“Come, come! don’t be foolish,” said practical Milly.<span class="pagenum" id="Page_273">[273]</span> -“Take a look in the secret closet—wherever it is—or -I shall be tempted to do it myself.”</p> - -<p>Brandon, thus urged, rose and approached the companionway.</p> - -<p>“Third panel, on port side,” he repeated. “That -was Caleb’s direction, if I remember rightly. Now -let’s see.”</p> - -<p>He pressed on the designated panel, first one way -and then another. It seemed a trifle loose, but otherwise -refused to move.</p> - -<p>“Maybe I’ve made a mistake,” he muttered, when -suddenly, on his pressing downward on the edge of the -wood, a section of the panel dropped out leaving a -shallow, metal lined cavity displayed to view.</p> - -<p>“Bring the lamp, Milly,” he cried eagerly.</p> - -<p>The girl obeyed and held the light so that it might -illuminate the interior of the secret closet. There -was something in the compartment!</p> - -<p>Brandon hastily thrust in his hand and drew forth -a flat, heavy package, sealed in oiled silk and bound -with a cord. Hurrying to the cabin table with his -prize he tore off the cord, broke the seals, and unwound -the outer wrappings.</p> - -<p>Milly, quite as excited as himself, held the lamp -closer, watching his movements anxiously.</p> - -<p>Beneath the outer covering was a flat pouch of -chamois skin, the flap sealed at one end. This seal -the youth broke without hesitation, and in another instant -had poured a glittering shower of gems upon the -polished surface of the cabin table.</p> - -<p>“Diamonds! diamonds! thousands of dollars’ -worth!” cried Milly delightedly, running her fingers<span class="pagenum" id="Page_274">[274]</span> -through the little heap of glittering stones and letting -them fall in a flashing shower from her hands.</p> - -<p>The gems were uncut—at least by the hand of man—but -even in their crude state they sparkled wonderfully.</p> - -<p>For several moments they feasted their eyes on the -brilliant spectacle, and then Milly filled both hands -with the precious gems and ran to show Swivel.</p> - -<p>“Whew!” whispered that youth, his eyes growing -round with wonder. “Wot a lot of shiners!”</p> - -<p>“Don’t let him talk, Milly,” commanded Brandon, -beginning to see that it would never do for them to -excite the sick boy by the sight of the gems. “When -he is better he can see them all.”</p> - -<p>The young girl came back with the jewels, smiling -happily at her friend. She seemed quite as joyful because -of his good fortune as though the gems were -her own.</p> - -<p>Brandon took the precautions to close the door between -the cabin and Swivel’s stateroom soon after -this, that the boy might go to sleep, and then he and -Milly sat down at the table and counted the diamonds.</p> - -<p>There were no very large gems among the lot, but -they were of fair size and of the purest white.</p> - -<p>It was late that night before the two castaways retired. -Brandon prepared what had once been Caleb -Wetherbee’s quarters for Milly, but he himself slept in -the cabin, rolled up in a blanket on the floor, that he -might be near Swivel.</p> - -<p>They were so exhausted from their privations of -the past day and a half that they slept until far into -the next forenoon. Swivel was actually better, and<span class="pagenum" id="Page_275">[275]</span> -had no more sinking spells, so that Milly and Brandon -began to hope for his recovery.</p> - -<p>Just after they rose Brandon saw a sailing vessel -far down on the horizon; but it passed by without -noticing the brig. And once during the day the smoke -of a steam vessel blotted the lines where the sky and -sea met, far to the eastward.</p> - -<p>These momentary glimpses of other craft gave them -some hope, for it showed them that they were not entirely -out of the track of shipping.</p> - -<p>That night Brandon hung the lanterns out again, -and according to arrangement with Milly, remained -on deck to watch. She was to watch days, and he at -night, and he fulfilled his lonely vigil faithfully.</p> - -<p>But not a vessel appeared to gladden his lonely eyes.</p> - -<p>Milly rose early on that third day and prepared -breakfast, after eating which Brandon went to bed. -The sky remained beautifully clear, and they had nothing -to fear from the elements, for the glass forecasted -a continued spell of fine weather.</p> - -<p>Milly took up her position with the long spy glass -on the deck, and swept the horizon for some sign of -rescue. Occasionally she went down to look in on -Swivel, and about noon to prepare the dinner.</p> - -<p>When the meal was nearly ready the young girl ran -up the companionway stairs again for a final look before -she summoned Brandon from his stateroom. As -she put the glass to her eye and gazed toward the -west a cry of surprise and joy burst from her lips.</p> - -<p>Approaching the derelict brig, with a great expanse -of canvas spread to the fresh breeze, was a small<span class="pagenum" id="Page_276">[276]</span> -schooner, the water dashing white and frothy from her -bows!</p> - -<p>“Saved! saved!” gasped the girl. “Oh, thank -God!”</p> - -<p>While she had been below the vessel had come in -sight, and was now less than half a mile from the -wreck.</p> - -<p>What seemed strange, however, was that the -schooner was laying a course directly for the brig as -though it was her intention to board her.</p> - -<p>“Brandon! Brandon!” she cried, running back to -the cabin and rapping on the door.</p> - -<p>“Aye, aye!” he shouted, and was out of his berth -in a moment.</p> - -<p>“What is it?” he asked, appearing in the cabin.</p> - -<p>“There is a schooner coming right for us!” cried -Milly, laughing and crying for joy. “I’ve just discovered -it. It’s about here.”</p> - -<p>She was about to dart out upon deck again, but -Brandon grasped her arm.</p> - -<p>“Wait, Milly,” he said cautiously. “Have they -seen you yet?”</p> - -<p>“No; but I want them to.”</p> - -<p>“Not yet. We don’t know what they may be. Let -me look at them,” said the boy rapidly.</p> - -<p>He seized the glass, and mounting to the top of the -stairs, peered out from the shelter of the companionway -at the strange schooner.</p> - -<p>She lay to about a quarter of a mile away from the -derelict, and a boat was already half way between the -vessel and the wreck. Brandon examined the men in -it intently.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_277">[277]</span>Only a moment did he scrutinize them, and then he -dropped the glass with a cry of alarm. He had -recognized Jim Leroyd and the fellow Weeks among -the crew of the small boat!</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_278">[278]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XXXIX<br /> - - -<small>SHOWING HOW MR. WEEKS MADE HIS LAST MOVE</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">What</span> is it, Brandon?” gasped Milly, seeing the -look upon her companion’s face.</p> - -<p>“Look! look!” whispered the youth, thrusting the -glass into her hands.</p> - -<p>Milly gazed in terrified silence at the approaching -boat.</p> - -<p>She, as well as Don, at once recognized the villainous -Leroyd and his friend, Sneaky Al, and her heart sank -with fear.</p> - -<p>“What shall we do?” she inquired at last, turning -to Brandon.</p> - -<p>The latter turned back into the cabin without a -word, opened the secret closet and grasping the package -of diamonds thrust it into the breast of his shirt.</p> - -<p>“I’ll hide in the hold,” he said, appearing to grasp -the situation at once. “I do not believe they’ll find -me. Tell Swivel, and he’ll know what to tell and -what not to tell, if they try to pump him.</p> - -<p>“They needn’t know that I’m here at all, or that -you know anything about me. They’ll not dare to -hurt you, Milly. But I shall be on hand in case they -try it.”</p> - -<p>“But what can you do against so many?” she returned, -with a hysteric laugh.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_279">[279]</span>“Something—you’ll see. They shan’t hurt you -while I’m alive,” he declared earnestly.</p> - -<p>“But suppose they take us off with them—Swivel -and I?”</p> - -<p>“Go, of course,” returned Brandon promptly. -“Leave me to shift for myself. When you get ashore -communicate with Adoniram Pepper & Co. of New -York, and tell them how I’m fixed. Good by, Milly!”</p> - -<p>He wrung her hand warmly and disappeared in the -direction of the booby hatch ’tween decks. At the -same moment there were voices outside and the noise -of the schooner’s small boat scraping against the -side of the brig.</p> - -<p>Milly, with hands clasped tightly across her breast, -as though in the endeavor to still the heavy beating -of her heart, remained standing beside the cabin table -as the men boarded the brig and entered the cabin.</p> - -<p>The first to come below was the ill featured Leroyd -himself, and close behind him was Alfred Weeks and -two other men from the crew of the schooner.</p> - -<p>“Dash my top lights!” cried the sailor, as he caught -sight of the young girl standing there so silently.</p> - -<p>He retreated precipitately upon his friend Weeks, -who was almost as greatly astonished as himself.</p> - -<p>“How under the sun came you here, Miss Frank?” -demanded Sneaky Al, stepping forward.</p> - -<p>But Leroyd grabbed his arm and strove to drag him -back.</p> - -<p>“Stop, man! ’tis not a human!” he gasped, his usually -red face fairly pallid. “It’s the spirit of the -poor girl. I knowed how ’twould be we’en we left -her aboard the Success.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_280">[280]</span>Weeks shook off his grasp in contempt.</p> - -<p>“I’m only too willing to meet such a charming ghost -as this,” he said, with a smirk, smiling at the young -girl. “Don’t be a fool, Jim. It is Miss Frank herself, -though how she came here is the greatest of all -mysteries.”</p> - -<p>“’Tis the work o’ Davy Jones hisself,” muttered the -sailor.</p> - -<p>The other two men, both low browed, sullen appearing -fellows looked on without comment.</p> - -<p>“How did you get here?” repeated Weeks.</p> - -<p>“We came from the Success just before she was -about to sink,” Milly declared. “Did you come to -save us?”</p> - -<p>“<i>Us?</i>” cried Weeks, in utter amazement. “For -goodness’ sake, who’s with you?”</p> - -<p>“After poor papa was killed,” there was a little -choke in Milly’s voice here, “a vessel overhauled the -Success and a boy tried to save me. He brought a -rope to the wreck, but it parted before we could haul -in a heavier cable, and the gale swept the other vessel -away during the night.”</p> - -<p>“Brave chap!” muttered Weeks. “Where is he -now?”</p> - -<p>“There,” she said, pointing to the open door of the -stateroom in which Swivel was lying. “He is hurt.”</p> - -<p>“But that doesn’t explain how ye got here, miss,” -said the sailor suspiciously.</p> - -<p>“I hadn’t got to that, Mr. Leroyd. Had you been -men, you would not have left me to drown as you did, -and then there would have been no necessity for my -remaining for three days on these two vessels.”</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_281">[281]</span>“You misjudge us, I assure you,” Weeks hastened -to say, as Leroyd shrank back at the girl’s scornful -words. “Both Leroyd and I were in one boat and -the second mate was in the other boat. He declared -you to be safe, and I thought, and so did Mr. Leroyd, -that you were with him.</p> - -<p>“It was not until we were picked up by the schooner -Natchez, of Bermuda, and carried to those islands, -that we discovered your deplorable loss.”</p> - -<p>But Milly did not believe this plausible story. She -had too vivid a remembrance of Leroyd and the cowardly -Weeks during the gale, to be impressed by this -tale.</p> - -<p>“This brig passed the Success on the second day -after you left me, and we made a raft and came to it, -because it was so much more seaworthy than papa’s -vessel,” said Milly coldly.</p> - -<p>“You say this boy is hurt, eh?” said Weeks, stepping -around to the stateroom door and peering in at -Swivel, who was sleeping heavily despite the sound -of voices. “Gee! he does look bad, doesn’t he?”</p> - -<p>“Well, wot in thunder shall we do?” growled Leroyd -at length. “We’ve got no time to spend in fooling, -Al. No knowing what that—that other craft -is.”</p> - -<p>“Miss Milly,” Weeks assured her, without paying -any attention to the words of his companion, “we -shall have the pleasure of taking you and your brave -young friend ashore with us—after we settle a little -business here.”</p> - -<p>“Well, I’m glad ter hear you gittin’ down ter business,” -declared Leroyd, with satisfaction. “Come,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_282">[282]</span> -now, skin out of here, you fellers,” he added, addressing -the two men at the companionway. “We’ll come -up or call for you when we want ye.”</p> - -<p>The men departed and the sailor turned again to his -partner.</p> - -<p>“Hurry!” he exclaimed eagerly. “Where’s the -place you said they were hid? It’s somewhere in the -cabin here, isn’t it?”</p> - -<p>“Yes.”</p> - -<p>“Then send the gal on deck, too, and let’s rummage.”</p> - -<p>“We won’t be rude enough to do that,” said Weeks, -with another smirk at Milly. “We will just request -the young lady not to speak of what she sees us do.”</p> - -<p>“I don’t care. Anything, so long’s we get ’em and -get out o’ here. Suppose—”</p> - -<p>“Never mind supposing any longer. Let me see, -now,” and Weeks walked slowly to the upper end of -the cabin and counted off three panels from the companionway -on the port side.</p> - -<p>Quickly his long finger touched the surface of the -panel, pressing here and there and rattling the loose -board, and finally the panel dropped down, disclosing -the secret cupboard—empty!</p> - -<p>Leroyd darted forward.</p> - -<p>“What is it? Is it there?” he cried.</p> - -<p>“The infernal luck! it’s empty!” shouted Weeks, -and with a volley of maledictions he staggered back -and dropped into the nearest chair.</p> - -<p>Leroyd was fairly purple.</p> - -<p>“Have you tricked me!” he yelled, seizing his partner -by the shoulders and shaking him.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_283">[283]</span>“No, you fool! why should I trick you? That is -where Caleb Wetherbee said the diamonds were hid.”</p> - -<p>“Sh!” growled the sailor. “D’ye want that gal ter -know everything? She knows too much now.”</p> - -<p>“She doesn’t know anything about this; why should -she?”</p> - -<p>“Then, what’s become of them?”</p> - -<p>“I can tell you that,” returned Weeks. “Cale -Wetherbee’s been here.”</p> - -<p>“And left the Silver Swan a derelict—almost as -good as new—an’ him with a steamer?” roared Leroyd. -“Man, you’re dreaming!”</p> - -<p>“Then—what—has happened!” asked Alfred -Weeks slowly.</p> - -<p>“The gal—the gal here,” declared Leroyd, turning -fiercely upon Milly. “She’s found ’em, I tell ye!”</p> - -<p>He advanced upon the shrinking girl so threateningly, -that Milly screamed, and rushed to the companionway. -Leroyd pursued her, and Weeks followed -the angry sailor.</p> - -<p>Up to the deck darted the girl, and almost into the -arms of one of the men whom Leroyd had driven out -of the brig’s cabin. The fellow looked excited and he -shouted to the angry sailor as soon as he saw him:</p> - -<p>“De steamer come—up queek. Mr. Leroyd! Dey -put off-a boat already.”</p> - -<p>Milly, who had dodged past the speaker, turned her -eyes to the east—the opposite direction from which -the schooner had appeared—and beheld a steamship, -her two funnels vomiting thick smoke, just rounded to, -less than two cable lengths away.</p> - -<p>It was the whaleback steamer, Number Three!</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_284">[284]</span>Already a boat had put off from the whaleback and -it was now being swiftly propelled toward the Silver -Swan.</p> - -<p>The two men whom Leroyd and Weeks had brought -with them from the schooner, had been smoking in the -lee of the deck-house and had not discovered the -steamer’s approach until she was almost upon the derelict.</p> - -<p>“Curses on it!” Weeks exclaimed as he took in -the situation and recognized the steamer, whose smoke -they had beheld in the distance, before boarding the -brig.</p> - -<p>But Leroyd kept on after the fleeing Milly. He believed -that she knew something about the missing -gems, or had them in her possession, and he was determined -to get them.</p> - -<p>Milly ran to the bows of the brig, with Leroyd close -behind her.</p> - -<p>“Let that gal alone!” roared a voice from the approaching -boat. “Give way, boys! I won’t leave a -whole bone in that scoundrel’s body, once I get my -paws on him.”</p> - -<p>In an instant the small boat was under the brig’s -rail, and Caleb Wetherbee himself was upon her deck -with an agility quite surprising. Mr. Coffin and two -of the boat’s crew were right behind him.</p> - -<p>A moment later the panting girl, having eluded the -clumsier sailor, was behind the shelter of Caleb’s towering -form and those of his companions.</p> - -<p>Weeks stopped Leroyd in his mad rush for the -girl, and whispered a few swift sentences in his ear. -Then he stepped forward.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_285">[285]</span>“By what right do you board this brig, Mr. Wetherbee?” -he asked. “This is a derelict. We have -seized her and propose to tow her to port for salvage. -I command you to leave her.”</p> - -<p>“How long since you boarded her for that purpose?” -Mr. Coffin demanded, for Caleb was fairly -purple with rage and surprise.</p> - -<p>“Since half an hour ago,” replied Weeks calmly.</p> - -<p>“If that is the case, I think I have a prior claim,” -suddenly interrupted a voice. “I came aboard two -days ago and I claim the Silver Swan as mine by right -of discovery!”</p> - -<p>The astounded company turned toward the cabin entrance -and beheld Brandon Tarr just appearing from -below.</p> -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<span class="pagenum" id="Page_286">[286]</span> - -<h2 class="nobreak">CHAPTER XL<br /> - - -<small>IN WHICH THE ENEMY IS DEFEATED AND THE QUEST OF -THE SILVER SWAN IS ENDED</small></h2> -</div> - -<p>“<span class="smcap">Brandon!</span>” shouted Caleb; “it’s the boy himself!”</p> - -<p>But Leroyd uttered a howl of rage and sprang toward -the youth, his face aflame and his huge fist raised -to strike. Caleb, however, despite his wooden leg, was -too quick for him.</p> - -<p>He flew to Don’s rescue, and ere Leroyd could reach -his intended victim, the old mariner felled the villain -to the deck with one swing of his powerful arm.</p> - -<p>Weeks, who had also dashed forward to aid in -Brandon’s overthrow, was seized by the doughty captain -of the whaleback and tossed completely over the -brig’s rail.</p> - -<p>“Git out o’ here, the hull kit an’ bilin’ of ye!” Caleb -roared, starting for the two men belonging to the -schooner.</p> - -<p>They obeyed with surprising alacrity, and the old -man picked up the dazed Leroyd and tossed him into -the boat after them. Weeks, dripping and sputtering, -was hauled aboard by his companions, and the small -boat was rowed back to the schooner, while Brandon, -unable to restrain his emotion, threw up his hat -and shouted, “Hurrah!” with all his might.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_287">[287]</span>It occupied the three castaways—Milly, Brandon, -and Swivel—and Mr. Coffin and Caleb, fully two -hours to straighten out matters satisfactorily. They -had so much to tell and so much to explain for one -another’s benefit, that the whaleback had run in and -the crew passed a hawser from her stern to the bow -of the brig, under Mr. Bolin’s directions, ere the conference -was ended.</p> - -<p>Words cannot well express the astonishment that -those on the whaleback felt at finding the castaways -aboard the Silver Swan—or at finding the brig itself. -For the past twelve hours they had all believed -that the derelict was a victim of Uncle Sam’s feverish -impatience to destroy all obstructions to commerce in -his ocean.</p> - -<p>Upon figuring the whole matter up, it was pretty -evident that it was the Success which the naval ensign -had exploded, for she had been sunk at the stern -sufficiently to cover her name, and had been so battered -by the waves that the lettering on the bow was -also probably unreadable.</p> - -<p>After believing, as they did, that the Swan was -sunk and all her treasures with her, the whaleback had -sailed about in circles, seeking the wreck of the Success, -on which they believed Brandon and his two companions -to be.</p> - -<p>It was only by providential fortune that the brig -had finally been sighted, and the whaleback had -steamed up just in time to wrest the Silver Swan from -Messrs. Leroyd and Weeks.</p> - -<p>Swivel was taken aboard the steamer and carefully -examined by Lawrence Coffin, who was no mean surgeon,<span class="pagenum" id="Page_288">[288]</span> -and he pronounced the youth as seriously, if -not dangerously, injured. He had burst a blood vessel -and had sustained other internal injuries, and -would probably be unfit for work of any kind for a -long time.</p> - -<p>“Best place for him is the Marine Hospital,” declared -Mr. Coffin to Brandon and Caleb that night in -the steamer’s cabin.</p> - -<p>“Hospital nothin’!” exclaimed Caleb, with conviction. -“The hospital is all right for them as hain’t -go no homes—like as I hadn’t, nor no friends—a -good deal as I <i>was</i>—nor nothing; but <i>that</i> boy ain’t -goin’ to lack a shelter as long as <i>I’m</i> alive.”</p> - -<p>“Best not take him on a sea voyage just yet, Mr. -Wetherbee,” responded Mr. Coffin seriously.</p> - -<p>“I don’t intend to. He’s goin’ ter live with me, -though.”</p> - -<p>“But won’t you sail the Silver Swan?” asked the -first officer. “She’s as good as new and she’s yours, -too, I understand.”</p> - -<p>“No, sir, I’m not. When the Silver Swan is in -shape again, I shall put Mr. Bolin in command of her. -I’ve already spoken to him about it.”</p> - -<p>“Whew!” whistled Mr. Coffin. “And the whaleback?”</p> - -<p>“You’ll command her; that was the agreement I -made with Adoniram before we left New York.”</p> - -<p>“Thank you, Mr. Wetherbee,” exclaimed the first -officer gratefully. “But may I ask what you propose -to do?”</p> - -<p>“I shall retire from the sea—that is, from commandin’ -a ship, any way.”</p> - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_289">[289]</span>“So you’re goin’ to keep bachelor’s hall, and going -to take this Swivel to it?” and Mr. Coffin shook his -head gravely. “He really needs a woman’s nursing.”</p> - -<p>Caleb grew very red in the face, and blew his nose -furiously.</p> - -<p>“He—he’ll get it, Mr. Coffin,” he said hesitatingly.</p> - -<p>Both Brandon and the first officer looked at the old -tar in blank amazement.</p> - -<p>“I said he’d get it,” repeated Caleb solemnly, though -with a rather shamefaced look. “He’ll get it, sir, -an’ from the trimmest little woman ye ever see.”</p> - -<p>“It’s Miss Frances!” burst forth Brandon at -length.</p> - -<p>“It is her, my lad. An’ hain’t I right erbout her -bein’ a mighty trim one?”</p> - -<p>“She is, indeed! She’s splendid!” cried Brandon -enthusiastically, seizing his friend’s mighty palm.</p> - -<p>Mr. Coffin also offered his congratulations, but went -away afterward with rather a dazed look on his face.</p> - -<p>He was pretty well acquainted with the old seaman, -and he wondered, as did Brandon, how under -the sun Caleb had ever plucked up the courage to ask -Adoniram Pepper’s sister for her hand.</p> - -<p>“Yes, lad,” said the old man gravely; “I’ve been -floating about from sea to sea and from land to land -for the better part of fifty years, an’ now I’m goin’ ter -lay back an’ take it easy for the rest of my days.”</p> - -<p>And as Brandon wrung his hand again he felt that -the old seaman fully deserved it all.</p> - -<hr class="tb" /> - -<p>In good time the whaleback, with her tow, the derelict -brig, arrived in New York, where the Silver<span class="pagenum" id="Page_290">[290]</span> -Swan was at once sent to the shipyard for repairs, and -is now doing her owner good service as a merchantman.</p> - -<p>Adoniram Pepper & Co.’s scheme of recovering -derelicts in general and towing them in for their salvage, -has never amounted to anything yet, for directly -following the trip of Number Three (rechristened the -Milly Frank, by the way), the owner received a good -offer for putting the whaleback in the European trade, -and she is still carrying grain to England, with Mr. -Coffin as commander.</p> - -<p>Milly Frank’s joy at finding her relatives, of whose -existence her father had never told her, was only -equaled by the joy of Adoniram and Frances Pepper -themselves in recovering their “little sister” again—for -as such Milly appears to them.</p> - -<p>Miss Frances is of course Miss Frances no longer; -but with her husband, she still occupies her brother’s -house in New York, and Milly dwells with them.</p> - -<p>Brandon, who is at present in the naval school, resides -there also during vacation, and calls the company -of assorted humanity there gathered “the happy -family.”</p> - -<p>Swivel is in the West—that land of bracing and -salubrious climate—for after he recovered from the -accident he sustained on the wreck, the doctors told -him that he could never live and be strong in the East -again. So, with the assistance of Caleb, Adoniram, -and Brandon, who quarreled not a little as to who -should do the most for him, he was sent West, and a -glorious start in business life was given him in that -rapidly growing country.</p> - - - -<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_291">[291]</span>Brandon himself, though made independently rich -by the sale of the diamonds found by Anson Tarr, -loves the sea too well to give it up altogether, and, as -I said, is in the naval academy at Annapolis. When -he is through school and gets his appointment, he -and Milly may—but I won’t anticipate.</p> - -<p>As for the disappointed Uncle Arad, he never -pressed the matter of Brandon’s arrest after the failure -of the plot (hatched up by himself and Messrs. -Leroyd and Weeks) to convert his nephew’s property -to his own use. He still remains on the farm at Chopmist, -and by report is as crabbed and stingy as ever; -but Brandon has had no desire to return to the farm -since his Quest of the Silver Swan was ended.</p> - - -<p class="center">THE END</p> - - -<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop" /> - -<div class="chapter"> -<div class="transnote"> -<p class="ph1">TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES:</p> - -<p>Obvious typographical errors have been corrected.</p> - -<p>Inconsistencies in hyphenation have been standardized.</p> - -<p>Archaic or variant spelling has been retained.</p> -</div></div> -<div style='display:block; margin-top:4em'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE QUEST OF THE SILVER SWAN ***</div> -<div style='text-align:left'> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Updated editions will replace the previous one—the old editions will -be renamed. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright -law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works, -so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United -States without permission and without paying copyright -royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part -of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project -Gutenberg™ electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG™ -concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark, -and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following -the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use -of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for -copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very -easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation -of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project -Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away—you may -do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected -by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark -license, especially commercial redistribution. -</div> - -<div style='margin-top:1em; font-size:1.1em; text-align:center'>START: FULL LICENSE</div> -<div style='text-align:center;font-size:0.9em'>THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE</div> -<div style='text-align:center;font-size:0.9em'>PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -To protect the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting the free -distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work -(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase “Project -Gutenberg”), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full -Project Gutenberg™ License available with this file or online at -www.gutenberg.org/license. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> -Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg™ -electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to -and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property -(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all -the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or -destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in your -possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a -Project Gutenberg™ electronic work and you do not agree to be bound -by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person -or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.B. “Project Gutenberg” is a registered trademark. It may only be -used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who -agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few -things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg™ electronic works -even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See -paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project -Gutenberg™ electronic works if you follow the terms of this -agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg™ -electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (“the -Foundation” or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection -of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works. Nearly all the individual -works in the collection are in the public domain in the United -States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the -United States and you are located in the United States, we do not -claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing, -displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as -all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope -that you will support the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting -free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg™ -works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the -Project Gutenberg™ name associated with the work. You can easily -comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the -same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg™ License when -you share it without charge with others. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern -what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are -in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, -check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this -agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, -distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any -other Project Gutenberg™ work. The Foundation makes no -representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any -country other than the United States. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other -immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg™ License must appear -prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg™ work (any work -on which the phrase “Project Gutenberg” appears, or with which the -phrase “Project Gutenberg” is associated) is accessed, displayed, -performed, viewed, copied or distributed: -</div> - -<blockquote> - <div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> - This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most - other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions - whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms - of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online - at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you - are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws - of the country where you are located before using this eBook. - </div> -</blockquote> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is -derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not -contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the -copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in -the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are -redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase “Project -Gutenberg” associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply -either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or -obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg™ -trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is posted -with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution -must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any -additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms -will be linked to the Project Gutenberg™ License for all works -posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the -beginning of this work. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg™ -License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this -work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg™. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this -electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without -prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with -active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project -Gutenberg™ License. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, -compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including -any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access -to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg™ work in a format -other than “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other format used in the official -version posted on the official Project Gutenberg™ website -(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense -to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means -of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original “Plain -Vanilla ASCII” or other form. Any alternate format must include the -full Project Gutenberg™ License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, -performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg™ works -unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing -access to or distributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works -provided that: -</div> - -<div style='margin-left:0.7em;'> - <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> - • You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from - the use of Project Gutenberg™ works calculated using the method - you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed - to the owner of the Project Gutenberg™ trademark, but he has - agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project - Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid - within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are - legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty - payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project - Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in - Section 4, “Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg - Literary Archive Foundation.” - </div> - - <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> - • You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies - you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he - does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg™ - License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all - copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue - all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg™ - works. - </div> - - <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> - • You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of - any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the - electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of - receipt of the work. - </div> - - <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> - • You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free - distribution of Project Gutenberg™ works. - </div> -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project -Gutenberg™ electronic work or group of works on different terms than -are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing -from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of -the Project Gutenberg™ trademark. Contact the Foundation as set -forth in Section 3 below. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable -effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread -works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project -Gutenberg™ collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg™ -electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may -contain “Defects,” such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate -or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other -intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or -other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or -cannot be read by your equipment. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the “Right -of Replacement or Refund” described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project -Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project -Gutenberg™ trademark, and any other party distributing a Project -Gutenberg™ electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all -liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal -fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT -LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE -PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE -TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE -LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR -INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH -DAMAGE. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a -defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can -receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a -written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you -received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium -with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you -with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in -lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person -or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second -opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If -the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing -without further opportunities to fix the problem. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth -in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you ‘AS-IS’, WITH NO -OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT -LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied -warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of -damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement -violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the -agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or -limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or -unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the -remaining provisions. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the -trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone -providing copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in -accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the -production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg™ -electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, -including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of -the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this -or any Project Gutenberg™ work, (b) alteration, modification, or -additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg™ work, and (c) any -Defect you cause. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> -Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg™ -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Project Gutenberg™ is synonymous with the free distribution of -electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of -computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It -exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations -from people in all walks of life. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the -assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg™’s -goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg™ collection will -remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project -Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure -and permanent future for Project Gutenberg™ and future -generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see -Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> -Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit -501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the -state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal -Revenue Service. The Foundation’s EIN or federal tax identification -number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by -U.S. federal laws and your state’s laws. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -The Foundation’s business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, -Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up -to date contact information can be found at the Foundation’s website -and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact -</div> - -<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> -Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Project Gutenberg™ depends upon and cannot survive without widespread -public support and donations to carry out its mission of -increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be -freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest -array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations -($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt -status with the IRS. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating -charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United -States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a -considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up -with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations -where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND -DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state -visit <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/donate/">www.gutenberg.org/donate</a>. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we -have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition -against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who -approach us with offers to donate. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make -any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from -outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation -methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other -ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To -donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate -</div> - -<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> -Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg™ electronic works -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project -Gutenberg™ concept of a library of electronic works that could be -freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and -distributed Project Gutenberg™ eBooks with only a loose network of -volunteer support. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Project Gutenberg™ eBooks are often created from several printed -editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in -the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not -necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper -edition. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -Most people start at our website which has the main PG search -facility: <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. -</div> - -<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> -This website includes information about Project Gutenberg™, -including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary -Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to -subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. -</div> - -</div> -</body> -</html> diff --git a/old/68182-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/68182-h/images/cover.jpg Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index e864272..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/images/cover.jpg +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h/images/coversmall.jpg b/old/68182-h/images/coversmall.jpg Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 73c28a7..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/images/coversmall.jpg +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h/images/i_084.jpg b/old/68182-h/images/i_084.jpg Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 12649d0..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/images/i_084.jpg +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h/images/i_212.jpg b/old/68182-h/images/i_212.jpg Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 36a5545..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/images/i_212.jpg +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h/images/i_268.jpg b/old/68182-h/images/i_268.jpg Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index 25af7aa..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/images/i_268.jpg +++ /dev/null diff --git a/old/68182-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg b/old/68182-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg Binary files differdeleted file mode 100644 index c0434f8..0000000 --- a/old/68182-h/images/i_frontispiece.jpg +++ /dev/null |
